midterm review of the resource allocation framework

222
Global Environment Facility Evaluation Office Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework July 2009 (The main findings and recommendations of this evaluation were presented to the GEF Council in November 2008.) Evaluation Report No. 47

Upload: gef-independent-evaluation-office

Post on 14-Mar-2016

266 views

Category:

Documents


25 download

DESCRIPTION

L’évaluation menée à la faveur du présent examen à mi-parcours vise à déterminer dans quelle mesure les ressources ont été allouées aux pays de manière transparente et avec un bon rapport coûtefficacité, sur la base de l’amélioration de l’environnement mondial et des résultats nationaux. S’il est trop tôt pour justifier les répercussions du DAR sur l’amélioration de l’environnement, il ressort que la transition vers un nouveau mode d’allocation des ressources du FEM se heurte à des difficultés.

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Global Environment Facility Evaluation Office

Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

July 2009

(The main findings and recommendations of this evaluation were presented to the GEF Council in November 2008.)

Evaluation Report No. 47

Page 2: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

© 2009 Global Environment Facility Evaluation Office1818 H Street, NWWashington, DC 20433Internet: www.gefeo.orgEmail: [email protected]

All rights reserved.

The findings, interpretations, and conclusions expressed herein are those of the authors and do not necessarily reflect the views of the GEF Council or the governments they represent.

The GEF Evaluation Office does not guarantee the accuracy of the data included in this work. The boundaries, colors, denomi-nations, and other information shown on any map in this work do not imply any judgment on the part of the GEF concerning the legal status of any territory or the endorsement or acceptance of such boundaries.

Rights and PermissionsThe material in this work is copyrighted. Copying and/or transmitting portions or all of this work without permission may be a violation of applicable law. The GEF encourages dissemination of its work and will normally grant permission promptly.

ISBN-10: 1-933992-17-4 ISBN-13: 978-1-933992-17-4

Credits Director of the GEF Evaluation Office: Robert D. van den BergTask Manager: Siv Tokle, Senior Evaluation Officer

Editing and design: Nita CongressPrinting: Professional Graphics Printing Co.Cover photo: Svilen Mushkatov (Stock.XCNG).

Evaluation Report No. 47

A FREE PUBLICATION

Page 3: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

iii

Contents

FRAnçAis

Avant-propos .............................................................................................................................. F-1

Remerciements .......................................................................................................................... F-3

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations ................................................................... F-51.1 Évolution et état actuel du DAR .............................................................................................................. F-51.2 Principales conclusions ........................................................................................................................... F-141.3 Recommandations .................................................................................................................................... F-231.4 Mesures envisageables pour l’avenir .................................................................................................... F-26Note ...................................................................................................................................................................... F-32

Figures et tableauxFigure 1.1 Utilisation des ressources au titre de FEM-4 par Entité d’exécution et

par domaine d’intervention .................................................................................................................... F-10Figure 1.2 Utilisation des ressources par Entité d’exécution et par période de reconstitution ..... F-11Tableau 1.1 Groupes de pays/région attributaires d’allocations : parts reçues par le passé et parts reçues dans le cadre du DAR ......................................................................................................... F-7Tableau 1.2 Présentation synthétique des allocations à titre collectif ................................................... F-8Tableau 1.3 Allocation du DAR corrigée et nombre de pays par catégorie ......................................... F-9Tableau 1.4 Comparaison des parts d’allocation et des parts des notes d’IPF au titre du DAR ...... F-9Tableau 1.5 Allocation du DAR : situation à la date du 3 juillet 2008 .................................................. F-10

esPAñol

Prefacio ....................................................................................................................................... s-1

Agradecimientos ........................................................................................................................s-3

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones ....................................................................s-51.1 Evolución y situación actual del MAR ................................................................................................... S-51.2 Principales conclusiones .........................................................................................................................S-141.3 Recomendaciones .....................................................................................................................................S-231.4 Cuestiones para el futuro ........................................................................................................................S-26Nota ......................................................................................................................................................................S-31

Page 4: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

iv Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Gráficos y cuadrosGráfico 1.1 Utilización de los recursos en el FMAM-4, por organismo y esfera de actividad .......S-10Gráfico 1.2 Utilización de recursos por organismo y por período de reposición .............................S-11Cuadro 1.1 Comparación de proporciones de asignación del MAR y proporciones históricas, por grupo/región ........................................................................................................................................ S-7Cuadro 1.2 Resumen de asignación por grupo ........................................................................................... S-8Cuadro 1.3 Asignaciones ajustadas en el contexto del MAR, por clasificación de país .................... S-9Cuadro 1.4 Comparación de la proporción de puntajes del IBM y asignaciones, en el contexto del MAR ............................................................................................................................. S-9Cuadro 1.5 Situación de asignaciones del MAR al 3 de julio de 2008 .................................................S-10

enGlish

Foreword ......................................................................................................................................... i

Acknowledgments ....................................................................................................................... iii

Abbreviations ............................................................................................................................... iv

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations ............................................................................ 11.1 RAF Development and Status ..................................................................................................................... 11.2 Main Conclusions ........................................................................................................................................... 81.3 Recommendations ........................................................................................................................................ 151.4 Issues for the Future ..................................................................................................................................... 18Note .......................................................................................................................................................................... 22

2. Purpose and Methodology ................................................................................................... 242.1 Background .................................................................................................................................................... 242.2 Key Questions and Scope .......................................................................................................................... 242.3 Methodology ................................................................................................................................................ 252.4 Scope and Limitations ................................................................................................................................ 292.5 Follow-Up ....................................................................................................................................................... 29Notes ........................................................................................................................................................................ 30

3. Context of the RAF ................................................................................................................ 313.1 Origins and Objectives ............................................................................................................................... 313.2 Organizational and Institutional Context .............................................................................................. 333.3 Evolution ........................................................................................................................................................ 393.4 Allocation Process ....................................................................................................................................... 453.5 Council Decisions and Implementation ................................................................................................ 50Notes ........................................................................................................................................................................ 52

4. Design of the RAF .................................................................................................................. 544.1 The GEF Benefits Index .............................................................................................................................. 544.2 The GEF Performance Index ..................................................................................................................... 604.3 Other Design Elements .............................................................................................................................. 66

Page 5: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Contents v

4.4 Recognition of Country Achievements .................................................................................................. 734.5 Synergies and Interrelationships ............................................................................................................... 77Notes ........................................................................................................................................................................ 80

5. Allocations and Utilization ................................................................................................... 825.1 Country Allocations ..................................................................................................................................... 825.2 Portfolio Overview ...................................................................................................................................... 89Notes ........................................................................................................................................................................ 93

6. implementation of the RAF .................................................................................................. 956.1 Institutional Roles and Relationships....................................................................................................... 956.2 Guidance, Support, and Transparency .................................................................................................1006.3 RAF Effectiveness and Efficiency ..........................................................................................................1026.4 Emerging Effects ........................................................................................................................................1086.5 Cost-Effectiveness .....................................................................................................................................125Notes ......................................................................................................................................................................127

Annex: Management Response ............................................................................................... 129

Bibliography .............................................................................................................................. 137

Boxes6.1 Key Trends in GEF-4 .................................................................................................................................108

Figures1.1 Resource Utilization in GEF-4 by Agency and Focal Area ................................................................... 51.2 Resource Utilization by Agency and Replenishment Period ................................................................ 64.1 Distribution of Indicators in the GBI and the GPI ............................................................................... 625.1 Logarithm Match with Historical Allocation ........................................................................................ 835.2 Regional Shares of Resources: Historical and RAF Adjusted Allocations ...................................... 835.3 Shares of Resource Utilization by Individual and Group Allocation Countries by Replenishment Period ................................................................................................................................. 885.4 Shares of Historical and GEF-4 Resource Utilization by Focal Area ............................................... 90

Tables1.1 Comparison of Historical and RAF Allocation Shares by Constituency/Region ........................... 31.2 Summary of Group Allocation .................................................................................................................... 31.3 Adjusted Allocations under the RAF by Country Classification ........................................................ 41.4 Comparison of Allocation and GBI Score Shares under the RAF ...................................................... 41.5 Status of RAF Allocation as of July 3, 2008 .............................................................................................. 54.1 RAF Allocations and GBI Scores by Type of Allocation: Biodiversity ............................................. 574.2 RAF Allocations and GBI Scores by Type of Allocation: Climate Change ..................................... 594.3 Distribution of GPI and GBI Scores across GPI Quintiles ................................................................. 655.1 Comparison of Historical and RAF Allocations .................................................................................. 825.2 Comparison of Historical, Adjusted, and Unadjusted Group Allocations under the RAF ........ 845.3 Allocations under the RAF by Country Income Category ................................................................. 865.4 Top 10 Recipients of GEF Assistance under the RAF and Historically ........................................... 87

Page 6: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

vi Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

5.5 Number and Percentage of Countries with Resource Access across the GEF Phases ................. 916.1 Key Factors Influencing Access to Funds .............................................................................................1036.2 Shares of Resource Utilization by GEF Operational Program Historically and under the RAF ....................................................................................................................................................1126.3 Shares of Global/Regional Resource Utilization by Focal Area Historically and under the RAF ....1196.4 GEF Investment in the SGP Project Portfolio by Focal Area ...........................................................124

Page 7: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-1

Avant-propos

En réponse aux recommandations pratiques de la troisième reconstitution des ressources du Fonds pour l’environnement mondial (FEM), le Conseil du FEM a convenu de mettre en application un dispositif d’allocation des ressources (DAR) basé sur les potentialités dont dispose un pays pour contribuer à améliorer l’environnement mondial et sur un indice de résultat. Dans le contexte de l’évaluation des besoins et des potentialités dans les domaines de la diversité biologique et des chan-gements climatiques, le DAR se présente comme un système d’allocation basé sur les résultats pas comme les autres. Compte tenu du caractère innovateur de ce dispositif, le Conseil a demandé au Bureau de l’évaluation du FEM de procéder à l’examen du DAR en 2008, au terme de deux ans de mise en application.

L’évaluation menée à la faveur du présent exa-men à mi-parcours vise à déterminer dans quelle mesure les ressources ont été allouées aux pays de manière transparente et avec un bon rapport coût-efficacité, sur la base de l’amélioration de l’envi-ronnement mondial et des résultats nationaux. S’il est trop tôt pour justifier les répercussions du DAR sur l’amélioration de l’environnement, il res-sort que la transition vers un nouveau mode d’al-location des ressources du FEM se heurte à des difficultés.

Les pays pouvant prétendre au régime d’allocation individuelle se félicitent en général de la prévisi-

bilité accrue des financements du FEM, alors que ceux bénéficiant d’allocations plus modestes et regroupées se sont heurtés à des difficultés pour avoir accès aux ressources du FEM. Les coûts de transaction liés au DAR et aux autres réformes ayant étant élevés pour le partenariat du FEM, les coûts-avantages en termes de rapport qualité-prix, n’ont pas été clairement démontrés. Cela reflète, au moins en partie, les attentes de voir le FEM fournir son appui à un grand nombre de pays alors qu’il dispose de ressources limitées pour remplir sa mission de protection de l’environne-ment mondial.

En droite ligne des recommandations de l’exa-men à mi-parcours de novembre 2008, le Conseil a décidé que les fonds inutilisés seraient réalloués durant la dernière année de FEM-4, suivant des règles objectives et une procédure transparente et équitable à établir au cours des prochains mois. L’information complète du public, l’obligation de transparence, la participation des différents acteurs et la définition de responsabilités claires sont les aspects qui présideront à la mise en appli-cation de la dernière phase de FEM-4, y compris la réallocation des fonds.

Par rapport à l’avenir, le Conseil a aussi demandé au Secrétariat du FEM, au Groupe consultatif du FEM pour la science et la technologie et à d’autres acteurs de proposer des mesures destinées à amé-liorer la conception du DAR et des indices pour les

Page 8: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-2 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

domaines d’intervention « diversité biologique » et « changements climatiques » dans la perspective de FEM-5 ; il leur a aussi été demandé de proposer des scénarios d’expansion éventuelle du DAR — si possible —au regard de tous les domaines d’inter-vention pour FEM-5. Les aspects ciblés par l’exa-men à mi-parcours pour ces améliorations com-prennent la suppression du régime d’allocation collective, la reconnaissance des problèmes envi-ronnementaux à caractère mondial, l’amélioration du coefficient de pondération affecté aux résultats du portefeuille (indice de résultat du FEM) et le réexamen des règles régissant les plafonds et plan-chers d’allocation et les limites de dépense.

L’examen à mi-parcours a couvert un champ plus complexe et plus ambitieux qu’une évaluation for-mative habituelle. Il présente une analyse compa-rative du DAR avec les systèmes d’allocation basés sur les résultats en vigueur dans d’autres organis-mes multilatéraux ; comprend une analyse statisti-que exhaustive, des simulations et la modélisation de données, ainsi qu’un examen de portefeuille couvrant toutes les allocations passées et modifi-cations opérées au cours de la période de FEM-4. Les indicateurs, les indices et la conception du

DAR sont l’objet d’une étude Delphi par les pairs menée par trois groupes d’experts indépendants sur la diversité biologique, les changements clima-tiques et les résultats.

L’examen a permis de produire plusieurs docu-ments techniques de base et annexes statistiques contenant des conclusions détaillées et des don-nées sous-jacentes. Ces documents et informa-tions sont disponibles sur le site web du Bureau de l’évaluation du FEM (www.gefeo.org) et sur CD-ROM. Je ne doute pas que ces documents et les informations de fond qu’ils véhiculent sur les aspects multiples de la conception et de l’appli-cation du DAR aideront le FEM à poursuivre l’ef-fort d’amélioration de son dispositif d’allocation des ressources à l’avenir et durant la prochaine période de programmation. Le Bureau de l’éva-luation continuera de se pencher sur cet impor-tant aspect de l’appui du FEM dans le contexte du Quatrième bilan global du FEM.

Rob D. van den BergDirecteur, Bureau de l’évaluation

Page 9: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-3

Remerciements

Ce rapport a été préparé sous la direction de Siv Tokle, chef de l’équipe d’évaluation et spécialiste principale de l’évaluation au Bureau de l’évaluation du FEM, qui a coordonné et dirigé tous les volets de l’évaluation et rédigé le rapport avec l’aide des membres principaux de l’équipe. La longue expé-rience de Kenneth Watson, consultant spécialisé dans les systèmes d’allocation fondés sur les résul-tats, a été une source inestimable d’inspiration et d’enseignements pour le DAR ; James Fremming, consultant également, a enrichi l’analyse des ques-tions de mise en application et de méthodologie avec son expertise en renforcement des capacités et en évaluation.

Au sein du Bureau de l’évaluation du FEM, l’ana-lyse des allocations et d’indispensables simula-tions statistiques a été menée par Yu-Kui Zhou qui a travaillé en collaboration avec Divya Nair pour passer en revue le portefeuille et les alloca-tions passées du FEM. Shaista Ahmed a analysé et appuyé l’enquête conduite auprès de 700 person-nes et soutenu le travail d’analyse du portefeuille de projets en instance, tandis que Florentina

Mulaj s’est occupée de la longue étude de docu-ments qui a été effectuée. D’autres collègues du Bureau de l’évaluation ont aussi aidé l’équipe, dont Neeraj Negi, spécialiste de l’évaluation qui a étu-dié les répercussions du DAR sur le Programme de microfinancements du FEM.

L’équipe exprime ses remerciements à tous les groupes d’acteurs concernés, pour les commen-taires détaillés et francs qu’ils ont formulés au cours des longues séances de consultation tenues avec eux, en particulier les points focaux du FEM à l’occasion de cinq ateliers sous-régionaux, le Secrétariat du FEM, les 10 organismes et agents d’exécution du FEM, les secrétariats des conven-tions sur la diversité biologique et les change-ments climatiques, le Groupe consultatif pour la science et la technologie et les organisations non gouvernementales.

Un avant-projet du présent document a été pré-senté au Conseil du FEM en novembre 2008. Le Bureau de l’évaluation assume l’entière responsa-bilité du contenu de ce rapport.

Page 10: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework
Page 11: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-5

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations

En réponse aux recommandations de la troisième reconstitution des ressources du Fonds pour l’en-vironnement mondial (FEM) correspondant à la période 2003–06, le Conseil du FEM a convenu de mettre en application un dispositif d’allocation des ressources (DAR) basé sur les potentialités dont dis-pose un pays pour contribuer à améliorer l’environ-nement mondial dans les domaines de la diversité biologique et des changements climatiques et sur un indice de résultat. (Une synthèse des décisions sur le DAR figure dans le Document technique no 1 intitulé « Methodology and Context », tableau 2.3.)

Les recommandations pratiques pour la quatrième reconstitution demandaient au Secrétariat du FEM de travailler en collaboration avec le Conseil pour établir un dispositif permettant d’allouer les res-sources limitées du FEM « de manière qu’elles aient le plus grand impact possible sur l’amélioration de l’environnement mondial et favorisent l’adoption de politiques et méthodes environnementales ration-nelles à l’échelle mondiale » (FEM 2002f). Le DAR devait offrir aux pays un cadre pour la program-mation de leurs ressources en fonction des priori-tés nationales ; permettre aux pays de prévoir avec plus de certitude le montant de ressources du FEM auquel ils auront accès ; et favoriser la transparence dans la mesure où il rend publique une méthode bien définie d’allocation des ressources du FEM.

D’après le document final approuvé du dispositif, le DAR est «… un dispositif d’allocation des res-

sources du FEM destiné à allouer les ressources de façon transparente et cohérente sur la base de priorités environnementales à caractère mondial et en fonction des politiques et pratiques des pays et de leur capacité à exécuter efficacement des projets du FEM » (FEM 2005c). Il est composé de trois indices :

Indice de potentialité du FEM pour la diversité z

biologique (IPF-BIO)

Indice de potentialité du FEM pour les change- z

ments climatiques (IPF-CC)

Indice de résultat du FEM (IRF) z

Le FEM a alloué, dans le cadre du DAR, 1 milliard de dollars à 150 pays dans le domaine d’interven-tion « diversité biologique » et 1 milliard de dol-lars à 161 pays dans celui des changements clima-tiques au titre de la période 2006-10. Les pays ont accès à ces financements en proposant des projets conformes aux priorités stratégiques du FEM. Le Conseil du FEM a demandé au Bureau de l’évalua-tion du FEM de procéder à un examen du DAR après deux années d’application et d'évaluer les résultats concrets obtenus par le FEM et ses par-tenaires dans le cadre du DAR.

1.1 Évolution et état actuel du DARL’élaboration et la mise en application du DAR sont intervenues au cours d’une période marquée par de nombreux autres changements et réformes.

Page 12: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-6 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

Ces événements ont influé sur la conception et la mise en application du DAR qui, à son tour, a mar-qué le partenariat du FEM et l'application d'autres réformes. Par ailleurs, la reconstitution de FEM-4, bien qu’elle ait été une réussite et qu’elle soit en augmentation en valeur nominale par rapport à FEM-3, n’a pas constitué une augmentation en termes de fonds réellement disponibles, bien que la demande des ressources du FEM et le nombre d’objectifs stratégiques et de domaines d’interven-tion se soient accrus au fil du temps.

Parallèlement, la communauté des bailleurs de fonds et les instances des conventions internatio-nales accordent une attention croissante à la néces-sité de mobiliser des appuis et des ressources au profit de l’environnement. La prise de conscience des changements climatiques et de leurs effets se traduit par la mise en place de nouveaux fonds aux côtés de la Caisse du FEM. Les stratégies révi-sées des domaines d’intervention dans le cadre de FEM-4 (approuvées en octobre 2007) se caracté-risent par une meilleure efficacité, circonscrivent davantage les domaines d’intervention et inscri-vent les objectifs stratégiques dans l’optique des plateformes-cadres. FEM-4 a également démarré en mettant davantage l’accent sur une plus grande efficacité, en révisant le cycle de projet du FEM, en renforçant l’approche-programme (voir le cha-pitre 6) et en décidant de placer les Entités d’exé-cution du FEM sur un pied d’égalité, par la sup-pression des budgets institutionnels des Entités d’exécution et la majoration des allocations pour frais d’administration des projets. Ces change-ments et réformes du FEM et d’autres ont eu des répercussions sensibles sur l’application du DAR, ce qui donne à penser qu’il est impossible d’établir des comparaisons exactes entre la période d’appli-cation du DAR et FEM-3.

L’élaboration du DAR a pris du temps : le Conseil a tenu sept réunions sur une période de quatre ans

et de nombreux séminaires, groupes de travail et consultations ont été organisés. La préparation pour la mise en application a commencé une fois l’accord conclu en septembre 2005. Les alloca-tions de ressources aux pays ont été publiées en septembre 2006, après la fin de FEM-3 en juillet 2006. Les échanges de vues sur les objectifs prio-ritaires de chaque allocation de ressources se sont poursuivies jusqu’au printemps 2007. La mise en application du DAR a officiellement commencé en février 2007, lorsque la quatrième reconstitu-tion du FEM est entrée en vigueur. Ces différents retards n’ont pas permis de lancer le DAR dans les délais prévus. Si moins de deux années se sont écoulées jusqu’à mi-parcours, en juillet 2008, et si les répercussions sur l’environnement ne peuvent pas encore se remarquer, des effets clairs apparais-sent, notamment les différences avec les autres domaines d'intervention qui ne sont pas encore financés par le biais du DAR.

Allocations de ressources dans le cadre de cycles précédentsComme le prévoit la conception du DAR, les allo-cations de ressources correspondent aux tendan-ces passées des allocations du FEM. Au plan statis-tique, la formule du DAR donne lieu à des niveaux élevés de corrélation entre les allocations passées et les allocations actuelles pour tous les pays dans toutes les phases, comme le montre l’analyse des tendances dans le diagramme de dispersion (voir la figure 5.1). Les résultats du DAR peuvent repro-duire les allocations passées, mais plusieurs autres formules avec des coefficients de pondération dif-férents pourraient en faire de même.

Pendant toutes les périodes passées de reconsti-tution des ressources du FEM, 3 seulement des 20 allocations de ressources à titre individuel les plus importantes dans le domaine de la diversité biolo-gique étaient aussi parmi les 20 plus importantes par le passé, et 12 des 20 plus importantes dans

Page 13: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-7

le domaine des changements climatiques étaient les mêmes. La part des ressources affectées aux pays pour chaque cycle de refinancement corres-pond de près à celle qui leur a été allouée pendant FEM-4 tant en fonction de leur IFP dans le cadre du DAR que par domaine d’intervention. La plu-part des pays relevant du régime collectif ont reçu des montants limités dans le passé. De même, le montant plus élevé en valeur nominale de FEM-4 et la réduction des projets mondiaux et régionaux se sont traduits par une augmentation des res-sources disponibles aux fins d’allocation aux pays.

Cette tendance générale fait ressortir des varia-tions considérables pour certains pays et une variation de la prédominance des ressources entre les deux domaines d'intervention du DAR dans un pays. Au cours de la période de FEM-3, plus de 100 pays ont eu accès à des financements dans les deux domaines d’intervention. Par rapport aux montants passés, les ressources allouées par le DAR représentent un gain éventuel pour 115 pays dans le domaine de la diversité biologique et pour 71 pays bénéficiant d’allocations dans le domaine des changements climatiques, bien que le mon-tant de ces gains ne soit pas considérable, à condi-

tion que les pays puissent avoir accès au montant maximum des ressources qui leur sont allouées : les pays restants pouvant prétendre aux finance-ments reçoivent moins que par le passé. Les chan-ces d’accès sont plus importantes si un pays a été associé au FEM dans le passé, a un portefeuille de projets et a bénéficié d’une allocation du DAR.

Pays attributaires d’allocations à titre individuel Le DAR a accordé à 57 pays, dans le domaine d’in-tervention « diversité biologique » des allocations individuelles potentielles d’un montant total de 753,2 millions de dollars. Dans le domaine « chan-gements climatiques », ce montant a été de 751,4 millions de dollars au total pour 46 pays. La com-paraison avec les parts reçues dans le passé par groupe de pays/région du FEM est présentée au tableau 1.1.1 Les 31 pays attributaires d’allocations individuelles dans les deux domaines d’interven-tion ont reçu 61 % de financement total au titre de la diversité biologique (contre 52 % dans le passé) ; et 68 % dans le domaine des changements climati-ques (contre 73 % dans le passé). Pour promouvoir une répartition plus équitable des ressources, l’al-

Tableau 1.1

Groupes de pays/région attributaires d’allocations : parts reçues par le passé et parts reçues dans le cadre du DAR

Groupe de pays membres/région

Diversité biologique (57 pays relevant du régime individuel)

Changements climatiques (46 pays relevant du régime individuel)

Passé (%) DAR (%) Passé (%) DAR (%)

Europe et CEI 6 5 11 30

Asie 26 27 49 44

Afrique de l’Ouest et centrale 5 5 2 1

Afrique de l’Est et australe 16 16 6 6

Caraïbes 1 4 1 1

PEID Pacifique 2 2 0 0

Amérique latine 40 40 23 15

Moyen-Orient et Afrique du Nord 3 2 8 4

Total (UsD) 1 347 millions 753 millions 1 557 millions 751 millionsnote : CEI = Communauté des États indépendants.

Page 14: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-8 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

location d’un pays ne peut pas excéder 10 % pour la diversité biologique et 15 % pour les changements climatiques du montant total des ressources consa-crées au domaine d’intervention concerné. Ces pla-fonds sont fixés à un niveau trop élevé pour avoir un effet sur les allocations et limitent actuellement l’allocation à un pays seulement (la Chine) dans le domaine des changements climatiques.

Allocations de ressources à titre collectif Dans le cas des pays relevant du régime collec-tif, il est difficile de faire une comparaison avec le passé parce que les pays partagent une enveloppe de financement qui ne prévoit pas d'allocation fixe par pays. Toutefois, ces pays, avant d’être placés dans le groupe, ont une note et une allocation pré-liminaires (non rendues publiques). Le montant total de cette enveloppe comprend les allocations préliminaires des pays soumis au régime collectif, se chiffrant à plus d’un million de dollars, plus le million de dollars chacun pour le reste des pays ; ce montant est qualifié d’allocation corrigée (voir le tableau 1.2). Dès lors que les pays sont placés sous le régime collectif, aucun montant ne peut plus être garanti pour tel ou tel pays, mais tous les pays peuvent soutenir la concurrence en vue de bénéficier d’un montant plus élevé que celui qu’ils auraient normalement reçu au titre de leur alloca-tion préliminaire.

Les possibilités d’accès sont nombreuses. Dans un cas extrême, 42 pays pourraient obtenir dans le domaine de la diversité biologique, le maximum de 3,5 millions de dollars et les 51 autres pays ne recevraient aucun financement. Dans le domaine des changements climatiques, 48 pays pourraient obtenir le maximum et il ne resterait rien pour les 67 autres pays. Dans le cadre des cycles précé-dents de refinancement, de nombreux pays n’ont en fait reçu aucun financement. À l’opposé, si tous les pays recevaient 1 million de dollars de l’enve-loppe de financement, 21 pays pour le domaine

de la biodiversité et 16 pays pour celui des chan-gements climatiques pourraient obtenir le maxi-mum, soit plus de 3 millions de dollars chacun.

La plupart des pays qui se trouvent dans une situa-tion particulière reçoivent des allocations collecti-ves (voir le tableau 1.3). À titre d’exemple, dans le domaine des changements climatiques, 97 % des 48 petits États insulaires en développement (PEID) font partie du groupe des pays bénéficiant d’allo-cations collectives ; de même 88 % des 48 pays les moins avancés (PMA). L’appartenance au groupe bénéficiant des allocations collectives intensifie les difficultés que les PEID et les PMA rencontrent pour accéder aux ressources du FEM.

Ressources et effets positifs pour l’environnement mondialLe DAR accorde des financements aux pays qui apportent une contribution importante à l’amélio-ration de l’environnement mondial telle qu’elle est mesurée par l’indice de potentialité du FEM pour la diversité biologique (IPF-BIO) ; l’indice de résultat

Tableau 1.2

Présentation synthétique des allocations à titre collectif

ParamètreDiversité

biologique Changements

climatiques

Nombre de pays 93 115

Montant total des fonds mis en commun

USD 146,8 M USD 148,6 M

Maximum possible par pays USD 3,5 M USD 3,0 M

Allocation préliminaire

> USD 1 million 53 pays 41 pays

USD 1 million 10 pays 33 pays

< USD1 million 30 pays 41 pays

Compléments nécessairesa

USD 15,4 M USD 25,9 M

a. Les compléments nécessaires permettent aux pays de recevoir une allocation préliminaire de moins d’un million de dollars accom-pagnée d’une allocation corrigée d’un montant minimum d’un million de dollars ; le montant total des compléments est intégré aux fonds mis en commun au titre des allocations collectives.

Page 15: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-9

du FEM (IRF) ne joue pas un rôle aussi important pour la détermination du montant des ressources allouées. Dans le domaine « diversité biologique » les 57 pays attributaires d’une allocation indivi-duelle drainent 88 % du total des notes d’IPF pour les 150 pays pouvant prétendre aux financements et drainent 75,3 % du montant total des ressour-ces dans ledit domaine. Dans le domaine « chan-gements climatiques », les 46 pays relevant du régime individuel reçoivent 75 % du montant total des ressources pour ce domaine d’intervention et couvrent 89 % des notes de l’indice de résultat du FEM pour les changements climatiques (IPF-CC) des 161 pays pouvant prétendre aux financements (voir le tableau 1.4). Les pays à mégabiodiversité sont bien représentés pour ce qui est de la diver-sité biologique, mais il n'en est pas de même pour les sites sensibles qui recouvrent plusieurs pays

pouvant prétendre à des allocations à titre indivi-duel et à titre collectif (la réduction des ressources mondiales et régionales a également une incidence sur la part des sites sensibles). Dans le domaine des changements climatiques, les émissions de gaz à effet de serre représentent le principal fac-teur déterminant.

Utilisation des ressourcesDans le cadre du nouveau cycle de projet, l’expres-sion « utilisation des ressources » est définie par le Secrétariat du FEM comme désignant l’appro-bation de la fiche d’indentification du projet (FIP) et précède l’adoption du document du projet. Sur la base de cette définition, la première période du DAR a enregistré une utilisation nettement moins élevée des fonds dans les domaines d’intervention du dispositif. À mi-parcours, pratiquement aucun décaissement des fonds de FEM-4 n’a été enregis-tré sur le terrain. Le taux global d’utilisation des ressources s’établit à 31 % des fonds consacrés aux domaines d’intervention à mi-parcours. Le taux d’utilisation des ressources est bien plus élevé dans les domaines d’intervention non liés au DAR (voir la figure 1.1) : eaux internationales (59 %), dégra-dation des sols (81 %) et POP (48 %). Il convient de relever que la première période du DAR a en fait duré moins de deux ans, FEM-4 étant entré en vigueur en février 2007.

Tableau 1.3

Allocation du DAR corrigée et nombre de pays par catégorie

Catégorie de pays

Diversité biologique (150 pays) Changements climatiques (161 pays)

nombre de pays Allocation (UsD millions) nombre de pays Allocation (UsD millions)

Tous ind. Groupe Tous ind. Groupe Tous ind. Groupe Tous ind. Groupe

PEID 35 9 26 110,05 62,29 47,76 35 1 34 40,56 4,25 36,31

PMA 48 13 35 154,84 95,63 59,20 48 6 42 80,36 28,44 51,92

Pays enclavés 35 9 26 87,64 50,48 37,16 36 9 27 98,63 59,86 38,76

États fragiles 30 8 22 86,21 48,33 37,87 30 4 26 56,35 27,64 28,71

PPTE 40 16 24 164,69 124,08 40,61 40 5 35 67,90 21,55 46,35

note : PPTE = Pays pauvres très endettés ; Ind. = Allocation individuelle ; Groupe = Allocation collective.

Tableau 1.4

Comparaison des parts d’allocation et des parts des notes d’iPF au titre du DAR

Paramètre

Diversité biologique

Changement climatique

ind. Groupe ind. Groupe

Nombre de pays 57 93 46 115

Part des pays (%) 38 62 29 71

Part de l’ allocation (%) 75 15 75 15

Part de la note d’IPF (%) 88 12 89 11

note : Ind. = Allocation individuelle ; Groupe = Allocation collective.

Page 16: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-10 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

Depuis le 3 juillet 2008, date à laquelle le DAR arrive normalement à mi-parcours, la Directrice générale avait agréé 15 projets nationaux de grande envergure. Si l’on considère l’agrément du descrip-tif de projet par la Directrice générale comme une indication plus réaliste de l’utilisation des fonds, les pays ont jusqu’ici utilisé 6 % du montant total des allocations individuelles du DAR au titre de FEM-4 (voir le tableau 1.5). Étant donné que le projet est censé démarrer lorsque les fonds sont décaissés, on n’a enregistré qu’un seul projet.

Tableau 1.5

Allocation du DAR : situation à la date du 3 juillet 2008

situationDiversité

biologique Changements

climatiques

Allocation du DAR USD 900 M USD 900 M

Utilisation des ressources (validation de la FIP)

USD 287 M (32%)

USD 252 M (28%)

Agrément par la direc-trice générale

USD 37,8 M (4%)

USD 65,4 M (7%)

En cours d’exécution s.o. s.o.

note : s.o. = sans objet.

L’accès aux financements n’est pas uniforme. Les pays attributaires d’une allocation collective dans le domaine de la diversité biologique ont utilisé 18 % de leur allocation, contre 5 % seulement dans le domaine des changements climatiques. En revan-che, les pays relevant du régime individuel ont utilisé 33 % des validations de FIP, des dons pour la préparation de projets et des approbations de projets de moyenne envergure.

Composition des entités d’exécutionLe DAR a entraîné un accroissement de la parti-cipation du Programme des Nations Unies pour le développement (PNUD) et des « nouvelles » Entités d’exécution du FEM et une réduction de la participation de la Banque mondiale, et de celle du Programme des Nations Unies pour l’environ-nement (PNUE) dans une moindre mesure.

La part de la Banque mondiale (y compris la Société financière internationale - IFC), tradition-nellement l’Agent d’exécution le plus important en termes de ressources du FEM, est passée de plus de la moitié des ressources du FEM consacrées à la diversité biologique et aux changements clima-tiques au cours des périodes précédentes, à 32 % de l’utilisation des financements du DAR en ce qui concerne les agréments de FIP. La part de la Ban-que mondiale a augmenté pour les domaines d’in-tervention multisectoriels, passant de 21 % à 33 % dans le cadre de FEM-4, alors que sa participation globale dans les domaines d’intervention non liés au DAR a augmenté par rapport au passé. Comme le montre la figure 1.2, le niveau d’utilisation des ressources par le PNUD se chiffre désormais à 43 %, contre 28 % dans le passé.

Suite à la révision de la politique de manière à pla-cer les Organismes et Agents d’exécution du FEM sur un même pied d’égalité, le rôle des Organis-mes d’exécution a été renforcé dans FEM-4, à 17 % d’utilisation des financements du DAR, contre

Figure 1.1

Utilisation des ressources au titre de FeM-4 par entité d’exécution et par domaine d’intervention

Millions de dollars

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

180

200

Diversitébiologique

Changementsclimatiques

Domainesd’interventionmultisectoriels

Sourcesautres que

le DAR

Banque mondiale PNUD PNUE Organisme d’exécution

0

note : La figure ne mentionne pas les projets exécutés conjointement, ceux-ci représentant un total inférieur ou égal à un million de dollars.

Page 17: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-11

7,9 % dans le cadre de FEM-3 (y compris l’accès indirect), soit 2 % de tous les financements pas-sés. Ces montants comprennent 30,1 millions de dollars pour des projets de la banque européenne pour la reconstruction et le développement (BERD) en Russie et en Ukraine, sept projets de la Banque asiatique de développement (BAsD) com-portant des activités rattachées à la plateforme-cadre du Pacifique. La Banque interaméricaine de développement (BID) compte huit projets dans la région Amérique latine et Caraïbes (LAC) et le Fonds international de développement agricole (FIDA) et l’Organisation des Nations Unies pour l’alimentation et l’agriculture (FAO) ont aussi des projets de FEM-4.

Ces changements sont influencés non seulement par le DAR mais aussi par de nombreux autres facteurs : tous les Agents et Organismes d’exécu-tion sont touchés par d’autres réformes de FEM-4 et l’évolution des rôles dans le cadre du DAR. Par ailleurs, la situation actuelle est rapport avec la capacité du PNUD à fournir de l’assistance tech-nique et contribuer au renforcement des capacités avec l’aide des bureaux locaux, ainsi que sa volonté de participer à des projets d’envergure relative-

ment modeste au titre du DAR. L’éparpillement des petits montants d’allocations du DAR sur de nombreux pays ne facilite guère l’application de la politique consistant à combiner les prêts des ins-titutions financières internationales (IFI) avec des projets du FEM de taille rentable. Il est souvent plus facile d’accéder à d’autres sources de finance-ment internes qu’aux ressources du FEM.

Rôles et relationsS’il est vrai que le DAR n’exigeait pas de modifica-tion formelle des rôles du FEM si ce n'est la nou-velle fonction de gestion et de contrôle assumée par le Secrétariat, il a provoqué des réorientations importantes des rôles dans le partenariat du FEM. En combinaison avec d’autres réformes, le DAR a incité le Secrétariat à jouer un rôle plus impor-tant dans le lancement des projets, la préparation de programmes et la concertation bilatérale avec les pays, dont le point de départ a été l’examen du portefeuille de projets en instance du DAR. Les points focaux techniques font état d’un accrois-sement de leur rôle (en particulier dans les pays attributaires d'allocations individuelles), qui est passé du simple agrément à la programmation et l'établissement de l'ordre des priorités proprement dits. Pour établir les priorités du portefeuille de projets du FEM, ils conduisent des consultations nationales qui sont souvent plus larges et plus sys-tématiques qu'auparavant. Les points focaux dans les pays soumis au régime collectif devraient jouer le même rôle de coordination et d'établissement de l'ordre des priorités, mais avec moins de res-sources à programmer.

Il ne faudrait pas déduire de cette participation accrue des points focaux techniques que les pays adhèrent totalement aux projets du FEM, parce que d’autres partenaires comme les ONG, le sec-teur privé et des donateurs participent moins et les consultations portent davantage sur le por-tefeuille national que sur les projets individuels.

Figure 1.2

Utilisation des ressources par entité d’exécution et par période de reconstitution

note : AE = Agent d’exécution ; OE = Organisme d’exécution.

Banque mondiale

PNUD

PNUE

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

Phasepilote

GEF-1 GEF-2 GEF-3 GEF-4

% du total pour la phase de reconstitution

AE conjointOEAE/OE

conjoint

Page 18: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-12 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

L’examen à mi-parcours montre que seulement 44 % des services des ONG et des organisations du secteur privé ont indiqué que la participation publique au titre du DAR avait connu un succès modéré à très important, et 69 % des parties pre-nantes du Programme de microfinancements ont indiqué qu’elles craignaient que le rôle neutre de ce programme ne soit mis à mal par le renforce-ment du rôle joué par le gouvernement dans la planification du FEM.

Les rôles continuent d’évoluer aussi bien par suite des changements au titre du RAF qu’en fonction des autres changements du FEM. Par exemple, le rôle joué par les trois Entités d’exécution initiales du FEM a diminué récemment dans la gestion stratégique du FEM, et le rôle du Conseil a changé au regard du nouveau cycle de projet et en consé-quence de l'adoption des plateformes-cadres.

nature du portefeuille Bien que le niveau d’utilisation des ressources ainsi que mesuré par le stade de la validation de la FIP ne soit pas encore élevé, certaines tendances de la mise en application sont évidentes. Une légère augmentation s’observe dans la part des projets de moyenne envergure, comparé au passé (9,5 % contre 5,5 % à mi-parcours de FEM-3). Étant donné que 93 % des pays attributaires d’une alloca-tion collective dans le domaine des changements climatiques et 53 % des pays relevant du même régime dans le domaine de la diversité biologique n’avaient reçu aucun financement au moment de l’examen à mi-parcours, cette part des projets de moyenne envergure pourrait augmenter davan-tage au cours de la période restante de FEM-4. Toutefois, à certaines exceptions régionales près, les pays et les Entités d’exécution ne considèrent généralement pas les projets de moyenne enver-gure comme étant des opérations rentables, cel-les-ci exigeant pratiquement le même niveau de formalités que les projets de grande envergure.

Les projets de moyenne envergure n’ont pas été affectés par la simplification du cycle de projet. Les projets de moyenne envergure peuvent constituer un moyen de répartir des ressources insuffisantes entre un plus grand nombre de promoteurs de projets, mais la réorientation en faveur de ce type de projet a des répercussions sur le coût-efficacité de l’ensemble du portefeuille du FEM.

La part des projets recoupant plusieurs domaines d’intervention a augmenté, passant de 13 % du montant des reconstitutions à 33 % dans FEM-4 jusqu’à présent, incluant aussi bien les finance-ments du DAR que d’autres sources. Les projets faisant intervenir plusieurs Entités d’exécution semblent avoir disparu, mais dans la mesure où les projets sont scindés entre les volets FIP par Entité d’exécution, pays, domaine d’intervention et source de financement, la comparaison avec les pratiques passées est difficile. La répartition des financements du DAR – entre pays, domaines d’intervention et déductions – accroit la nécessité de recourir à de nombreuses sources pour prépa-rer un projet réalisable, de sorte que les synergies fondamentales de tels projets couvrant plusieurs domaines d’intervention sont incertaines. C’est aussi le cas des 12 plateformes-cadres approuvées, dont certaines sont en cours d’exécution pour un pays donné, d'autres pour des programmes régio-naux et mondiaux. La plateforme-cadre peut offrir une solution au problème de faible utilisation des ressources rencontré par certains pays, mais il est trop tôt pour en discerner les effets. Le Quatrième bilan global (OPS4) du FEM examinera de nou-veaux éléments d’appréciation pour déterminer dans quelle mesure et comment ces plateformes-cadres telles qu’elles sont appliquées actuellement améliorent l’efficacité.

L’utilisation des ressources pour les activités habi-litantes est également en baisse : 10 seulement ont été approuvées dans le domaine de la diversité

Page 19: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-13

biologique et aucune dans celui des changements climatiques au cours de FEM-4. Les activités habi-litantes font partie intégrante des responsabili-tés que les pays sont tenus d’assumer aux termes d’une convention donnée. Cette faible utilisation des ressources du DAR tient peut-être au fait que jusqu’ici, pour les activités habilitantes relatives au domaine des changements climatiques, les financements obtenus par les pays proviennent d’un programme-cadre en cours approuvé avant le DAR ; une autre explication réside dans le caractère cyclique des activités habilitantes, qui reflète les directives de la convention. À l’avenir, l’accès au financement des activités habilitantes est censé se faire au moyen des allocations du DAR. Le coût du financement des activités habi-litantes pourrait toutefois absorber la totalité des ressources pour les pays soumis au régime collectif, ce qui ne laisserait pas de ressources pour d’autres projets. Le Protocole de Cartagena sur la prévention des risques biotechnologiques est d’un intérêt primordial à cet égard ; c’est le seul protocole entièrement financé par le FEM comme mécanisme financier. Jusqu’à présent, FEM-4, une plateforme-cadre sur la prévention des risques biotechnologiques et 10 projets sur la prévention des risques biotechnologiques ont été approuvés dans le domaine d’intervention « diversité biologique », ce qui est moins que prévu par rapport aux tendances passées. Dans le cadre de FEM-3, la majeure partie de l’aide consacrée à la promotion de la prévention des risques biotechnologiques (21 millions de dollars) a été fournie par le biais de projets mondiaux. Le DAR semble avoir ralenti la dynamique engendrée par le précédent projet mondial sur la prévention des risques biotechnologiques. Les experts de Delphi consultés durant l’examen à mi-parcours ont convenu que la meilleure manière d'aborder la biosécurité consiste à l’inscrire dans une optique transfrontalière en dehors du cadre du DAR.

Coût-efficacité Il est trop tôt pour savoir si le DAR a été efficace, mais les tendances enregistrées jusqu’à présent ne sont pas favorables. Le coût-efficacité du DAR sera essentiellement fonction de sa contribution à l’amélioration de l’impact du FEM. Dans un pre-mier temps, le DAR a permis d’améliorer la pla-nification et l’adhésion de certains pays. Il donne aussi aux pays des indications plus précises sur les financements qui leur seront alloués à titre indi-viduel. Toutefois, son incidence sur le portefeuille du FEM et la réserve de projets en instance est mitigée. S’il ne fait aucun doute que certains pays attributaires d'allocations d’un montant élevé ont pu améliorer la cohérence de leurs portefeuilles, à l’opposé, le DAR a probablement entrainé un éparpillement plus important des ressources, des projets de moindre envergure et le sentiment dans certains gouvernements membres que les ressour-ces leur étaient acquises.

Le processus d’élaboration du DAR a été long et laborieux. Le DAR n’a pas bénéficié d’une parti-cipation importante des ONG, de la société civile et du secteur privé, et l’occasion de renforcer l’effi-cacité et la gamme des ressources du FEM a ainsi été perdue. Étant donné que peu de projets ont été approuvés et qu’un nombre encore moins élevé a démarré, le coût d’opportunité occulte des retards subis peut être élevé.

Les coûts-avantages du DAR, en termes de rap-port qualité-prix, n’ont pas été clairement démon-trés par rapport au système précédent ou d’autres systèmes d’allocation fondés sur les résultats. Le montant modeste des allocations, conjugué aux nombreuses formalités du FEM, a réduit le coût-efficacité au niveau tant du portefeuille qu'à celui de l'accès aux projets, en raison des longues concertations, du gaspillage d’efforts, de la néces-sité de reconfirmer les agréments, de l’abandon de certains projets ainsi que des procédures comple-

Page 20: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-14 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

xes d’obtention des approbations de projets. Les résultats ne se sont pas concrétisés. Le coût-effi-cacité peut être amélioré par l’accroissement du volume des financements et des allocations à titre individuel (ce qui exigerait le même effort mais donnerait des avantages accrus), la diminution des efforts à consentir pour obtenir les finance-ments existants (ce qui demanderait moins d’ef-fort mais donnerait les mêmes avantages et qua-lité initiale) ou, de préférence, une combinaison de ces mesures.

1.2 Principales conclusionsD’une manière générale, le DAR a été appliqué conformément aux décisions du Conseil. Cela ne veut pas dire que les objectifs fondamentaux aient été pleinement atteints, car le passage à un nou-veau système d’allocation des ressources n’a pas été facile. L’examen à mi-parcours, en analysant la conception du DAR, son application et les don-nées d’expérience comparatives, a établi que ces aspects sont, dans une certaine mesure, liés entre eux. Certaines difficultés rencontrées dans l'appli-cation sont imputables aux règles de conception rigides du DAR ; dans d'autres cas, les règles de conception sont raisonnables mais l’application n’a pas été satisfaisante. Certains problèmes d’ap-plication sont imputables au fait que le mandat du FEM, ses pratiques et la conception du DAR diffè-rent des autres systèmes d’allocation de ressources fondés sur les résultats.

Conclusion 1 : le FeM opère dans des condi-tions qui renforcent la nécessité d’allouer à bon escient des ressources limitées.

Les appels s’intensifient au plan international en faveur de l’harmonisation, de l’alignement, de l’ap-propriation et de l’adaptation des financements extérieurs aux priorités et stratégies nationales. Pour régler le problème de l'insuffisance des res-sources et promouvoir la programmation natio-

nale, des systèmes d'allocation ont été mis en place dans la plupart sinon toutes les institutions de financement multilatérales. Les institutions des Nations Unies ont tendance à appliquer des systèmes d’allocation fondés sur les besoins, alors que les institutions financières internationales ont tendance à combiner les besoins et les indicateurs de résultat.

La quatrième reconstitution du FEM a mobilisé moins de ressources que les cycles précédents. Parallèlement, le nombre de domaines d’interven-tion du FEM est passé à six. De nouveaux problè-mes ne cessent de se poser et il est devenu plus urgent de s’attaquer aux enjeux environnemen-taux de la planète. Par ailleurs, un nombre relati-vement important de pays pouvant prétendre aux financements n’ont reçu aucune aide du FEM dans le passé. En conséquence, moins de ressources doivent être réparties entre un plus grand nom-bre de pays pour financer un plus grand nombre de projets. Pour se conformer aux directives des Parties aux conventions, répondre à leurs attentes et relever les défis environnementaux en nombre croissant, le retour à un système ponctuel de mise à disposition des financements ne constitue plus une solution. Toutefois, le système d’allocation qui est désormais appliqué par le FEM doit faire l’ob-jet d’améliorations précises pour devenir un outil efficace permettant de régler ces problèmes.

L’adoption du DAR ne s’est pas fondée sur une évaluation de la contribution du système existant à l’amélioration de l’état environnemental de la pla-nète. La démarche adoptée auparavant pour déter-miner cette contribution se fondait sur la stratégie opérationnelle, les programmes opérationnels et les priorités stratégiques du FEM établis pour cha-que cycle de reconstitution. Ces stratégies et prio-rités sont encore en place, mais le fait que le DAR soit fondé sur les pays pose des difficultés intrin-sèques dans la gestion et le suivi de la réserve et du

Page 21: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-15

portefeuille de manière à y répondre. Cela risque aussi de limiter les possibilités de promouvoir de nouvelles modalités de projet et des initiatives ins-titutionnelles novatrices, par exemple, la coopéra-tion avec les ONG et le secteur privé.

Conclusion 2 : les données et les indicateurs utilisés dans le cadre du DAR se fondent sur les meilleures informations disponibles actuelle-ment, avec des lacunes qu’il faudrait combler au fil du temps.

En général, les indicateurs adoptés pour la diver-sité biologique et les changements climatiques sont en rapport avec les meilleures données scien-tifiques disponibles en ce moment. La commu-nauté scientifique s’emploie cependant à trouver des réponses aux lacunes de l’information, ce qui pourrait, à moyen et long terme, améliorer les indices du DAR. L’étude Delphi n’est pas favorable à l’extension des indices de diversité biologique à la biodiversité agricole, ce qui amène à se deman-der si les indices peuvent permettre de régler de manière satisfaisante les problèmes de prévention des risques biotechnologiques. Les experts de Del-phi soutiennent résolument la prise en compte des invertébrés et écosystèmes marins, sur lesquels des informations sont désormais disponibles ou commencent à l’être.

Des simulations effectuées pour trouver des réponses à la question de l’équilibre entre les milieux marin/terrestre montrent qu’une pondération de 50-50 avec les données actuel-les ferait passer cinq PEID au régime individuel, alors que sept pays (y compris un PEID et quatre pays enclavés) passeraient des allocations indivi-duelles à des allocations à titre collectif. Dans le cas des PEID actuellement attributaires d’alloca-tions individuelles, les montants augmenteraient pour cinq et diminueraient pour deux pays. Étant donné que les pays soumis au régime individuel disposent aussi d’abondantes ressources marines,

leur IPF augmente également lorsque les pondé-rations sont modifiées. Rien n’indique clairement si de nouvelles informations sur les ressources de la biodiversité marine modifieraient sensiblement cette tendance. Les pays pouvant prétendre aux allocations individuelles ont actuellement 85 % de la note cumulée de biodiversité marine (et 89 % de la note cumulée de la biodiversité terrestre). Les experts internationaux ne sont pas parvenus à une concordance de vues sur l’équilibre idéal entre les coefficients de pondération des ressour-ces marines et terrestres. Certains ont fait valoir qu’étant donné qu’il n’existe pas de raison scienti-fique d’appliquer des coefficients de pondération, une espèce marine devrait avoir le même traite-ment qu’une espèce terrestre, sans faire l’objet de pondération.

Les indices ne tiennent pas compte de l’adapta-tion et de la vulnérabilité aux changements cli-matiques. Les experts internationaux soutiennent résolument qu’il faudrait s’employer davantage à réaliser un équilibre entre les financements consa-crés à l’adaptation et ceux réservés à l’atténuation dans les pays en développement. Toutefois, aucun accord ne s’est dégagé sur une pratique ou norme optimale acceptée au plan international pour tra-duire l’ampleur de la vulnérabilité ou les besoins d’adaptation.

Par ailleurs, l’IPF pour les changements climati-ques multiplie une variable des « besoins » (émis-sions) par une variable de « résultat » (variation de l’intensité carbone). Cette formule ne permet pas d’interpréter facilement les coefficients de pondé-ration, et signifie que les allocations de ressources sont dominées par les émissions. Il faudrait envi-sager de prendre pleinement en compte les amé-liorations de l’intensité énergétique. Les experts de Delphi ont déclaré que ni le volume global des émissions d’un pays ni sa croissance économique ne constituent des variables de substitution fiables

Page 22: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-16 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

pour obtenir le plus de réductions d’émissions pour une dépense donnée. Ils ont constaté que l'intensité énergétique est un bon indicateur parce que les améliorations de l’efficacité énergétique peuvent contribuer notablement à la réduction des émissions.

Conclusion 3 : le DAR ne comporte pas de mesu-res efficaces d’incitation à l’amélioration des résultats.

Le DAR part notamment du principe que les bons résultats doivent être récompensés par des mon-tants plus élevés de ressources allouées. Les pays membres devraient être en mesure de constater que les pratiques améliorées se traduisent par des notes élevées du DAR, ce qui à son tour devrait améliorer le montant des ressources qui leur sont initialement allouées. La corrélation entre mesu-res d’incitation et comportements est complexe, et dépend de la compréhension par le gouvernement du lien qui existe entre ses résultats, ses notes et les dons qu’il reçoit, ainsi que de sa capacité à pro-mouvoir des activités qui ont des effets positifs sur l’environnement mondial et à obtenir des notes de résultat élevées. L’efficacité d’un système d’inci-tation est fonction de la mesure dans laquelle un pays peut aspirer de manière réaliste à augmenter le montant des ressources qui lui sont allouées. Il n’a pas été clairement expliqué aux points focaux ou à d’autres acteurs concernés ce que l’on entend par résultats dans le contexte du FEM, ni com-ment les obtenir.

La plupart des acteurs concernés considèrent les « résultats » comme étant la qualité des projets du FEM. Toutefois, les résultats du portefeuille environnemental ont une importance relative-ment faible dans les indices de résultat (5 % pour les projets du FEM en cours), ce qui revient à dire que l’amélioration de ce portefeuille n’entrainera qu’une augmentation très limitée des finance-ments alloués. La pondération pour les projets

clos est également de 5 %. Pour les autres indices généraux de résultat au titre des politiques et des institutions environnementales et de l’environne-ment porteur, l’amélioration ne sera pas encou-ragée par la promesse d’une légère augmentation des ressources du FEM, en raison de la part mar-ginale des financements représentée par le FEM dans pratiquement tous les pays. Les 57 pays pou-vant bénéficier d’allocations de ressources à titre individuel dans le domaine de la diversité biolo-gique drainent 41 % des scores de l’IRF, alors que dans le domaine des changements climatiques les 46 pays relevant du même régime drainent 35 % des scores de l’IRF, ce qui, dans les deux cas, est inférieur à leurs scores de l’IPF. Les investisse-ments consacrés à l’amélioration des politiques et des institutions environnementales dépassent de loin le niveau d’augmentation des ressources du FEM que ces améliorations des résultats pour-raient permettre d’obtenir. Même si l’on accorde une plus grande importance à l'IRF, l’ajustement des indices de résultat n’aura probablement pas d’incidence réelle, à moins d'une augmentation spectaculaire du montant global des ressources disponibles. Il faudrait modifier considérablement les coefficients de pondération pour modifier le cours des choses, ce qui entrainerait une instabi-lité des montants alloués.

Tel qu’il est conçu, le DAR prévoit que 75 % du montant total des financements seront fournis sous forme d’allocations individuelles aux pays suivant une formule fondée sur la classification des pays, le solde des ressources étant accordé aux autres pays à titre collectif. Le FEM est le seul mécanisme d’allocation fondé sur les résultats qui applique cette règle. Du fait de cette règle, la plupart des pays relevant du régime collectif conserveront ce statut même s’ils améliorent sen-siblement leurs résultats. L’accroissement des res-sources disponibles profitera aux pays classés sous le régime individuel auxquels sont affectés les 75 %

Page 23: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-17

des financements. Les pays relevant du régime collectif dont les notes préliminaires sont voisines de celles qui donnent droit au régime individuel peuvent y accéder, comme cinq pays l’ont fait dans le cadre de la réallocation de ressources de 2008. Toutefois, rien n’incite à l’amélioration des résul-tats car les montants préliminaires de ressources allouées et les notes préliminaires n’ont pas été communiqués aux pays.

L’on craint d’une manière générale que la prise en compte des résultats ne se fasse au détriment des besoins, en particulier dans le cas des pays les moins avancés (PMA). Cette crainte est fondée en ce qui concerne les indices de performance géné-rale, la faible capacité et le faible développement institutionnel pouvant se traduire par une faible note. Elle ne l’est pas dans le cas des résultats du portefeuille environnemental, qui seraient axés sur les besoins précis du pays. Un projet dans un PMA pourrait être sensiblement différent d’un projet dans un pays à revenu intermédiaire, tout en obtenant une note de résultat élevée. Toutefois, la contribution du portefeuille environnemental global ne représente actuellement que 10 % de l’indice de résultat du FEM.

Conclusion 4 : Des directives imprécises ont limité l’accès aux financements du FeM par les pays relevant du régime d’allocation collective au cours de la première période du DAR.

Au total, le montant d’environ 148 millions de dollars prévu pour chaque allocation à titre col-lectif est le même qu’il aurait été si toutes les allo-cations avaient conservé leur caractère individuel, y compris un modeste supplément (de l’ordre de 2 % du montant total des ressources des domai-nes d’intervention) pour 88 pays pour lesquels on ne dispose pas d’informations suffisantes pour calculer une allocation digne d’intérêt. Le régime d’allocation à titre collectif pourrait en principe ménager une marge de manœuvre pour les pays

et le FEM tout en assurant l’égalité dans la répar-tition des ressources, ce qui n'est pas possible de la manière dont il est appliqué actuellement. Les petits montants de ressources allouées peuvent en eux-mêmes constituer un obstacle à l’accès aux financements.

L’examen du portefeuille met en évidence cette situation qui est aussi apparue clairement lors des échanges de vues avec les acteurs concernés. D’une manière générale, les pays n’ont pas com-pris comment réagir lorsqu’ils sont classés sous le régime collectif, en particulier les pays qui ont des moyens limités. Malgré des montants limités, les ressources allouées ne sont utilisées qu’à hauteur de 8 % par les PMA (au nombre de 44), contre 40 % par les pays autres que les PMA (au nombre de 106). Sur une base régionale, les pays en dehors de l’Afrique (au nombre de 98) ont en moyenne utilisé 39 % des montants qui leur sont alloués dans le domaine de la diversité biologique, contre 14 % pour les 52 pays africains.

Les pays relevant du régime d’allocation collective ont reçu des directives conflictuelles ou incom-plètes concernant la gestion du portefeuille de projets dans le cadre du DAR. La plupart d’entre eux n’ont pas reçu d’encouragement pour leurs projets lors des téléconférences tenues avec le Secrétariat du FEM (75 % des projets des pays attributaires d’une allocation collective n’ont pas été retenus). Les pays relevant du régime indivi-duel ont aussi connu un niveau élevé de « rejets », mais ils avaient plus de projets en préparation. L’enveloppe collective permet au FEM de financer des projets à hauteur d’un million de dollars pour tous les pays relevant de ce régime dans les deux domaines d’intervention, mais ne suffit pas pour financer le montant plafond pour chaque pays du groupe. Les pays doivent donc déployer des efforts considérables pour préparer des projets de petite envergure d’un million de dollars tout

Page 24: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-18 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

en se conformant aux stratégies ambitieuses du domaine d’intervention. Certains pays sont trop découragés par les coûts de transaction élevés d’un projet de moyenne envergure d’un million de dollars pour préparer des propositions, en dépit du fait qu’ils pourraient recevoir le don sans faire l’objet d’examen en concurrence avec d’autres. Les Entités d’exécution du FEM ont été encouragées à accorder la priorité aux pays relevant du régime individuel. La plateforme-cadre a été élaborée en réponse aux problèmes qui se sont posés, mais il a fallu du temps pour la faire adopter par les pays concernés, et rien n'indique que cette approche ait renforcé ou accéléré l'accès pour la majorité des pays.

Le Secrétariat a donné aux pays soumis au régime collectif jusqu’à fin décembre 2008 pour présen-ter des projets d’un montant maximum de 1 mil-lion de dollars, passé ce délai, l’accès sera soumis à la concurrence, sans garantie de financement au cours de la période de FEM-4. Les pays relevant du régime individuel ne sont pas soumis à un tel délai, bien que six d’entre eux n’aient eu accès à aucun montant de leur allocation individuelle dans le domaine de la diversité biologique et huit pays dans celui des changements climatiques. Ces ressources se chiffrent au total à 126,5 millions de dollars, montant analogue à celui non dépensé des allocations à titre collectif.

Conclusion 5 : la complexité des règles d’appli-cation du DAR n’encourage pas l’utilisation sou-ple et dynamique des ressources de FeM-4 dont le montant est relativement modeste.

Le Conseil a adopté certaines règles qui diminuent ou entravent la souplesse du DAR. La règle qui sti-pule que seulement 50 % des allocations peuvent être utilisées durant les deux premières années (la règle de 50 %) semble inutile – elle a entravé l’uti-lisation des ressources et n’est pas nécessaire pour maintenir dans les limites le financement dans la

première moitié du dispositif. Pour le régime col-lectif, il n’est pas nécessaire de limiter les proposi-tions à 50 % du montant maximum hypothétique, étant donné que cela diminue davantage le coût-efficacité pour les pays soumis à ce régime. La règle de 50 % repose sur une hypothèse qui ne se vérifie pas, à savoir qu'elle encouragera l’améliora-tion des résultats et sanctionnera leur dégradation lors du passage à la seconde phase. Qui plus est, la règle n’est pas nécessaire à des fins de liquidité, comme il ressort de la pratique d’autres dispositifs d’allocation fondés sur les résultats. La règle de 50 % n’est donc pas une norme internationale : les autres dispositifs d’allocation fondés sur les résul-tats appliquent des stratégies plus dynamiques de limitation de l’accumulation des financements en début de période tout en procédant à des révisions périodiques des montants alloués en guise d’inci-tation. Elle ne se justifie pas pour les niveaux de financement disponibles, en particulier dans le cas des pays relevant du régime collectif.

Il importe encore plus de noter que les règles de réallocation de fonds au cours de la dernière phase décisive du DAR n’ont pas été mises en place. Les règles en vigueur prévoient que le solde des fonds sera reporté à FEM-5 au lieu de servir à financer des activités qui pourraient contribuer à améliorer l’environnement mondial et les résultats. L’application du DAR retarde l’utilisation des res-sources, en raison de l’irrégularité de la demande et de l’offre de ressources. La réallocation de fonds ne s’est pas traduite par des modifications sensi-bles des allocations en raison du manque de cer-taines nouvelles informations dans le domaine de la diversité biologique, de la nature du DAR et des modifications limitées apportées à l’IRF. La réallo-cation dans le cadre du FEM consiste simplement à recalculer les indices, plutôt que de redéployer les ressources en fonction d’une évaluation sou-ple de la demande et de l’offre comme le font de nombreux systèmes d’allocation fondés sur les

Page 25: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-19

résultats. Les fonds non utilisés à la fin de FEM-4 ne contribuent pas à l’amélioration de l’environne-ment mondial.

Les autres facteurs de la conception exercent peut-être une influence plus importante que les indices eux-mêmes sur la tendance des ressour-ces que les pays peuvent obtenir. Les indicateurs se fondent sur les études scientifiques et les analy-ses, alors que les autres paramètres de la concep-tion décrits reposent sur les décisions pratiques à caractère stratégique. Ces paramètres compren-nent les pondérations qui traduisent les relations quantitatives entre les indicateurs ; le plafond de 15 % dans le domaine des changements clima-tiques ; la règle de 75 % de l’ensemble des res-sources des domaines d’intervention (et non des pays) accordées aux pays qui ont la note cumulée la plus élevée ; les 10 % des ressources réservées aux projets à caractère mondial et régional ; et la règle de 50 % de l’utilisation des ressources. Ces paramètres déterminent les montants que les pays reçoivent et quels pays sont soumis aux régimes collectif ou individuel.

Conclusion 6 : la conception et les règles du DAR sont trop complexes pour un partena-riat constitué en réseau comme le FeM, et les directives fournies et les financements accor-dés n’ont réussi à rendre le DAR transparent et accessible.

Des efforts importants ont été déployés pour communiquer le DAR aux points focaux une fois qu’il a été approuvé, et ces efforts se sont poursui-vis au cours des dernières années. Le programme de réforme adopté par le Conseil et la Directrice générale devait aussi faire l’objet d’une vaste cam-pagne de communication. Tous ces efforts n’ont cependant pas rendu le mécanisme transparent. Sa conception est trop complexe pour être com-muniquée facilement et de nombreux éléments qui auraient pu être rendus publics ne l’ont pas été.

Il n’est peut-être pas réaliste de s’attendre à ce que tous les acteurs concernés maîtrisent parfaitement les questions techniques liées aux mesures, et la plupart des acteurs n’ont peut-être pas besoin de comprendre le mode de fonctionnement détaillé du DAR. Les pays partenaires doivent cependant être informés sur 1) le montant maximum d’un don qu’ils pourraient recevoir ; 2) les résultats obtenus par le pays pour tous les trois indices, par rapport aux autres pays ; et 3) les mesures qui pourraient améliorer les notes de résultat du pays au cours du prochain cycle.

Les lacunes de l’information et les limites de la capacité institutionnelle des bureaux des points focaux et des promoteurs de projets, ainsi que des bureaux locaux des Entités d’exécution continuent d’avoir des répercussions sur le portefeuille des projets en instance, en particulier dans les pays relevant du régime collectif, les PMA et les pays d’Afrique subsaharienne. Le Programme conjoint FEM/PNUD d’aide aux points focaux nationaux et les pages « Fiche-pays » du FEM ont donné des informations de base aux points focaux. Toutefois, les mécanismes d’appui classiques pourraient ne pas suffire pour le type de formation et d’aide per-manente dont on a besoin, pour un mécanisme multidimensionnel à composantes multiples, fai-sant intervenir de si nombreux acteurs différents et différentes catégories de pays. L’exclusion des échanges de vues sur le portefeuille de projets en instance et les modifications des dispositions d’application ont entravé la capacité des Entités d’exécution à fournir des précisions et un appui aux pays. Qui plus est, les gouvernements concer-nés comme le FEM n’ont pas toujours donné à un acteur clé de l’application du DAR — le point focal du FEM — les éléments et les outils cruciaux dont il a besoin pour jouer son nouveau rôle. Dans la plupart des cas, le FEM ne représente qu’un élé-ment modeste du programme de travail du point focal qui ne peut donc pas appuyer l’application

Page 26: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-20 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

du DAR dans toute la mesure nécessaire. Certains points focaux ont fait savoir que l’application du DAR a pris beaucoup trop de leur temps limité. Les points focaux, en particulier dans les pays soumis au régime individuel, doivent désormais mettre en place et gérer des mécanismes de programmation des ressources et de sélection des projets.

Les réformes et les critères institutionnels ont eu des répercussions allant au-delà de leur objectif qui consistait à régler des problèmes anciens dans un nouveau cadre du DAR. La suspension du por-tefeuille de projets de 2007 et des programmes de travail par manque de fonds au cours de la période de transition et la nécessité de reconfirmer l'agré-ment des projets et de les présenter sous forme de FIP sont autant de facteurs qui ont contribué à ralentir la préparation du portefeuille. Tous les acteurs concernés ont été très satisfaits par la sim-plification du cycle de projet du FEM, mais celui-ci semble constituer à présent un obstacle du fait des modifications et de l’expansion constante des modèles de FIP et de leur sélection. La nécessité de dépenser les fonds dans un délai de quatre ans rend les critères liés au cycle de projet et au cofi-nancement plus difficiles à satisfaire par de nom-breux pays. De nouvelles exigences fonctionnelles du FEM, les modifications des conditions finan-cières et l’absence de directives précises découra-gent les services des Entités d’exécution de colla-borer avec le FEM.

Le faible taux d’utilisation des fonds observé actuellement ne tient pas à la conception du DAR en tant que telle. Cette situation est plutôt imputa-ble à son application, conjuguée au retard accusé par le démarrage de FEM-4 et au programme de réforme. Des règles claires et simples sont indis-pensables pour un partenariat constitué en réseau aussi complexe que le FEM, et dont les acteurs divers ont de nombreux niveaux différents de moyens et sont situés partout dans le monde.

Au cours de la première phase, les questions de conception, de règles, d’allocation et de mode de fonctionnement ne se distinguent pas facilement et ont été source de confusion. L’utilisation des ressources est en outre freinée par des ambigüités et des incohérences occasionnelles. Les téléconfé-rences de 2006-2007 entre les pays et le Secréta-riat du FEM ont été très appréciées quant à leur intention, mais l’imprécision des responsabilités concernant les mesures de suivi a cependant limité les effets potentiellement positifs de ces échanges de vues bilatéraux, ce qui s’est traduit par un man-que de suivi systématique des acteurs concernés, en particulier dans le cas des pays pouvant pré-tendre à une allocation collective. Cette situation a créé, dans bien de cas, davantage de confusion chez les parties prenantes nationales et les Entités d’exécution.

L’approche-programme a aussi beaucoup de mal à se concrétiser. Le Secrétariat du FEM ne dis-pose pas de ressources humaines lui permettant de jouer le rôle central qui devait être le sien dans une structure complexe, compte tenu de l’applica-tion simultanée du DAR et des réformes en cours du FEM. .

Conclusion 7 : le DAR a modifié l’adhésion des pays qui relèvent du régime individuel et a eu un effet neutre ou négatif sur l’adhésion des pays soumis au régime collectif.

Dans le cas de plusieurs grands pays relevant du régime individuel, comme l’Inde et la Russie, la certitude d’un montant substantiel a galvanisé les points focaux, attiré l’attention des milieux poli-tiques et favorisé la cohérence de la planification des portefeuilles nationaux. D’autres pays qui ont généralement des taux d’utilisation élevés ont conservé leurs pratiques en matière de prépara-tion des portefeuilles. Dans l’ensemble, il y a eu un accroissement du nombre de comités constitués ainsi que des concertations informelles et formel-

Page 27: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-21

les ; et les réunions de concertation nationales sont passées de la concentration sur les projets à une attention accrue accordée à l’ensemble du portefeuille. Cette tendance a fait porter l’atten-tion sur les points focaux du FEM, au lieu des pro-moteurs de projets qui sont situés le plus souvent au sein des ministères sectoriels ou des Entités d’exécution du FEM. L’application du DAR semble aussi avoir renforcé les moyens de négociation des points focaux avec les Entités d’exécution.

Toutefois, la notion d’adhésion des pays est aussi source de certaines tensions intrinsèques. La concertation à grande échelle est laborieuse et peut, dans certains cas, ralentir l’utilisation des ressources. L’adhésion des pays est indispensable à la planification et à l’exécution des projets du FEM, mais les priorités environnementales nationales peuvent ne pas concorder avec celles du Secré-tariat et des Entités d’exécution. Les résultats des négociations sur le portefeuille de projets en ins-tance du DAR ont mis davantage en évidence les conflits qui existent inévitablement entre les critè-res d’amélioration de l’environnement mondial et les besoins de viabilité propres à chaque pays. Les consultations nationales ont identifié une vaste gamme de priorités, et le rejet des idées et des propositions qui en a résulté a découragé l’engage-ment vis-à-vis du FEM et a parfois mis les points focaux dans une position difficile. Cette situation n’a pas favorisé la réalisation de l’objectif fonda-mental du DAR qui consistait à offrir aux pays un mécanisme pour la programmation de leurs res-sources en fonction des priorités nationales.

Si 63 % d’enquêtés conviennent que le DAR a pro-bablement renforcé les rôles joués par les pays en matière de planification de portefeuilles, bon nombre – sinon la plupart – des pays relevant du régime collectif estiment que les moyens des pays n’ont pas été effectivement renforcés. Les pays sont déçus par les faibles montants de ressour-

ces allouées qu’ils ne peuvent pas programmer de manière réaliste, par des règles qui changent et sont difficiles à comprendre et par les niveaux prévisibles de fonds auxquels ils ne peuvent pas avoir accès. Dans la plupart des pays, il est difficile de maintenir le sentiment d’adhésion du pays et la connaissance du DAR en raison du remplacement fréquent des points focaux.

De même, l’« adhésion des pays » dans la pratique peut ou ne peut pas, en fonction des circonstances de tel ou tel pays, impliquer la participation et la consultation d’un groupe largement représentatif d’acteurs concernés aux niveaux national et local. Il existe certes quelques bons exemples de coopé-ration des ONG et de la société civile dans le cadre du DAR, notamment au Honduras, à Madagascar et en Ouganda, mais dans la plupart des pays, la participation de la communauté des ONG ne s’est pas améliorée, et le secteur privé est en grande partie exclu des propositions de projet et des réu-nions de concertation sur le portefeuille du FEM organisées à l’initiative du gouvernement.

Conclusion 8 : les déductions n’ont pas donné des résultats satisfaisants et ont peut-être réduit l’efficacité de la contribution du FeM à l’amélioration de l’environnement mondial et régional.

Les ressources consacrées aux projets mondiaux et régionaux ont considérablement diminué. Elles sont passées de 23 % pour les ressources des domaines d’intervention consacrées à la diver-sité biologique et de 20 % dans le cas des change-ments climatiques à des déductions de 10 % dans le cadre du DAR, dont 5 % (50 millions de dollars) sont réservés aux projets mondiaux et régionaux par domaine d’intervention du DAR. Malgré cette réduction, les ressources allouées à ces types de projets ne sont utilisées qu’à hauteur de 16 % pour la diversité biologique, mais de 52 % pour les changements climatiques. Les pays reconnais-

Page 28: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-22 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

sent l’importance des problèmes environnemen-taux à caractère transnational, mais pour régler ces problèmes ils ne sont pour autant pas prêts à renoncer aux ressources qui leur sont allouées, en raison des contraintes culturelles et régionales, de l’appropriation nationale et du bilan des projets transnationaux.

L’ « ensemble de politiques claires… applicables à ces déductions au moment où on a révisé les stra-tégies des domaines d’intervention » promis au Conseil du FEM en juin 2007 ne lui ont pas été présentées (FEM 2007f). Le Secrétariat affecte actuellement les fonds à différentes fins et les ressources mondiales et régionales sont utili-sées pour compléter les financements accordés à titre individuel ou collectif au profit des FIP se rattachant aux plateformes-cadres. Les pays ne comprennent pas bien l’intention fondamentale du FEM de consacrer les 5 % à certaines activités de coordination ou de préparation des platefor-mes-cadres, ce qui rend opaque la différence entre les objectifs que l’on réaliserait plus efficacement avec des activités à caractère mondial, régional ou national. Le niveau d’« imposition » des ressour-ces allouées dans les domaines d’intervention au titre des programmes à caractère institutionnel et mondial est également très élevé.

L’objectif de la Déduction à usage mondial et régional (DMR) consistait à financer des projets d’envergure mondiale non financés par les pays, ainsi que des projets plurinationaux rentables ayant des retombées positives allant au-delà de chaque pays. L’absence de transparence et de par-ticipation à la gestion des déductions a fait naî-tre un sentiment de confusion parmi les acteurs nationaux et les Entités d’exécution concernées, et mis en doute la possibilité d’atteindre les objec-tifs visés.

La réduction des fonds consacrés aux projets mon-diaux et régionaux a eu des répercussions sur des

Agents d’exécution comme le PNUE, qui inter-viennent essentiellement dans ce domaine (85 % des fonds consacrés par le PNUE à la diversité biologique et 81 % aux changements climatiques). Elle a également eu des répercussions sur les pays qui bénéficiaient de cette aide auparavant ainsi que sur les priorités précises des domaines d’interven-tion. Les experts internationaux estiment que les indices ne tiennent pas suffisamment compte des risques biotechnologiques, pas plus que les alloca-tions individuelles, et que ces risques pourraient aussi bénéficier d’un traitement spécial.

Dans le cas du Programme de microfinance-ments, l’introduction du DAR semble s’être soldée par une réduction du montant convenu au titre de FEM-4. Sur un montant maximum de 200 mil-lions de dollars, 80 millions devaient être réservés sur les ressources allouées aux projets mondiaux dans le cadre du DAR et le Programme de microfi-nancements pouvait aussi obtenir des allocations du DAR à titre individuel. Ces deux catégories de contributions du DAR se sont avérées insuffisantes. Les décisions du Comité directeur du Programme ont plafonné les contributions du DAR pour au moins 29 pays (qui voulaient accorder plus de financements au Programme) sur les 74 pays qui ont des allocations à titre individuel dans le cadre du Programme de microfinancements et du DAR qui se recoupent. Au cours de la première année du programme des opérations 4 du Programme de microfinancements, les pays participants ont contribué au total près de 18 millions de dollars sur les ressources qui leur étaient allouées au titre du DAR. Les indications des montants prévus pour le Programme de microfinancements sont devenues moins précises et l’influence des gouvernements s’est parallèlement renforcée. Dans les pays qui financent le Programme à l’aide des fonds alloués par le DAR, il est impossible de se conformer à la stratégie de diversification du portefeuille du Pro-gramme, car les fonds ne peuvent servir que dans

Page 29: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-23

les domaines des changements climatiques et de la diversité biologique.

Pour avoir accès à un montant compris entre 300 000 et 400 000 dollars sur les fonds alloués au pays par le DAR, le Programme de microfinan-cements doit présenter une stratégie d’utilisation de ces fonds, alors qu’il existe déjà une stratégie nationale de ce Programme et que les pays qui ont une allocation importante des ressources du DAR à titre individuel ne sont pas soumis à la même contrainte. Le coût-efficacité est réduit du fait du niveau des négociations, de la charge accrue de travail, de la nécessité de tenir une comptabilité distincte, des modifications du portefeuille, des nouvelles prescriptions et des occasions man-quées pour la communauté des ONG et la société civile.

1.3 RecommandationsL’introduction du DAR peut être considérée comme s’inscrivant dans le cadre d’une tendance mondiale vers l’harmonisation et l’efficacité de l’aide. De nombreuses institutions financières internationales (IFI) ont adopté des systèmes d’al-location de ressources fondées sur les résultats en même temps que le FEM, même si d’aucuns sou-tiendront que le FEM n’est pas une IFI classique et le système des Nations Unies applique géné-ralement des systèmes d’allocation fondés sur les besoins. Plusieurs des difficultés rencontrées dans l’application tiennent au fait que le FEM n’est pas une banque de développement, mais plutôt un partenariat complexe consacré à la protection de l’environnement mondial.

Les recommandations formulées ci-après se rap-portent aux mesures immédiates et à court terme pour améliorer l’application du DAR pendant le reste de la période de FEM-4 et, à moyen terme, pour apporter des améliorations à FEM-5 et peut-être au-delà.

Recommandation 1 : la réallocation des fonds inutilisés devrait être autorisée au cours de la dernière année de FeM-4.

Aux termes des règles en vigueur, le solde des ressources de FEM-4 doit être reporté à FEM-5. La conception du DAR n’avait naturellement pas anticipé les problèmes d’utilisation des ressources que de nombreux pays rencontrent actuellement. C’est le moment indiqué d’introduire des règles pour faire face à de tels problèmes. Ceux-ci sont rendus encore plus épineux par la nouvelle défi-nition de l’utilisation des ressources. Même si la FIP ne représente pas une obligation juridique, les fonds sont mis en réserve sous forme d’engage-ment. Il y aurait lieu d’accélérer les approbations tout en maintenant une gestion prudente des ris-ques. Sans pour autant perdre de vue le bilan de FEM-3, dont le programme de travail était vaste au point de poser des problèmes d’absorption dans le mécanisme, il importe de veiller à ce que les pays soient en mesure d’utiliser les fonds dans les limites du présent cycle de refinancement.

Il se pourrait bien qu’un niveau élevé de ressour-ces reste inutilisé à la fin de la période de FEM-4. Le FEM doit chercher à savoir si les pays envisa-gent d’utiliser les fonds qui leur sont alloués et être ensuite autorisé à réallouer tout solde potentiel-lement inutilisé aux pays qui ont un portefeuille de projets prêts à être financés. D’autres systèmes d’allocation fondés sur les résultats ont des règles à cet effet et l’on pourrait adapter ces règles aux conditions particulières prévalant à la dernière année du DAR. Trois options sont envisageables : 1) réallocations itératives des fonds pour l’ensem-ble du groupe de pays – à moins qu’ils n’en deman-dent pas – comme le pratique le FIDA ; 2) réallo-cations au cas par cas et de pays à pays, à l’exemple de l’Association internationale de développement (IDA) membre du Groupe de la Banque mondiale, mais uniquement des pays moins performants aux pays plus performants ; ou 3) financement des

Page 30: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-24 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

déficits enregistrés par les programmes institu-tionnels et les déductions.

Recommandation 2 : l’information complète du public, l’obligation de transparence, la par-ticipation des différents acteurs et la définition claire des tâches sont des aspects qui doivent présider à la mise en application de la dernière phase de FeM-4, y compris la réallocation des fonds.

Avec l’application du DAR, le rôle du Secrétariat du FEM a évolué, mais il n’existe pas de cadre de référence précis pour son nouveau rôle et ses nou-velles responsabilités. Compte tenu de la restruc-turation et de la mise en place de nouvelles équi-pes, les pays ne savent pas trop à qui s’adresser ni même si le Secrétariat ou une Entité d’exécution devrait donner une réponse. Le nouveau système intégré de gestion n’est pas encore opérationnel et les systèmes en vigueur ne suffisent pas pour informer les pays sur la situation des projets. Les Entités d’exécution et le Secrétariat devraient mettre en place des modes de fonctionnement et définir les tâches pour informer les pays sur les propositions et les idées en instance. Les rapports institutionnels doivent indiquer plus clairement la source de fonds et les fonds disponibles. La pla-nification et l’utilisation des déductions aux fins des projets mondiaux et régionaux doivent être rendues transparentes pour les pays et les Entités d’exécution, en particulier lorsqu’elles reposent sur des plateformes-cadres.

Les contacts bilatéraux entre le Secrétariat et les pays peuvent offrir un moyen indispensable de clarifier des propositions susceptibles d’être financées. Ce manque de précision semble avoir été un obstacle de taille et continuera d’entraver la communication tant que n’interviendront pas les Entités d’exécution qui préparent les FIP et les descriptifs de projet. Les réunions des grou-pes d’étude dans les domaines d’intervention et

des coordinateurs exécutifs, ainsi que de l’ancien groupe d’étude sur le DAR, serviront de mécanis-mes utiles pour s’accorder sur les directives opéra-tionnelles et les stratégies qui sont efficaces.

Une plus grande transparence et une meilleure communication ont probablement prévenu ou atténué certaines des difficultés rencontrées. Il ne faudrait pas sous-estimer la nécessité de la forma-tion et d’un appui continu. Les mécanismes d’ap-pui classiques pourraient ne pas suffire. Il faudrait envisager d’accroître les fonds alloués aux points focaux, mais ceci ne suffira pas pour aider les gou-vernements à préparer rapidement un portefeuille de projets en instance. Une « permanence télépho-nique du DAR », des programmes de formation en ligne, des réunions plus efficaces de groupes de pays et des échanges seraient utiles. On pour-rait utiliser les moyens électroniques pour mieux informer les acteurs concernés.

Recommandation 3 : les règles d’application doivent être simplifiées.

En passant à un nouveau mécanisme d’allocation de ressources, comme le DAR, il faudrait déployer des efforts importants pour maintenir aussi bien le portefeuille de projets en instance que la dynami-que de l’application. Les retards subis dans l’identi-fication et l’exécution des projets peuvent se solder par des coûts d’opportunité importants. Il faudrait suivre et gérer la composition du portefeuille de projets, du point de vue de la taille et des domai-nes d’intervention, pour éviter que le nouveau dis-positif n’entraîne des obstacles inattendus.

Un moratoire sur les nouveaux critères pour l’identification et l’élaboration des projets pour le reste de la période de FEM-4 devrait promouvoir la stabilité qui permettra aux pays et aux entités de programmer les ressources. Il est grand temps de simplifier davantage les critères applicables aux projets de moyenne envergure étant donné le

Page 31: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-25

niveau des ressources allouées et le faible risque financier, mais les coûts de transaction élevés.

Plus précisément, il faudrait encourager les Enti-tés d’exécution et les pays à préparer des projets. En laissant aux pays une plus grande marge de manœuvre pour tenir compte de leurs priorités nationales et choisir l’Entité d’exécution, on rédui-rait les retards et renforcerait l’adhésion des pays aux programmes, sans compromettre inutilement la qualité. Les pays relevant du régime collectif ne devraient pas être soumis à des critères analogues ou plus rigoureux que ceux qui sont appliqués aux grands pays qui ont plus de moyens et sont soumis au régime individuel.

Les plateformes-cadres sont prometteuses, mais doivent être élaborées davantage. S’il est trop tôt pour apprécier les résultats, il est d’ores et déjà évident qu’il faudrait s’intéresser de plus près aux principes clés sur lesquels reposent les plate-formes-cadres. Il y a lieu de renforcer l’adhésion nationale, la transparence, la participation, le rôle catalyseur et l’effet de levier. Le processus de représentation d’acteurs multiples doit être ouvert et transparent. Il faudrait améliorer la rentabilité, réduire les coûts de transaction et encourager davantage les Entités d’exécution à appuyer les plateformes-cadres. Par ailleurs, il est absolument nécessaire de suivre attentivement la prépara-tion des FIP au niveau national. La composition des financements doit être claire et faire l’objet de négociation et des directives opérationnelles ont été demandées à cet effet.

Il faudrait envisager de rationaliser et d’harmoni-ser d’une manière générale les critères du DAR et les besoins du Programme de microfinancements. On pourrait atténuer certaines des répercussions des contraintes imposées sur le Programme de microfinancements suite à l’application du DAR. Le relèvement des plafonds de dépenses pour des pays comme l’Inde, le Mexique et les Philippines,

qui ont la capacité suffisante pour absorber les ressources du FEM par le biais d’interventions de petite envergure, permettrait à ces programmes de contribuer de manière rentable à l’amélioration de l’environnement mondial. Il est également recom-mandé de permettre aux programmes nationaux du Programme de microfinancements qui ne reçoivent que des fonds du DAR d’avoir accès à un niveau relativement modeste des ressources de base du Programme de microfinancements, ce qui réduirait les déséquilibres actuels des portefeuilles de projets de ces programmes nationaux.

Recommandation 4 : il faudrait d’ores et déjà prendre des mesures pour améliorer la concep-tion et les indices du DAR pour FeM-5.

Les recommandations précédentes appuieraient les améliorations immédiates de l’application du DAR. Les problèmes qui se posent dans le cadre de FEM-5 s’appliquent davantage à l’ensemble du système et ne sont pas aussi faciles à régler. En raison de la nouveauté d’un dispositif d’allocation fondé sur les résultats appliqué par un partenariat ayant vocation à améliorer l’environnement mon-dial, certains des éléments du DAR n’ont pas été éprouvés et méritent à présent d’être réexaminés. Il faudrait prendre dès maintenant les mesures relatives au DAR pour le démarrage de FEM-5 en 2010. Il ressort des premières données d’expé-rience que le lancement du mécanisme, la plani-fication et la disponibilité des ressources dans les délais revêtent une importance cruciale.

Comme on l’a vu plus haut, un dispositif d’allo-cation de ressources fondé sur les résultats qui aurait pu être relativement simple est devenu un mécanisme complexe. Chaque pays membre a un montant maximum auquel il peut prétendre, mais aucun montant ne lui est acquis d’avance. Les pays et les Entités d’exécution doivent plutôt proposer des projets de qualité pour avoir accès à ces fonds. Un système qui ne prévoit pas de montants précis

Page 32: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-26 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

de ressources à allouer sera inévitablement com-plexe, mais il n’est pas possible d’avoir un système offrant des montants de ressources garantis. En revanche, le FEM devrait veiller à faciliter l’accès des ressources allouées dans le cadre du DAR. Il faudrait à cet effet apporter des améliorations tant à la conception qu’à l’application de FEM-5 en procédant ainsi qu’il suit :

Améliorer les indices de potentialité du FEM z

et les coefficients de pondération affectés aux résultats du portefeuille environnemental

Augmenter la prévisibilité et les coûts-avan- z

tages du régime collectif ou mettre fin à ce régime

Reconnaître les problèmes de l’environnement z

mondial à caractère transfrontalier

Réexaminer les plafonds, les planchers et la z

règle de 50 %

Transformer le DAR en un mécanisme d’allo- z

cation intégré pour tous les domaines d’inter-vention

1.4 Mesures envisageables pour l’avenirLes mesures préconisées ci-après doivent faire l’ob-jet de concertation avec tous les acteurs concernés du FEM. Elles comportent des éléments liés à la conception (indices, pondérations, déductions, réaménagement du régime collectif, et expan-sion), mais sont aussi tributaires de bonnes stra-tégies d’application (transparence, information, planification, simplification). En améliorant le dispositif d’allocation de ressources en vigueur, il importe d’examiner ensemble les aspects liés à la conception et à l’application. De toute évidence, de nouvelles modifications pourraient rendre le dispositif plus complexe, aussi faudrait-il veiller à maintenir la simplicité et à planifier l’application de manière stratégique. La quatrième étude du

fonctionnement global continuera de rassembler les informations à mesure qu’elles se présenteront au cours de la dernière période de FEM-4, et four-nir de nouveaux éléments utiles au règlement de ces questions à l’avenir.

les indices de potentialité et leurs coefficients de pondération respectifs devraient être améliorés pour FeM-5Le DAR utilise efficacement les données qui sont déjà connues du public et devrait continuer de le faire toutes les fois possible. Les futures activités de conception devraient s’effectuer sur une base participative et comporter des mécanismes pour associer les pays, les Entités d’exécution, les ONG et le Groupe consultatif du FEM pour la science et la technologie (STAP).

L’indice pour la diversité biologique est satisfaisant pour le moment en ce qui concerne les menaces et la représentation et toute décision relative aux pondérations respectives est une question prati-que qu’il appartient au FEM de décider, avec les conseils des experts en diversité biologique. On pourrait inclure des informations sur différen-tes espèces telles que les invertébrés marins. Un meilleur équilibre entre les espèces marines et terrestres traduirait l’importance accordée aux différents écosystèmes, même si en fin de compte les montants de ressources effectivement allouées puissent ne pas différer sensiblement.

Les experts conviennent, tout comme de nom-breux acteurs concernés, qu’il faudrait accorder aux pays les plus vulnérables la majeure partie des fonds consacrés à l’adaptation, si la majeure par-tie des fonds au titre de l’IPF-CC sert à financer les activités d’atténuation dans les pays qui sont les plus grandes sources d’émissions. Les guichets de financement distincts pourraient ne pas suf-fire pour répondre aux besoins d’adaptation, sans compter que les acteurs nationaux trouvent qu’il

Page 33: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-27

est de plus en plus difficile de suivre l’évolution des différentes méthodes d’accès aux différents fonds. Cet aspect va au-delà de la question des informa-tions à inclure dans les indices, et implique un débat sur la stratégie d’adaptation dans le porte-feuille des changements climatiques. Si le Fonds d’adaptation devrait répondre à ces besoins, il serait inutile d’inclure l’adaptation dans un indice pour le financement des activités d’atténuation.

Les experts en changements climatiques de Delphi aimeraient que l’on améliore les indices en tenant davantage compte des gaz et des sources d’émis-sions de gaz à effet de serre (GES), y compris l’agri-culture et les changements des modes d’utilisation des sols ; le déboisement et la dégradation des forêts ; le brûlage de gaz ; et les émissions indus-trielles de gaz autres que le CO2. Ils reconnaissent cependant qu’il est difficile de déterminer de telles émissions avec exactitude. Les informations com-muniquées par les pays pourraient servir à vérifier l’exactitude des fichiers mondiaux, mais une telle solution mérite d’être étudiée plus avant. Il fau-drait harmoniser et rendre plus transparents les indices appliqués aux changements climatiques, par des pondérations et l’inclusion des émissions et de l’intensité énergétique, ou encore l’inclusion d’une nouvelle variable pour prendre convena-blement en compte l’amélioration de l’indice de potentialité du FEM d’une période sur l’autre.

Il n’existe actuellement pas de lien entre les indi-ces qui déterminent les montants de ressources allouées et la manière d’utiliser ces ressources. C’est ainsi que dans le domaine de la diversité bio-logique le FEM ne finance pas la conservation des espèces alors que les montants alloués se fondent sur les espèces. Le FEM doit envisager la possibi-lité d’engager avec les pays un dialogue sur les poli-tiques et de tirer parti des informations recueillies pour circonscrire davantage ses interventions. Si le FEM inclut de nouveaux aspects dans les indi-

ces du DAR, comme l’adaptation, la vulnérabilité et les sources marines, il faudrait les accompagner de stratégies relatives aux domaines d’intervention pour être en mesure de consacrer des ressources à ces priorités.

il faudrait augmenter le coefficient de pondération des résultats du portefeuille environnemental dans un pays au titre de FeM-5 afin de récompenser les résultats Le DAR ne fonctionne pas comme un mécanisme réaliste d’incitation aux résultats ou à l’amélioration de l’état environnemental de la planète. L’efficacité d’un système d’incitation est fonction de la mesure dans laquelle un pays peut aspirer de manière réa-liste à augmenter le montant des ressources qui lui sont allouées, ainsi que de la compréhension par le gouvernement de la corrélation existant entre ses résultats, ses notes et les dons qu’il reçoit. Elle est encore plus tributaire de la capacité des acteurs concernés à améliorer ces résultats. Les points focaux, qui représentent les pôles du portefeuille du FEM, n’ont généralement pas d’emprise directe sur les indicateurs qui servent à bâtir les indices, et les fonds ne suffisent pas pour encourager la parti-cipation d’autres autorités.

Le simple fait d’accroître l’importance de l’indice de résultat du FEM, par rapport à l’indice de potentia-lité du FEM, ne suffira pas en lui-même pour offrir dans le domaine de l’environnement suffisamment d’incitations sur lesquelles le FEM pourrait avoir prise. Il pourrait être plus indiqué de récompen-ser les améliorations plus récentes des résultats des projets du FEM, en accordant un coefficient de pondération plus élevé à l’indicateur de résul-tat du portefeuille. Il faudra inévitablement opé-rer certains arbitrages entre la stabilité (mesurée par une moyenne sur une longue période, comme c’est le cas actuellement) et la réceptivité et l'exac-titude (mettant l'accent sur les résultats récents). Il faudrait aussi améliorer la pertinence de l’indice

Page 34: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-28 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

en y incluant les notes des évaluations finales des projets du FEM. Lorsque le DAR a été conçu, le Bureau de l’évaluation du FEM avait examiné un nombre relativement faible des évaluations fina-les. Il faut espérer qu’au moment du démarrage de FEM-5, un nombre crédible d’évaluations et une couverture géographique acceptable auront été réalisées. Il en sera davantage rendu compte dans le quatrième bilan global.

L’augmentation de l’importance relative du porte-feuille environnemental permettra de mieux recon-naître les réalisations et les résultats dans les PMA et les PEID, qui pourraient obtenir des notes plus élevées de résultats de leurs portefeuilles, même s’ils ont des notes relativement moins élevées de perfor-mance institutionnelle générale. Dans la pratique internationale courante, le pourcentage du porte-feuille se situe entre 5 % et 30 %. Le DAR, à 10 %, se situe à l’extrémité inférieure de la fourchette ; ce niveau de performance pourrait être porté à 30 %.

il faudrait améliorer la prévisibilité et les coûts-avantages du régime d’allocation collective de ressources, faute de quoi il devrait être abandonnéPour maintenir le régime collectif, il faudrait qu’il donne lieu à des attentes réalistes et qu’une straté-gie précise soit adoptée. On observe deux appro-ches antagonistes : 1) le régime collectif représente le « minimum » d’un niveau égal de ressources pour les pays, de sorte qu’une certaine aide sera garantie aux pays qui ont plus de besoins ; et 2) tous les pays n’auront pas normalement accès aux financements au cours d’une phase, et il est donc acceptable que le niveau d’utilisation soit faible. La première approche a été mise en évidence lors de l’introduction du DAR, et a donné lieu à des attentes importantes, mais l’application semble axée sur la seconde approche. Les efforts qui sont déployés actuellement pour donner accès, par le biais des plateformes-cadres, aux pays relevant

du régime collectif sont prometteurs, mais pour-raient, à ce stade, ne pas inclure toutes les mesures permanentes nécessaires pour les pays qui ont des problèmes de capacité dans le cadre de FEM-5. Le quatrième bilan global continuera d’étudier la pré-paration des plateformes-cadres.

Bon nombre des pays pouvant prétendre au régime d’allocation collective bénéficiaient aupa-ravant de l’aide régionale et de projets-cadres consacrés à des activités habilitantes ; le nombre de tels projets a diminué sous le régime du DAR. Les pays ont plutôt la possibilité d’obtenir des financements pour des projets nationaux sur des ressources mises en commun. Leurs projets natio-naux individuels ont été en grande partie décou-ragés. Le Secrétariat et les Entités d’exécution déploient à présent des efforts considérables pour convaincre les pays de remettre les fonds dans une plateforme-cadre régionale, afin de recevoir en retour des FIP nationales individuelles. Cette manière détournée de programmer les ressour-ces ne permet pas d’utiliser de manière rentable les fonds du FEM déjà insuffisants et représente une source de frustration considérable pour les pays. D’autre part, pour accéder aux ressources du FEM, les petits pays encourent des coûts de tran-saction plus élevés que les plus gros bénéficiaires. Le montant modeste des financements, conjugué aux difficultés que l’on rencontre à faire accepter les projets, fait que le jeu n’en vaut pas la chandelle pour de nombreux pays et Entités d’exécution.

Certains phénomènes erratiques transitoires et des directives contradictoires pourraient expliquer cer-taines des difficultés rencontrées par les pays, mais les auteurs de l’examen à mi-parcours estiment que les difficultés ont un caractère plus systémique, sont liées aux contraintes de capacités, au man-que de prévisibilité et de transparence et aux stra-tégies des domaines d’intervention. Dans tous les scénarios concernant le régime collectif, les amé-

Page 35: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-29

liorations nécessiteraient des orientations claires et cohérentes de la part du FEM, en coopération avec les Entités d’exécution, une communication améliorée sur la situation des projets et la pro-grammation des ressources, l’assouplissement des conditions imposées par les stratégies des domai-nes d’intervention pour les allocations de faibles montants et l’acceptation d’un plus grand nombre de propositions de projets émanant des pays et la simplification des procédures et de la bureaucratie pour les projets de petite et moyenne envergure.

En fonction de l’équilibre recherché entre la sou-plesse, la simplicité et la prévisibilité, deux options s’offrent pour changer le régime collectif :

Option 1. z Mettre fin au régime collectif, afin que tous les pays reçoivent des allocations de ressources à titre individuel. Une allocation minimum de 1 million de dollars pourrait être prévue pour les pays dont les allocations préli-minaires étaient inférieures à ce montant ; tous les autres pays pourraient recevoir leur alloca-tion préliminaire.

Option 2. z La réserve commune pourrait être répartie en région, afin de maximiser les pos-sibilités de plateformes-cadres et de collabora-tion régionale.

La « règle de 75 % » dans la conception du DAR joue un rôle très important car elle détermine la structure des ressources auxquelles les pays peu-vent prétendre, le montant que les pays obtien-nent, et les pays qui relèvent du régime collectif ou du régime individuel. Cette règle, consistant à allouer 75 % des fonds aux pays les mieux clas-sés, n’est pas une pratique acceptée au plan inter-national dans le cadre des dispositifs d’allocation fondés sur les résultats. Un des avantages qu’il y aurait à abandonner le régime collectif est que l’on peut ainsi mettre fin à la règle de 75 % et permet-tre ainsi à un plus grand nombre de pays de béné-

ficier de montants prévisibles et le mode de calcul continuerait de s’appliquer.

Un système d’allocation de ressources au titre de FeM-5 devrait prendre en compte les problèmes de l’environnement mondial aux effets transfrontièresLes activités mondiales et régionales s’inscrivent dans le cadre de la mission première du FEM. Des ressources doivent être mises à disposition à cet effet. Une « prime transfrontières » de 15 %, par exemple, sur des projets appropriés et des alloca-tions à titre individuel pourrait promouvoir des financements à caractère mondial et régional. L’on pourrait revoir la part des projets mondiaux et régionaux, mais en tenant clairement compte de la contribution que les déductions pourraient appor-ter à l’amélioration de l’environnemental mondial et régional. Un financement modeste pourrait suffire s’il est uniquement consacré à des activités d’intérêt mondial. Mais il ne suffirait pas s’il était consacré à des mesures d’incitation en faveur des projets régionaux, des plateformes-cadres et des initiatives et de la souplesse institutionnelles dont le financement ne peut pas être assuré par des allocations de ressources à titre individuel.

Le Programme de microfinancements se retrouve en train de consacrer beaucoup de temps et d’ef-forts à la mobilisation de fonds auprès du FEM, au lieu de – ou plutôt que de – rechercher des finan-cements nouveaux et complémentaires. Il faut assurer au Programme de microfinancements un niveau raisonnable de ressources de base qui lui permet de poursuivre les politiques visant à ren-forcer la portée des domaines d’intervention et la mobilisation des fonds.

il faudrait envisager de réexaminer les plafonds, les planchers et la règle de 50 % L’on pourrait aussi envisager de réexaminer la question de la réduction des plafonds, en rame-

Page 36: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-30 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

nant à 5 % le montant maximum qui pourrait être alloué à un pays dans le domaine d’intervention, ce qui assurerait une répartition plus uniforme des financements, ou dégagerait davantage de res-sources pour les projets mondiaux et régionaux. Des simulations montrent qu’un plafond de 10 % n’est pas efficace pour modifier les structures actuelles des allocations, alors que la réduction du plafond à 5 % a des répercussions sensibles.

Des plafonds moins élevés augmenteront proba-blement la liquidité et l’efficacité (efficience éco-nomique) du DAR, en particulier dans le domaine des changements climatiques. Une réduction échelonnée des plafonds est envisageable : à 5 % dans le domaine de la diversité biologique et à 10 % dans celui des changements climatiques au titre de FEM-5, et à 5 % au titre de FEM-6.

La fixation de planchers est à présent superflus : le plancher d’un million de dollars est appliqué aux pays, mais étant donné que par la suite les pays et les planchers qui leurs sont appliqués se trouvent regroupés sous le régime collectif, les planchers s’avèrent inefficaces. Il est indiqué d’appliquer des planchers aux allocations pour assurer aux pays un minimum de financement leur permet-tant d’honorer leurs obligations aux termes des conventions. Pour la plupart des pays, un montant d’un million de dollars devrait suffire à cet effet. Toutefois, si les pays aimeraient utiliser les fonds du FEM pour améliorer l’état environnemental de la planète, le financement des activités habili-tantes au moyen des allocations à titre individuel pourrait ne pas être une solution efficace. Par ailleurs, le niveau « minimum » de l’aide du FEM qui serait raisonnable pour permettre aux pays de promouvoir l’amélioration de l’environnement mondial peut varier d’un pays à l’autre et d’une Entité d’exécution à l’autre, certains mentionnant 4 millions de dollars comme étant un niveau pra-tique. Le FEM aurait intérêt à revoir le niveau des

planchers, notamment parce qu’il apparaît déjà que le montant d’un million de dollars ne suffit guère pour avoir des effets positifs notables sur l’environnement mondial.

Il faudrait remplacer la règle de 50 % par des solu-tions transparentes et dynamiques permettant de limiter, le cas échéant, la concentration des fonds en début du cycle, tout en réalisant un équilibre entre la disponibilité de fonds et la promotion de l’utilisation de fonds. En consultation avec les Entités d’exécution, le Secrétariat devrait, sur les conseils de l’Administrateur du FEM, instituer des plafonds raisonnables et transparents sur les dépenses en début du cycle. L’opération de réallo-cation permettrait en tout état de cause, à l’instar d’autres mécanismes d’allocation fondés sur les résultats, de récompenser les bons résultats.

Pour appliquer le DAR à tous les domaines d’intervention dans le cadre de FeM-5, il faudrait adopter un régime d’allocation intégré pour tous les domaines d’intervention d’un paysParmi les organisations appliquant un disposi-tif d’allocation fondé sur les résultats, le FEM est actuellement celle qui intervient dans le plus grand nombre de pays avec le plus faible volume de ressources, et l’unique donateur appliquant deux mécanismes complexes d’allocation de res-sources, dont un pour la diversité biologique et l’autre pour les changements climatiques. Si l’on passe à six mécanismes d’allocation de ressources dans le cadre de FEM-5, le système deviendra pra-tiquement ingérable, à moins que la reconstitution du FEM n’augmente considérablement de même que l’effectif du Secrétariat. Par exemple, le Fonds mondial de lutte contre le SIDA, la tuberculose et le paludisme, dont les décaissements à ce jour se chiffrent à 10 milliards de dollars, compte un effectif de 400 fonctionnaires au siège. Le FIDA, dont le niveau de financement est similaire à celui

Page 37: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusions et recommandations F-31

du FEM, a un effectif de 225 cadres en service au siège, en plus de quelques représentants régionaux et nationaux. Le FEM, par contre, se fonde sur un réseau d’Entités d’exécution possédant les compé-tences nécessaires, ainsi que sur des systèmes de gestion et des bureaux extérieurs.

L’appel en faveur d’une plus grande intégration a été entendu par l’ensemble du FEM et les instan-ces des conventions internationales. C’est ainsi que de nombreux articles récents mettent en évidence la corrélation entre la diversité biologique et les changements climatiques. Les nouvelles initiati-ves que le Conseil, le Secrétariat du FEM et les ins-tances des conventions aimeraient prendre néces-sitent également une nouvelle optique consistant à considérer les allocations dans les domaines d’intervention comme des montants indicatifs et non pas à caractère prescriptif dans le cadre des ressources allouées aux pays à titre individuel. Les pays bénéficiaires du FEM sont des pays membres des conventions et doivent donc avant tout veiller à appliquer ces conventions.

Au nombre des nouvelles initiatives pourraient figurer la participation du secteur privé comme l’envisage la stratégie de ce secteur, la coopéra-tion avec la communauté des ONG et/ou la prise en compte de questions thématiques précises, comme le transfert des technologies. Un système d’allocation fondé sur les pays impliquera inévi-tablement certains arbitrages entre les priorités nationales et les programmes institutionnels. On pourrait régler de tels problèmes pratiques dans le cadre d’un mécanisme d’allocation soit en pré-voyant des réserves distinctes et suffisantes, soit en préparant des mécanismes d’incitation des pays et des Entités d’exécution à participer et à contribuer à de telles initiatives. À cet effet, il faudrait nor-malement apporter certaines modifications aux modalités des projets et aux mesures d’incitation financière.

L’on peut supposer que les montants alloués seront calculés pour chaque domaine d’interven-tion et regroupés ensuite pour chaque pays. La question qui se pose est celle de savoir dans quelle mesure un pays pourra financer des projets indi-viduels en prélevant des fonds sur son enveloppe globale, et dans quelle mesure il devra respecter la répartition de son enveloppe en domaines d’in-tervention distincts. Comme on l’a indiqué plus haut dans le cas des questions transnationales, il faudrait accorder une attention spéciale aux eaux internationales et à la nécessité de promouvoir les activités régionales. Au niveau des pays, il pourrait être approprié d’attribuer aux domaines d’intervention des financements proportionnel-lement aux scores que le pays a obtenus dans les différents domaines d’intervention. Il serait alors indispensable de communiquer régulièrement aux pays les informations suffisantes sur ces scores.

Il est essentiel de maintenir la souplesse pour améliorer le coût-efficacité. Les résultats obtenus jusqu’à présent mettent en évidence un décalage entre les priorités nationales et les priorités straté-giques du FEM dans la préparation du portefeuille de projets, ce qui entraîne des retards, des frustra-tions et le manque d’accès. Le FEM ne peut pas offrir une réserve commune de ressources pour améliorer la souplesse et le coût-efficacité – et éliminer ensuite cette souplesse en décidant du lieu où ces fonds doivent être dépensés et des fins auxquelles ils doivent être consacrés. Il ne suffit pas de mettre en commun des fonds provenant de différents domaines d’intervention pour créer des synergies. Pour améliorer l’efficacité, le FEM doit avoir une idée précise sur le mode de fonction-nement de ce dispositif de mise en commun des financements au sein des domaines d’intervention et entre eux, ainsi que de la stratégie à appliquer en la matière.

Page 38: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

F-32 examen à mi-parcours du dispositif d’allocation des ressources du FeM

notePour obtenir une classification géographique 1. exhaustive et raisonnable aux fins des analyses, l’examen à mi-parcours s’est servi de différentes sources de classification, celles normalement uti-lisées ne couvrant pas tous les pays pouvant pré-tendre à l’aide du FEM. Par exemple, le FEM n’uti-lise que quatre régions pour classer les projets, ce qui ne prend pas en compte le Moyen-Orient et l’Afrique du Nord (l’une des régions de la Banque mondiale) et la dénomination États arabes utilisée par le PNUD, mais comprend diverses catégories de classification de groupes. La combinaison des six régions géographiques de la Banque mondiale avec huit groupes du FEM donne la classification ci-après utilisée par l’examen à mi-parcours :

L’Afrique subsaharienne subdivisée en deux zgroupes : l’Afrique de l’Est et australe et l’Afri-que de l’Ouest et centrale

Deux régions de la Banque mondiale en Asie : zAsie de l’Est et Pacifique et Asie du Sud, réparties dans deux sous-groupes Asie et PEID Pacifique

Europe et Asie centrale (Europe et Commu- znauté des États indépendants)

Amérique latine et Caraïbes, constituant les zsous-groupes Amérique latine et Caraïbes

Moyen-Orient et Afrique du Nord z

Voir l’annexe statistique 4, « Classification des pays et allocation du DAR », tableau 6.

Page 39: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-1

Prefacio

En respuesta a las recomendaciones normativas para la tercera reposición de recursos, el Con-sejo del Fondo para el Medio Ambiente Mundial (FMAM) acordó aplicar un marco de asigna-ción de recursos (MAR) basado en un índice del potencial de un país para generar beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial y en un índice de des-empeño. El MAR es único entre los sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño porque evalúa las necesidades y el potencial en el contexto de la biodiversidad y el cambio climático. Dado su carácter innovador, el Consejo solicitó a la Oficina de Evaluación del FMAM que exami-nara el MAR en 2008, al cabo de dos años de su puesta en marcha.

Este examen de mitad de período apunta a eva-luar la medida en que los recursos se han asig-nado a los países de manera transparente y eficaz en función de los costos teniendo en cuenta los beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial y el desempeño de cada país. Si bien aún no es posible ofrecer datos empíricos sobre el efecto del MAR en términos de beneficios para el medio ambiente, se concluyó que ha presentado desaf íos a la tran-sición hacia una nueva manera de suministrar recursos del FMAM.

Los países que reciben asignaciones individuales en general apreciaron la mayor previsibilidad de los fondos del FMAM; mientras que los países con asignaciones más pequeñas y que comparten

un fondo mancomunado registraron dificultades para acceder a los recursos del FMAM. Los costos de transacción relativos al MAR y otras reformas fueron elevados en toda la alianza que conforma el FMAM, por lo que aún no se ha probado acabada-mente que el MAR sea más eficaz en función de los costos, en términos de rentabilidad. Esto muestra, al menos en parte, la expectativa del FMAM de ofrecer respaldo al mayor número de países con recursos limitados, de acuerdo con su mandato de protección del medio ambiente mundial.

En función de las recomendaciones realizadas en el examen de mitad de período, de noviembre del año 2008, el Consejo decidió que los fondos sin utilizar serán reasignados en el último año del FMAM-4, de acuerdo con reglas claras y un pro-cedimiento transparente y equitativo, por desarro-llarse en los próximos meses. La última etapa del FMAM-4, incluida la reasignación de fondos, se ejecutará en condiciones de pleno acceso público a la información, transparencia, participación y claridad en cuanto a las responsabilidades.

Con miras al futuro, el Consejo también solicitó a la Secretaría del FMAM, a los organismos del FMAM, al Grupo Asesor Científico y Tecnológico (STAP) y a las otras partes interesadas que presen-ten medidas para mejorar el diseño y los índices del MAR para las esferas de la biodiversidad y el cambio climático del FMAM-5, y que presenten escenarios para una posible expansión del MAR

Page 40: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-2 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

tos independientes en las esferas de biodiversidad mundial, cambio climático y desempeño.

En el contexto del examen se generaron varios documentos técnicos y anexos estadísticos com-plementarios, con resultados detallados y datos subyacentes, disponibles en el sitio web de la Ofi-cina de Evaluación del FMAM (www.gefeo.org) y en CD-ROM. Confío en que estos documentos y su detallada información sobre los diversos aspec-tos del diseño y la aplicación del MAR ayuden al FMAM a continuar con la mejora en su marco de asignación de recursos en el futuro y a prepararse para el próximo período de programación. La Oficina de Evaluación seguirá dedicando su aten-ción a esta importante característica del apoyo del FMAM en el contexto del cuarto estudio sobre el desempeño general del FMAM.

Rob D. van den BergDirector, Oficina de Evaluación

—de ser viable— a todas las esferas del FMAM-5. El examen de mitad de período hace referencia a algunas áreas en las que se puede mejorar de esta manera, tales como el abandono de la asignación por grupo de países; el reconocimiento de los problemas transfronterizos en materia de medio ambiente mundial; la mayor ponderación del des-empeño de la cartera en el índice de desempeño mundial (IDM) del FMAM; y la reconsideración de las reglas que determinan los montos máximos y mínimos de asignación y los límites de gasto.

El examen de mitad de período tuvo un alcance más complejo y ambicioso que el que suelen tener las evaluaciones formativas de mitad de período: incluyó un examen comparativo del MAR con los sistemas de asignación basada en el desempeño de otros organismos multilaterales; numerosos análi-sis estadísticos, simulaciones y modelos de datos; una revisión de la cartera con todas las asignacio-nes históricas y cambios durante el período del FMAM-4; y un estudio de pares realizado con el método Delfos de los indicadores, los índices y el diseño del MAR, a cargo de tres paneles de exper-

Page 41: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-3

Agradecimientos

Este informe se elaboró bajo la dirección general del jefe de proyecto de evaluación, Siv Tokle, ofi-cial superior de evaluación de la Oficina de Eva-luación del FMAM, quien coordinó y supervisó todos los componentes y métodos, y elaboró un informe con contribuciones del equipo principal. El consultor Kenneth Watson, de amplia experien-cia en lo relativo a sistemas de asignación basada en el desempeño, aportó importantes observa-ciones y lecciones para el MAR, mientras que el consultor James Fremming aportó conocimientos especializados sobre evaluación y desarrollo de capacidades al análisis de problemas de aplicación y métodos de examen.

Dentro de la Oficina de Evaluación del FMAM, el análisis de asignaciones y las simulaciones estadís-ticas indispensables estuvieron a cargo de Yu-Kui Zhou, quien también trabajó con Divya Nair en el examen de las asignaciones históricas y la cartera del FMAM. Shaista Ahmed contribuyó con el aná-lisis y el respaldo para la encuesta a 700 personas aproximadamente y para el examen de los proyec-

tos en tramitación, mientras que el amplio estudio de la documentación estuvo a cargo de Florentina Mulaj. Otros colegas de la Oficina de Evaluación colaboraron con el equipo, como Neeraj Negi, ofi-cial de evaluación, que analizó el efecto del MAR en el programa de pequeñas donaciones (PPD) del FMAM.

El equipo agradece la información detallada y franca que obtuvieron en el contexto de las amplias consultas organizadas con todas las partes interesa-das, en especial los cinco coordinadores del FMAM que participaron de cinco talleres subregionales, la Secretaría del FMAM, los diez organismos del FMAM, las Secretarías del Convenio sobre la bio-diversidad y de la Convención sobre el cambio cli-mático, al Grupo Asesor Científico y Tecnológico y a las organizaciones no gubernamentales.

En noviembre del año 2008 se presentó al Consejo del FMAM una versión preliminar de este docu-mento. La Oficina de Evaluación es totalmente responsable por el contenido del informe.

Page 42: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework
Page 43: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-5

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones

En respuesta a las recomendaciones normativas para la tercera reposición de recursos (2003-06) del Fondo para el Medio Ambiente Mundial (FMAM), el Consejo del FMAM acordó aplicar, para la repo-sición del FMAM-4 (2006-10), un marco de asig-nación de recursos (MAR) basado en un índice del potencial de un país para generar beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial en las esferas de la bio-diversidad y el cambio climático, y en un índice de desempeño. (Puede obtenerse un resumen de las decisiones sobre el MAR en el documento técnico #1, “Metodología y contexto”, Cuadro 2.3.)

En las recomendaciones normativas para la cuarta reposición de recursos se solicitó a la Secretaría del FMAM que colaborara con el Consejo para esta-blecer un sistema para la asignación de los escasos recursos del FMAM con “miras a lograr el máximo impacto de estos recursos en mejorar la situación del medio ambiente mundial, y promover políticas y prácticas ambientales acertadas en todo el mundo” (FMAM 2002f). Se preveía que el MAR serviría de marco para que los países hicieran la progra-mación de sus recursos de acuerdo con sus prio-ridades nacionales; se permitiera a los países una mayor previsibilidad del financiamiento disponible del FMAM, y una mayor transparencia al especifi-carse un método bien definido y de conocimiento público para asignar los recursos del FMAM.

Según el documento final aprobado sobre el marco, el MAR es “…un sistema para asignar los

recursos del FMAM a los países en forma trans-parente y coherente, basado en las prioridades ambientales mundiales y en la capacidad, políticas y prácticas de cada país para la ejecución eficaz de los proyectos del FMAM” (FMAM 2005c). Consta de tres índices:

Índice de beneficios del FMAM en materia de z

biodiversidad (IBMBIO)

Índice de beneficios del FMAM en materia de z

cambio climático (IBMCC)

Índice de desempeño mundial (IDM) del FMAM z

En el contexto del MAR, el FMAM asignó US$1.000 millones a 150 países para la protección de la biodiversidad, y US$1.000 millones a 161 países para hacer frente al cambio climático para el período de 2006-10. Para tener acceso a estos fondos, los países deben presentar propuestas de proyecto que se ajusten a las prioridades estraté-gicas del FMAM. El Consejo del FMAM solicitó a la Oficina de Evaluación del FMAM que exami-nara el MAR al cabo de dos años de aplicación, así como la experiencia operacional del FMAM y sus socios con el MAR.

1.1 evolución y situación actual del MAREl desarrollo y la puesta en práctica del MAR se produjeron durante un período signado por

Page 44: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-6 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

muchos otros cambios y reformas que incluyeron en su diseño y su puesta en marcha. El MAR, a su vez, afectó a la alianza integrada por el FMAM y provocó la puesta en vigor de otras reformas. Asimismo, si bien el cuarto período de reposición del FMAM resultó exitoso y representó un incre-mento en términos nominales en relación con los fondos reunidos en el FMAM-3, no implicó un aumento en el financiamiento real disponible, aunque las demandas a las que se ve sometido el FMAM y el número de objetivos estratégicos y esferas de actividad se han incrementado con el tiempo.

Simultáneamente, la comunidad de donantes, los convenios y las convenciones mundiales han prestado cada vez más atención a la necesidad de brindar apoyo y movilizar recursos en favor del medio ambiente. La creciente conciencia respecto del cambio climático y de sus efectos ha llevado a la creación de nuevos fondos paralelos al Fondo fiduciario del FMAM. Una mayor eficacia es la meta que sustenta las estrategias revisadas para las esferas de actividad en el FMAM-4 (aprobadas en octubre de 2007), con las cuales se circuns-cribe el alcance de dichas esferas y se trasladan los objetivos estratégicos a un nivel superior, más programático. El FMAM-4 también se inició con un fuerte impulso en favor de una mayor eficien-cia, que se plasmó tanto en el examen del ciclo de los proyectos del FMAM y el consiguiente incremento de los enfoques programáticos (véase Capítulo 6) como en la decisión de otorgar un tratamiento más equitativo a los organismos del FMAM mediante la eliminación de los presupues-tos institucionales para los organismos de ejecu-ción y el incremento de las cuotas para proyectos. Estas y otras reformas y modificaciones produci-das en el FMAM han afectado en gran medida la aplicación del MAR e indican que no se pueden realizar comparaciones precisas entre el período de ejecución del MAR y el FMAM-3.

La elaboración del MAR fue un proceso prolon-gado que implicó siete reuniones del Consejo a lo largo de cuatro años y numerosos talleres, gru-pos de trabajo y consultas. Una vez alcanzado un acuerdo en septiembre de 2005, se inició la etapa de planificación para la puesta en marcha. Las asig-naciones a los países se dieron a conocer en sep-tiembre de 2006, luego de la finalización ocurrida en el mes de julio del FMAM-3. Las deliberacio-nes a nivel de los países acerca de las prioridades en relación con sus correspondientes asignaciones continuaron hasta la primavera boreal de 2007. El inicio oficial de la aplicación del MAR se produjo recién en febrero de 2007, cuando entró en vigor el cuarto período de reposición del FMAM. Estas demoras afectaron la puntualidad en la puesta en práctica del MAR. Si bien desde el inicio de su apli-cación hasta la mitad del periodo (julio de 2008) han transcurrido menos de dos años, y los impac-tos ambientales no son observables aún, están surgiendo efectos claros entre los que se incluyen las diferencias con otras esferas de actividad que todavía no forman parte del MAR.

Asignaciones históricasComo se pretendió en el diseño del MAR, las asig-naciones otorgadas en función de este sistema se corresponden con los patrones de las asignaciones históricas del FMAM. Estadísticamente, la fór-mula del MAR establece una estrecha correlación entre las asignaciones anteriores y las actuales en el caso de todos los países y durante todas las fases; como puede verse al analizar las tendencias en un diagrama de dispersión (véase Gráfico 5.1). Aunque los resultados de la aplicación de la fór-mula del MAR pueden asemejarse a las asignacio-nes históricas, son varias las fórmulas con ponde-raciones diversas que podrían generar la misma situación.

A lo largo de los períodos previos de reposición del FMAM, todos excepto tres de los 20 países que en

Page 45: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-7

la actualidad reciben las asignaciones mayores del MAR para la esfera de la biodiversidad, se ubica-ban también entre los primeros 20 históricos y 12 de los 20 países que reciben las asignaciones más elevadas para la esfera del cambio climático son los mismos que en el pasado. Las proporciones correspondientes a los diversos países para cada período de reposición muestran una alta correla-ción con la proporción de asignaciones para las esferas de actividad y las determinadas en virtud del IBM. La mayor parte de los países que reciben asignación por grupo habían obtenido cantidades limitadas en el pasado. Asimismo, la reposición del FMAM-4, nominalmente mayor, y la reduc-ción en el número de proyectos regionales y de alcance mundial dieron como resultado un mayor volumen de recursos disponible para asignar a los países.

Se observan considerables variaciones en el caso de algunos países dentro de este patrón general, y también cambios en la preponderancia de los montos destinados a las dos esferas de actividad incluidas en el MAR para un país determinado. Durante el FMAM-3, más de 100 países recibie-ron recursos para ambas esferas de actividad. En comparación con los montos anteriores, la asigna-

ción del MAR representa un posible incremento —si bien no en montos elevados— para 115 paí-ses de la esfera de la biodiversidad y para 71 paí-ses con proyectos relativos al cambio climático, siempre que las naciones accedan al máximo de sus asignaciones; los países admisibles restantes reciben menos que en el pasado. Las posibilidades de acceso son mayores si el país ha colaborado con FMAM anteriormente, si tiene proyectos en tra-mitación y una asignación individual en el MAR.

Países con asignación individual El MAR otorgó asignaciones individuales a 57 países de la esfera de la biodiversidad, por un total posible de US$753,2 millones. En la esfera del cambio climático, se otorgaron asignaciones individuales por un total de US$751,4 millones a 46 países. En el Cuadro 1.1 se presenta la com-paración con los porcentajes de las asignaciones históricas por grupo/región del FMAM1. Los 31 países que recibieron asignaciones individuales para ambas esferas de actividad poseen una pro-porción del 61% del total de asignaciones para la biodiversidad (anteriormente, del 52%) y una pro-porción del 68% del total de asignaciones para el cambio climático (anteriormente, del 73%). Para

Cuadro 1.1

Comparación de proporciones de asignación del MAR y proporciones históricas, por grupo/región

Grupo/Región

Biodiversidad (57 países indicativos) Cambio climático (46 países indicativos)

histórico (%) MAR (%) histórico (%) MAR (%)

Europa y CEI 6 5 11 30

Asia 26 27 49 44

África occidental y central 5 5 2 1

África oriental y meridional 16 16 6 6

Caribe 1 4 1 1

PEID del Pacífico 2 2 0 0

América Latina 40 40 23 15

Oriente Medio y Norte de África 3 2 8 4

Total (Us$) 1,347 millones 753 millones 1,557 millones 751 millonesnote: CEI = Comunidad de Estados Independientes.

Page 46: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-8 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

promover una distribución más equitativa de los recursos, la asignación de un país no puede exce-der el 10% del total de los recursos destinados a la biodiversidad ni el 15% del total dirigido al cam-bio climático. Estos topes máximos son dema-siado altos para afectar las asignaciones y solo un país (China) se ve limitado (en la esfera de cambio climático).

Asignación por grupoResulta dif ícil establecer una comparación histórica para los países que reciben asignación por grupo, ya que comparten un fondo manco-munado sin asignaciones fijas para cada país. Sin embargo, antes de incorporarse a los grupos, estos países reciben una calificación y una asig-nación preliminares (que no se dan a conocer). El monto total del fondo mancomunado se compone de las asignaciones preliminares de los países del grupo que superen US$1 millón, más US$1 millón para cada uno de los demás (esto se denomina asignación ajustada) (véase el Cuadro 1.2). No se garantiza un monto específico para ningún país en la asignación por grupo, pero todos pueden com-petir por recibir una suma mayor de la que obten-drían normalmente con su asignación preliminar.

Las posibilidades para acceder a los fondos son numerosas. En el caso extremo, 42 países de la esfera de biodiversidad podrían obtener el máx-imo de US$3,5 millones, pero esto implicaría que 51 países no recibirían fondos; en la esfera del cam-bio climático, 48 países podrían percibir el máximo mientras que a los otros 67 no se les otorgaría nada. En los periodos de reposición precedentes, fueron muchos los países que, de hecho, no recibieron ningún importe en concepto de donación. Desde la perspectiva opuesta, si todos los países reciben US$1 millón del fondo mancomunado, 21 naciones de la esfera de la biodiversidad y 16 correspondi-entes a la del cambio climático podrían recibir el máximo superior a US$3 millones cada uno.

La mayoría de los países en circunstancias espe-ciales reciben asignaciones por grupo (véase Cuadro 1.3). Por ejemplo, en la esfera del cambio climático, el 97% de los 48 pequeños Estados insu-lares en desarrollo (PEID) forma parte del grupo, al igual que el 88% de los 48 países menos ade-lantados (PMA). La designación de la asignación por grupo incrementa los obstáculos preexisten-tes que deben superar los PEID y los PMA para acceder a los recursos del FMAM.

Recursos y beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial El modelo del MAR canaliza recursos a países que aportan grandes beneficios al medio ambiente mundial, según la medición de los puntajes del IBM; el IDM no influye significativamente a la hora de establecer las asignaciones. Los 57 países indicativos, definidos como países que reciben asignaciones individuales, acumulan el 88% del total de los puntajes del IBM para los 150 países admisibles según el índice de biodiversidad, y reúnen el 75,3% del total de recursos de esta esfera de actividad. En la esfera del cambio climático, los

Cuadro 1.2

Resumen de asignación por grupo

Parámetro Biodiversidad Cambio climático

Cantidad de países 93 115

Total del monto reunido

US$146,8 millones

US$148,6 millones

Máximo posible por país

US$3,5 millones

US$3,0 millones

Asignación preliminar

> US$1 millón 53 países 41 países

US$1 millón 10 países 33 países

< US$1 millón 30 países 41 países

Complementos específicosa

US$15,4 millones

US$25,9 millones

a. El complemento específico otorga a los países una asignación pre-liminar menor a US$1 millón con una asignación mínima ajustada de US$1 millón; el complemento total pasa a ser parte del fondo mancomunado de recursos de la asignación por grupo.

Page 47: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-9

46 países indicativos reciben el 75% del total de los recursos destinados a esta área y representan el 89% de los puntajes del IBMCC correspondientes a los 161 países admisibles (véase el Cuadro 1.4). Los países con enorme biodiversidad están debi-damente incluidos, pero no tanto las zonas críti-cas de biodiversidad que abarcan países con asig-nación individual y por grupos (en la cobertura de las zonas críticas también influye la reducción de los recursos mundiales y regionales). En la esfera del cambio climático, el principal factor determi-nante para la asignación es la emisión de gases de efecto invernadero.

Utilización de los recursosEn el nuevo ciclo de proyectos, la Secretaría del FMAM define la “utilización de los recursos” como la aprobación de las fichas de identificación de proyectos (FIP) y precede a la ratificación del documento de proyecto. Con esta definición, en el primer período del MAR se registró un uso sig-nificativamente menor de los fondos en las esferas de actividad del MAR respecto de los períodos de reposición anteriores. A la mitad del período, no se ha registrado en el terreno casi ningún desem-bolso del financiamiento del FMAM-4. La tasa general de utilización de los recursos es, a mitad del período, del 31% del total de los fondos des-tinados a la esfera de actividad. El empleo de los recursos es mucho mayor en las esferas no inclui-das en el MAR (véase Gráfico 1.1): aguas interna-cionales, el 59%, degradación de la tierra, el 81%, y contaminantes orgánicos persistentes, el 48%. Sin embargo, cabe notar que el primer período del MAR en realidad ha comprendido menos de dos años, puesto que el FMAM-4 entró en vigor en febrero de 2007.

Hasta el 3 de julio de 2008 —fecha formal de mitad de período del MAR—, la Directora Ejecutiva del FMAM había ratificado 15 proyectos ordinarios

Cuadro 1.4

Comparación de la proporción de puntajes del iBM y asignaciones, en el contexto del MAR

Parámetro

BiodiversidadCambio

climático

ind. Grupo ind. Grupo

Cantidad de países 57 93 46 115

Porcentaje de países 38 62 29 71

Porcentaje de asignación 75 15 75 15

Porcentaje de puntaje del IBM

88 12 89 11

nota: Ind. = asignación individual; Grupo. = asignación por grupo.

Cuadro 1.3

Asignaciones ajustadas en el contexto del MAR, por clasificación de país

Clase de país

Biodiversidad (150 países) Cambio climático (161 países)

Cantidad de países Asignación (Us$ millones) Cantidad de países Asignación (Us$ millones)

Todos ind. Grupo Todos ind. Grupo Todos ind. Grupo Todos ind. Grupo

PEID 35 9 26 110,05 62,29 47,76 35 1 34 40,56 4,25 36,31

PMA 48 13 35 154,84 95,63 59,20 48 6 42 80,36 28,44 51,92

Países sin salida al mar

35 9 26 87,64 50,48 37,16 36 9 27 98,63 59,86 38,76

Estados frágiles

30 8 22 86,21 48,33 37,87 30 4 26 56,35 27,64 28,71

Países pobres muy endeudados

40 16 24 164,69 124,08 40,61 40 5 35 67,90 21,55 46,35

nota: Ind. = asignación individual; Grupo = Asignación por grupo.

Page 48: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-10 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

de alcance nacional. Si se utiliza la ratificación del documento de proyecto por parte de la Directora Ejecutiva como indicación del uso de los fondos (y parece un indicador más realista), los países llevan utilizado el 6% del total del financiamiento del FMAM-4 destinado a ellos a través del MAR (véase Cuadro 1.5). Solo un proyecto ha comen-zado (luego del desembolso de los fondos).

El acceso a los recursos es dispar: los países a los que se otorga una asignación por grupo en la esfera

de la biodiversidad han empleado el 18% de su asignación, proporción que en el caso de los países que reciben asignación por grupo en la esfera del cambio climático es de solo el 5%; mientras que los países que reciben asignaciones individuales han usado el 33% para la aprobación de la FIP, las donaciones para la preparación de proyectos y la aprobación de proyectos de tamaño mediano.

Participación de los organismos del FMAMEl MAR ha generado una mayor participación del Programa de las Naciones Unidas para el Desa-rrollo (PNUD) y de los "nuevos" organismos del FMAM y un menor protagonismo del Banco Mundial y, en menor medida, del Programa de las Naciones Unidas para el Medio Ambiente (PNUMA).

El Banco Mundial (incluida la Corporación Finan-ciera Internacional), que históricamente fue el organismo más importante en términos de recur-sos del FMAM, ha pasado de una participación de más de la mitad de los recursos del FMAM para las esferas de biodiversidad y cambio climático en períodos precedentes, al 32% de la utilización de recursos del FMAM en virtud del MAR en las FIP aprobadas. Simultáneamente, la participación del Banco Mundial en los proyectos correspondientes a múltiples esferas de actividad se ha incremen-tado del 21% al 33% durante el FMAM-4, mientras que su participación total en las áreas no incluidas en el MAR ha aumentado en relación con perío-dos anteriores. Como se observa en el Gráfico 1.2, actualmente el PNUD es responsable del 43% de la utilización de recursos del MAR, lo que consti-tuye un aumento en relación con el 28% histórico.

En consonancia con la política revisada dirigida a establecer condiciones más equitativas para los organismos del FMAM, se ha incrementado la participación de las siete “entidades de ejecución” (EE) hasta alcanzar un 17% de la utilización de

Cuadro 1.5

situación de asignaciones del MAR al 3 de julio de 2008

situación Biodiversidad Cambio climático

Asignación del MAR US$900 millones

US$900 millones

Utilización de recur-sos (aprobación mediante FIP)

US$287 millones (32%)

US$252 millones (28%)

Ratificación de la Directora Ejecutiva

US$37,8 millones (4%)

US$65,4 millones (7%)

En ejecución N/D N/D

note: N/D = no disponiblee.

Gráfico 1.1

Utilización de los recursos en el FMAM-4, por organismo y esfera de actividad

Millones de US$

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

180

200

Biodiversidad Cambioclimático

Proyecto paravarias esferasde actividad

No incluidosen el MAR

Banco Mundial PNUD PNUMA Entidad de ejecución

0

nota: El gráfico no muestra los proyectos ejecutados de manera conjunta, ya que totalizaron US$1 millón o menos.

Page 49: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-11

recursos en virtud del MAR durante el FMAM-4 (en relación con el 7,9% registrado en el FMAM-3, incluido el acceso indirecto, o el 2% de todos los recursos históricos). Esta cifra incluye US$30,1 millones destinados a proyectos del Banco Euro-peo de Reconstrucción y Desarrollo en Rusia y Ucrania y siete proyectos del Banco Asiático de Desarrollo que comprenden actividades enmarca-das en el enfoque programático de la región del Pacífico. El Banco Interamericano de Desarro-llo lleva adelante ocho proyectos en la región de América Latina y el Caribe, y tanto el Fondo Inter-nacional de Desarrollo Agrícola (FIDA) como la Organización de las Naciones Unidas para la Agricultura y la Alimentación (FAO) también par-ticipan en proyectos del FMAM-4.

Además del MAR, son muchas las razones que influyen sobre estos cambios. Todos los organis-mos se han visto afectados por otras reformas encaradas durante el FMAM-4 y por el cambio de funciones establecido en función del MAR. Adi-cionalmente, la situación actual refleja la capaci-dad del PNUD de brindar asistencia técnica para el fortalecimiento de la capacidad con el respaldo de las oficinas locales, además de su disposición

a participar en proyectos relativamente pequeños en virtud del MAR. La distribución de las peque-ñas asignaciones del MAR entre numerosos países dificulta la aplicación de la política de aunar los préstamos de las instituciones financieras interna-cionales con los proyectos del FMAM cuya mag-nitud resulte eficaz en función de los costos. Con frecuencia resulta más fácil acceder a otras alter-nativas internas de financiamiento que al apoyo del FMAM.

Funciones y relacionesAunque el MAR no exigía modificaciones forma-les en las funciones del FMAM más allá de la nueva tarea de gestionar y controlar el MAR, encomen-dada a la Secretaría, el marco ha generado impor-tantes cambios en las funciones de la alianza que conforma el FMAM. En combinación con otras reformas, el MAR ha impulsado a la Secretaría del FMAM a asumir una función de mayor peso en la creación de proyectos, el desarrollo de programas y el diálogo bilateral con los países, para lo cual las deliberaciones sobre los proyectos en tramitación del MAR fue el punto de partida. Los coordinado-res de operaciones del FMAM informan que sus funciones se han incrementado, en particular en el caso de los países que reciben asignaciones indivi-duales, puesto que anteriormente solo se requería su aprobación y en la actualidad deben encargarse de la programación y la fijación de prioridades. Han organizado consultas en los países para esta-blecer las prioridades en los proyectos en tramita-ción del FMAM. Dichas consultas a menudo han sido más amplias y sistemáticas que en el pasado. Por otro lado, se espera que los coordinadores de operaciones de los países que reciben asignacio-nes por grupo desempeñen la misma función de coordinación y fijación de prioridades, pero con menos recursos.

Sin embargo, la mayor participación de los coor-dinadores de operaciones no significa que los

Gráfico 1.2

Utilización de recursos por organismo y por período de reposición

nota: EE = entidad de ejecución; OE = organismo de ejecución.

Banco Mundial

PNUD

PNUMA

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

Fasepiloto

GEF-1 GEF-2 GEF-3 GEF-4

Porcentaje del total de la etapa de reposición

OE en colaboraciónEEOE/EE en

colaboraciónt

Page 50: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-12 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

países se identifiquen plenamente con las pro-puestas del FMAM, ya que la participación de otros socios, como las organizaciones no guber-namentales (ONG), el sector privado o los donan-tes, fue menor y las consultas pasaron del nivel de los proyectos al de la cartera para todo el país. En la encuesta realizada para el examen de mitad de período solo el 44% del personal de las ONG y las organizaciones del sector privado indicó que la participación en el contexto del MAR había sido muy o moderadamente exitosa; y el 69% de las partes involucradas en el programa de pequeñas donaciones (PPD) manifestaron su inquietud por la posibilidad de que la posición neutral de este programa se vea debilitada a causa del mayor peso de los gobiernos en la planificación del FMAM.

Las funciones aún están en evolución, en respuesta al MAR y a otros cambios en el FMAM. Por ejem-plo, la función de los tres organismos originales del FMAM se ha reducido recientemente en la gestión estratégica del FMAM, y la función del Consejo ha cambiado respecto del nuevo ciclo de los proyectos con la introducción de enfoques programáticos.

Características de la cartera de proyectos Si bien la utilización de los fondos en la etapa de aprobación de las FIP no es aún elevada, se obser-van con claridad algunas tendencias en la eje-cución. La proporción de proyectos de tamaño mediano se ha incrementado ligeramente res-pecto de tendencias anteriores (9,5%, mientras que a mitad del FMAM-3 se situaba en el 5,5%). Como el 93% de los países que reciben asignacio-nes por grupo para la esfera del cambio climático y el 53% de aquéllos a los que se asigna fondos por grupo para proyectos de biodiversidad no acce-dieron a ningún monto al momento de la reali-zación del examen de mitad de período, la cifra puede aumentar en lo que resta del FMAM-4. Sin embargo, con algunas excepciones a nivel regional, los proyectos de tamaño mediano generalmente

no resultan eficaces en función de los costos para los países y los organismos, puesto que esta moda-lidad exige casi el mismo nivel de esfuerzo en los procedimientos que las iniciativas ordinarias. El ciclo de los proyectos de tamaño mediano no ha sido simplificado. Si bien los proyectos de tamaño mediano pueden representar un medio para dis-tribuir recursos escasos entre más entidades que proponen proyectos, el incremento en el uso de este tipo de proyectos acarrea consecuencias en la eficacia en función de los costos de la cartera total del FMAM.

Se ha registrado un incremento en el número de proyectos para varias esferas de actividad, que pasaron del 13% en las reposiciones históricas al 33% en lo que va del FMAM-4, tanto en términos de fondos comprendidos en el MAR como con recursos excluidos de dicho marco. Los proyec-tos conjuntos de varios organismos parecen haber desaparecido, pero como los proyectos también se dividen en los distintos componentes de las FIP por organismo, país, esfera de actividad y fuente de financiamiento, es dif ícil hacer una compara-ción con las prácticas vigentes en el pasado. La división de fondos en virtud del MAR (entre paí-ses, esferas de actividad y exclusiones) ha incre-mentado la necesidad de recurrir a numerosas fuentes para llevar adelante un proyecto factible, de modo que las importantes sinergias de esos proyectos de múltiples esferas resultan inciertas. Este es también el caso de los 12 enfoques progra-máticos aprobados, algunos de ellos destinados a un país en particular, otros a programas regionales o mundiales. Los enfoques programáticos pueden representar una solución a la baja utilización de recursos registrada en ciertos países, pero es aún demasiado pronto para determinar los efectos. En el cuarto estudio sobre los resultados globales del FMAM (ERG4) se analizarán nuevas pruebas para establecer si, tal como se los aplica actualmente, incrementan la eficiencia y en qué medida.

Page 51: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-13

También se ha reducido la utilización de recursos para las actividades de apoyo: se han aprobado tan solo 10 en la esfera de la biodiversidad y nin-guna en la del cambio climático en el FMAM-4. Las actividades de apoyo son responsabilidad de los países, puesto que forman parte de sus obli-gaciones respecto de la convención o el conve-nio. Este bajo nivel de uso de los fondos del MAR puede deberse al hecho de que los países hasta el momento accedieron al financiamiento a partir de un programa utilizado como marco general de actividades de apoyo para el cambio climá-tico, aprobado antes del MAR, y a la naturaleza cíclica de las actividades de apoyo, que depende de las orientaciones impartidas por la convención o el convenio respectivos. En el futuro, se supone se acceda al financiamiento de las actividades de apoyo a través de las asignaciones del MAR. Sin embargo, su costo podría requerir la totalidad del monto destinado a los países que reciben asigna-ciones por grupo, por lo que no quedaría finan-ciamiento para otros proyectos. El Protocolo de Bioseguridad de Cartagena reviste especial impor-tancia en este sentido, ya que es el único protocolo totalmente respaldado por el FMAM en calidad de mecanismo de financiamiento. En lo que va del FMAM-4 se ha aprobado un enfoque programá-tico sobre bioseguridad y 10 proyectos referidos a la seguridad de la biotecnología en la esfera de biodiversidad, menos de lo esperado en vista del patrón histórico. Durante el FMAM-3, la mayor parte del apoyo a la bioseguridad (US$21 millo-nes) se canalizó a través de proyectos de alcance mundial. El MAR parece haber frenado el impulso que generó el proyecto anterior de alcance mun-dial referido a la seguridad de la biotecnología. Los expertos en el método Delfos consultados durante el examen de mitad de período acordaron que resulta más adecuado tratar este tema como una cuestión transfronteriza, por fuera del diseño del MAR.

eficacia en función de los costos Es aún demasiado pronto para determinar si el MAR ha sido eficaz en función de los costos, pero hasta el momento las tendencias no son favora-bles. La eficacia en función de los costos del MAR dependerá principalmente de si sirve o no para aumentar el efecto del FMAM. En el corto plazo, el MAR ha generado beneficios, pues ha permi-tido una mejor planificación e identificación en ciertos países y ha incrementado la previsibilidad del financiamiento en el caso de las naciones que reciben asignaciones individuales. No obstante, los efectos que ha generado hasta el momento en la cartera y en los proyectos en tramitación del FMAM han sido dispares. Por un lado, algunos países con asignaciones importantes han logrado conferir mayor coherencia a sus carteras de pro-yectos. Por otro lado, es probable que el MAR haya alentado una mayor distribución de recur-sos, proyectos más pequeños y el “sentido de dere-cho” a las asignaciones entre algunos gobiernos participantes.

El proceso de desarrollo del MAR fue una empresa larga y laboriosa. No se ha beneficiado con una participación significativa de las ONG, la sociedad civil ni el sector privado, por lo que se han perdido oportunidades para ampliar la eficacia y el alcance de los recursos del FMAM. Dado que son pocos los proyectos aprobados, y menos aún los que han comenzado a ejecutarse, es posible que los costos de oportunidad ocultos que implican los efectos demorados sean considerables.

Aún no se ha probado acabadamente que el MAR sea más eficaz en función de los costos que el sis-tema anterior o que otros sistemas de asignación basada en el desempeño, en términos de rentabi-lidad. Los montos pequeños de las asignaciones, unidos al gran número de requisitos del FMAM, han reducido la eficacia en función de los costos tanto a nivel de la cartera como de los proyectos,

Page 52: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-14 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

debido a las amplias consultas organizadas, los esfuerzos malgastados, las aprobaciones duplica-das, los proyectos abandonados y los complejos procedimientos necesarios para obtener la apro-bación de las propuestas. Los resultados no se han concretado. Se puede incrementar la eficacia en función de los costos aumentando el total de los fondos y las asignaciones a los países (lo que conllevaría el mismo esfuerzo pero lograría un beneficio mayor), disminuyendo los esfuerzos necesarios para acceder a los fondos existentes (lo que implicaría un menor esfuerzo, pero lograría el mismo beneficio y calidad iniciales), o —preferen-temente—aplicando una combinación de ambas medidas.

1.2 Principales conclusionesEn general, el MAR se ha aplicado conforme a las decisiones del Consejo. Esto no significa que los objetivos básicos se hayan logrado plenamente, puesto que la transición hacia una nueva manera de suministrar recursos ha sido dif ícil. Al exa-minar el diseño, la aplicación y las experiencias comparadas del MAR, en el examen de mitad de período se concluyó que estas cuestiones están de alguna manera interconectadas. Algunas dificul-tades de la aplicación se deben a las rígidas reglas de diseño del MAR, en tanto que en otros casos el diseño es razonable pero su aplicación no ha dado buenos resultados. Algunos problemas de la aplicación se vinculan al hecho de que el mandato del FMAM, las prácticas y el diseño del MAR son distintos de las de otros sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño.

Conclusión 1: el FMAM está funcionando en con-diciones que intensifican la necesidad de asig-nar los recursos escasos a fines determinados.

A nivel internacional ha aumentado la demanda de armonización, convergencia, identificación con los proyectos y de una adaptación del finan-

ciamiento externo a las prioridades y estrategias nacionales. A fin de abordar la cuestión de los recursos escasos y promover la programación nacional de recursos, se han establecido siste-mas de asignación de recursos en casi todos, si no todos, los organismos multilaterales de financia-miento. Los organismos de las Naciones Unidas por lo general tienen sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en las necesidades, en tanto que las instituciones financieras internacionales en general tienen una combinación de indicadores de necesidades y desempeño.

La cuarta reposición de los recursos del FMAM ha proporcionado en términos reales menos dinero que reposiciones anteriores. Al mismo tiempo, el número de esferas de actividad ha aumentado a seis. Siguen surgiendo nuevas cuestiones y ha aumentado la urgencia por resolver los problemas relativos al medio ambiente mundial. Asimismo, un número relativamente grande de países que pueden recibir asistencia no recibieron respaldo del FMAM en el pasado, y por lo tanto es preciso repartir menos dinero entre más países para rea-lizar más tareas. A fin de cumplir con las directri-ces y expectativas de los convenios y convencio-nes y abordar el número creciente de problemas ambientales, el volver a la modalidad ad hoc para proporcionar fondos para poder solucionar los problemas ya no es una opción. Sin embargo, es preciso introducir mejoras específicas en el sis-tema de asignación de recursos que ahora ha adoptado el FMAM a fin de que sea eficaz como instrumento para resolver estos problemas.

El MAR no se deriva de una evaluación del sistema existente para generar beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial. El enfoque histórico respecto de los beneficios para el medio ambiente mun-dial se ha basado en la estrategia operacional del FMAM, los programas operacionales y las prio-ridades estratégicas establecidas para cada etapa

Page 53: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-15

de reposición de recursos. Si bien estas estrategias y prioridades siguen vigentes, el enfoque por paí-ses del MAR plantea problemas intrínsecos en la administración y el seguimiento de proyectos en tramitación y la cartera con miras a cumplir con dichas prioridades. También puede coartar las oportunidades de promover nuevas modalidades de proyecto e iniciativas institucionales novedo-sas, como la cooperación de las ONG y el sector privado.

Conclusión 2: los datos e indicadores utiliza-dos en el MAR para evaluar los beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial reflejan la mejor información disponible en la actualidad, con algunas lagunas que deberían llenarse con el tiempo.

En general, los índices en materia de biodiversidad y cambio climático reflejan los mejores datos cien-tíficos disponibles en la actualidad. Sin embargo, en los círculos científicos se están desplegando esfuerzos por solucionar la falta de datos, lo que, de mediano a largo plazo, puede convertirse en mejoras para los índices del MAR. El estudio realizado según el método Delfos no respaldó la ampliación de los índices en materia de biodi-versidad a fin de incluir a la agrobiodiversidad, y planteó interrogantes acerca de si se puede abor-dar adecuadamente la seguridad de la biotecno-logía a través de índices. Los expertos de dicho estudio prestan su decidido apoyo a la inclusión de los ecosistemas e invertebrados marinos, para los cuales ahora hay nuevos datos disponibles que se suman a los existentes.

Las simulaciones para dar respuesta a la cuestión del equilibrio entre los recursos marinos y terres-tres demuestra que una ponderación de 50-50 con los datos actuales llevaría a cinco pequeños Esta-dos insulares en desarrollo a recibir asignaciones individuales, en tanto que siete países (incluidos un pequeño Estado insular en desarrollo y cuatro

países sin litoral) pasarían de recibir asignaciones individuales a recibir asignaciones por grupo de países. En el caso de los pequeños Estados insu-lares en desarrollo que actualmente reciben asig-naciones individuales, los montos aumentarían para cinco de ellos y disminuirían para dos. Como los países que reciben asignaciones individuales también cuentan con grandes recursos marinos, su IBM también aumenta cuando se modifican las ponderaciones. No está claro si los nuevos datos acerca de los recursos marinos de biodiversidad alterarían considerablemente este patrón. A los países que reciben asignaciones individuales les corresponde el 85% del puntaje total correspon-diente a recursos marinos (y el 89% del puntaje total correspondiente a recursos terrestres). No se ha logrado un consenso entre los expertos interna-cionales acerca de cuál sería la ponderación ideal entre recursos marinos y terrestres. Algunos han aducido que habida cuenta de la falta de una base científica para la ponderación, cualquier especie marina debería recibir el mismo trato que cual-quier especie terrestre, sin ponderación alguna.

La adaptación y la vulnerabilidad al cambio cli-mático no se reflejan actualmente en los índices relacionados con el cambio climático. Los exper-tos internacionales se mostraron totalmente de acuerdo en que se debe hacer más por lograr un equilibrio en el financiamiento para la adaptación y la mitigación en los países en desarrollo. Sin embargo, no se llegó a ningún acuerdo acerca de una norma o práctica óptima a nivel internacional que refleje la escala de la vulnerabilidad o las nece-sidades de adaptación.

También en relación con el índice de cambio cli-mático, en la fórmula del IBMCC se multiplica una variable de “necesidades” (emisiones) por una variable de “desempeño” (modificación de la dependencia del carbono). Ello torna dif ícil de interpretar la ponderación e implica que las

Page 54: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-16 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

asignaciones dependan de las emisiones. Se debe considerar el pleno reconocimiento del aumento del coeficiente energético. Los expertos del estu-dio realizado según el método Delfos afirmaron que ni la cantidad total de emisiones de un país ni su crecimiento económico constituyen variables aproximadas confiables para lograr la máxima reducción de emisiones por el monto de dinero gastado. Concluyen que el coeficiente energético es un buen indicador debido al gran potencial de reducir las emisiones mediante el aumento del rendimiento energético.

Conclusión 3: el MAR no brinda incentivos efica-ces para mejorar el desempeño.

Una premisa del MAR es que el buen desempeño debe reconocerse en forma de asignaciones más altas. Los países miembros deben poder obser-var que las mejores prácticas conducen a punta-jes más elevados en el contexto del MAR y esto a su vez debería redundar en un aumento de sus asignaciones iniciales. La relación entre los incen-tivos y la conducta es compleja, y depende de que el gobierno entienda el vínculo entre su desem-peño, su puntaje y las donaciones que recibe, así como también de la capacidad para influir en el logro de beneficios para el medio ambiente mun-dial y los puntajes de desempeño. El incentivo depende de la medida en que los países puedan aspirar en forma realista al aumento de sus asig-naciones. Ni los coordinadores ni las demás partes interesadas entienden claramente lo que significa el desempeño en el contexto del FMAM, ni cómo abordarlo.

La mayoría de las partes interesadas perciben el “desempeño” como la calidad de los proyectos del FMAM. Sin embargo, el desempeño de la cartera ambiental tiene una ponderación relativamente baja en los índices de desempeño (5% en el caso de los proyectos en marcha del FMAM), lo que significa que la mejora del desempeño de esta

cartera conducirá a un aumento muy limitado de la asignación correspondiente. La ponderación de las calificaciones en el caso de los proyectos cerrados es de otro 5%. En cuanto a los índices de desempeño general en materia de normas e ins-tituciones ambientales y de las condiciones pro-picias, su mejora no se verá incentivada con la promesa de un poco más de financiamiento del FMAM, habida cuenta de la proporción marginal del financiamiento que corresponde al FMAM en casi todos los países. A los 57 países con asigna-ciones individuales en materia de biodiversidad les corresponde en total el 41% de los puntajes del IDM, en tanto que a los 46 países que reciben asignaciones individuales en materia de cambio climático les corresponde un total del 35% de los puntajes del IDM, lo que es inferior a sus punta-jes en materia de beneficios en ambos casos. Las inversiones para mejorar las normas e institucio-nes ambientales superan con creces el nivel de aumento del financiamiento del FMAM en que podrían redundar dichas mejoras de desempeño. Aunque se asignara una ponderación más alta al IDM, a menos que el monto global disponible para el FMAM aumentara extraordinariamente, es poco probable que el perfeccionamiento de los índices de desempeño tenga alguna influencia. Habría que cambiar las ponderaciones en gran medida para que se notara una diferencia, lo que generaría volatilidad en las asignaciones.

En el diseño del MAR se especifica que el 75% del total de recursos acumulados se proporcionará a los países en forma de asignaciones individuales en función de una fórmula basada en la califica-ción del país, mientras que los países restantes recibirán asignaciones conjuntas por grupo de países, un parámetro exclusivo del FMAM entre los sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño. Debido a esta regla referida al 75%, la mayoría de las naciones que reciben asig-naciones por grupo de países permanecerán en

Page 55: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-17

el grupo aunque su desempeño mejore mucho. La disponibilidad de más fondos beneficiará a la categoría de países que reciben asignaciones indi-viduales y se encuentran entre el 75% más alto. Los países que reciben asignaciones por grupo de países cuya calificación preliminar sea de cerca del límite del 75% pueden pasar a recibir asignaciones individuales, como ocurrió con cinco países en la reasignación de recursos de 2008. Sin embargo, no hay incentivo para la mejora, porque no se ha comunicado a los países sus asignaciones y califi-cación preliminares.

Una inquietud general ha sido que el reconoci-miento del desempeño menoscabaría el reconoci-miento de las necesidades, especialmente en los países menos adelantados. Esto es cierto respecto de los índices de desempeño general, donde la escasa capacidad y el menor desarrollo institu-cional pueden redundar en un puntaje bajo. No es cierto en el caso del desempeño de la cartera ambiental, que estaría orientado hacia las nece-sidades específicas del país. Un proyecto corres-pondiente a un país menos adelantado podría ser considerablemente distinto de un proyecto en un país de ingreso mediano y, no obstante, lograr una calificación alta de los efectos directos. Con todo, la participación de la cartera ambiental en el índice de desempeño general es actualmente del 10%.

Conclusión 4: las directrices poco claras han restringido el acceso a los fondos del FMAM para las naciones que reciben asignaciones por grupo de países en el primer período del MAR.

En total, el financiamiento de alrededor de US$148 millones para cada asignación por grupo de países es el mismo que habría sido si todas las asigna-ciones hubieran continuado siendo individuales, incluido un pequeño complemento (de alrededor del 2% del total de fondos correspondientes a la pertinente esfera de actividad) de recursos para 88 países sin datos suficientes para computar una

asignación significativa. El sistema de asignacio-nes por grupo de países en principio podría brin-dar flexibilidad a los países y al FMAM al mismo tiempo que ofrece igualdad de recursos, pero no en la forma en que se está aplicando. Las pequeñas asignaciones pueden actuar por sí mismas como obstáculo al acceso de fondos.

La reseña de la situación de la cartera demuestra este resultado, que también surgió claramente en las consultas celebradas con las partes interesadas. Se observó una falta general de entendimiento por parte de los países con respecto a la manera de reaccionar al ser parte de un grupo, especialmente en el caso de los países con capacidad limitada. La utilización por parte de los 44 países menos adelantados fue de solo el 8% frente al 40% en el caso de las 106 naciones que no son países menos adelantados, pese al hecho de que sus asignacio-nes son reducidas. Por región, los 98 países que se encuentran fuera de África en promedio han utilizado el 39% de su asignación en materia de biodiversidad, frente a 52 países de África que en promedio han utilizado el 14%.

Los países que reciben asignación por grupo recibieron orientaciones incompletas y contra-dictorias acerca de la gestión de los proyectos en tramitación en virtud del MAR. En las teleconfe-rencias celebradas con la Secretaría del FMAM no recibieron aliento la mayoría de sus propuestas (se desalentó el 75% de las propuestas de los países que recibían asignaciones por grupo de países en materia de biodiversidad). Si bien también regis-traron un elevado nivel de “rechazos”, los países que reciben asignaciones individuales tenían más propuestas que seguir preparando. Los recursos para los grupos de países permiten al FMAM financiar proyectos de hasta US$1 millón para todos los países del grupo en materia de ambas esferas de actividad, pero no son suficientes para financiar el tope máximo para todos los países

Page 56: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-18 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

que reciben asignación por grupo. En la actuali-dad, los países se están esforzando por preparar pequeños proyectos por valor de US$1 millón, a la vez que cumplen con las amplias estrategias de las pertinentes esferas de actividad. Algunos paí-ses se vieron muy desalentados por los elevados costos de transacción vinculados con los proyec-tos de tamaño mediano de US$1 millón —a pesar de que podían recibir la donación sin un examen competitivo entre muchas propuestas—, a punto tal de no desarrollar ninguna propuesta. Se incen-tivó a los organismos del FMAM a asignar prio-ridad a los países con asignaciones individuales. El enfoque programático se desarrolló como res-puesta a los problemas que surgieron, pero llevó tiempo llevarlo hasta los países involucrados, y no hay pruebas de que dichos enfoques redundaran en un acceso mayor o más rápido en el caso de la mayoría de los países.

La Secretaría concedió a los países que reciben asignaciones por grupo un plazo hasta finales de diciembre de 2008 para presentar propuestas de hasta US$1 millón y a partir de entonces el acceso se obtendrá en condiciones de competencia. Los países que reciben asignaciones individuales no están sujetos a dicho plazo, aunque seis países que reciben asignaciones individuales en materia de biodiversidad y ocho que las reciben en mate-ria de cambio climático no han registrado acceso alguno a sus asignaciones. El conjunto de recursos asociados asciende a un total de US$126,5 millo-nes, monto semejante al de los fondos sin gastar correspondientes a los grupos de países.

Conclusión 5: la complejidad de las reglas de aplicación del MAR no alienta el uso flexible y dinámico de recursos, dado el financiamiento relativamente pequeño del FMAM-4.

El Consejo aprobó algunas reglas que disminuyen u obstaculizan la flexibilidad del MAR. La regla que dice que solo el 50% de las asignaciones puede

utilizarse en los primeros dos años (la regla del 50%) al parecer es innecesaria: ha obstaculizado la utilización de recursos y no es necesaria para mantener, dentro de los límites, el financiamiento en la primera mitad de un sistema de asignación de los recursos. En el caso de las asignaciones por grupos de países no hay necesidad de limi-tar las propuestas al 50% de un monto máximo hipotético, lo que disminuye la eficacia en fun-ción de los costos para estos países. El supuesto básico que subyace a la regla del 50% no se cum-ple: según dicho supuesto serviría de incentivo o sería consecuencia de cambios en el desempeño a mitad de período. Asimismo, la regla no es nece-saria para fines de liquidez, como lo demuestran las experiencias con otros sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño. La regla no es por lo tanto una norma internacional, ya que otros sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño tienen enfoques más dinámicos para limitar la concentración del desembolso de los fondos al comienzo del período contemplado y asegurar, sin embargo, revisiones periódicas de las asignaciones como incentivos. No tiene sen-tido para los niveles de financiamiento disponible, especialmente en el caso de las asignaciones por grupos de países.

Lo más importante es que no se han establecido reglas para reasignar los fondos en la última etapa crucial del MAR. Las reglas actuales pre-vén que el resto de los fondos pasará al FMAM-5, en lugar de utilizarse donde se encuentren bue-nas oportunidades de elevado desempeño y para generar beneficios para el medio ambiente mun-dial. La aplicación del MAR ha ocasionado retra-sos en la utilización de los recursos, y la demanda y la capacidad de entrega han sido desparejas. La reasignación no redundó en cambios sustanciales en las asignaciones, habida cuenta de la falta de algunos datos nuevos en materia de biodiversidad, la naturaleza de la fórmula del MAR y los limitados

Page 57: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-19

cambios del IDM. La reasignación para el FMAM consiste fundamentalmente en un nuevo cálculo de los índices, en lugar de una nueva asignación de recursos basada en una evaluación flexible de la demanda y oferta, como sucede en muchos otros sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño. Los fondos sin utilizar al final del FMAM-4 no beneficiarán al medio ambiente mundial.

Tal vez, más que los mismos índices, los demás factores del diseño influyen mucho en la configu-ración del patrón de recursos que los países pue-den obtener. Los indicadores se basan en estudios científicos y analíticos, pero los demás paráme-tros descritos del diseño se basan en decisiones de política estratégica. Los parámetros incluyen las ponderaciones que describen las relaciones cuan-titativas entre los indicadores; el límite máximo del 15% en materia de cambio climático; el 75% del total de recursos para la esfera de actividad (no los recursos de los países) que se destinan a los países que tienen la calificación acumulada más alta, el 10% reservado para recursos destinados a proyectos de alcance mundial y regional, y la regla del 50% en cuanto a la utilización de los recursos. Estos factores determinan cuánto reciben los paí-ses y cuáles de ellos reciben asignaciones indivi-duales o por grupo de países.

Conclusión 6: el diseño y las reglas del MAR son demasiado complejos para asociaciones que forman parte de una red como el FMAM, y las directrices y el apoyo ofrecidos no han logrado que el MAR sea transparente y accesible.

Se desplegaron intensos esfuerzos por comunicar el MAR a los coordinadores una vez aprobado el marco y en los últimos años se ha continuado con estos esfuerzos. El programa de reforma aprobado por el Consejo y la Directora Ejecutiva también exigió una intensa labor en materia de comunica-ción. Pese a los esfuerzos, el sistema no es trans-

parente. El diseño es demasiado complejo como para ser comunicado fácilmente y muchos com-ponentes que podrían haberse difundido no son de conocimiento público. Tal vez no sea realista que todos los involucrados alcancen un entendi-miento amplio y profundo de las cuestiones técni-cas de medición, y la mayoría de las partes intere-sadas tal vez no necesite saber los pormenores de cómo funciona la fórmula del MAR. Sin embargo, hace falta informar a los países asociados: 1) el monto máximo que el país podría obtener en forma de donación; 2) el desempeño del país en lo que respecta a los tres índices, en relación con otros países, y 3) las medidas que probablemente aumentarían el puntaje de desempeño del país en la ronda siguiente.

Las lagunas de conocimientos y las limitacio-nes de capacidad institucional de las oficinas de los coordinadores y de quienes proponen los proyectos, así como de las oficinas locales de los organismos, continúan afectando los proyectos en tramitación, especialmente en los países que reciben asignaciones por grupo de países, los países menos adelantados y de África al sur del Sahara. El Programa de apoyo a los coordinadores del FMAM-PNUD en los países y las páginas del sitio web del FMAM sobre el perfil de los países han sido útiles para brindar información básica a los coordinadores. Sin embargo, los mecanismos tradicionales de apoyo tal vez no basten para la clase de capacitación y apoyo constante que hacen falta para un sistema multidimensional con tantos agentes distintos y categorías de países del MAR. La exclusión de las deliberaciones de los proyectos en tramitación y los cambios en los sistemas de ejecución han obstaculizado la capacidad de los organismos para brindar aclaraciones y respaldo a los países. Asimismo, en muchas ocasiones los coordinadores del FMAM —agentes clave de la aplicación del MAR— no han recibido, ya sea de sus respectivos gobiernos o del FMAM, los com-

Page 58: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-20 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

ponentes e instrumentos esenciales para cumplir con su nueva función. En casi todos los casos, el FMAM es tan solo una pequeña parte de los pro-gramas de trabajo de estos agentes y por lo tanto no pueden respaldar, en la medida necesaria, la aplicación del MAR. Algunos coordinadores señalaron que la aplicación del MAR ha insumido demasiado de su escaso tiempo. Ahora se prevé que los coordinadores, especialmente en los paí-ses que reciben asignaciones individuales, desa-rrollen y administren sistemas de programación y selección de proyectos.

Los requisitos y reformas institucionales han tenido efectos que se extienden más allá de la fina-lidad pretendida de abordar anteriores problemas en el nuevo contexto del MAR. La interrupción de los proyectos en tramitación de 2007, la suspen-sión de los programas de trabajo debido a la falta de fondos en el período de transición y el requisito de la nueva aprobación de los conceptos y la pre-sentación de un nuevo formato de las FIP han con-tribuido a la desaceleración del crecimiento de los proyectos en tramitación. Todas las partes intere-sadas se mostraron muy agradecidas por la simpli-ficación del ciclo de los proyectos del FMAM; sin embargo, el nuevo ciclo parece presentar sus pro-pios obstáculos debido a la revisión y las modifica-ciones, y ampliaciones aparentemente constantes del formato de las FIP. La premura para gastar los fondos en un período de cuatro años torna tanto al ciclo como a los requisitos en materia de cofi-nanciamiento más dif íciles de abordar en muchos países. En el caso de los organismos, las necesida-des funcionales adicionales del FMAM, el cambio de la situación financiera y la falta de directrices claras han desalentado a los funcionarios a cola-borar con el FMAM.

El diseño del MAR no fue en sí mismo la causa de la utilización lenta de fondos que se observa actual-mente; sí lo fue la aplicación, junto con el lento ini-

cio del FMAM-4 y el programa de reforma. Para las asociaciones que forman parte de una red tan compleja como el FMAM, es indispensable con-tar con reglas claras y simples, pues en dichas asociaciones diversos agentes tienen niveles muy distintos de capacidad y están ubicados en todo el mundo. En la etapa inicial, las cuestiones de diseño, reglas, asignaciones y la manera de funcio-nar no pueden distinguirse fácilmente y ello ha lle-vado a la confusión. La ambigüedad e incongruen-cias ocasionales en materia de directrices también han demorado la utilización de recursos. Se agra-deció mucho la intención de las teleconferencias celebradas durante 2006-07 entre los países y la Secretaría del FMAM, pero los posibles efectos positivos de estas deliberaciones bilaterales acerca de las prioridades de proyectos en tramitación se vieron restringidos por la falta de claridad en las responsabilidades respecto de los puntos de acción; esto redundó en una falta de seguimiento sistemático por las partes involucradas, especial-mente en lo que se refiere a las naciones que reci-ben asignaciones por grupo de países y, en muchos casos, aumentó la confusión entre los países que eran partes interesadas y los organismos.

También está insumiendo mucho esfuerzo poner en práctica el enfoque programático. La Secreta-ría del FMAM no cuenta con el personal necesa-rio para cumplir la función central requerida en el complicado sistema, dada la ejecución simultánea del MAR y las reformas en marcha del FMAM.

Conclusión 7: el MAR ha intensificado la identi-ficación con los proyectos de los países que reci-ben asignaciones individuales y ha tenido un efecto neutro o pernicioso en la identificación con los proyectos de las naciones que reciben una asignación por grupo de países.

Para varios países grandes que reciben asignacio-nes individuales, como India y Rusia, la previsibili-dad de un monto importante ha galvanizado a los

Page 59: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-21

coordinadores y atraído el interés político, además de haber promovido más coherencia en la planifi-cación de la cartera del país. Otros países que han hecho históricamente un gran uso de los recursos continuaron sus enfoques vigentes en cuanto al crecimiento de los proyectos en tramitación. En general se ha observado un aumento de la crea-ción de comités y de las consultas informales y formales; las consultas nacionales han pasado de centrarse en el nivel de los proyectos a prestar más atención a las carteras como un todo. Esta tenden-cia ha centrado la atención en los coordinadores del FMAM, en lugar de los proponentes de los proyectos que suelen encontrarse en los ministe-rios sectoriales o los organismos del FMAM. La aplicación del MAR también al parecer ha poten-ciado a los coordinadores en sus negociaciones con los organismos del FMAM.

El concepto de identificación de los países con los proyectos contiene ciertas tensiones intrínse-cas. Las consultas extensas llevan mucho tiempo y en algunos casos pueden vincularse a la utiliza-ción lenta de los recursos. Y, aunque la identifi-cación de los países con los proyectos es esencial para la planificación y entrega de los proyectos del FMAM, las prioridades nacionales en materia de medio ambiente pueden no coincidir con las de la Secretaría y los organismos del FMAM. La expe-riencia recogida con las negociaciones relativas a los proyectos en tramitación en virtud del MAR ha revelado con más firmeza los conflictos inhe-rentes entre los criterios relativos a los beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial y las necesida-des de sostenibilidad específicas de cada país. En las consultas nacionales se identificó una amplia variedad de prioridades, y los rechazos de ideas y propuestas posteriores tuvieron para el FMAM un efecto fuertemente negativo en la participación, y algunas veces colocaron a los coordinadores en una situación dif ícil. Esta circunstancia fue en contra del objetivo básico del MAR de brindar un

marco para que los países programen sus recursos de acuerdo con sus prioridades nacionales.

Mientras que el 63% de los encuestados está de acuerdo en que el MAR puede fortalecer el papel que cabe a los países en la planificación de la car-tera, muchas de las naciones, sino todas, que reci-ben asignaciones por grupo de países creen que no se ha concretado su potenciación. Hay desen-canto con las reducidas asignaciones que no pue-den programarse de manera realista, con el cam-bio de reglas que son dif íciles de entender y con las expectativas de niveles previsibles de fondos a los que no se puede acceder. En muchos países, la rotación frecuente de los coordinadores torna dif ícil mantener un sentido de identificación con los proyectos y de conocimiento acerca del MAR.

Asimismo, en la práctica, la “identificación de los países con los proyectos” puede —o no, según la situación particular de cada país— implicar la participación y consulta con un grupo amplia-mente representativo de partes interesadas a nivel nacional y local. Si bien hay algunos ejemplos excelentes de cooperación de ONG y la sociedad civil en el contexto del MAR, como en Honduras, Madagascar y Uganda. En la mayoría de los países la participación de la comunidad de ONG no ha aumentado, y el sector privado se ve excluido en gran medida de las propuestas de proyecto y las consultas dirigidas por los gobiernos acerca de la cartera del FMAM.

Conclusión 8: las exclusiones no han funcio-nado bien y tal vez hayan menoscabado la efi-cacia del FMAM para producir beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial y regional.

Se ha producido una importante disminución de los recursos disponibles para proyectos de alcance mundial y regional, de las proporciones históricas del 23% de recursos para la esfera de biodiver-sidad y del 20% para las de cambio climático al

Page 60: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-22 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

10% en virtud del MAR, que están excluidos de la fórmula, de los cuales el 5% (US$50 millones) se reserva para proyectos de alcance mundial y regional por esfera de actividad del MAR. Pese a la disminución, el uso de recursos para proyectos de alcance mundial y regional es de tan solo el 16% de los fondos para biodiversidad, pero es del 52% para cambio climático. Si bien los países recono-cen la importancia de las cuestiones ambientales transfronterizas, hay renuencia general a ceder las asignaciones por países para esos fines debido a restricciones culturales y regionales, la autoría nacional y la experiencia recogida en materia de dichos proyectos.

El “conjunto claro de normas […] para [su] uso en el contexto de las estrategias revisadas rela-tivas a las esferas de actividad” que se prometió al Consejo en junio de 2007 no se ha concretado (FMAM 2007f). La tendencia actual, en la cual la Secretaría asigna específicamente fondos para distintos fines, es el uso de recursos para proyec-tos de alcance mundial y regional a fin de adicio-nar o complementar las FIP correspondientes a las asignaciones individuales o por grupo de países en el contexto de los enfoques programáticos. No se ha dejado en claro a los países el propósito básico del FMAM —utilizar el 5% para respaldar algunos esfuerzos de coordinación o formular enfoques programáticos— lo que desdibuja los límites de lo que resulta más beneficioso entre las actividades de alcance mundial, regional o nacional. También las esferas de actividad se ven considerablemente “gravadas” a fin de contribuir al financiamiento de las actividades institucionales y de alcance mundial.

La finalidad de la exclusión para proyectos de alcance mundial y regional era respaldar proyec-tos de alcance mundial que no estuvieran finan-ciados por los países, así como proyectos multi-nacionales eficaces en función de los costos que

reportaran beneficios más allá de las fronteras de cada país. La falta de transparencia y participación en la administración de las exclusiones ha condu-cido a un sentido de confusión entre las partes interesadas de los países y organismos, y ha plan-teado dudas acerca de la viabilidad del logro de los objetivos.

La disminución de fondos para proyectos de alcance mundial y regional ha afectado a organis-mos como el PNUMA, cuyo apoyo predominó fundamentalmente en los proyectos de alcance mundial y regional (el 85% de los fondos del PNUMA para la biodiversidad y el 81% de los des-tinados al cambio climático). También ha afectado a los países que antes recibían dicho apoyo y a las prioridades específicas de las esferas de actividad. Los expertos internacionales están de acuerdo en que la seguridad de la biotecnología no está bien contemplada en los índices, ni en las asignaciones a los países y tal vez podría tratarse también como una excepción.

Para el programa de pequeñas donaciones (PPD), la introducción del MAR parece haber contri-buido a una deficiencia en el monto acordado por el FMAM-4. Del máximo de US$200 millones, se reservaron 80 millones de los recursos del MAR para proyectos de alcance mundial y el PPD tam-bién podría obtener contribuciones de las asig-naciones por países en virtud del MAR. Ambas contribuciones del MAR han resultado deficien-tes. Las decisiones del Comité Directivo del PPD impusieron un límite máximo a las contribucio-nes del MAR en el caso de por lo menos 29 países que querían proporcionar más fondos al PPD, de los 74 países que cuentan con asignaciones indi-viduales en virtud del MAR y del PPD. Durante el primer año de la cuarta etapa operativa del PPD, los países participantes aportaron un total de unos US$18 millones de sus asignaciones en virtud del MAR. La previsibilidad del financiamiento se ha

Page 61: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-23

visto reducida en el caso del PPD y la influencia de los gobiernos receptores ha aumentado con-comitantemente. En los países que hacen uso de las asignaciones en virtud del MAR para el PPD, resulta imposible cumplir con la estrategia acor-dada de diversificar la cartera del PPD, puesto que los fondos solo pueden usarse para donacio-nes destinadas a abordar el cambio climático y la biodiversidad.

Para acceder a fondos del MAR para los países de entre US$300.000 y US$400.000, el PPD debe proporcionar una estrategia para el uso de estos fondos, aunque ya exista una estrategia del PPD para el país y los países con asignaciones indivi-duales grandes en virtud del MAR no estén suje-tos a dichos requisitos. La eficacia en función de los costos se reduce por el nivel de negociaciones necesarias, la mayor carga de trabajo, la contabi-lización independiente, los cambios de la cartera, requisitos adicionales y oportunidades perdidas para la comunidad de ONG y la sociedad civil.

1.3 RecomendacionesLa introducción del MAR puede considerarse parte de un movimiento mundial hacia la armo-nización y la eficacia de la ayuda. Muchas insti-tuciones financieras internacionales introdujeron sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño al mismo tiempo que el FMAM, aun-que hay quienes alegarán que el FMAM no es una institución financiera internacional común y el sis-tema de las Naciones Unidas en general ha intro-ducido sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en las necesidades. Varios de los problemas de la ejecución surgen del hecho de que el FMAM no es un banco de desarrollo, sino una alianza compleja a favor del medio ambiente mundial.

Las recomendaciones que siguen se vinculan tanto con la acción inmediata y de corto plazo para mejorar la aplicación del MAR durante el resto

del período del FMAM-4 como con las medidas a mediano plazo de refuerzo del FMAM-5 y tal vez en adelante.

Recomendación 1: se debe permitir la reasigna-ción de los fondos sin utilizar en el último año del FMAM-4.

Las reglas actuales prevén que los fondos restan-tes se trasladarán al FMAM-5. Naturalmente, los problemas relativos al uso de los recursos con que topan en la actualidad muchos países no se pre-vieron en el diseño del MAR. Este es el momento adecuado para aplicar dichas reglas. El problema se agrava por la nueva definición de la utilización de los recursos. Aunque la FIP no constituye una obligación legal, los fondos se reservan en calidad de compromiso. Es posible acelerar las aprobacio-nes mientras se mantiene una gestión conserva-dora de riesgos. Teniendo en cuenta lo ocurrido con el FMAM-3, cuando el último programa de trabajo era tan grande que ocasionó problemas de absorción en el sistema, es importante asegurar que los países puedan utilizar los fondos dentro de los límites del actual período de reposición.

Es posible que un elevado nivel de financiamiento permanezca sin utilizar al finalizar el FMAM-4. El FMAM debe determinar si los países tienen planificado utilizar la asignación y después debe-ría permitírsele reasignar los posibles fondos sin utilizar a países que cuentan con una cartera de propuestas listas para su financiamiento. Otros sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño cuentan con reglas al efecto y estas reglas pueden adaptarse a circunstancias especí-ficas del último año del MAR. Hay tres posibili-dades: 1) reasignaciones iterativas de fondos para todo el conjunto de países, distinguiendo la falta de demanda, como lo hace el FIDA; 2) reasigna-ciones de un país a otro por pares atendiendo las particularidades de cada caso, método que sigue la Asociación Internacional de Fomento pero solo

Page 62: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-24 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

de los países de peor desempeño a los de mejor desempeño, o 3) cobertura de las necesidades de financiamiento para las exclusiones y los progra-mas institucionales.

Recomendación 2: la última etapa del FMAM-4, incluida la reasignación de fondos, debe ejecu-tarse en condiciones de pleno acceso público a la información, transparencia, participación y claridad en cuanto a las responsabilidades.

Con la puesta en marcha del MAR, la función de la Secretaría ha cambiado, pero no hay un mandato claro que describa su función y responsabilidades nuevas. Habida cuenta de la reestructuración y la existencia de nuevos equipos, los países no están seguros de a quién deben acudir, ni siquiera, si la Secretaría o un organismo deben dar una res-puesta. El nuevo sistema de información para la administración del FMAM aún no está en pleno funcionamiento y los sistemas actuales no bastan para dar a conocer a los países el estado de las pro-puestas. Los organismos junto con la Secretaría deberían establecer rutinas y responsabilidades para informar a los países acerca de las ideas y pro-puestas pendientes. Los informes institucionales deberían ser más explícitos en cuanto a las fuentes y disponibilidad de fondos. La planificación y el uso de los fondos relativos a las exclusiones para proyectos de alcance mundial y regional deben ser transparentes para los países y organismos, espe-cialmente cuando están involucrados enfoques programáticos.

Los contactos bilaterales entre la Secretaría y los países tal vez sean indispensables para aclarar las propuestas que reúnen los requisitos exigidos, lo que al parecer ha sido un obstáculo clave, pero con-tinuarán dando lugar a comunicaciones equívocas a menos que en ellos participen los organismos que preparan las FIP y la documentación de los pro-yectos. Los Grupos de estudio sobre las esferas de actividad y las reuniones de los coordinadores eje-

cutivos, así como el disuelto Grupo de trabajo del MAR, servirían de mecanismos útiles para acordar directrices y estrategias operacionales eficaces.

Una mayor comunicación tal vez habría evitado o atenuado algunos de los problemas que se regis-traron. No debe subestimarse la necesidad de capacitación y apoyo constante. Tal vez no basten los mecanismos tradicionales de apoyo. Debe con-siderarse el aumento de los fondos de respaldo a los coordinadores, pero esto no bastará para ayu-dar a los gobiernos a preparar rápidamente una cartera. Sería útil contar con una “línea directa del MAR”, medios de capacitación por vía electrónica y reuniones e intercambios más eficaces de grupos de países. Se puede hacer más por mantener infor-madas por vía electrónica a las partes interesadas.

Recomendación 3: se deben simplificar las reglas relativas a la ejecución.

En la transición hacia un nuevo sistema de asigna-ción de recursos como el MAR, se deben desple-gar intensos esfuerzos por mantener la cartera de proyectos en preparación y el impulso de la ejecu-ción. La demora en la identificación y ejecución de los proyectos puede redundar en grandes costos de oportunidad. La composición de la cartera de proyectos en preparación, en cuanto a tamaño y enfoque de los proyectos, debe seguirse y admi-nistrarse a fin de asegurar que el nuevo sistema no cree obstáculos imprevistos.

La moratoria en lo que hace a los requisitos adi-cionales para la identificación y formulación de los proyectos para el resto del FMAM-4 debería promover una estabilidad que permitiera a los países y organismos hacer programaciones. Está más que justificada la mayor simplificación de los requisitos relativos a los proyectos de tamaño mediano, habida cuenta del nivel de asignaciones y el reducido riesgo financiero pero elevado costo de transacción.

Page 63: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-25

Más concretamente, se debe incentivar a los orga-nismos y países a que formulen propuestas. Per-mitir a los países más libertad para reflejar sus prioridades nacionales y elegir el organismo de ejecución reduciría las demoras y fortalecería la identificación con los proyectos, sin riesgos inde-bidos en materia de calidad. Las naciones que reciben asignaciones por grupo de países no debe-rían estar sujetas a requisitos iguales o más estric-tos que los aplicados a los países grandes de más capacidad que reciben asignaciones individuales.

El uso de enfoques programáticos es alentador pero debe desarrollarse más. Si bien es demasiado pronto para evaluar los resultados, ya es evidente que los principios clave de los enfoques programá-ticos deben ser objeto de una mayor vigilancia. Se puede mejorar la identificación de los países con los proyectos, la transparencia, la participación y la función de agente catalizador y el efecto movili-zador de las actividades del FMAM; garantizar los procesos abiertos y transparentes de representa-ción de varias partes interesadas; el aumento de la eficacia en función de los costos y la reducción de los costos de transacción, así como los incentivos para que los organismos respalden los enfoques programáticos. Asimismo, es vital seguir haciendo un seguimiento estricto y prestar mucha atención con respecto a la preparación de las FIP de los países. Hace falta claridad en las negociaciones relativas a la composición del financiamiento y se han solicitado directrices relativas a cuestiones operativas.

Deben tomarse en consideración la racionaliza-ción y conciliación general de los requisitos del MAR con el PPD. Podrían mitigarse algunos de los efectos de las restricciones impuestas al PPD como consecuencia de la aplicación del MAR. El aumento de los límites máximos de gastos de los programas correspondientes a países como Fili-pinas, India y México, que tienen gran capacidad

para absorber recursos del FMAM, a través de intervenciones de pequeña escala ayudaría a que estos programas generen beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial de manera eficaz en función de los costos. También se recomienda que los pro-gramas del PPD para los países que reciben úni-camente fondos del MAR solo puedan acceder a un nivel relativamente limitado de apoyo de los fondos básicos del PPD. De esa manera se podrían mitigar los desequilibrios actuales de la cartera de proyectos de estos programas para los países.

Recomendación 4: Deben comenzar a adop-tarse ya medidas para mejorar el diseño y los índices del MAR para el FMAM-5.

Las recomendaciones precedentes servirían de apoyo a las mejoras inmediatas en la ejecución. Los problemas relacionados con el FMAM-5 son más sistémicos y no pueden remediarse tan fácilmente. Habida cuenta de lo novedoso de un sistema de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño para una alianza que tiene un man-dato relativo al medio ambiente mundial, algunos aspectos del MAR no fueron puestos a prueba y ahora se justifica su revisión. Se debe empezar ya la labor relativa al MAR con relación al inicio del FMAM-5 en 2010. La experiencia inicial revela que la puesta en marcha, la planificación y la dis-ponibilidad de recursos revisten una importancia vital.

Como se desprende de lo expuesto, lo que podría haber sido un sistema relativamente sencillo de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño se ha convertido en un marco complejo. Cada país miembro tiene un monto máximo que puede pedir, pero ningún monto está garantizado; por el contrario, los países y organismos deben presen-tar propuestas de proyectos de buena calidad para acceder a dichos fondos. Siempre habrá comple-jidades inevitables en un sistema de asignaciones inciertas, pero no es viable un sistema de derechos

Page 64: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-26 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

adquiridos. Por otra parte, el FMAM debe asegu-rar el acceso a los recursos asignados en virtud del MAR. Para ello es preciso mejorar tanto el diseño como la ejecución del FMAM-5 en lo que respecta a las siguientes esferas:

Mejora de los índices de beneficios del FMAM y z

Aumento de la ponderación del desempeño de z

la cartera de proyectos ambientales

Aumento de la previsibilidad y los beneficios en z

materia de costos de la asignación por grupo de países o el abandono de este tipo de asignación

Reconocimiento de los problemas transfronte- z

rizos en materia de medio ambiente mundial

Reconsideración de los montos máximos y z

mínimos, y de la regla del 50%

Extensión de la aplicación del MAR a una asig- z

nación integrada para todas las esferas de acti-vidad

1.4 Cuestiones para el futuroLas recomendaciones que se presentan más ade-lante acerca de las cuestiones por abordarse exi-gen la consulta con todas las partes interesadas del FMAM. Estas cuestiones conllevan aspectos del diseño (índices, ponderaciones, exclusiones, nuevo diseño de las asignaciones por grupo de países y la extensión de la aplicación), aunque también dependen de buenas estrategias de eje-cución (transparencia, información, planifica-ción y simplificación). Al avanzar en la mejora del MAR actual deben considerarse conjuntamente los aspectos relativos al diseño y la ejecución. Naturalmente que existe el riesgo de que nuevas modificaciones tornen al sistema más complejo; se debe tener cuidado de garantizar la simplicidad y planificar estratégicamente para su ejecución. En el cuarto estudio acerca del desempeño gene-ral se continuarán recogiendo los datos que sur-

jan durante el último período del FMAM-4, y se seguirán haciendo más aportes respecto de estas cuestiones para el futuro.

los índices de beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial y sus ponderaciones deben mejorarse para el FMAM-5El MAR ha utilizado con eficiencia los datos que ya están disponibles públicamente y debe continuar haciéndolo en la medida de lo posible. La ulterior labor de diseño debe ser de carácter participativo, con mecanismos que involucren a los países, los organismos, las ONG y el Grupo Asesor Cientí-fico y Tecnológico del FMAM.

Si bien el índice en materia de biodiversidad es adecuado en la actualidad con respecto a los ries-gos y la representación, toda decisión acerca de las respectivas ponderaciones es una cuestión nor-mativa que debe decidir el FMAM, con el asesora-miento de expertos en biodiversidad. Puede agre-garse información sobre distintas especies como los invertebrados marinos. Un mejor equilibrio entre las especies marinas y terrestres indicaría la importancia que se atribuye a los distintos ecosis-temas, aunque las asignaciones efectivas puedan en definitiva no ser muy diferentes.

Los expertos están de acuerdo, al igual que muchas partes interesadas, en encauzar la mayor parte del financiamiento a fines de adaptación a los países más vulnerables, si la mayor parte de los fondos en el marco del IBMCC se destinan a la mitigación en países con más emisiones. Los servicios inde-pendientes de financiamiento tal vez no basten para abordar las necesidades en materia de adap-tación; además las partes interesadas de los países encuentran cada vez más dif ícil poder seguir los diferentes caminos de acceso a distintos fondos. Esto va más allá del posible contenido de datos de los índices, hasta una discusión de la estrategia relativa a la adaptación en la cartera de proyectos

Page 65: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-27

sobre cambio climático. Si se prevé cubrir estas necesidades con un fondo independiente para la adaptación, no será necesario incluir la adapta-ción en un índice relativo al financiamiento de la mitigación.

Los expertos del estudio realizado sobre el cambio climático según el método Delfos quisieran ver una mejora en los índices, con más representa-ción de los gases y fuentes de emisiones de gases de efecto invernadero —incluidos los cambios registrados en la agricultura y el uso de las tierras; la deforestación y la degradación de los bosques; la quema de gases, y las emisiones industriales distintas del dióxido de carbono— pero admiten que dichas emisiones son dif íciles de determinar con precisión. Se podrían utilizar datos de comu-nicaciones nacionales para verificar la exactitud de los conjuntos de datos a nivel mundial, pero esto debería estudiarse en más detalle. Se debe-ría lograr más armonización y transparencia en el índice en materia de cambio climático, agregando y utilizando la ponderación relativa a las emisio-nes y el coeficiente energético, o adicionando una nueva variable para asignar la debida ponderación a la mejora del IBM de un periodo a otro.

Actualmente no hay vinculación entre el contenido de los índices que permiten hacer las asignacio-nes y la manera en que estas asignaciones pueden utilizarse. Por ejemplo, en materia de biodiversi-dad, el FMAM no financia la conservación de las especies, sino que las asignaciones se basan en las especies. El FMAM debería considerar la oportu-nidad de celebrar diálogos sobre políticas con los países y de mejorar el enfoque que los datos pue-den brindar. Si se incluyen nuevos aspectos en los índices del MAR —como la adaptación, la vulne-rabilidad y las fuentes marinas—, ellos deberían ir acompañados de estrategias relativas a las esferas de actividad a fin de que puedan gastarse recursos en estas prioridades.

se debe aumentar la ponderación relativa del desempeño de la cartera de proyectos ambientales de los países en el FMAM-5, a fin de asegurar que se recompense el desempeñoEl MAR no está sirviendo como estructura rea-lista de incentivos para el buen desempeño o la generación de beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial. El incentivo depende de cuánto un país puede aspirar a mejorar en forma realista su asig-nación, así como del entendimiento del gobierno acerca del vínculo que existe entre su desempeño, su puntaje y las donaciones que recibe. Lo más importante es que depende de la capacidad de los involucrados para mejorar dicho desempeño. Los coordinadores del FMAM, que están más involu-crados en la cartera del FMAM, por lo general no ejercen influencia directa en los aspectos medidos por los índices, y los fondos no constituyen sufi-ciente incentivo para otras autoridades.

El mero aumento de la ponderación exponencial del índice de desempeño, en comparación con el índice de beneficios, no brindará por sí misma suficientes incentivos en la esfera del medio ambiente que está dentro de la órbita de influencia del FMAM. Podría ser más relevante recompensar las mejoras más recientes de los resultados de los proyectos del FMAM, asignando una ponderación más alta del indicador de desempeño de la cartera. Existen inevitablemente algunas soluciones de compromiso entre la estabilidad (mediante el pro-medio a lo largo de un periodo prolongado, como sucede actualmente) y la capacidad de reacción y precisión (haciendo hincapié en el desempeño reciente). La pertinencia del índice también debe-ría aumentar al agregársele las calificaciones de las evaluaciones finales de los proyectos del FMAM. Cuando se diseñó el MAR, la Oficina de Evalua-ción del FMAM había examinado un número relativamente bajo de evaluaciones definitivas. Se prevé que al inicio del FMAM-5 se habrán alcan-

Page 66: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-28 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

zado un número confiable de evaluaciones y una cobertura geográfica aceptable. Se dará cuenta de esto más adelante en el cuarto estudio sobre los resultados globales (ERG4).

El aumento de la importancia relativa de la car-tera de proyectos ambientales permitirá un mejor reconocimiento de los logros y los resultados en los países menos adelantados y los pequeños Esta-dos insulares en desarrollo, que pueden lograr calificaciones altas en cuanto a los efectos directos para sus carteras aunque su puntaje sea relativa-mente más bajo en cuanto al desempeño institu-cional general. La práctica internacional actual coloca a la proporción de la cartera entre el 5% y el 30%. Con el 10%, el MAR se encuentra en la franja más baja de la gama; la proporción podría aumen-tarse al 30%.

Debe aumentarse la previsibilidad y los beneficios en materia de costos de la asignación por grupo de países, o debe abandonarse este tipo de asignaciónDeben crearse expectativas realistas y una clara visión respecto de las asignaciones por grupo de países para que estas puedan continuar. Se obser-van dos percepciones contradictorias, a saber: 1) las asignaciones por grupo de países representan un nivel “mínimo” de recursos iguales para los paí-ses, de modo que los países que tienen más nece-sidades tendrían garantizado algún apoyo, y 2) no todos los países tendrían normalmente acceso a los fondos durante cualquier etapa, de modo que es aceptable que la utilización de recursos sea baja. La primera visión se puso de relieve al intro-ducirse el MAR, y ha creado grandes expectativas; sin embargo, la ejecución al parecer se ha centrado en la segunda. Es alentador el impulso actual para brindar acceso a las naciones que reciben asigna-ciones por grupo de países a través de enfoques programáticos, aunque tal vez en esta etapa no se incluyan todas las medidas permanentes necesa-

rias para países con problemas de capacidad para el FMAM-5. En el ERG4 se seguirá estudiando la evolución de los enfoques programáticos.

Muchas de las naciones que reciben asignacio-nes por grupo de países se beneficiaron antes del respaldo regional y de los proyectos generales de actividades de apoyo, los que han disminuido en el contexto del MAR. Los países tienen en cam-bio la oportunidad de obtener recursos para paí-ses de un fondo mancomunado. Sus propuestas para proyectos nacionales se han desalentado en gran medida. La Secretaría y los organismos están ahora desplegando grandes esfuerzos tra-tando de convencer a los países de que vuelvan a asignar los fondos en un programa de enfo-que programático regional, de modo que ellos a su vez puedan recibir FIP por país. Esta manera indirecta de programación de recursos no repre-senta un uso eficaz en función de los costos de los recursos escasos del FMAM y es muy frustrante para los países. Además, los países más pequeños encaran costos más elevados de transacción para acceder a los fondos del FMAM que los benefi-ciarios más grandes del FMAM. Muchos países y organismos juzgan que las pequeñas asignaciones no valen la pena y presentan dificultades para con-cretar los proyectos.

Mientras que las “dificultades” de la transición y las orientaciones ambiguas tal vez sean la fuente de algunos de los problemas con los cuales se han topado estos países, en el examen de mitad de período se concluye que estos son más sistémicos y se relacionan con restricciones de la capacidad, falta de previsibilidad y transparencia y las estra-tegias relativas a las esferas de actividad. En todas las hipótesis de las asignaciones por grupo de paí-ses, las mejoras requerirían una orientación clara y coherente del FMAM con la cooperación de los organismos, mejores comunicaciones acerca del estado de las propuestas y la programación

Page 67: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-29

de recursos, la simplificación de los requisitos correspondientes a las estrategias relativas a las esferas de actividad en el caso de las pequeñas asignaciones, y que se permitan más propuestas impulsadas por los países, la simplificación de los procedimientos y la racionalización de la burocra-cia en el caso de los proyectos pequeños y los de tamaño mediano.

Son posibles dos opciones para modificar las asig-naciones por grupo de países, según el equilibrio que se pretenda lograr entre la flexibilidad, la sim-plicidad y la previsibilidad:

Opción 1: z Abandonar las asignaciones por grupo de países, de modo que todos los países recibirían asignaciones individuales. Se podría proporcionar una asignación mínima de US$1 millón para los que tuvieran asignaciones pre-liminares por debajo de ese monto; los demás países podrían recibir su asignación prelimi-nar.

Opción 2. z El fondo mancomunado del grupo podría dividirse por regiones, a fin de que pudieran aprovecharse al máximo las oportu-nidades de colaboración regional y los enfoques programáticos.

La regla del 75% del diseño del MAR tiene una fuerte influencia en la configuración del patrón de recursos que los países pueden obtener, la canti-dad que perciben, y qué naciones reciben asigna-ciones individuales o por grupo de países. La regla del 75% de las asignaciones indicativas a los países de calificación más alta no es una práctica acep-tada internacionalmente de asignación de recur-sos basada en el desempeño. Una de las ventajas de abandonar el sistema de asignaciones por grupo de países sería que la regla del 75% podría dejar de aplicarse, lo que permitiría que más países se beneficiaran de asignaciones previsibles, en tanto que se aseguraría la aplicación de la fórmula.

Debe haber un mayor reconocimiento de los problemas transfronterizos en materia de medio ambiente mundial, los cuales deben abordarse con un sistema revisado de asignación de recursos en el FMAM-5Las actividades de alcance mundial y regional se consideran parte del mandato básico del FMAM, y deberían proporcionarse recursos adicionales para ellas. La motivación para el financiamiento de proyectos de alcance mundial y regional podría estimularse mediante una “prima transfronteriza” de, por ejemplo, el 15%, aplicable a las asignaciones para los países y los proyectos pertinentes. Podría replantearse la proporción de proyectos de alcance mundial y regional, pero con una clara visión de lo que debería facilitarse con las exclusiones para poder mejorar la generación de beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial y regional. Si se centrara exclusivamente en cuestiones mundiales, bastaría una pequeña asignación; pero no sería suficiente si se utilizara para incentivos de los proyectos de alcance regional, los enfoques programáticos y la flexibilidad y las iniciativas institucionales que no pueden asegurarse a través de la asignación por países

El PPD se encuentra ahora empleando mucho tiempo y esfuerzos en la movilización de recur-sos del FMAM, en lugar de (o además de) procu-rar financiamiento nuevo y adicional. Se debería asegurar al PPD un nivel razonable de financia-miento básico y permitírsele seguir las políticas de aumento de la atención que se presta a las esferas de actividad y la movilización de recursos.

se debe contemplar la reconsideración de los montos máximos y mínimos y de la regla del 50%Se podría replantear la reducción de los montos máximos que pueden asignársele a un país, al 5% de los fondos correspondientes a la esfera de acti-vidad de que se trate. Así, se aseguraría una dis-

Page 68: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-30 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

tribución más pareja de fondos, o de otro modo, más recursos para las exclusiones para proyectos de alcance mundial y regional. Las simulaciones revelan que el monto máximo del 10% no es eficaz para modificar los patrones actuales de asignación de recursos, en tanto que la reducción del límite máximo al 5% ejerce un efecto significativo.

La reducción de los montos máximos probable-mente haría que aumentara la equidad y la eficacia (eficiencia económica) del MAR, particularmente para el caso del cambio climático. Tal vez sería posible una reducción escalonada, reduciendo al 5% el monto máximo aplicable a la biodiversidad, y al 10% el monto máximo aplicable al cambio cli-mático en el FMAM-5, y al 5% en el FMAM-6.

En el presente, la aplicación de montos mínimos es superflua, como el monto mínimo de US$1 millón que se aplica a los países. Sin embargo, después se incluye los países y sus asignaciones de mon-tos mínimos en un fondo mancomunado para las asignaciones por grupo de países y, en consecuen-cia, los montos mínimos no son eficaces. La asig-nación de montos mínimos sería adecuada para asegurar un nivel mínimo de financiamiento de las obligaciones contempladas en los convenios y las convenciones. Para la mayoría de los países, el monto de US$1 millón sería suficiente para tal fin. Sin embargo, si los países quisieran utilizar los fondos del FMAM para generar beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial, el respaldo de las activi-dades de apoyo a través de asignaciones a los paí-ses tal vez no resulte un enfoque eficaz. Asimismo, el nivel “mínimo” de apoyo del FMAM que sería razonable para que los países promovieran bene-ficios para el medio ambiente mundial puede diferir de un país y un organismo a otro: algunos tal vez digan que lo práctico sería un monto de US$4 millones. Tal vez el FMAM busque anali-zar el nivel de los montos mínimos puesto que se ha determinado que el monto de US$1 millón es

reducido para generar amplios beneficios para el medio ambiente mundial.

La regla del 50% debería reemplazarse con enfo-ques transparentes y dinámicos a fin de limitar la concentración de desembolsos de los fondos al comienzo del período contemplado según sea necesario, mientras se mantiene el equilibrio entre la disponibilidad de fondos y el estímulo de la utilización de recursos. Se debería permitir a la Secretaría, sobre la base del asesoramiento del Depositario del FMAM, fijar límites razona-bles y transparentes en materia del gasto al ini-cio del ciclo, en consulta con los organismos. En todo caso, la práctica de la reasignación de recur-sos serviría para el reconocimiento de los logros, como sucede en otros sistemas de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño.

la introducción del MAR en todas las esferas de actividad del FMAM-5 requiere una asignación integrada por país para todas las esferas de actividadDel total de organizaciones con un sistema de asignación de recursos basada en el desempeño, el FMAM es actualmente el donante que actúa en el mayor número de países con el monto más redu-cido de fondos, y el único donante con dos siste-mas complejos de asignación de recursos, uno en materia de biodiversidad y el otro en materia de cambio climático. Pasar a seis sistemas de asigna-ción de recursos en el FMAM-5 implicará que el sistema se convierta en imposible de administrar desde el punto de vista operacional, a menos que la reposición de los recursos del FMAM aumente mucho, al igual que el número de personal de la Secretaría. Por ejemplo, el Fondo Mundial de Lucha contra el SIDA, la Tuberculosis y el Palu-dismo cuyos desembolsos ascienden a la fecha a US$10.000 millones, tiene alrededor de 400 empleados en la sede. El FIDA, que funciona con un nivel de financiamiento similar al del FMAM,

Page 69: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Principales conclusiones y recomendaciones s-31

cuenta con 225 miembros de personal profesional en la sede, al igual que con algunos representantes en regiones y países. El FMAM, por otra parte, está constituido por una red de organismos que cuen-tan con conocimientos especializados, sistema de administración y oficinas fuera de la sede.

La exhortación a una acción más integrada se ha escuchado en todo el FMAM y en las convencio-nes mundiales. Por ejemplo, el vínculo entre la biodiversidad y el cambio climático se ha desta-cado en muchos artículos recientes. Las nuevas iniciativas que el Consejo, la Secretaría del FMAM y las convenciones quisieran adoptar también exi-gen una nueva perspectiva acerca de las esferas de actividad como las asignaciones para los paí-ses indicativas en lugar de restrictivas. Los países beneficiarios del FMAM son países miembros de los convenios y las convenciones y, por lo tanto, son los primeros responsables de asegurar que las apliquen.

Las nuevas iniciativas pueden comprender, por ejemplo, la participación del sector privado según se prevé en la estrategia para ese sector, la coope-ración con la comunidad de ONG, y/o la atención a temas específicos, como la transferencia de tec-nología. En lo que respecta a las asignaciones a los países, inevitablemente habrá algunas soluciones de compromiso entre las prioridades nacionales y los planes institucionales. Dichas cuestiones de políticas podrían abordarse a través de un sis-tema de asignación de recursos ya sea brindando reservas independientes y suficientes o creando mecanismos de incentivos para que los países y organismos participen y contribuyan a dichas iniciativas. Esto normalmente implicaría algunas modificaciones en las modalidades de los proyec-tos, e incentivos financieros.

Se presume que se calcularían asignaciones para cada esfera de actividad y luego se constituiría con ellas un fondo mancomunado para cada país. La

cuestión que debe resolverse es cuánta flexibilidad se brindaría para que un país preparara proyectos valiéndose del total de su fondo mancomunado de recursos, y en qué medida cada país debería restringirse a las subdivisiones de las esferas de actividad en el marco de su asignación. Como se mencionó antes respecto de las cuestiones trans-fronterizas, se debería prestar especial atención a las aguas internacionales y a la necesidad de esti-mular las actividades regionales. A nivel nacional, tal vez sea adecuado el gasto en las esferas de acti-vidad en una proporción aproximada a sus pun-tajes en virtud del MAR en las distintas esferas de actividad. Después sería esencial proporcionar a los países información oportuna y adecuada acerca de estos puntajes.

Es indispensable mantener la flexibilidad para lograr mayor eficacia en función de los costos. Lo acontecido hasta ahora ha demostrado la falta de conexión entre las prioridades propias de cada país y las prioridades estratégicas del FMAM al momento de preparar los proyectos para su tra-mitación, lo que a su vez ocasiona demoras, frus-tración y falta de acceso. No cabe que el FMAM espere proporcionar una cantidad determinada de fondos para aumentar la flexibilidad y la efica-cia en función de los costos, y que luego elimine la flexibilidad al decidir dónde y para qué fines deben gastarse esos fondos. Tampoco se logran las sinergias reuniendo simplemente los recursos de diferentes esferas de actividad en un fondo. Para lograr una mayor eficacia, el FMAM nece-sita una visión o estrategia acerca de la manera en que debe funcionar dicha constitución de fondos mancomunados dentro de cada esfera de activi-dad y entre ellas, así como a nivel de los países.

notaPara obtener una clasificación geográfica exhaus-1. tiva y razonable a los fines analíticos, en el examen

Page 70: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

s-32 examen de mitad de período del Marco de Asignación de Recursos

de mitad de período se utilizaron diferentes fuentes de clasificación, dado que aquellas uti-lizadas comúnmente no incluyen, de manera sistemática, todos los países admisibles por el FMAM. Por ejemplo, el FMAM utiliza solo cua-tro regiones para su clasificación en el proyecto, las cuales excluyen la designación regional del Banco Mundial de Oriente Medio y Norte de África, y la designación del PNUD de los Estados Árabes; no obstante, incluye varias categorías de clasificación para los países representados. El sistema de clasificación que se utiliza en el examen de mitad de período combina las seis regiones geográficas del Banco Mundial con las ocho clasificaciones para los países representa-dos en el FMAM:

LÁfrica al sur del Sahara, dividida en los países zrepresentados de África oriental y meridional, y de África occidental y centralDos regiones de Asia del Banco Mundial: Asia zoriental y el Pacífico, y Asia meridional, divididas en países representados de Asia y de los peque-ños Estados insulares en desarrollo del PacíficoEuropa y Asia central (llamadas Europa y la zComunidad de Estados Independientes)América Latina y el Caribe, divididas en los países zrepresentados de América Latina y del CaribeOriente Medio y Norte de África z

Véase el Anexo estadístico n.º 4, “Clasificación de países y las asignaciones del MAR”, cuadro 6.

Page 71: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

i

Foreword

In response to the policy recommendations of the third replenishment, the Council of the Global Environment Facility (GEF) agreed to implement a resource allocation framework (RAF) based on an index of a country’s potential to generate global environmental benefits and on an index of perfor-mance. The RAF is unique among performance-based allocation systems in assessing needs and potential within biodiversity and climate change. Given its innovative nature, the Council requested that the GEF Evaluation Office review the RAF in 2008, after two years of implementation.

This midterm review evaluates the degree to which resources have been allocated to countries in a transparent and cost-effective manner based on global environmental benefits and country per-formance. While it is too early to provide evidence on the impact of the RAF on environmental ben-efits, it emerged that the transition to a new way of providing GEF resources has been challenging.

Countries with individual allocations have gen-erally appreciated the improved predictability in GEF funds; while countries with a smaller, pooled allocation have experienced difficulties in access-ing GEF resources. Transaction costs related to the RAF and other reforms have been high across the GEF partnership, so the cost benefit has not been fully demonstrated in terms of value for the money. This reflects, at least in part, the GEF’s expectation of providing support to a large

number of countries with limited resources as it responds to its mandate of protecting the global environment.

In line with the recommendations of the midterm review made in November 2008, the Council has decided that unused funds will be reallocated in the last year of GEF-4, based on objective rules and a transparent and equitable procedure to be developed over the next months. The last phase of GEF-4, including reallocation of funds, will be implemented with full public disclosure, transpar-ency, participation, and clear responsibilities.

Looking toward the future, the Council also asked the GEF Secretariat, the GEF Agencies, the GEF Scientific and Technical Advisory Panel, and other stakeholders to present steps to improve the RAF’s design and indexes for the biodiversity and climate change focal areas for GEF-5, and to pres-ent scenarios for possible expansion of the RAF—if feasible—to all focal areas for GEF-5. The mid-term review points to a number of areas for such improvement, including discontinuation of the group allocation; recognition of transboundary global environmental problems; increased weight for portfolio performance in the GEF Performance Index; and reconsideration of the rules for alloca-tion ceilings, floors, and expenditure limitations.

The midterm review covered a more complex and ambitious scope than is customary for a midpoint

Page 72: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

ii Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

these papers and their in-depth information on the multiple aspects of RAF design and implementa-tion will help the GEF in continuing to improve its resource allocation framework in the future and in looking forward to the next programming period. The Evaluation Office will continue to address this important feature of GEF support in the context of the Fourth Overall Performance Study of the GEF.

Rob D. van den BergDirector, Evaluation Office

formative evaluation. It included a comparative review of the RAF with the performance-based allocation systems of other multilateral agencies; extensive statistical analysis, simulations, and data modeling; a portfolio review of all historical allo-cations and changes in the GEF-4 period; and a Delphi peer study of the RAF indicators, indexes, and design by three panels of independent experts on global biodiversity, climate change, and performance.

The review has produced several supporting tech-nical papers and statistical annexes, containing detailed findings and underlying data. These are available on the GEF Evaluation Office Web site (www.gefeo.org) and on CD-ROM. I trust that

Page 73: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

iii

Acknowledgments

This report was prepared under the overall lead-ership of the evaluation task manager, Siv Tokle, Senior Evaluation Officer in the GEF Evaluation Office, who provided coordination and oversight to all evaluation components and methodology, and drafted the report with contributions from the core team. Consultant Kenneth Watson’s extensive experience with performance-based allocation systems provided valuable insight and lessons for the RAF, and consultant James Frem-ming brought capacity development and evalua-tion expertise to the analysis of implementation issues and review methodology.

Within the GEF Evaluation Office, the analysis of allocations and indispensable statistical simula-tions were conducted by Yu-Kui Zhou, who also worked with Divya Nair to review the GEF port-folio and historical allocations. Shaista Ahmed provided analysis and support to the survey of

some 700 respondents and to the pipeline analy-sis, while the extensive documentation review was undertaken by Florentina Mulaj. Other Evaluation Office colleagues also supported the team, includ-ing Neeraj Negi, Evaluation Officer, who reviewed the effect of the RAF on the GEF Small Grants Programme.

The team is grateful for the detailed and frank feedback provided during the extensive consul-tations with all groups of stakeholders, especially the GEF focal points in five subregional work-shops, the GEF Secretariat, the 10 GEF Agencies, the biodiversity and climate change convention secretariats, the Scientific and Technical Advisory Panel, and nongovernmental organizations.

A draft of this document was presented to the GEF Council in November 2008. The Evaluation Office is fully responsible for the contents of the report.

Page 74: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

iv

Abbreviations

ADB Asian Development BankAfDB African Development BankBFI broad framework indicator CBD Convention on Biological DiversityCDB Caribbean Development BankCEO Chief Executive Officer CEPIA country environmental policy and

institutional assessmentCOP Conference of PartiesCPIA country policy and institutional

assessment FSP full-size project GBI GEF Benefits IndexGBIBIO GEF Benefits Index for Biodiversity GBIcc GEF Benefits Index for Climate Change GEF Global Environment FacilityGHG greenhouse gas GNI gross national incomeGNP gross national productGPI GEF Performance IndexGRE global and regional exclusionIBRD International Bank for Reconstruction

and DevelopmentICR implementation completion reportIDA International Development Association IDB Inter-American Development BankIFAD International Fund for Agricultural

Development

IFC International Finance CorporationLDC least developed country MSP medium-size projectNGO nongovernmental organizationODA official development assistanceOECD Organisation for Economic Co-operation

and DevelopmentOFP operational focal pointOPS4 Fourth Overall Performance StudyPBA performance-based allocation PDF project development facilityPIF project identification formPIR project implementation review POP persistent organic pollutantPPI portfolio performance indicatorRAF Resource Allocation FrameworkRBM results-based managementSDR special drawing rightsSGP Small Grants ProgrammeSIDS small island developing stateSTAP Scientific and Technical Advisory PanelUN United NationsUNDP United Nations Development

ProgrammeUNEP United Nations Environment

ProgrammeUNFCCC United Nations Framework Convention

on Climate Change

Page 75: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations

In response to the policy recommendations of the third replenishment (2003–06) of the Global Envi-ronment Facility (GEF), the GEF Council agreed to implement, for the GEF-4 replenishment (2006–10), a resource allocation framework (RAF) based on an index of a country’s potential to generate global environmental benefits in the biodiversity and climate change focal areas and an index of performance. (A summary of the decisions on the RAF can be found in Technical Paper #1, “Meth-odology and Context,” table 2.3.)

The policy recommendations for the fourth replenishment asked the GEF Secretariat to work with the Council to establish a system for allo-cating scarce GEF resources with “a view toward maximizing the impact of these resources on global environmental improvements and promot-ing sound environmental policies and practices worldwide” (GEF 2002f). It was expected that the RAF would provide a framework for coun-tries to program their resources in accordance with national priorities, provide countries with increased predictability in the financing avail-able from the GEF, and enhance transparency by specifying a well-defined and publicly disclosed method for allocating GEF resources.

According to the final approved document on the framework, the RAF is “… a system for allocat-ing resources to countries in a transparent and consistent manner based on global environmen-

tal priorities and country capacity, policies and practices relevant to successful implementation of GEF projects” (GEF 2005c). It is made up of three indexes:

GEF Benefits Index for Biodiversity (GBI z BIO)GEF Benefits Index for Climate Change (GBI z CC)GEF Performance Index (GPI) z

Under the RAF, the GEF has allocated $1 billion to 150 countries for biodiversity and $1 billion to 161 countries for climate change for the period 2006–10. Countries access these funds by propos-ing projects in line with GEF strategic priorities. The GEF Council asked the GEF Evaluation Office to review the RAF after two years of implementa-tion and examine the operational experience of the GEF and its partners with the RAF.

1.1 RAF Development and statusThe development and implementation of the RAF took place during a period marked by many other changes and reforms. These influenced RAF imple-mentation and design, and the RAF in turn affected the GEF partnership and shaped the implemen-tation of other reforms. Furthermore, the GEF-4 replenishment, although successful and an increase over GEF-3 in nominal terms, did not provide an increase in real available funding, even though the demands on the GEF and its number of strategic objectives and focal areas had grown over time.

Page 76: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

2 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Concurrently, the donor community and global conventions have paid increasing attention to the need for support and resource mobilization for the environment. Growing awareness of climate change and its effects has led to the establishment of new funds in parallel to the GEF Trust Fund. Enhanced effectiveness underpins the revised focal area strategies for GEF-4 (approved in October 2007), which tightened the scope of the focal areas and moved the strategic objectives to a higher, more programmatic level. GEF-4 also started with a push for greater efficiency, with a revision of the GEF project cycle, subsequent growth in programmatic approaches (see chap-ter 6), and the decision to level the playing field among the GEF Agencies through deletion of the corporate budgets for Implementing Agencies and increase of the project fees. These and other GEF reforms and changes have greatly affected RAF implementation and signal that exact com-parisons of the RAF implementation period with GEF-3 cannot be made.

The development of the RAF was lengthy, occu-pying seven Council meetings over four years as well as numerous workshops, task forces, and consultations. Once agreement was reached in September 2005, planning for implementation started. The country allocations were disclosed in September 2006, after the end of GEF-3 in July 2006. Country-level discussions on priorities relative to each allocation continued through the spring of 2007. The implementation of the RAF officially began in February 2007, when the fourth GEF replenishment came into effect. These vari-ous delays affected the timely launch of the RAF. While the period until midpoint in July 2008 has been less than two years, and environmental impacts are not yet observable, clear effects are emerging including differences with the other focal areas that are not yet part of the RAF.

historical AllocationsAs intended by the RAF design, RAF allocations correspond to the pattern of historical allocations in the GEF. Statistically, the RAF formula yields high levels of correlation between past and cur-rent allocations for all countries over all phases; this can be seen when analyzing trends in a scatter-gram (see figure 5.1). Although the results of the RAF formula may mimic historical allocations, there are several formulas with various weights that could achieve this result.

Across all past GEF replenishment periods, all but 3 of the top 20 RAF country allocations in biodiversity were also in the top 20 historically, and 12 of the 20 highest allocation countries in climate change are the same. The country shares within each replenishment period show a high correlation with the GBI and focal area alloca-tion share. Most of the countries in the group allocation received limited amounts in the past. Also, the nominally larger GEF-4 replenishment and the reduction in global and regional projects have resulted in more resources being available to allocate to countries.

There are considerable shifts for some countries within this general pattern, as well as shifts in the predominance of resources between the two RAF focal areas for a given country. During GEF-3, more than 100 countries accessed funds in both focal areas. Compared to past amounts, the RAF allocation represents a possible gain for 115 biodi-versity countries and for 71 climate change coun-tries, although not in large amounts, provided the countries access their maximum allocation; the remaining eligible countries receive less than they did in the past. The possibilities of access are greater if a country has a history of GEF involve-ment, an existing pipeline, and an individual RAF allocation.

Page 77: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 3

individual Allocation Countries The RAF provided 57 countries with individual potential allocations in the biodiversity focal area totaling $753.2 million. In climate change, 46 coun-tries have been allocated a total of $751.4 million in individual allocations. The comparison with historical allocation shares by GEF constituency/region is presented in table 1.1.1 The 31 countries with individual allocations in both focal areas have a 61 percent share of total biodiversity fund-ing (compared to 52 percent historically) and a 68 percent share of total climate change funding (compared to 73 percent in the past). To promote a more equitable distribution of resour ces, a coun-try’s allocation cannot exceed 10 percent of total focal area resources in biodiversity and 15 percent in climate change. These ceilings are set too high to affect allocations, and only one country (China) is limited by them (in climate change).

Group Allocation A historical comparison is difficult for the group allocation countries, because they share a pool of funds with no fixed allocation per country. How-ever, before they are put into the group, these countries are given a preliminary ranking and

allocation (these are not made public). The total pool amount consists of the preliminary alloca-tions for the group allocation countries with more than $1 million each, plus $1 million each for the remaining countries; this is called the adjusted allocation (see table 1.2). No amount is guaran-teed for any country in the group allocation, but all can compete for a higher amount than they normally would receive based on their prelimi-nary allocation.

Table 1.1

Comparison of historical and RAF Allocation shares by Constituency/Region

Constituency/region

Biodiversity (57 indicative countries) Climate change (46 indicative countries)

historical (%) RAF (%) historical (%) RAF (%)

Europe and CIS 6 5 11 30

Asia 26 27 49 44

West and Central Africa 5 5 2 1

East and Southern Africa 16 16 6 6

Caribbean 1 4 1 1

Pacific SIDS 2 2 0 0

Latin America 40 40 23 15

Middle East and North Africa 3 2 8 4

Total ($) 1,347 million 753 million 1,557 million 751 millionnote: CIS = Commonwealth of Independent States; SIDS = small island developing states.

Table 1.2

summary of Group Allocation

Parameter Biodiversity Climate change

Number of countries 93 115

Total pool amount $146.8 mil. $148.6 mil.

Max. possible per country $3.5 mil. $3.0 mil.

Preliminary allocation

> $1 million 53 countries 41 countries

$1 million 10 countries 33 countries

< $1 million 30 countries 41 countries

Targeted supplementa $15.4 mil. $25.9 mil.

a. The targeted supplement provides countries with a preliminary allocation of less than $1 million with a minimum adjusted alloca-tion of $1 million; the total supplement becomes part of the group allocation pool of funds.

Page 78: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

There are many possibilities for access. As an extreme case, 42 biodiversity countries could get the maximum of $3.5 million, leaving 51 with zero; in climate change, 48 can get the maximum while 67 countries receive nothing. (In previous replenishment periods, many countries did in fact get zero grants.) From the opposite perspective, if all countries receive $1 million from the pool, then 21 countries in biodiversity and 16 countries in climate change could receive the maximum of more than $3 million each.

The majority of countries in special circumstances receive group allocations (see table 1.3). For exam-ple, in climate change, 97 percent of the 48 small island developing states (SIDS) are part of the group allocation, as are 88 percent of the 48 least devel-oped countries (LDCs). The group allocation des-ignation intensifies the already existing challenges for SIDS and LDCs of access to GEF resources.

Resources and Global environmental BenefitsThe RAF model channels resources to coun-tries with high global environmental benefits as measured by GBI scores; the GPI is not as influ-ential in determining allocations. The 57 indica-tive countries, defined as countries with indi-vidual allocations, accumulate 88 percent of the total GBI scores for the 150 eligible countries, as

Table 1.3

Adjusted Allocations under the RAF by Country Classification

Country type

Biodiversity (150 countries) Climate change (161 countries)

number of countries Allocation (million $) number of countries Allocation (million $)

All ind. Group All ind. Group All ind. Group All ind. Group

SIDS 35 9 26 110.05 62.29 47.76 35 1 34 40.56 4.25 36.31

LDC 48 13 35 154.84 95.63 59.20 48 6 42 80.36 28.44 51.92

Landlocked 35 9 26 87.64 50.48 37.16 36 9 27 98.63 59.86 38.76

Fragile 30 8 22 86.21 48.33 37.87 30 4 26 56.35 27.64 28.71

HIPC 40 16 24 164.69 124.08 40.61 40 5 35 67.90 21.55 46.35

note: HIPC = heavily indebted poor countries; Ind. = individual allocation; Group = group allocation.

defined by the biodiversity index, and accumu-late 75.3 percent of the total resources in the focal area. In climate change, the 46 indicative countries receive 75 percent of total focal area resources, and account for 89 percent of GBICC scores for the 161 eligible countries (see table 1.4). There is good coverage of megadiverse countries for bio-diversity, but less for biodiversity hotspots that straddle individual and group allocation countries (the coverage of hotspots is also influenced by a reduction in global and regional resources). In cli-mate change, the main determinant for allocation is greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions.

Table 1.4

Comparison of Allocation and GBi score shares under the RAF

Parameter

Biodiversity Climate change

ind. Group ind. Group

Number of countries 57 93 46 115

Share of countries (%) 38 62 29 71

Share of allocation (%) 75 15 75 15

Share of GBI score (%) 88 12 89 11

note: Ind. = individual allocation; Group = group allocation.

Resource UtilizationUnder the new project cycle, “resource utilization” is defined by the GEF Secretariat as approval of the project identification form (PIF) and precedes

Page 79: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 5

endorsement of the project document. Using this definition, the first period of the RAF saw sub-stantially lower use of funds in the RAF focal areas than in previous replenishment periods. At mid-point, there have been almost no disbursements on the ground from GEF-4 funding. The overall rate for resource utilization is 31 percent of focal area funds at midpoint. Resource utilization is much higher in the non-RAF focal areas (see fig-ure 1.1): international waters, 59 percent; land degradation, 81 percent; and persistent organic pollutants (POPs), 48 percent. Note, however, that the first period of the RAF has actually been less than two years, given that GEF-4 became effective in February 2007.

RAF funding (see table 1.5). Only one project has started, in terms of funds having been disbursed for it.

Table 1.5

status of RAF Allocation as of July 3, 2008

status Biodiversity Climate change

RAF allocation $900 million $900 million

Resource utilization (PIF approval)

$287 million (32%)

$252 million (28%)

CEO endorsement $37.8 million (4%)

$65.4 million (7%)

In implementation N/A N/A

note: N/A = not applicable.

Access to resources is uneven; biodiversity group allocation countries have used 18 percent of their allocation, compared to only 5 percent for cli-mate change group allocation countries; the indi-vidual allocation countries have used 33 percent in PIF clearance, project preparation grants, and medium-size project (MSP) approvals.

Agency CompositionThe RAF has led to increased participation by the United Nations Development Programme (UNDP) and the “new” GEF Agencies and to a decrease in World Bank and, to a lesser extent, United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP) participation.

Historically the largest Agency in terms of GEF resources, the World Bank, including the Inter-national Finance Corporation (IFC), has dropped from a share of more than half of GEF resources in biodiversity and climate change in past periods to 32 percent of GEF RAF resource utilization in PIF approvals. Concurrently, the Bank’s share has increased for multifocal areas, from 21 percent to 33 percent in GEF-4, and its overall involvement in non-RAF focal areas has increased as com-pared to the past. As seen in figure 1.2, UNDP

Figure 1.1

Resource Utilization in GeF-4 by Agency and Focal Area

Million $

20

40

60

80

100

120

140

160

180

200

Biodiversity Climatechange

Multifocal Non-RAF

World Bank UNDP UNEP Executing Agency

0

note: Figure does not show jointly implemented projects as these totaled $1 million or less.

As of July 3, 2008—the formal midpoint of the RAF—15 full-size country projects have been endorsed by the GEF Chief Executive Officer (CEO). If CEO endorsement of the project docu-ment is used to indicate resource utilization (and it seems a more realistic indicator), countries have so far used 6 percent of total GEF-4 country

Page 80: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

now accounts for 43 percent of RAF resource uti-lization, up from 28 percent historically.

Following the revised policy of leveling the play-ing field for the GEF Agencies, the role of the seven Executing Agencies has increased in GEF-4 to 17 percent of RAF utilization, compared to 7.9 percent in GEF-3 (including indirect access), or 2 percent of all historical resources. This includes $30.1 million for European Bank for Reconstruc-tion and Development projects in Russia and Ukraine, and seven projects for the Asian Devel-opment Bank (ADB), including programmatic approach activities within the Pacific. The Inter-American Development Bank (IDB) has eight projects in the Latin America and the Caribbean region; and both the International Fund for Agri-cultural Development (IFAD) and the Food and Agriculture Organization of the United Nations also have GEF-4 projects.

Many reasons in addition to the RAF influence these changes. All of the Agencies have been affected by other GEF-4 reforms and the shift in roles under the RAF. Additionally, the current sit-uation reflects UNDP’s ability to provide techni-cal assistance and capacity building supported by

local offices, plus its readiness to engage in rela-tively small projects under the RAF. The spread of small RAF allocations over many countries makes it difficult to pursue the policy to blend interna-tional financial institution loans with GEF proj-ects of a cost-effective size. Other, internal, fund-ing alternatives are often easier to access than GEF support.

Roles and RelationshipsEven though the RAF did not require any formal change in GEF roles apart from the Secretariat’s new task of managing and monitoring the frame-work, the RAF has caused major shifts in roles in the GEF partnership. Combined with other reforms, the RAF has prompted the Secretariat to take on a stronger role in project inception, pro-gram development, and bilateral dialogue with countries, for which the RAF pipeline discus-sion was the starting point. GEF operational focal points (OFPs) report an increase in their role, mainly in individual allocation countries, from just endorsement to actual programming and pri-oritization. They have led national consultations to establish GEF priorities for the pipeline which have often been broader and more systematic than previously. OFPs in group allocation coun-tries are expected to fulfill the same coordination and prioritization role, but with less programming resources.

This intensified OFP involvement does not trans-late into full national ownership of GEF proposals, however, since the involvement of other partners such as nongovernmental organizations (NGOs), the private sector, and donors has become less extensive as consultations have shifted from a project to a national portfolio level. In the mid-term review survey, only 44 percent of NGO and private sector organization staff indicated that public participation under the RAF was mod-erately or very successful; 69 percent of Small

Figure 1.2

Resource Utilization by Agency and Replenishment Period

note: ExA = Executing Agency; IA = Implementing Agency.

World Bank

UNDP

UNEP

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

Pilotphase

GEF-1 GEF-2 GEF-3 GEF-4

% of total phase replenishment

Joint IAExAJoint

IA-ExA

Page 81: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 7

Grants Programme (SGP) stakeholders cited their concern that the SGP’s neutral role may be under-mined by governments’ strengthened position in GEF planning.

Roles are still evolving in response to the RAF and other GEF changes. For example, the role of the three original GEF Agencies has recently dimin-ished in the strategic management of the GEF, and the Council’s role has changed vis-à-vis the new project cycle and with the introduction of pro-grammatic approaches.

nature of the Portfolio Although resource utilization as measured at the PIF approval stage is not yet high, some implemen-tation trends are obvious. There is a slight increase in the MSP share over past trends (9.5 percent com-pared to 5.5 percent at GEF-3 midpoint). Because 93 percent of the climate change group alloca-tion countries, and 53 percent of the biodiversity group allocation countries, have not accessed any amounts as of the midterm review, this figure may rise during the remainder of GEF-4. However, with some regional exceptions, countries and Agencies generally do not find MSPs cost-effective, as this modality requires almost the same level of proce-dural effort as full-size projects (FSPs). MSPs were not subject to cycle simplification. While MSPs can be a way to distribute scarce resources among more project proponents, a shift toward MSPs has implications for the cost-effectiveness of the over-all GEF portfolio.

There has been a growth in multifocal area proj-ects, from a 13 percent share of historical replen-ishments to 33 percent in GEF-4 so far, cover-ing both RAF and non-RAF funds. Joint Agency projects seem to have disappeared, but because projects are split into PIF components by Agency, country, focal area, and source of funds, compari-son with past practice is difficult. The division of

funds under the RAF—among countries, focal areas, and exclusions—has increased the need to draw on several sources to develop a feasible proj-ect, so the substantive synergies of such multifocal area projects are uncertain. This is also the case for the 12 approved programmatic approaches, some of which are being applied for a given coun-try, some for regional programs, and some for global. The programmatic approaches may pres-ent a solution to low resource utilization for some countries, but it is too early to discern any effects. The Fourth Overall Performance Study (OPS4) of the GEF will address new evidence as to whether and how these approaches increase efficiency as currently implemented.

Resource utilization for enabling activities is also down, with only 10 approved enabling activities in biodiversity and none in climate change during GEF-4. Enabling activities are part of countries’ responsibilities in fulfilling their obligations to a given convention. This low usage of RAF funds may be explained by the fact that countries have thus far accessed funding from an existing umbrella program for climate change enabling activities which was approved before the RAF, and by the cyclical nature of enabling activities which reflect convention guidance. In future, enabling activ-ity funding is supposed to be accessed from RAF allocations. However, their cost could deplete the full amount allocated for countries in the group allocation, leaving no funding for other projects. The Cartagena Protocol on Biosafety is of particu-lar concern in this regard, as it is the only protocol fully supported by the GEF as the financial mecha-nism. So far in GEF-4, a biosafety programmatic approach and 10 biosafety projects have been approved in the biodiversity area; this is less than expected given historical patterns. In GEF-3, most support for biosafety ($21 million) was provided through global projects. The RAF appears to have slowed the momentum created by the previous

Page 82: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

8 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

global biosafety project. The Delphi experts con-sulted during the midterm review agreed that bio-safety is best addressed as a transboundary issue outside the RAF design.

Cost-effectiveness It is too early to say if the RAF has been cost-effective, but trends so far are not favorable. The RAF’s cost-effectiveness will depend primarily on whether it improves the GEF’s impact. In the short term, the RAF has yielded benefits in terms of bet-ter planning and ownership in some countries, and it has improved predictability of funding for indi-vidual allocation countries. However, its effects on the GEF portfolio and pipeline have so far been mixed. On the positive side, some countries with large allocations have been able to bring more coherence to their portfolios. On the other hand, the RAF may have encouraged a broader spread of resources, smaller projects, and an “entitlement mentality” among some member governments.

The RAF development process was a long and laborious investment. It did not have the benefit of significant involvement by NGOs, civil society, and the private sector; this has led to a consequent loss in opportunities to broaden the effectiveness and range of GEF resources. As few projects have been approved, and even fewer started, the hid-den opportunity costs of delays in impact can be large.

The RAF’s cost-benefit has not been fully dem-onstrated compared with the previous system or with other performance-based allocation (PBA) systems in terms of value for the money. Small allocations coupled with extensive GEF require-ments have reduced cost-effectiveness both at the portfolio level and the project access level, due to extensive consultations, wasted efforts, re-endorsements, dropped projects, and complex procedures for obtaining approvals for proposals.

Results have not materialized. Cost-effectiveness can be enhanced by increasing overall funds and country allocations (which would entail the same effort but yield more benefit), decreasing efforts to access existing funds (which would require less effort but would yield the same benefit and quality at entry), or—preferably—some combination of both of these measures.

1.2 Main ConclusionsOverall, the RAF has been implemented in accor-dance with Council decisions. This does not imply that the underlying objectives have been fully achieved, as the transition to a new way of provid-ing resources has been challenging. When review-ing the RAF design, implementation, and compar-ative experiences, the midterm review found that these issues are to some extent interlinked. Some difficulties in implementation are caused by the rigid design rules of the RAF; in other cases, the design is reasonable but operationalization has not worked well. Some implementation problems are linked to the fact that the GEF mandate, prac-tices, and RAF design differ from those of other PBA systems.

Conclusion 1: The GeF is operating in circum-stances that intensify the need to allocate scarce resources purposefully.

Internationally, there has been an increased demand for harmonization, alignment, owner-ship, and fitting of external funding with national priorities and strategies. To address the issue of scarce resources and promote national program-ming, resource allocation systems have been put in place in most if not all multilateral funding agencies. The United Nations (UN) agencies tend to have needs-based allocation systems, while the international financial institutions tend to com-bine needs and performance indicators.

Page 83: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 9

The fourth replenishment of the GEF has deliv-ered less money in real terms than previous replenishments. At the same time, the number of GEF focal areas has increased to six. New issues continue to emerge, and the urgency of tackling global environmental problems has increased. Furthermore, a relatively large number of eligible countries received no GEF support in the past; in consequence, less money must be spread over more countries to perform more tasks. To meet the guidance and expectations of the conventions and address the growing number of environmen-tal challenges, returning to an ad hoc system of funding delivery is no longer an option. However, the resource allocation system now adopted by the GEF needs specific improvements if it is to be an effective tool in resolving these issues.

The RAF was not introduced based on an assess-ment of the existing system for producing global environmental benefits. The historical approach to global environmental benefits has been based on the GEF Operational Strategy, operational programs, and strategic priorities established for each replenishment phase. While these strategies and priorities are still in place, the country-based nature of the RAF poses intrinsic challenges in managing and monitoring the pipeline and port-folio to meet them. It may also curtail opportuni-ties to promote new project modalities and inno-vative corporate initiatives, such as cooperation with NGOs and the private sector.

Conclusion 2: Data and indicators for assessing global environmental benefits used in the RAF reflect the best information available today, with some gaps that should be addressed over time.

In general, the indicators for biodiversity and cli-mate change reflect the best scientific data cur-rently available. There are, however, efforts to develop responses to data gaps within the scien-

tific community that may represent improvements to the RAF indexes in the medium to longer term. The Delphi study did not support extending the biodiversity indexes to include agrobiodiversity, and raised questions as to whether biosafety can be addressed appropriately through indexes. The Delphi experts strongly support the inclusion of marine invertebrates and ecosystems, for which data are now available or emerging.

Simulations to respond to the issue of marine/ter-restrial balance demonstrate that a 50/50 weight with the current data would bring five SIDS up to individual allocations, while seven countries (including one small island developing state and four landlocked countries) would move from indi-vidual to group allocations. For SIDS currently receiving individual allocations, amounts would increase for five, and decrease for two, coun-tries. Because individual recipient countries also have large marine resources, their GBIs increase when the weights are modified. It is not clear if new data on biodiversity ocean resources would change this pattern significantly. The individual allocation countries currently have 85 percent of the accumulated marine score (and 89 percent of the accumulated terrestrial score). No consensus emerged among international experts on what the ideal weight balance between marine and terres-trial resources would be. There was some argu-ment that given the lack of a scientific foundation for weighting, a marine species should be treated the same as a terrestrial species, without weights.

Adaptation and vulnerability to climate change are not reflected in the current climate change index. International experts strongly agreed that more should be done to balance funding between adaptation and mitigation in developing coun-tries. However, no agreement emerged on a best practice or standard to use to reflect the scale of vulnerability or adaptation needs.

Page 84: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

10 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Also regarding the climate change index, the GBICC formula multiplies a “need” variable (emissions) with a “performance” variable (change in carbon intensity). This makes the weight difficult to inter-pret and means that emissions dominate the allo-cations. Consideration should be given to full rec-ognition of energy intensity improvements. The Delphi experts stated that neither the overall size of a country’s emissions nor its economic growth are reliable proxies for obtaining the most emis-sion reductions for the money spent. They found that energy intensity was a good indicator because of the significant potential in reducing emissions through improvements in energy efficiency.

Conclusion 3: The RAF does not provide effec-tive incentives to improve performance.

A premise of the RAF is that good performance should be recognized with higher allocations. Member countries should be able to see improved practices leading to higher RAF scores, which in turn should improve their initial allocation. The relation between incentives and behaviors is com-plex and depends on a government’s understand-ing the link between its performance, its scores, and the grants it receives, as well as its ability to influence the achievement of global environmen-tal benefits and performance scores. The incen-tive depends on how much a country can realisti-cally aspire to improve its allocation. Neither focal points nor other stakeholders have been given a clear understanding of what performance means in the GEF context or how to address it.

Most stakeholders perceive “performance” as the quality of GEF projects. However, the performance of the environmental portfolio has a relatively low weight in the performance indexes (5 percent for ongoing GEF projects), which means that improv-ing the performance of this portfolio will only lead to a very limited increase in the allocation. The weight of ratings for closed projects is another

5 percent. For the other general performance indexes on environmental policies and institutions and enabling environment, their improvement will not be incentivized through the promise of slightly more GEF funding, given the marginal share of funding accounted for by the GEF in almost all countries. The 57 countries with individual alloca-tions in biodiversity accumulate 41 percent of the GPI scores, while the 46 climate change individual allocation countries accumulate 35 percent of GPI scores; in both cases, this is less than their benefits scores. The investments to improve environmen-tal policy and institutions far outweigh the level of increase in GEF funding that such performance improvements might bring. Even with a higher weight assigned to the GPI, fine-tuning the per-formance indexes is unlikely to make a difference unless the overall amount available to the GEF increases dramatically. The weights would need to be changed to a large extent to make a difference, with subsequent volatility in allocations.

The RAF design specifies that 75 percent of accu-mulated resources will be provided as individual allocations to countries in accordance with a for-mula based on country ranking, with the remain-ing countries receiving a joint group allocation—a parameter unique to the GEF among PBA systems. Because of this 75 percent rule, most group alloca-tion countries will remain in the group even if their performance improves greatly. Availability of more funds will benefit the category of individual alloca-tion countries in the top 75 percent. The group allo-cation countries with preliminary ranking close to the 75 percent cutoff point may move up to an indi-vidual allocation, as five did in the 2008 realloca-tion. However, there are no incentives for improve-ment, because countries have not been made aware of their preliminary allocations and ranking.

A general concern has been that recognition of performance would be detrimental to recognition of needs, especially in the LDCs. This is correct

Page 85: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 11

with regard to the general performance indexes, where low capacity and less institutional develop-ment may result in a low score. It is not correct for the performance of the environment portfolio, which would be geared toward the specific needs of the country. A project in an LDC could substan-tially differ from a project in a medium-income country, yet achieve high outcome ratings. Cur-rently, however, the environment portfolio overall only contributes 10 percent to the GPI.

Conclusion 4: Unclear guidelines have limited the access of the group allocation countries to GeF funds in the first period of the RAF.

In total, the approximately $148 million desig-nated for each group allocation is the same as it would have been if all allocations had remained individual, including a small supplement (about 2 percent of total focal area funds) for 88 countries without sufficient data to compute a meaningful allocation. The group allocation system could in principle provide flexibility to countries and the GEF while providing for equality in resources, but not in the way it is now implemented. The small allocations can in themselves serve as a barrier to access of funds.

The portfolio overview demonstrates this finding, which also emerged in the stakeholder consulta-tions. There was a general lack of understanding by countries regarding how to react to being in a group, especially for countries with limited capaci-ties. Utilization by the 44 LDCs was just 8 percent, compared with 40 percent for the 106 non-LDCs, in spite of the fact that their allocations are lim-ited. By region, countries outside Africa (98) have on average utilized 39 percent of their biodiver-sity allocation as compared with 14 percent for 52 African countries.

The group allocation countries were issued con-flicting or incomplete guidance on pipeline man-

agement under the RAF. Most of their proposals were discouraged in the teleconferences with the GEF Secretariat (the biodiversity group alloca-tion countries had 75 percent of their proposals discouraged). While individual allocation coun-tries also experienced a high level of “rejection,” they had more proposals to continue developing. Group resources allow the GEF to fund projects up to $1 million for all countries in the group for both focal areas, but are insufficient for funding the upper limit for every group allocation coun-try. Countries are now struggling to develop small projects for $1 million while complying with the ambitious focal area strategies. Some countries have been too discouraged by the high transac-tion costs associated with a $1 million MSP—even though they could receive the grant without com-petitive review—to even develop proposals. The GEF Agencies were incentivized to give priority to countries with an individual allocation. The pro-grammatic approach was developed as an answer to the problems that emerged, but it took time to convey this to the countries concerned, and there is no evidence that such approaches lead to increased or faster access for the majority of countries.

The Secretariat has given group allocation coun-tries until the end of December 2008 for proposals up to $1 million, after which access will be based on competition. Individual allocation countries are not subject to such time limitations, although six biodiversity and eight climate change countries have accessed none of their individual allocations. The associated resources total $126.5 million, a comparable amount to the unspent group funds.

Conclusion 5: The complexity of the RAF’s implementation rules does not encourage flex-ible and dynamic use of resources given the rel-atively small GeF-4 funding.

Some rules were adopted by the Council that decrease or hamper the flexibility of the RAF.

Page 86: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

12 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

The rule that only 50 percent of allocations can be utilized in the first two years (the 50 percent rule) appears to be unnecessary—it has hindered resource utilization, and it is not necessary to keep funding in the first half of a resource allocation system within bounds. For the group allocation, there is no need to limit proposals to 50 percent of a hypothetical maximum amount, which further decreases cost-effectiveness for these countries. The assumption underlying the 50 percent rule does not hold true: that it would serve as an incen-tive or consequence for changes in performance at midpoint. Furthermore, the rule is not needed for liquidity purposes, as the experiences of other PBA systems show. The rule is not an interna-tional standard, as other PBA systems have more dynamic approaches to limiting “front-loading” of funds and yet ensuring periodic revisions in allo-cations as incentives. It does not make sense for the levels of funding available, particularly for the group allocation countries.

More importantly, rules for reallocating funds in the crucial last phase of the RAF are not in place. The current rules envisage that remaining funds will be turned over to GEF-5 rather than be used where good opportunities for global benefits and high performance exist. The introduction of the RAF has caused a lag in resource utilization, with uneven demand and capacity to deliver. The reallocation did not lead to substantial changes in allocation, given the lack of some new data in bio-diversity, the nature of the RAF formula, and limited changes in the GPI. The reallocation for the GEF is mainly a recalculation of the indexes, rather than shifting resources based on a flexible assessment of demand and supply as is done by many other PBA systems. Unused funds at the end of GEF-4 are not of benefit to the global environment.

Perhaps more than the indexes themselves, other design factors are very influential in shaping the

pattern of resources countries may obtain. The indicators are based on scientific and analytical work, but the other design parameters described are based on strategic policy decisions. These parameters include the weights that describe the quantitative relationships among the indica-tors, the 15 percent ceiling in climate change, the 75 percent rule of all focal area resources (not country resources) going to the countries with the highest accumulated ranking, the 10 percent set-aside for global and regional resources, and the 50 percent rule of resource utilization. These fac-tors determine how much countries receive, and which receive group versus individual allocations.

Conclusion 6: The RAF design and rules are too complex for a network partnership such as the GeF, and the guidelines and support provided have not succeeded in making the RAF trans-parent and accessible.

Strong efforts were made to communicate the RAF to focal points once the framework was approved, and these have continued over the last years. The agenda of reform adopted by the Council and CEO also entailed extensive communication work. In spite of these efforts, the system is not transpar-ent. The design is too complex to communicate easily, and many elements that could have been disclosed have not been made public. It may not be realistic for all involved to obtain broad and in-depth understanding of the technical mea-surement issues, and the details of how the RAF formula works may not be needed for most stake-holders. However, country partners do need to be informed of (1) the maximum the country could obtain in a grant, (2) the country’s performance on all three indexes relative to other countries, and (3) what actions would likely increase the coun-try’s performance scores in the next round.

Gaps in knowledge and limits of the institutional capacity of focal point offices and project propo-

Page 87: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 13

nents, as well as of local Agency offices, continue to affect the pipeline, especially in group coun-tries, LDCs, and Sub-Saharan Africa. The GEF-UNDP Country Support Programme and the GEF country profile pages have been helpful in provid-ing basic information to focal points. However, the traditional support mechanisms may not be sufficient for the kind of training and continuous support needed for a multicomponent, multidi-mensional system with so many different actors and country categories. Exclusion from pipeline discussions and shifting implementation arrange-ments have hampered Agencies’ ability to provide clarification and support to countries. Further-more, a key actor in the RAF implementation—the GEF focal point—often has not been provided with the crucial elements and tools to fulfill the new role, either by the respective government or by the GEF. In most cases, the GEF is only a small part of the work program performed by these individu-als, and therefore they cannot support RAF imple-mentation to the requisite extent. Some focal points indicated that the implementation of the RAF has taken too much of their limited time. Focal points, especially in individual allocation countries, are now expected to establish and manage systems for programming and project selection.

Corporate reforms and requirements have had effects beyond their intended purpose of address-ing previous problems in the new RAF setting. The stoppage of the 2007 pipeline, the suspen-sion of work programs due to lack of funds in the transitional period, and the requirement for re-endorsement of concepts and reformatting as PIFs have all contributed to a slowdown in pipe-line development. The simplification of the GEF project cycle was greatly appreciated by all stake-holders, but the new cycle seems to present its own barriers because of seemingly ever-changing and expanding PIF templates and screening. Pres-sure to spend funds within a four-year window

makes both cycle and cofunding requirements more difficult to address in many countries. For Agencies, additional functional demands from the GEF, changes in financial circumstances, and lack of clear guidelines have discouraged staff from working with the GEF.

The RAF design did not in itself cause the slow utilization of funds currently observed; implemen-tation did, combined with the slow start of GEF-4 and the reform agenda. Clear and simple rules are indispensable for a network partnership as com-plex as the GEF, in which a variety of actors have many different levels of capacity and are located all over the world. In the initial phase, issues of design, rules, allocation, and operation cannot be easily separated and have led to confusion. Ambiguity and occasional inconsistencies in guidance have further slowed resource utilization. The 2006–07 telecon-ferences between countries and the GEF Secretar-iat were highly appreciated in intent, but the poten-tially positive effects of these bilateral discussions on pipeline priorities were restrained by unclear responsibilities for action points; this resulted in a lack of systematic follow-up by the concerned par-ties—especially regarding group allocation coun-tries—and frequently heightened the confusion felt by country stakeholders and Agencies.

The programmatic approach is also taking much effort to get off the ground. The GEF Secretariat does not have the personnel available to play the central role needed in the complicated system, given the concurrent implementation of the RAF and ongoing GEF reforms.

Conclusion 7: The RAF has increased country ownership in countries with an individual allo-cation and has had a neutral or detrimental effect on country ownership in countries with a group allocation.

For several larger individual allocation countries, such as India and Russia, the predictability of a

Page 88: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

14 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

sizable amount has galvanized the focal points and attracted political interest, and promoted more coherence in country portfolio planning. Other countries with historically large utilization continued their existing approaches to pipeline development. Overall, there has been a growth in the establishment of committees and informal and formal consultations; national consultations have shifted from a focus at the project level to greater attention to the portfolio as a whole. This trend has focused attention on the GEF focal points and away from the project proponents who are often located in sector ministries or the GEF Agen-cies. RAF implementation also appears to have empowered focal points in negotiating with GEF Agencies.

The concept of country ownership contains cer-tain intrinsic tensions. Extensive consultations are time consuming and can, in some cases, be linked to slow utilization. And, although country own-ership is essential to the planning and delivery of GEF projects, country environmental priorities may be at odds with those of the GEF Secretariat and Agencies. The experience with the RAF pipe-line negotiations brought out more strongly the inherent conflicts between the criteria of global environmental benefits and country-specific sus-tainability needs. National consultations identi-fied a broad range of priorities, and subsequent rejections of ideas and proposals had a dampen-ing effect on engagement for the GEF, and some-times put focal points in a difficult position. This circumstance has worked against the underlying RAF objective of providing a framework within which countries can program their resources in accordance with national priorities.

While 63 percent of survey respondents agree that the RAF may strengthen country roles in portfo-lio planning, many—if not most—group alloca-tion countries believe that empowerment has

not materialized. There is disenchantment with small allocations that cannot be realistically pro-grammed, with changing rules that are difficult to understand, and with expectations of predictable levels of funding that cannot be accessed. In most countries, a frequent turnover of the focal point position makes it difficult to sustain a sense of ownership in or and knowledge of the RAF.

Also, in practice, “country ownership” may—or may not, depending on particular country cir-cumstances—involve engagement and consulta-tion with a broadly representative group of stake-holders at the national and local levels. While there are a few excellent examples of NGO and civil society cooperation under the RAF, such as in Honduras, Madagascar, and Uganda, in the majority of countries the involvement of the NGO community has not improved, and the private sector is largely excluded from project proposals and government-led consultations on the GEF portfolio.

Conclusion 8: The exclusions did not work well and may have diminished the effectiveness of the GeF in the delivery of global and regional environmental benefits.

There has been a significant drop in available global and regional resources, from historical shares of 23 percent in biodiversity and 20 percent in climate change to the 10 percent fund under the RAF that is excluded from the formula, of which 5 percent ($50 million) is set aside for global and regional projects per RAF focal area. In spite of the reduction, the use of global and regional resources is only at 16 percent of biodiversity funds, but 52 percent in climate change. Although countries recognize the importance of transboundary envi-ronmental issues, there is a general reluctance to give up country allocations for such purposes due to cultural and regional constraints, national own-ership, and past experience with such projects.

Page 89: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 15

The “clear set of policies … for [its] use in the con-text of the revised focal area strategies” promised to the GEF Council in June 2007 has not been made available (GEF 2007f). The current trend, in which funds are earmarked by the Secretariat for different purposes, is the use of global and regional resources to top up or complement country or group allocation PIFs in the context of programmatic approaches. The underlying GEF intent—to use the 5 percent to support some coordination efforts or the development of pro-grammatic approaches—has not been made clear to countries and blurs the lines between what is best served by global, regional, or country activi-ties. There is also considerable “taxation” of focal areas for corporate and global activities.

The purpose of the global and regional exclusion (GRE) was to support projects of a global scope that were not funded by countries and multicoun-try cost-effective projects with benefits beyond each country. The lack of transparency and par-ticipation in the management of the exclusions have led to a sense of confusion among country and Agency stakeholders, and have raised doubts as to whether the objectives can be achieved.

The reduction in global and regional funds has affected Agencies such as UNEP, whose sup-port has been dominated by global and regional projects (85 percent of its biodiversity funds and 81 percent of climate change). It has also affected countries that were previously recipients of such support and specific focal area priorities. Interna-tional experts agree that biosafety is not covered well in the indexes or through country allocations, and could potentially be treated as an exception as well.

For the Small Grants Programme, the intro-duction of the RAF seems to have contributed to a shortfall in the agreed amount by the GEF-4 replenishment. Of a maximum of $200 million,

$80 million was to be set aside from RAF global resources; the SGP could also obtain country RAF allocation contributions. Both of these RAF con-tributions have fallen short. The SGP Steering Committee decisions capped the RAF contribu-tions for at least 29 countries that wanted to pro-vide more funds to the SGP of the 74 countries that have intersecting SGP and RAF individual allocations. During the first year of the SGP’s fourth operational phase, participating countries contributed a total of about $18 million from their RAF country allocations. The predictability of funding has been reduced for the SGP, and the influence of host governments has concomitantly increased. In countries using RAF allocations for the SGP, it is impossible to comply with the agreed strategy of diversifying the SGP portfolio, as the funds can only be used for climate change and biodiversity grants.

To access $300,00 to $400,000 from country RAF funds, the SGP must provide a strategy for the use of RAF funds—even though a country SGP strat-egy already exists, and countries with large indi-vidual RAF allocations have no such requirement. Cost-effectiveness is reduced by the level of nego-tiations required, an increased workload, separate accounting, the shift in the portfolio, additional requirements, and lost opportunities for the NGO community and civil society.

1.3 RecommendationsThe introduction of the RAF can be seen as part of a worldwide movement toward harmonization and aid effectiveness. Many international financial institutions introduced PBA systems at the same time as the GEF, although some will argue that the GEF is not a typical international financial institu-tion, and that the UN system has generally intro-duced needs-based allocation systems. Several of the problems in RAF implementation stem from

Page 90: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

16 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

the fact that the GEF is not a development bank, but rather a complex partnership for the global environment.

The following recommendations relate to both immediate and short-term actions to improve RAF implementation for the remainder of the GEF-4 period and medium-term actions for enhance-ments for GEF-5 and perhaps beyond.

Recommendation 1: Reallocation of unused funds should be allowed in the last year of GeF-4.

Current rules envisage that remaining funds will be turned over to GEF-5. The resource utilization issues that many countries are now experiencing were, naturally, not anticipated when designing the RAF. This is the appropriate time to intro-duce such rules. The issue is made more acute by the new definition of resource utilization. Even though the PIF does not constitute a legal obli-gation, the funds are set aside as a commitment. There is room to speed approvals while maintain-ing conservative risk management. Keeping the GEF-3 experience in mind, whereby the last work program was so large it caused absorption prob-lems in the system, it is important to ensure that countries can use funds within the bounds of the current replenishment period.

Potentially, a high level of funding will remain unused at the end of GEF-4. The GEF should determine whether countries plan to use the allo-cation and should then be allowed to reallocate any potentially unused funds to countries that have a portfolio of proposals ready for funding. Other PBA systems have rules to this effect, and these rules can be adapted to specific circumstances for the last year of the RAF. Three alternatives are (1) iterative reallocations of funds for the entire set of countries, winnowing out lack of demand, as is done by IFAD; (2) case-by-case pair-wise country-

to-country reallocations, as is done by the World Bank’s International Development Association (IDA), but only from lower performing to higher performing countries; or (3) meeting funding gaps in corporate programs and exclusions.

Recommendation 2: The last phase of GeF-4, including reallocation of funds, should be imple-mented with full public disclosure, transpar-ency, participation, and clear responsibilities.

With the implementation of the RAF, the role of the GEF Secretariat has changed, but there are no clear terms of reference in place delineating its new role and responsibilities. Given the restruc-turing and new teams in place, countries are not sure where to turn, or even if the Secretariat or an Agency should provide a response. The new GEF management information system is not yet operational, and the current systems are insuffi-cient for providing countries with proposal status. The Agencies together with the Secretariat should establish routines and responsibilities for inform-ing countries of pending proposals and ideas. Cor-porate reports should be made more explicit as to the source of funds and funds available. Planning for and use of GRE funds should be made trans-parent to countries and Agencies, especially when programmatic approaches are involved.

The bilateral contacts between the Secretariat and countries can be indispensable for clarifying eli-gible proposals, which seems to have been a key barrier, but will continue to lead to miscommuni-cation unless the Agencies that develop the PIFs and project documents are involved. The focal area task forces and executive coordinator meet-ings, as well as the disbanded RAF Task Force, would serve as useful mechanisms for agreeing on operational guidance and strategies that work.

More transparency and better communication may have prevented or alleviated some of the

Page 91: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 17

problems faced. The need for training and con-tinuous support should not be underestimated. Traditional support mechanisms may not suf-fice. An increase in support funds for the focal points should be considered, but this will not be enough in helping governments develop a portfo-lio quickly. A “RAF hotline,” online training pack-ages, and more effective constituency meetings and exchanges would help. More can be done to keep stakeholders informed electronically.

Recommendation 3: implementation rules need to be simplified.

In the transition to a new resource allocation sys-tem like the RAF, a strong effort has to be made to maintain both the project pipeline and imple-mentation momentum. Delay in identifying and implementing projects can result in large oppor-tunity costs. The composition of the project pipe-line, in terms of project size and focus, needs to be monitored and managed to ensure that unforeseen bottlenecks are not created by the new system.

A moratorium on additional requirements for project identification and formulation for the remainder of GEF-4 should promote the stabil-ity that will allow countries and Agencies to pro-gram. Further simplification of MSP requirements is overdue given the level of allocations and small financial risk, but associated high transaction costs.

More specifically, the Agencies and countries need to have incentives for developing proposals. Allowing countries more leeway to reflect national priorities and choice of implementing Agency would reduce delays and strengthen ownership without undue risk to quality. The group alloca-tion countries should not be subject to require-ments that are the same as or more stringent than those applied to large individual countries with more capacity.

The use of programmatic approaches is promis-ing but needs development. While it is too soon to assess results, it is already clear that the key principles for the programmatic approaches need more vigilance. There is room to improve national ownership, transparency, participation, and cata-lytic role and leveraging; ensure an open and transparent process of multistakeholder repre-sentation; increase cost-effectiveness and reduce transaction costs; and provide incentives for the Agencies to support programmatic approaches. Moreover, careful follow-up and attention are vital with regard to the development of country PIFs. Clarity in negotiations of funding compo-sition are needed, and operational guidance has been requested.

Overall rationalization and reconciliation of RAF requirements with the SGP must be taken into con-sideration. Some of the effects of the constraints on the SGP introduced by the RAF’s implementa-tion could be mitigated. An increase in program expenditure caps for countries such as India, Mexico, and the Philippines, which have consid-erable capacity to absorb GEF resources through small-scale interventions, would help these pro-grams produce global environmental benefits in a cost-efficient manner. It is also recommended that those SGP country programs receiving only RAF funds be allowed to access a relatively small level of support from SGP core funds. This would lessen the current imbalances in the project port-folios of these country programs.

Recommendation 4: steps to improve RAF design and indexes for GeF-5 should be taken now.

The previous recommendations would serve to support immediate improvements to implemen-tation. Issues for GEF-5 are more systemic and not as easily remedied. Given the novelty of a PBA sys-tem for a partnership with a global environmental

Page 92: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

18 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

mandate, some elements of the RAF were untried and now merit revisiting. Work related to the RAF for the start of GEF-5 in 2010 should start now. The initial experience shows that timely launch, planning, and resource availability are crucial.

As seen from the above, what could have been a relatively straightforward PBA system has evolved into a complex framework. Each member coun-try has a maximum amount it may request, but no amount is guaranteed; rather, countries and Agencies must propose quality projects to access the funds. There will always be inherent complex-ities in a system that has uncertain allocations, but an entitlement system is not feasible. On the other hand, the GEF should ensure that it facilitates access to the resources allocated under the RAF. This calls for improvements in both design and implementation for GEF-5 in the following areas:

Improvement of the GEF benefits indexes and z

Increased weight accorded environmental z

portfolio performance

Improvement of predictability and cost-bene- z

fits for the group allocation or discontinuation of the group allocation

Recognition of transboundary global environ- z

mental problems

Reconsideration of ceilings, floors, and the z

50 percent rule

Expansion of the RAF to one integrated alloca- z

tion for all focal areas

1.4 issues for the FutureThe following suggestions on issues to address require consultation with all GEF stakeholders. The issues entail design elements (indexes, weights, exclusions, group allocation redesign, expansion), but also depend on good strategies for implementation (transparency, information,

planning, simplification). In moving to improve the current RAF, aspects of design and imple-mentation must be considered together. There is, of course, a risk that further modifications may make the system more complex; care should be taken to ensure simplicity and to plan strategically for implementation. OPS4 will continue to gather evidence as it emerges during the last period of GEF-4 and provide further input to these issues for the future.

The indexes for Global Benefits and Their Respective Weights should Be improved for GeF-5The RAF has been efficient in using data that are already publicly available and should continue to do so wherever possible. Further design work should be participatory, with mechanisms to involve countries, Agencies, NGOs, and the GEF Scientific and Technical Advisory Panel (STAP).

While the index for biodiversity is appropriate as it is at present concerning threats and representa-tion, any decision on respective weights is a policy matter for the GEF to decide with the advice of biodiversity experts. Information on different spe-cies such as marine invertebrates can be added. A better marine/terrestrial balance would signal the importance attributed to different ecosystems, although actual allocations may in the end not dif-fer significantly.

Experts agree, as do many stakeholders, on chan-neling most of the funding for adaptation to the most vulnerable countries, if most of the funds under the GBICC go to mitigation in countries with more emissions. The separate funding windows may not suffice to address adaptation needs; fur-thermore, the country stakeholders find it increas-ingly difficult to keep track of different paths of access for different funds. This goes beyond the possible data content of the indexes to a discus-

Page 93: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 19

sion of the strategy of adaptation in the climate change portfolio. If the separate Adaptation Fund is expected to address these needs, there is no need to include adaptation in an index for mitiga-tion funding.

Climate change Delphi experts would like to see the indexes improved with more representation of gases and sources of GHG emissions—including agriculture and land use change, deforestation and forest degradation, gas flaring, and industrial non–carbon dioxide—but recognize that such emissions are hard to determine accurately. The data from national communications could possi-bly be used to verify the accuracy of global data sets, but this would need further study. The cli-mate change index should be made more harmo-nized and transparent by weighting and adding emissions and energy intensity, or by adding a new variable to give appropriate weight to improve-ment in the GBI from period to period.

There is currently no link between the content of the indexes that provide the allocations and how these allocations may be used. In biodiversity, for example, the GEF does not fund species conser-vation; rather, allocations are based on species. The GEF should consider the opportunity for policy dialogue with countries and the enhanced focus that the data can provide. If new aspects are included in the RAF indexes—such as adaptation, vulnerability, and marine sources—they should be accompanied by focal area strategies to permit expenditure of resources on these priorities.

The Relative Weight of environment Portfolio Performance in a Country should Be increased in GeF-5 to ensure That Performance is RewardedThe RAF is not serving as a realistic incentive structure for performance or global environmen-tal benefits. The incentive depends on how much

a country can realistically aspire to improve its allo-cation, as well as the government’s understanding of the link between its performance, its scores, and the grants it receives. Most importantly, it depends on the ability of those involved to improve such performance. The GEF focal points, who are most invested in the GEF portfolio, generally do not have direct influence over the aspects measured by the index, and the funds are insufficient to serve as an incentive for other authorities.

Merely increasing the exponent weight of the GPI compared to the GBI will not in and of itself provide sufficient incentives in the environment field that are within the reach of the GEF to influ-ence. It might be more relevant to reward more recent improvement in GEF project performance by assigning a higher weight to the portfolio per-formance indicator. There is inevitably some trade-off between stability (by being averaged over a long period of time, as is currently the case) and respon-siveness and accuracy (by emphasizing recent per-formance). The index should also increase its rele-vance by adding ratings from the final evaluations of GEF projects. When the RAF was designed, a relatively low number of terminal evaluations had been reviewed by the GEF Evaluation Office. It is expected that at the start of GEF-5, a credible number of evaluations and an acceptable geo-graphical coverage will have been achieved. This will be reported on further in OPS4.

Increasing the relative importance of the envi-ronment portfolio will provide better recognition of achievements and results in LDCs and SIDS, which may achieve high outcome ratings in their portfolios even while scoring relatively lower in general institutional performance. Current inter-national practice puts the portfolio percentage between 5 and 30. With 10 percent, the RAF is at the lower end of the range; its performance per-centage could be increased to 30.

Page 94: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

20 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Predictability and Cost-Benefits for the Group Allocation Must Be improved or the Group Allocation Abandoned Realistic expectations and a clear vision need to be established for the group allocation if it is to con-tinue. Two conflicting perceptions are observed: (1) the group allocation represents a “minimum” equal level of resources for countries, so that coun-tries with higher needs would be guaranteed some support; and (2) not all countries would normally access funds during a phase, so it is acceptable that resource utilization is low. The first vision was emphasized when introducing the RAF, and it has raised high expectations; implementation, however, seems to have focused on the second. The current push to provide access for group allocation countries through programmatic approaches is promising but at this stage may not include all per-manent measures needed for countries with capac-ity issues for GEF-5. OPS4 will continue to study the development of programmatic approaches.

Many of the group allocation countries previously benefited from regional support and enabling activity umbrella projects, which have diminished under the RAF. Countries instead have the oppor-tunity to obtain resources from a pool. Their pro-posals for individual country projects have largely been discouraged. The Secretariat and Agencies are now expending considerable effort approach-ing the countries to convince them to put the funds back into a regional programmatic program, so that they in turn can be provided with individual country PIFs. This roundabout way of program-ming is not a cost-effective use of scarce GEF resources and is very frustrating to countries. In addition, the smaller countries face higher trans-action costs in accessing GEF funds than do larger GEF recipients. The small allocation, combined with the difficulty in getting projects through, is judged to be not worth it for many countries and Agencies.

Whereas transitional “hiccups” and mixed guid-ance may explain some of the challenges these countries have encountered, the midterm review found that the problems are more systemic, linked to capacity limitations, lack of predictability and transparency, and focal area strategies. In all sce-narios for the group allocation, improvements would require clear and consistent guidance from the GEF in cooperation with the Agencies, improved communication on the status of pro-posals and programming, lessening the require-ments of focal area strategies for small allocations and allowing more country-driven proposals, and simplifying the procedures and bureaucracy for small projects/MSPs.

Two options for changing the group allocation are possible, depending on the desired balance of flex-ibility, simplicity, and predictability:

Option 1. z Abandon grouping, so that all coun-tries receive individual allocations. A minimum allocation of $1 million could be provided for those countries with preliminary allocations below that amount; all other countries could receive their preliminary allocation.

Option 2. z The group pot could be divided regionally, so that opportunities for program-matic approaches and regional collaboration could be maximized.

The 75 percent rule in the RAF design is very influ-ential in shaping the pattern of resources coun-tries may obtain, how much countries receive, and which countries receive group or individual alloca-tions. The 75 percent rule of allocations to the top-ranked indicative countries is not an internationally accepted PBA practice. An advantage of abandon-ing the group allocation system would be that the 75 percent rule could be discontinued, thus allow-ing more countries to benefit from predictable allo-cations while ensuring that the formula is applied.

Page 95: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 21

Transboundary Global environmental Problems need to Be Better Recognized and served in a Revised Resource Allocation system for GeF-5Global and regional activities are considered part of the core mandate of the GEF, and resources should be made available for them. Motivation for global and regional funding could be stimulated by a “transboundary premium” of say, 15 percent, on appropriate projects and country allocations. The share of global and regional projects could be reconsidered, but with a clear view of what the exclusions should facilitate to improve achieve-ment of global and regional environmental ben-efits. If purely focused on global matters, a small allocation may suffice; if used for incentives to regional projects, programmatic approaches, and corporate initiatives and flexibility that cannot be ensured through the country allocation, it does not suffice.

The SGP now finds itself spending consider-able time and effort mobilizing resources from the GEF, rather than—or in addition to—seeking new and additional financing. A reasonable level of core financing should be secured for the SGP, and it should be enabled to pursue the policies of expanding focal area attention and resource mobilization.

Reexamination of Ceilings, Floors, and the 50 Percent Rule should Be Considered Lowering the ceilings for how much one country can be assigned to 5 percent of focal area funds could also be reconsidered; this would ensure a more even distribution of funds or, alternatively, more resources for global and regional exclusions. Simulations show that a 10 percent ceiling is not effective in modifying current allocation patterns, while lowering the ceiling to 5 percent has a sig-nificant impact.

Lower ceilings would likely increase the equity and effectiveness (economic efficiency) of the RAF, particularly for climate change. A staggered reduction could be possible by reducing the ceiling in the biodiversity focal area to 5 percent and the ceiling in climate change to 10 percent in GEF-5, and to 5 percent in GEF-6.

The establishment of floors is now redundant, as the $1 million floor is applied to countries, but then countries and their floor allocations are pooled in the group allocation, so the floors are not effective. Allocation floors would be appropriate to ensure a minimum level of funding for obligations to the conventions. For the majority of countries, $1 mil-lion should suffice for this purpose. However, if countries would want to use GEF funds for global environmental benefits, the provision of support to enabling activities through country allocations may not be an effective approach. Furthermore, the “minimum” level of GEF support that would be reasonable for countries to promote global environmental benefits may vary from country to country, and from Agency to Agency, with some mentioning $4 million as a practical level. The GEF may want to consider the level of floors, particularly as it has already been determined that $1 million is limited for producing extensive global environmental benefits.

The 50 percent rule should be replaced by trans-parent and dynamic approaches for limiting front-loading of funds as necessary, while balancing availability of funds with stimulation of resource utilization. The Secretariat, on the advice of the GEF Trustee, should be allowed to put reason-able and transparent limits on spending early in the cycle, in consultation with the Agencies. In any case, the reallocation exercise would, as with other PBA systems, serve the purpose of recog-nizing achievements.

Page 96: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

22 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

introducing the RAF for All Focal Areas in GeF-5 Requires one integrated Allocation per CountryOf all organizations with a PBA system, the GEF operates in the largest number of countries with the smallest amount of funds, and is the only donor with two complex allocation systems, one for biodiversity and one for climate change. To turn this into six allocation systems in GEF-5 will guarantee an unmanageable operation, unless the GEF replenishment would increase manifold and the staff of the Secretariat also be substantially increased. The Global Fund to Fight AIDS, Tuber-culosis and Malaria, with disbursements to date of $10 billion, has around 400 headquarters staff. IFAD, operating with a similar level of funding as the GEF, has 225 professional staff at headquar-ters, as well as some regional and country repre-sentatives. The GEF, on the other hand, is built of a network of Agencies with existing expertise, management systems, and field offices.

The call for more integrative action has been heard throughout the GEF and in the global conventions. The linkage between biodiversity and climate change, for example, has been highlighted in many recent articles. New initiatives that the Council, the GEF Secretariat, and the conventions would like to take on also require a new perspective on the focal areas as indicative rather than prescriptive allocations within country allocations. Recipient countries of the GEF are member countries of the conventions and thus are first responsible to ensur-ing that they implement the conventions.

New initiatives may include involvement of the private sector as envisaged in the private sector strategy, cooperation with the NGO commu-nity, and/or attention to specific thematic issues such as technology transfer. With country-based allocations, there will inevitably be some trade-offs between country priorities and corporate

schemes. Such policy issues could be addressed through an allocation system either by providing separate and sufficient set-asides, or by developing incentive mechanisms for countries and Agencies to participate in and contribute to such initiatives. This would normally imply some modification of project modalities and financial incentives.

Presumably, allocations would be calculated for each focal area and then pooled for each country. The question to resolve is how much flexibility would be provided for a country to develop proj-ects drawing upon its whole pool of funds, and how much would a country be restricted to focal areas within its allocation. As mentioned above regard-ing transboundary issues, special attention should be paid to international waters and the need to stimulate regional activities. At the country level, focal area spending in rough proportion with RAF scores in different focal areas may be appropriate. Providing timely and adequate information on these scores to countries would then be essential.

Maintaining flexibility for greater cost-effective-ness is indispensable. To date, experience has shown a disconnect between nationally owned priorities and GEF strategic priorities in develop-ing the pipeline, which causes delays, frustration, and lack of access. The GEF cannot expect to pro-vide one pot of funds to increase flexibility and cost-effectiveness, and then remove flexibility by deciding where and on what those funds should be spent. Synergies are not achieved merely by pool-ing funds from different focal areas together. For increased effectiveness, the GEF needs a vision or strategy on how such pooling should work within and among focal areas and at the country level.

noteTo obtain a comprehensive and reasonable geo-1. graphic classification for analytic purposes, the midterm review used different sources of classifi-cations, since those normally used do not cover all

Page 97: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

1. Main Conclusions and Recommendations 23

the GEF-eligible countries in a consistent manner. For example, the GEF uses only four regions for project classification, which excludes the World Bank’s Middle East and North Africa regional designation and UNDP’s Arab States designation, but includes various classification categories for constituencies. The classification system used by the midterm review combines the six World Bank geographic regions with eight constituency classi-fications from the GEF:

Sub-Saharan Africa, split into the constituen- zcies of East and Southern Africa and of West and Central Africa

Two World Bank Asia regions—East Asia and zthe Pacific and South Asia, split into the con-stituencies of Asia and of the Pacific SIDS

Europe and Central Asia (called Europe and the zCommonwealth of Independent States)

Latin America and the Caribbean, split into zthe constituencies of Latin America and of the Caribbean

Middle East and North Africa z

See Statistical Annex #4, “Country Classification and RAF Allocations,” table 6.

Page 98: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

24

2. Purpose and Methodology

This chapter presents the purpose and methodol-ogy of the midterm review, as well as its limita-tions. See also Technical Paper #1, “Methodology and Context.”

2.1 BackgroundIn September 2005, the GEF Council

agreed to implement, for the GEF-4 replenishment (2006–10), a resource allocation framework based on an index of a country’s potential to generate global environmental benefits in the biodiversity and climate change focal areas and an index of performance.1

The establishment of the RAF was a response to the policy recommendations of the third replen-ishment, which requested

the GEF Secretariat to work with the Council to estab-lish a system for allocating scarce GEF resources within and among focal areas with a view toward maximizing the impact of these resources on global environmental improvements and promoting sound environmental policies and practices worldwide (GEF 2002f).

Nominally, the RAF began with the fourth replen-ishment period of the GEF Trust Fund, on July 1, 2006; official implementation began in February 2007 when GEF-4 became effective.

The GEF Council asked the GEF Evaluation Office to review the RAF after two years of implemen-tation in order to examine operational experi-ence to date. According to the terms of reference

approved by the Council and based on extensive consultation with GEF stakeholders and incor-poration of Council comments,2 the objective of this midterm review was to “evaluate the degree to which resources have been allocated to countries in a transparent and cost-effective manner based on global environmental benefits and country performance” (GEF 2007j).

The Council also asked the Office to consider the feasibility of using indicators from the UN system and to evaluate the weight of governance within the World Bank’s country environmental policy and institutional assessment (CEPIA) indicator. The GEF Assembly in Cape Town (August 2006) underscored the importance of the midterm review of the RAF in identifying the impacts of the new allocation system and of informing the Council of the lessons learned. Some delegations requested that the review examine the balance and interrelationship between the GEF performance and benefits indexes.

2.2 Key Questions and scope The midterm review aims to address three subobjectives:

To evaluate the extent to which the RAF z design facilitates maximum impact of scarce GEF resources to enhance global environmental benefits

Page 99: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

2. Purpose and Methodology 25

To assess the extent to which the early imple- z

mentation of the RAF is providing countries with predictability and transparency as well as enhancing country-driven approaches to improve the potential for delivery of global environmental benefits

To compare the design and implementation of z

the RAF with the resource allocation systems of other multilateral agencies

Standard evaluation criteria of relevance, efficiency, and effectiveness were used to assess the RAF.

Detailed subquestions of the midterm review are included in the terms of reference. Issues con-sidered include such design aspects as relevance of the indicators, volatility, weights of indicators in the indexes, interrelationships and synergies, incentives, flexibility, and exclusions to the allo-cation formula. Regarding RAF implementation, the review has considered guidelines and support, policies, the group allocation, country-driven approaches and ownership, roles and interrela-tionships, historical comparison, barriers to and promoting factors for access to funds, the proj-ect pipeline and the nature of projects, effect on enabling activities and global and regional proj-ects, the SGP, NGOs and civil society, LDCs and SIDS, and the 50 percent rule. In the area of con-textual issues, the review researched new practices in PBA frameworks, convention guidance, and recent scientific developments and databases.

2.3 Methodology The midterm review was managed and executed by the GEF Evaluation Office, with assistance from independent expert consultants and companies. The Office followed a mixed-method approach comprising desk reviews, interviews, statistical analysis, surveys, expert panel judgments, port-folio analysis, and stakeholder consultations. For this purpose, material was analyzed using

ATLAS.ti qualitative data analysis software. Sup-porting technical papers and statistical annexes detailing the use and results of these methods are available on the GEF Evaluation Office Web site.3

Document ReviewTo establish the underlying goals and expectations of the RAF, the midterm review began by looking at the policy framework. The review codified hun-dreds of Council documents and all joint sum-maries on the RAF and related subjects, reports from the working group and inter-Agency task force, guidance from the global conventions, GEF Assembly documents, and all written comments received during the RAF development process. Information was also obtained from consultations during other evaluations such as that examining the GEF’s catalytic role, impact evaluation field vis-its, and terminal evaluation verification missions.

In addition, information from internal and exter-nal sources was reviewed covering topics related to the design and implementation of the RAF. The literature review included findings from such recently completed evaluations as the Joint Evalu-ation of the GEF Small Grants Programme; the Joint Evaluation of the GEF Activity Cycle and Modalities; the country portfolio evaluations of Costa Rica, the Philippines, and Samoa, and the four Africa country portfolio evaluations. Reports from subregional workshops and National Dia-logue workshops from 2006 to 2008 were also reviewed. The bibliography to this report lists all the documents reviewed for this evaluation. Issues of design are covered in more detail in Techni-cal Paper #2, “Design of the RAF,” and Technical Paper #4, “Implementation of the RAF.”

Delphi ApproachThree panels of independent international experts on global biodiversity, climate change, and perfor-mance provided an assessment of the GEF indexes

Page 100: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

26 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

via a Delphi study. The study was contracted, on a competitive basis, to the company World Perspec-tives, Inc. Using a Web-based interactive tool, Real Time Delphi, the expert panels anonymously pro-vided both quantitative and qualitative review of the indexes. The participants in the Delphi study covered a broad range of expertise and geographi-cal representation, and were vetted for indepen-dence to prevent conflicts of interest. The GEF STAP supported the Delphi study through the provision of advice and experts. The study report is available in Technical Paper #5, “Delphi Study of the RAF Benefits and Performance Indexes.”

Portfolio ReviewThe midterm review team designed and compiled a number of databases to analyze the effect of the RAF on the GEF portfolio. The project database compiled by the recent Joint Evaluation of the GEF Activity Cycle and Modalities was used as a base-line for historical data. The data from the Project Management Information System had already been corroborated with the Agencies; these cover all recorded full- and medium-size projects and proposals processed by the GEF (1,926 in total), as well as enabling activities, across all GEF replen-ishment periods through the end of GEF-3. To capture data needed for the RAF review, the data-base was extended with the following.

A z RAF project database was established to include the portfolio of approved projects and PIFs since the start of GEF-4. All data were obtained directly from GEF Secretariat data-base downloads and were subsequently verified with the Agencies, countries, and Secretariat staff. The respective country profile Web site and RAF progress reports to the Council were also used for verification. The RAF database contains the same fields as the baseline data-base, with added features on programmatic approaches, allocation type, and the new project

cycle. All information is up to date as of July 3, 2008, the midpoint of GEF-4; any changes after that are provided in textual form. Details are available in Technical Paper #3, “RAF Alloca-tions and Utilization,” and Statistical Annex #2, “Portfolio Analysis and Historical Allocations.”

A z country analysis component was created to analyze the effect of the RAF on various coun-tries, using international country classification categories such as LDCs, SIDS, landlocked countries, income per capita, and fragile and post-conflict states. This classification is fea-tured in Statistical Annex #4, “Country Classi-fication and RAF Allocations.”

A separate Excel spreadsheet was established z

comparing the baseline database to the present—that is, to the pipeline at the end of GEF-3, the proposals made by countries in the teleconferences with the GEF Secretariat, and the current pipeline and approvals.

historical Time-series AnalysisThe effect of the RAF on GEF operations was analyzed through a quantitative comparison with historical commitments and previous imple-mentation arrangements. Quantitative data were analyzed for all projects approved under GEF-4, according to relevant dimensions such as indi-vidual or group allocation, region, operational program, Agency, project budget, and modality. Other focal areas were included to identify any spill-over effects and for comparison.

statistical Analysis and Data ModelingThe effectiveness of the indexes, their compo-sition, and their interrelations were analyzed through data modeling of different combinations of index weights, exclusions, and content. Based on the original indicator data provided by the GEF Secretariat, the midterm review team verified accuracy by replicating the allocations through

Page 101: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

2. Purpose and Methodology 27

the formula. The simulations covered include the effect of the various exclusions on the allocations and of different levels of exclusions, and the impli-cations for allocations when changing formula weights of performance or global environmental benefits or floors and ceilings. Details are available in Statistical Annex #1, “Simulations,” and Statisti-cal Annex #3, “Quintile Analysis.”

Financial AnalysisA tentative assessment was made of GEF opera-tional and administrative costs, including original investment costs of the RAF; cost of operation; and possible savings in terms of time, effort, or money. Data were obtained from the corporate budget, transactions in the administrative system of the World Bank for the GEF Trust Fund, and admin-istrative review of Agency expenses and of project fees from the portfolio analysis. The review also obtained financial data from the GEF Trustee.

stakeholder ConsultationStakeholder consultation for the midterm review was extensive. Semistructured and focus group interviews were undertaken with a large num-ber of key informants including all GEF entities referred to in the GEF Instrument. The stake-holders interviewed included GEF operational and political focal points, other relevant national government stakeholders, convention secretariats, Agency staff, GEF project staff, and NGOs. Inter-view protocols were developed to be used with different target groups. Consultations covered a range of experiences and perspectives, from those countries with significant individual allocations to those with a group allocation. Feedback on imple-mentation was compared with information gath-ered through portfolio analysis and documenta-tion review. The data from these interviews were aggregated using ATLAS.ti software to enable identification of recurring and divergent opinions across interviewees from different countries.

To capture a broad range of experiences, the Eval-uation Office took advantage of numerous oppor-tunities for consultations. Collaboration with the GEF Country Support Programme enabled the Office to obtain direct feedback from GEF focal points on the RAF. The RAF midterm review was the main item of discussion during five sub-regional workshops in 2007–08 in Bali, Belgrade, Douala, Manila, and Windhoek. Both plenary sessions and group work elicited debate among countries on barriers and promoting factors. Indi-vidual interviews with focal points provided in-depth country information. This covered the full constituencies of Europe and the Commonwealth of Independent States, Asia, West and Central Africa, East and Southern Africa, and the Middle East and North Africa.

For constituencies that were not covered by Country Support Programme workshops in the review period, the Evaluation Office consulted through other means of interaction, including National Dialogue workshops in Colombia and Peru, the meeting of the Caribbean GEF constitu-ency in April 2008 in the Bahamas, and bilateral meetings. In addition, the review team under-took a mission to Argentina, Chile, and Uruguay in May 2008 to consult with focal points, Agen-cies, and NGOs. The Pacific SIDS were consulted at the subregional meeting in September 2008, as well as through interviews conducted during the GEF Council meeting and consultations with the South Pacific Regional Environment Programme in Samoa. The New York–based focal points were also invited to provide feedback.

The Evaluation Office participated in the Confer-ences of the Parties (COPs) to the Convention on Biological Diversity (CBD) and the United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change (UNFCCC) in Bonn and Bali, respectively, and arranged consultations and side events to obtain

Page 102: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

28 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

feedback. A survey was also circulated in Bonn. The secretariats to the two conventions were visited.

A separate study of the SGP was undertaken, based on the 2007 joint evaluation of the pro-gram. This study included a separate and tailored survey for SGP national coordinators, a discus-sion session at an Asia regional SGP workshop, consultations with the SGP Central Programme Management Team, and interviews with OFPs and national coordinators. A download of annual monitoring report data allowed the review team to discern the impact of the RAF on the SGP grant portfolio. Documentation was analyzed from the SGP and the GEF, including all SGP country strategies for the use of RAF funds. See Technical Paper #6, “Effects of the RAF on the Small Grants Programme.”

During the NGO consultations prior to the GEF Council meetings in November 2007 and April 2008, the Evaluation Office briefed and consulted with the NGO Network. Separate meetings to provide feedback were arranged with both local and international NGOs, and a dedicated survey instrument was developed. Interviews with local NGOs were undertaken during country visits and subregional meetings.

Interviews with all Agencies, including GEF coor-dinators, task managers, regional offices, and PBA experts, provided feedback on implementation, the GEF portfolio, and changes in responsibilities. Seven Agencies were visited—the World Bank, UNDP, UNEP, IDB, ADB, and the African Devel-opment Bank (AfDB); for the remaining three Agencies, GEF coordinators and staff were inter-viewed directly or through teleconferences and videoconferences.

surveyAn electronic survey of all major GEF stakeholders was conducted through www.surveymonkey.com

during June–July 2008 and yielded experiences and perceptions from 689 respondents. Current and past stakeholders include Implementing and Executing Agency staff, national governments, STAP roster experts, GEF operational and politi-cal focal points, international NGOs, national and local NGOs, convention national focal points, the private sector, GEF Council members, STAP members, state and local governments, the GEF Secretariat, the convention secretariats, and oth-ers (consultants and so on). Survey instruments were tailored to each group. Respondents were identified through a mix of Evaluation Office and Secretariat contact databases, contacts made dur-ing the Joint Evaluation of the GEF Activity Cycle and Modalities, and Agency and NGO Networks. See Technical Paper #7, “Stakeholder Survey.”

Comparative studyThe midterm review included an external com-parison of the design and implementation expe-rience of the RAF with that of other PBA frame-works. Visits were undertaken to the World Bank Group, the Caribbean Development Bank (CDB), IDB, AfDB, and ADB, as well as consul-tations with IFAD. The exercise encompassed expert interviews and reviews of numerous documents from the multilateral development banks, the Development Assistance Committee of the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD), the UN, the GEF and its Implementing and Executing Agencies, and other global funds. Several evaluations of these resource allocation frameworks had recently been conducted and provided useful lessons for the RAF midterm review. Input from the PBA Technical Working Group, a collaborative annual meeting on PBA experiences, was also informa-tive. See Technical Paper #8, “Comparison of the GEF RAF with Other Performance-Based Alloca-tion Systems.”

Page 103: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

2. Purpose and Methodology 29

The GEF Secretariat supported the Evaluation Office by making available information on the design and implementation of the RAF and of data related to progress in implementation. On com-pletion of the draft report and technical papers, the Evaluation Office sought comments from all GEF stakeholders including the GEF Secretariat, country recipients, the STAP, the convention sec-retariats, NGOs, and Agencies.

2.4 scope and limitations Evaluations conducted at midterm primarily assess progress made in implementation and make recommendations to better achieve underlying objectives. The recommendations of this review should therefore enable the GEF Council to make informed decisions for improving RAF implemen-tation in the second half of GEF-4 and in designing and developing a GEF-wide RAF by 2010.

Because RAF implementation is in its early stages, with the first work program under the RAF approved by the GEF Council only in June 2007, it is too soon to provide evidence regarding the impact of the RAF on global and country envi-ronmental benefits. However, it was possible to identify and address preliminary effects related to country drivenness, predictability, transparency, organizational and institutional arrangements, and project and portfolio changes. When coun-tries have not been able to access RAF resources, the review addressed the reasons for this. This limitation of not being able to identify impact is usual for a midterm review or formative evalua-tion focused on system activities and processes that are under implementation.

The review was able to compare the previous sys-tem with the new RAF-based system in terms of commitments, roles and responsibilities, the port-folio, and related processes. However, because several policies and practices have changed during

GEF-4 for reasons unrelated to the RAF, it is not possible to attribute all system changes to the new allocation framework. A measure of attribution was achieved by comparing effects across focal areas not covered by the RAF; note, however, that in many cases the RAF has acted in conjunction with other reforms and changes are still ongoing.

Fewer experts participated in the Delphi study than initially anticipated. In declining to par-ticipate, potential panelists cited the complexity of the RAF system and their lack of knowledge. Nevertheless, all three panels obtained a reason-ably broad composition in terms of expertise and representation. The overall response rate to the electronic survey was satisfactory, but—again due to the complexity of the subject—not all respon-dents in different stakeholder groups were able to reply to each question. Consequently, results are here generally presented in terms of aggregate responses rather than by stakeholder group.

Cost-effectiveness was addressed by considering findings on questions of effectiveness and on effi-ciency (related to time, effort, and cost). The com-parative review of experiences and lessons of other allocation frameworks provided some insight into cost-effectiveness. However, it is too early to make a firm pronouncement on this aspect.

2.5 Follow-UpSeveral substantive and evaluative tasks and ini-tiatives derive from or are related to the midterm review of the RAF.

The Council decided that the RAF will undergo a second independent review at the same time as, or as part of, OPS4. This will allow the Evaluation Office to follow up on RAF aspects that are cur-rently still evolving and for which further research is needed. As of this writing, OPS4 is in an early stage of its implementation; a draft report will be presented to the Council at the end of 2009.

Page 104: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

30 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

The policy recommendations for GEF-4 note that the GEF Secretariat and the GEF Evaluation Office should, on a pilot basis, monitor and report on trends in countries’ GEF benefits indexes under the RAF drawing on country portfolio evaluations and other relevant evaluations that will take place in the coming years (GEF 2006i, annex A).

The recommendations also state that

Taking into account (i) the findings of the midterm review, (ii) the progress of developing indicators for the other focal areas, and (iii) subsequent decisions by the Council, the Secretariat will implement a GEF-wide RAF by 2010, if feasible (GEF 2006i, annex A).

Based on the experience with the two focal areas during the first GEF-4 period, the midterm review provides lessons that may help the GEF partner-ship in moving forward on the possible expansion of the RAF.

notesThe full Council decision is contained in GEF 1. (2005m), annex I.

The terms of reference are available on the GEF 2. Evaluation Office Web site at www.thegef.org/ gefevaluation.aspx?id=18468; also see Technical Paper #1, “Methodology and Context,” annex A.

www.thegef.org/gefevaluation.aspx?id=22712.3.

Page 105: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

31

3. Context of the RAF

This chapter looks to place the development of the RAF, and its review, in the context of broader trends and reforms related to results, other resource allocation frameworks, and changes within and outside the GEF. It describes the objectives of the RAF, its origin and evolution, and key factors that have influenced its design and implementation.

3.1 origins and objectives

inceptionAt each replenishment of the GEF Trust Fund, the donors meet to make policy recommendations and strategic guidance for the next programming period. These recommendations are considered by the General Assembly of all GEF participat-ing countries every four years. Subsequently, the GEF Council adopts these recommendations and provides direction to the GEF Secretariat and GEF Agencies, which operationalize the decisions. The concept of a PBA system for the GEF stems from the GEF-3 negotiations.

The GEF RAF was adopted by the GEF Council at a special meeting in Cape Town in September 2006, as part of its endorsement of the policy rec-ommendations of the third replenishment. The RAF is defined as

… a system for allocating resources to countries in a transparent and consistent manner based on global environmental priorities and country capacity, policies

and practices relevant to successful implementation of GEF projects (GEF 2005c).

Apart from allocating resources based on speci-fied parameters, no explicit goals were directly assigned to the RAF by Council decision. Objec-tives are contained in the policy recommenda-tions of the third replenishment adopted by the GEF’s 32 donors, which requested

… a system for allocating scarce GEF resources within and among focal areas with a view towards maximizing the impact of these resources on global environmental improvements and promoting sound environmental policies and practices worldwide (GEF 2002f).

These objectives are in line with those of PBA systems in other development organizations. The intent is to move away from opaque systems of allocating funds that were heavily influenced by precedent and myriad other considerations toward a rules-based system that is fully transparent because it is determined by a formula with stated variables and weights. The choice of formula has two subobjectives: (1) to place funds where they are likely to be effective and (2) to give all member countries an incentive to improve.

Premises and expectationsThe approval of the RAF was the culmination of a laborious process of design and debate spanning more than four years. During this process, stake-holders and the GEF governing structures estab-lished several premises to underlie the RAF:

Page 106: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

32 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Consistency. z The system should be consistent with the GEF Instrument, the environmen-tal conventions for which the GEF is a finan-cial mechanism, the policy recommendations of the third replenishment, Council decisions from the October 2002 meeting, and the Bei-jing Assembly Declaration.

Principles. z “Simplicity, transparency, pragma-tism, cost-effectiveness, comprehensiveness, country-drivenness, and equal opportunity for all recipient countries to have access to GEF resources” were to be taken into account in developing options for the framework (GEF 2003c, 2004d). Further, the framework should serve as “a transparent, equitable and inclusive system for the allocation of resources within the GEF” (GEF 2005m).

Uniqueness. z The system should reflect “the unique nature of the GEF, its mandate to pro-vide financing for incremental costs of achiev-ing global environmental benefits, and its role as a financial mechanism of the global environ-mental conventions” (GEF 2003c).

Good governance. z “[S]uccess in meeting the objectives of the GEF is based on good gover-nance related to environmental sustainability within each country and at the international level” (GEF 2005m).

The RAF was expected to yield additional advan-tages as well, including the following:

Increase the impact of GEF resources on the z

global environment through better targeting

Provide countries with increased predictability z

in the financing available from the GEF

Provide a framework for countries to program z

resources in accordance with national priorities

Enhance transparency by specifying a well- z

defined and publicly disclosed method for allo-cating GEF resources

Strengthen each country’s ability to ensure that z

GEF financing is based on country priorities and reflects guidance from the international environmental conventions for which the GEF serves as the financial mechanism

Duration and CoverageNeither the GEF-3 policy recommendations nor the Second Assembly placed a time limit on the duration of a PBA system. The GEF Coun-cil agreed to implement the RAF for the GEF-4 replenishment, and asked for a midterm review and a second independent review in conjunction with OPS4. While this seems to imply a specific period for the RAF, other decisions refer to expan-sion of the system.

The GEF-3 replenishment policy recommenda-tions and the Second Assembly also did not ini-tially specify coverage of the RAF. During devel-opment of the RAF design, it became clear that it was difficult to identify satisfactory indexes for all focal areas. Consequently, the Council agreed to implement the RAF in GEF-4 for the biodiversity and climate change focal areas only, tasking the Secretariat with developing a GEF-wide RAF by 2010, if feasible (GEF 2006i, annex A).

ConcernsSeveral concerns were raised during the RAF development and approval process involving risks or potential disadvantages that might jeop-ardize achievement of its underlying purpose. These concerns can be generally categorized as follows:1

Vulnerability. z Stakeholders were concerned about the impact and potential negative con-sequences of the RAF on smaller, vulnerable countries; SIDS; regional programs; and coun-tries with poor capacity as these would be com-peting for limited resources under the RAF.

Page 107: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 33

Transparency. z Council members cited “the lack of importance given to marine resources in the biodiversity indicator, and the lack of trans-parency over the criteria used,” and asked that “work be done to more comprehensively take into account countries’ vulnerabilities, national priorities and natural resources, both marine and terrestrial.” They also noted that the “lack of public disclosure in [the] RAF means that the GEF will no longer be fully transparent.” The conventions also expressed concern over the lack of transparency.

Efficiency. z Several Council members voiced their concern that the RAF would “result in complication of GEF operations, aside from [a] permanent increase in transaction costs” and pointed out that the RAF “does not ensure the cost-effectiveness of the GEF's activities but leads to increasing bureaucracy; and that it is not sufficiently flexible to respond to changing circumstances.”

Selectivity. z The RAF was deemed “exclusion-ary,” in that “it lacks incentives for those consid-ered to be low performers” and “does not reflect the necessity of universal participation.”

Funding. z Many of the participants at the third replenishment meeting “expressed concern over individual donors placing unilateral con-ditions on their contributions.”

Benefits. z Council members found “the prom-ised benefits of [the] RAF to be elusive” and noted their concern “that this jeopardizes the quality of GEF projects due to very low thresh-olds for a number of countries.” They also men-tioned that they were “still unclear as to the real impact that the implementation of this pro-posed RAF will have on our countries.”

Results. z Donors, recipient countries, and other GEF entities generally agreed that improved results-based management (RBM) was desir-

able for the GEF. In May 2004, the Council “underscored the need to ensure that the per-formance based framework serves as an incen-tive for enhanced performance in achieving global environmental objectives.”

Convention commitments. z UNFCCC and CBD representatives expressed concern regard-ing how the RAF would affect funding available to developing countries, especially LDCs and SIDS, for implementation of their commit-ments under the conventions, raising the pos-sibility that the RAF would “undermine the ability of developing countries” to meet their commitments.

3.2 organizational and institutional Context The development and implementation of the RAF have taken place over a period marked by many other changes and reforms, within sustainable development assistance as a whole and within the individual GEF entities themselves. These changes have influenced the RAF’s design and implemen-tation; and, in conjunction with the RAF, have in turn affected the GEF partnership. The trends sum-marized below provide a rationale, explanations for decisions, and attribution of changes to the RAF.

external Context and Trends

Performance-Based Allocation Systems

The GEF RAF reflects a growing emphasis on PBA systems for international financial institu-tions. The World Bank has operated a PBA system for its IDA concessional funds since 1977, while AfDB started its PBA in 1999. The other multi-lateral development banks launched PBA systems in 2000 (CDB), 2001 (ADB), 2002 (IDB), and 2005 (IFAD), concurrent with the development of the RAF for the GEF. There is a technical working group focusing on PBA systems, of which many

Page 108: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

34 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

GEF Agencies and the GEF Secretariat are mem-bers; the group meets annually and will enable the GEF to draw lessons from the experience of other organizations.

Results-Based Management

The emphasis on PBA is linked to effective RBM within development aid organizations and the GEF. RBM is an organizational management strategy of which allocations may form a part. A PBA system and RBM are not conditional on one another, but a good RBM system can enhance the achievement of results that a PBA aims to promote. Many GEF Agencies have long had RBM systems with regu-lar planning and reporting on results, as found by a study by the GEF Evaluation Office.2 The Joint Evaluation of the GEF Activity Cycle and Modali-ties found that “While the GEF has started taking note of the work done by the OECD DAC [Devel-opment Assistance Committee] Joint Venture on Managing for Development Results, overall, it has not been sufficiently involved in the RBM work of partner Agencies” (GEF EO 2007d). The call for RBM in the GEF started with the GEF-3 replenishment negotiations, which encouraged improved organizational performance, strategic priorities, and targets. The targets for the GEF-4 replenishment period will be influenced by RAF implementation. The Council approved a frame-work for RBM in the GEF in June 2007, for which development is still ongoing.

The United Nations has also promoted RBM for some time,3 mainly focusing on internal organiza-tional issues, and UN entities have implemented various ways to provide funding to countries based on needs and performance. For example, UNDP has had a type of incentive-based allocation sys-tem in place since 1997. At the beginning of each programming cycle, TRAC-1 (target for resource assignments from the core) resources are allocated based on the latest gross national income (GNI)

per capita and population data. Fifty percent of programmable resources (TRAC-2) are kept for incentive and performance-based allocations. The TRAC-2 resource facility allows for flexibility in allocating resources to high-impact, high-leverage activities and to reward program quality.

Simplification and Harmonization

The development community and the environ-mental convention COPs are increasingly empha-sizing simplification and harmonization of devel-opment efforts. Under the 2005 Paris Declaration, over 100 ministers, heads of agencies, and other senior officials worldwide committed their coun-tries and organizations to continue to increase efforts in harmonization, alignment, and manag-ing aid for results with a set of actions and indica-tors that can be monitored. The GEF and its RAF are not wholly congruent with international sim-plification/harmonization goals and trends. On the one hand, the RAF may be seen as a means of harmonizing with other PBA systems of inter-national financial institutions. On the other hand, the GEF has lagged behind other entities in the simplification, innovation, and harmonization of operational modalities through which allocations are used. The GEF does not apply new delivery modalities that stress increased national owner-ship such as budget support. Though improve-ments have been made, there is consensus among stakeholders that the GEF still has much to do in the area of simplification. As a partnership work-ing through many Agencies, harmonization is especially relevant to the GEF.

It is as yet unclear how the RAF will affect, or be affected by, UN reforms and the move toward the “UN-as-one.”4 A PBA is not currently part of this reform, but indicative grants viewed more or less as entitlements could allow easier integration into joint UN programming. The RAF has not made use of UN-based analytical tools such as the Com-

Page 109: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 35

mon Country Assessment or the UNDP Human Development Index.

The GEF Secretariat has started to cooperate with similar funds through its participation in the Global Programs Learning Group.5 The group’s recent paper, prepared for the High Level Forum on Aid Effectiveness in Accra in September 2008, notes that “The GEF sees itself evolving to become more country friendly while guarding its global priorities, with the evolution driven by its man-agement, its replenishment and governance pro-cess, and its evaluation system” (Learning Group of Global Programs on Aid Effectiveness n.d.).

Increased Competition for Funding

The RAF was introduced at a time of increasing competition for funding amid a growing realiza-tion that the level of resources is insufficient to meet needs. The Monterrey Consensus of the 2002 United Nations International Conference on Financing for Development noted the importance of addressing systemic issues, and of enhancing the coherence and consistency of the interna-tional monetary, financial, and trading systems in support of development. Meanwhile, the collapse of World Trade Organization trade negotiations “… gave way to resignation that a shift in the global economic hierarchy had darkened the prospect any time soon of a new accord to further open markets” (Castle and Bradsher 2008).

Most official development assistance (ODA) has been centered around the United Nations Millen-nium Declaration (2000) and its eight Millennium Development Goals to be achieved by 2015 or 2020, marking the first time that a holistic strat-egy to meet the development needs of the world was established. Consequently, much ODA and country programming have been aligned behind poverty strategies. The GEF mandate relates to Millennium Development Goal 7: To promote

environmental sustainability, with targets to inte-grate the principles of sustainable development into country policies and programs, and reduce biodiversity loss by 2010. The GEF does not have a mandate on poverty; in fact, during the discus-sions on RAF design, it was suggested that in tak-ing into account

… the Council’s guidance to consider the poverty indi-cator, it is our judgment that it would not be appropri-ate for the GEF framework given that there are several other multilateral institutions that focus on poverty, while GEF is the only institution that focuses on the global environment (GEF 2004c).

OECD recently surveyed aid allocation policies in an effort to determine the predictability of deliver-ing on global commitments. It found that coun-try programmable aid was $60 billion in 2005, the baseline year. Some $47 billion of this was from bilateral donors, equal to 46 percent of their gross bilateral ODA. The survey results show that so far country programmable aid “is programmed to increase by 2010 by nearly $12 billion over 2005 … Recent record replenishments of IDA and the African and Asian Development Banks will add around a further $4 billion of ODA to this fig-ure in 2010…” (OECD DCD-DAC 2008c).

The emphasis on funding needs has spread to environment areas and conventions. At the Ninth Meeting of the CBD COP in May 2008, it was pointed out that “African countries experience huge funding gaps at all levels in addressing the needs for achieving the three objectives of the Convention. The resource allocation framework has simply worsened this situation” (Namibia 2008). The COP pointed to the need for “a full assessment of the amount of funds needed for the implementation of the Convention for the sixth replenishment period of the Trust Fund of the GEF” (UNCBD 2008a, Decision IX/14). Mean-while, the GEF Secretariat has been working to

Page 110: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

36 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

support the convention secretariat on a resource mobilization strategy (UNCBD 2008c).

The changing context is especially notable in the area of climate change. A recent study from the OECD Development Centre pointed out that

International development finance has evolved into a complex system with emerging actors, both private and public, raising sources by using new instruments and channels. Rather than the scaling up of program-mable aid resources, there is a scaling up of the num-ber of aid providers (Reisen 2008).

On July 2, 2008, the World Bank Board gave for-mal approval to create Climate Investment Funds designed to scale up funding to help develop-ing countries in their efforts to address climate change. Total funding for the Climate Invest-ment Funds is expected to be between $5 billion and $10 billion.6 ADB also recently established a large climate change fund with an initial contri-bution of $40 million. Based on COP resolutions, the emphasis on adaptation to climate change is finally receiving due attention, and funds are being established for this purpose.7 However,

This multitude of actors and financing channels, com-bined with the broadening goals of traditional devel-opment assistance (which now also include global and regional public goods) make up an international devel-opment finance architecture which can be character-ized as spontaneous disorder, or a non-system (Reisen 2008).

With increasing competition for funds, the GEF is challenged to become more effective in providing a sufficient levels of funds in an efficient manner.

The GEF is a financial mechanism for several environmental conventions and was established as a facility (GEF 1994). Given its dual nature as a financial mechanism for the environment, the Council and governing structures have always been represented by ministries of finance and of the environment. The development of the RAF

mirrored these differing perspectives, as does the RAF itself.

The GEF is not a development bank. While the GEF Instrument does not prohibit loans, the GEF provides grant financing only. The operational guidelines on nongrant instruments established that “In the GEF context, all eligible countries are entitled to receive grants” (GEF 2008j). The recent GEF policy (April 2008) on nongrant instru-ments envisages that the use of such instruments directly or indirectly will be “primarily linked to investment projects” and that reflows should be reprogrammed to the benefit of the same coun-try. Loans are part of GEF projects, rather than the project being a loan that the government has to repay. In this regard, the GEF operates more like a UN organization than an international financial institution. Comparable global programs to the GEF do not operate through allocation systems like the RAF.

internal issues and other GeF Reforms

GEF Context

Development of the RAF coincided with the start of a new replenishment period (GEF-4) and the installation of a new GEF CEO. Policy changes and reforms related to these events have affected the RAF’s implementation. The CEO presented to the Council at the December 2006 meeting a sus-tainability compact consisting of five key elements (strategy, innovation, equity, accessibility, and focus) aimed at raising the impact of GEF invest-ments to a new level of results. Increased impact is also the intent underlying a number of other reforms. The main issues that have influenced RAF implementation include the following.

Revised focal area strategies. z Revised focal area strategies and new strategic programs for GEF-4 were approved in October 2007, more than a year after the RAF was launched. Both

Page 111: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 37

the timing of approval and the tighter scope of the focal areas from GEF-3 to GEF-4 have affected the pipeline and access to funding under the RAF. Both in biodiversity and climate change, the strategic long-term objectives have moved up to a higher level: for example, from attention to protected areas to protected area systems and to market transformation in the climate change area. In climate change, there has been a move toward energy efficiency (in industry and buildings) and on-grid renewable energy. Some areas are no longer key priorities, while other priorities are new. The four focal areas outside the RAF scope—some of which are relatively new—have also gained momen-tum in terms of demand for resources.

New areas of work. z The GEF was invited to provide secretariat services to the Board of the Adaptation Fund of the Kyoto Protocol at the most recent meeting held in Bali in December 2007 of the UNFCCC COP. Once operational, the new fund may benefit from the experi-ence of the GEF Strategic Pilot on Adaptation (launched in GEF-3 and carried over to the RAF) to support pilot and demonstration proj-ects for adaptation to climate change. The GEF also operates the Special Climate Change Fund and the LDC Fund, which remain outside the RAF. A new public-private partnership fund (the GEF Earth Fund) was approved in Decem-ber 2007, with IFC as the lead agency. The GEF was also asked to elaborate a strategic program to scale up investments in environmentally friendly technologies in mitigation and adapta-tion (UNCBD 2008a, Decision IX/14).

New project cycle. z The GEF project cycle has historically been a major bottleneck for access to GEF funds. Based on the findings of the Joint Evaluation of the GEF Activity Cycle and Modalities, the Council approved a new cycle in June 2007. This was first applied to the third

work program under GEF-4 in November 2007. It involves approval of a PIF by the CEO at an earlier stage of the cycle on a rolling basis. The project development facility (PDF) has been replaced with a more limited project prepara-tion grant. The new project cycle took time to put in place, and changes were introduced over time to templates and procedures for both MSPs and FSPs.

Programmatic approaches. z At its April 2008 meeting, the Council approved the use of pro-grammatic approaches, which had already gained momentum under GEF-3. Under the new policy, such programs are implemented through a number of projects, either in the same focal area, in different focal areas, or in multifocal projects. Agencies must first submit a PIF—called a program framework document—for the program and attach associated individual project PIFs concurrently or within a year.

Communications and outreach strategy. z A new strategy was approved by the Council in November 2007, which has led to a revised GEF Secretariat Web site, more attention to media and publicity, and active outreach to key stakeholders such as the convention secretari-ats. A barrier identified in several evaluations is the lack of transparency and information in the GEF, especially with regard to project management tracking of progress and status (GEF M&E Unit 2004; GEF EO 2006a, 2006b, 2007b, 2007d). In November 2005, the Council approved $700,000 in funding for the develop-ment of a new management information sys-tem, which was expected to be launched in October 2008.

Country portal. z In January 2008, the GEF Secretariat introduced a country portal pro-viding information on portfolio status. At first, information on pipeline status—the most rel-evant for RAF resource management—was

Page 112: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

38 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

limited in access and password protected, but the GEF Secretariat has since taken commend-able steps to make this information available to the Agencies. The system is not as yet able to report systematically on the 10-day response time for review or on the 22-month cycle. The lack of clear guidance was to be addressed by an Operations Manual, which was released in April 2008. The manual was supposed to be uploaded to the GEF Web site, but as of this writing, focal points must request a CD-ROM to be sent to them.

Restructured Secretariat. z To meet the new challenges of GEF-4, the GEF Secretariat has been restructured and has experienced con-siderable staff turnover. Three focal area teams have been merged into a natural resources team, and other teams have been reinforced (external affairs, climate change). About half of the staff has left and been replaced; a conflict resolu-tion commissioner has been appointed, and regional focal points created in some teams. The Secretariat has taken on additional tasks related to RAF implementation as well as port-folio monitoring under the 2006 GEF Monitor-ing and Evaluation Policy and the new RBM framework approved by the Council in June 2007.8 The STAP and the NGO Network have also reviewed their strategies and approaches.

GEF Partners

The GEF partners have been subject to consid-erable change under GEF-4. Following the 2006 Evaluation of the Experience of Executing Agen-cies under Expanded Opportunities in the GEF, these Agencies were put on an equal footing with the three GEF Implementing Agencies and granted direct access to GEF funding based on their com-parative advantages (GEF 2006g). These advan-tages were clarified to the Council in June 2007.

In addition to providing support on the RAF, the Agencies have met a variety of demands for sup-port or information from the GEF, including pro-viding increased support to corporate programs such as the SGP (by participating on the SGP Steering Committee), complying with the fidu-ciary standards approved by the Council in June 2007 (and on which the Agencies reported in April 2008), renegotiating financial procedures agree-ments with the GEF Trustee, reporting on efforts to mainstream global environmental challenges into core development work, and strengthening monitoring and evaluation systems. The Agencies must comply with new procedures on termination and cancellation of projects (December 2006), use of nongrant instruments (April 2008), templates and procedures for programmatic approaches through a program framework document (these are not covered by management fees); they were also recently asked to submit lessons learned forms from evaluations (August 2008).

In the interim, the corporate budget for Imple-menting Agencies was eliminated as of fiscal year 2008, as per the Council decision in December 2006, together with an increase in project cycle management fees to 10 percent applicable to all 10 GEF Agencies. In April 2008, the Council asked each GEF Agency to report annually on services provided and actual aggregated expenditures on corporate activities and project cycle manage-ment with breakdowns and lists of staff. Budgeting for projects has become more exacting, requiring new information on financial issues in the PIFs and with limitations on eligible budget items.

In the wake of the simplification of the project cycle, there has been a proliferation of related forms and documentation. In July 2008, the GEF Secretariat developed 100 or so internal formats and templates for project management that Sec-retariat staff, the GEF Agencies, and the GEF focal

Page 113: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 39

points must fill out at various points in the proj-ect cycle. In short, all Agencies are expected to do more, and those with small portfolios may not have sufficient funding to cover the costs. Where this proves to be difficult, the implementation of the RAF is affected.

3.3 evolution The evolution of the RAF can be divided into three periods: (1) development until approval, (2) plan-ning for implementation, and (3) implementation to midpoint reallocation. See Technical Paper #1, “Methodology and Context,” section 2.3, for a detailed timeline.

Phase 1: Development until Approval, 2002–August 2005The origin of the RAF stems from the third replenishment in 2002. It was introduced by the representative of the United States in the sixth and last negotiation meeting before the replenish-ment policy decisions were approved in August 2002. Replenishment participants asked that the GEF Secretariat prepare a proposal of an alloca-tion system for which implementation should be initiated immediately after a Council decision in May 2003. Furthermore, $70 million in additional financing of the record replenishment of $3 billion was made conditional upon approval of a PBA.

Initial Proposals

The May 2003 proposal was not able to develop a full-fledged PBA. It requested clarification from the Council on the framework’s overall objective and tried to interpret performance in the GEF context. It proposed two options: an a priori allo-cation to countries and a screening approach to projects. The first option was later chosen, but no decision was made at the meeting. A RAF Tech-nical Working Group was established to prepare elements of a PBA framework.

The working group, with 10 members nominated by Council constituencies as well as two PBA experts, started work in July 2003. The group’s report, presented at the November 2003 Coun-cil meeting, proposed a two-component system of performance and needs; it defined “needs,” for the first time, as the potential to deliver global environmental benefits. It also posited that a GEF-wide results framework would be difficult to develop, and recommended an immediate focus on the biodiversity and climate change focal areas. These two suggestions were milestones.

Nonetheless, the working group’s proposal of a phased development approach for a PBA was not adopted, nor was there agreement on the options presented. The United States sent Council mem-bers a letter in advance of the November 2003 meeting, commenting on the draft and warning that “… efforts are in substantial danger of becoming off-track” and “only Option 1 satisfies the requirements of the GEF-3 agreement” (Schuerch 2003). The let-ter reiterated the rationale for a PBA system:

Our strong belief is that these [PBA] systems bring greater effectiveness to international assistance pro-grams, by increasing analytical decision-making in allocation processes, by allocating resources where they will be better utilized, and by increasing the clar-ity and transparency of this decision-making for both donors and recipients.

At the meeting, the Council continued to request a GEF-wide system, based on global environmental priorities and country-level performance relevant to those priorities. Several key principles were estab-lished, together with a more realistic time frame which aimed for conclusion in November 2004. The working group was disbanded, and the GEF Secre-tariat continued development of the framework.

Introduction of Indexes and Group Allocations

At the May 2004 Council meeting, the Secretariat presented a comprehensive proposal with options

Page 114: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

40 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

on indicators, weights, and formulas for biodiver-sity and climate change. It had called on the World Bank’s Development Economics research group, which, alongside a number of international envi-ronmental NGOs, had worked assiduously on the effort, especially in biodiversity.

The Secretariat’s report proposed using perfor-mance indexes from Daniel Kaufmann, Aart Kraay, and Pablo Zoido-Lobatón of the World Bank Institute which cover six aggregate indicators for 199 countries. This recommendation was based on its argument that the World Bank’s country policy and institutional assessment (CPIA) indi-cators, although broader, are not fully disclosed; that the GEF would not have sufficient resources to develop its own data set; and that other sectoral indicators were not readily available. Although the Council rejected the Kaufmann, Kraay, and Zoido-Lobatón indexes, most of the Secretariat’s proposed elements were accepted; these are pres-ent, in an amended form, in the final version of the framework. Also, even though the Council decided that “consideration should be given to an indicator related to poverty and a country’s capacity to finance global environmental benefits by itself,” neither of these indicators were later included (GEF 2004d).

The Secretariat report discussed two models: ex ante allocation to countries, and a variation of this model in which five country groups (quintiles) each with similar needs and performance, would receive an equal share of resources and compete for funds within each group. This was the first time that a type of group allocation had been mentioned. The range of maximum and mini-mum amounts meant that the top-ranked country in the second quintile could hypothetically receive more than the lowest in the first quintile; this was not approved by key replenishment participants. Ultimately, both options—individual and group allocations—would be selected.

Further Refinements and Phased Approach

The complex subject seemed to call for another discussion format beyond Council meetings. A seminar was convened in Paris in September 2004, aimed at debating a more elaborated docu-ment on three models:

An individual country allocation model 1.

A country and group allocation model, with a 2. cap at $10 million for the individual countries and two separate group allocations

A rules-based model, with due diligence mea-3. sures to deal with performance issues

The second option was a compromise suggested by one donor (Canada) to satisfy the single mem-ber favoring the first option and others favoring the group approach. The third option was quickly ruled out. While one constituency favored the country allocation model, and several others were supportive of the country and group allocation model, still others asked the Secretariat to develop a model that would not allocate resources to coun-tries in an ex ante manner.9 One step forward was the confirmation that, legally, nothing in the GEF Instrument or the guidance of the global conven-tions prohibits or requires a performance-based framework. Another advance in the process was information provided by the GEF Secretariat on historical allocation shares to countries; to global, regional, and capacity-building projects; and to the SGP: “The historical allocations of the GEF are best represented by weights of 0.8 for potential environmental benefits and 1.0 for country perfor-mance for both the biodiversity and climate change focal areas” (GEF 2004a). However, this information caused the Bolivian representative to ask “If new models reflect historical allocations, why develop a new RAF based on different criteria?”

Based on the seminar discussions, the Secretariat proposed a phased approach at the November

Page 115: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 41

2004 Council consisting of an initial screening phase, a country/group allocation phase, and an exclusively country-based allocation phase (GEF 2004c, 2004e). This suggestion was not adopted, and the negotiations reached an impasse. For the first time in GEF history, the Council considered voting on an issue rather than reaching a consen-sus decision, and guidance on voting procedures had to be requested.

Compromises and Trade-offs

The written Council member comments received before the meeting had revealed divergent view-points.10 Most provided suggestions, but no pref-erence for particular options; several preferred the second option; and one representative preferred the first. At this point, the negotiations had split into three groups: the United States and Canada, Europe and Japan, and the Group of 77 (develop-ing countries). Three motions were tabled at the Council meeting with different views on process, conditions, and decision authority. While all three motions agreed on a screening phase, the start of this phase was not authorized at this point.

The year 2005 would be the decisive period in the RAF approval process. In early February 2005, a Heads of Agencies meeting resulted in commit-ment and support from the Implementing Agen-cies in obtaining agreement on the RAF. Up to this point, cooperation with the Agencies had been minimal in RAF development, although they had presented their practices related to performance and current allocation approaches to the 2003 working group.

At the second Paris consultations in March 2005, negotiations homed in on outstanding issues; specifically, the trigger to move the RAF beyond the screening phase, the content of the coun-try performance indicator, and the share of RAF resources between individual countries and group countries.

The discussions had by now moved to corridor diplomacy, with Council members continuing further discussions after March, with a view to taking a final decision on the RAF at the June 2005 Council meeting. In the interim, the GEF Secre-tariat produced six detailed technical notes on issues such as equations and weights, thresholds, public disclosure, and assessment of biodiversity and climate change benefits.11 The concept of energy intensity had been added to GHG emis-sions in the climate change index in response to concerns from several stakeholders, including the UNFCCC Secretariat. The note on thresholds ref-erenced a proposal made in the second option that 75 percent of resources go to individual countries, and additionally presented a simulation of shares of 48/52 percent and 62/38 percent for individual versus group country allocations (in biodiversity and climate change, respectively) with a cutoff (threshold) of $10 million. In the final approval, the thresholds would be dropped, and the 75 per-cent share would be selected.

No RAF decision was made at the June 2005 meeting, and the three pending motions were suspended given the unlikelihood of a double majority on any of these issues. Information was provided on one of the remaining contentious issues, namely disclosure of the CPIA, which had become publicly available in the interim, albeit for countries eligible for IDA funding only and not for borrowers from the International Bank for Recon-struction and Development (IBRD). Two con-stituencies expressed serious concerns in written statements on the RAF.12 The CEO stressed the need to reach final agreement at an extraordinary Council meeting in August 2005 if the replenish-ment meetings for GEF-4 were to go forward.

Accordingly, the Council approved the RAF in a special meeting from August 31 to September 1, 2005. The approved RAF document13 announced,

Page 116: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

42 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

for the first time, the eligible countries—148 in biodiversity and 160 in climate change—but as yet, no amounts. The various simulations may have enabled some countries to gain an idea of where they would stand in terms of allocations under the RAF and to participate in the negotia-tions accordingly.

Political compromises and trade-offs were appar-ent in the final RAF document. The proposed marine/terrestrial weighted score changed from 30/70 percent to 20/80 percent, thresholds were dropped and replaced with a 75/25 percent cut-off line between individual and group allocation countries, the weight of the portfolio performance indicator (PPI) decreased from 20 to 10 percent, and the weight of the CEPIA increased from 60 to 70 percent. One element, the 50 percent rule of resource use, was introduced in the document without prior analysis or discussion.

Discussion on country ceilings had not been raised since November 2004, when the GEF Secretariat noted that “country ceilings of approximately 7% [of the total focal area allocation given to a coun-try historically] in biodiversity and 20% in climate change will start to impact indicative country allo-cations” (GEF 2004a). Subsequently, the ceilings were fixed at 10 and 15 percent, respectively. The amounts for set-asides from the formula had also not been central in discussions. In the first Paris consultation, the Secretariat proposed 10 percent for the SGP and capacity building, and 12 percent for global and regional projects in each focal area. This was ultimately reduced to 5 percent each for SGP–capacity building and global-regional projects.

Ultimately, the RAF is the result of a political pro-cess. Its indicators and indexes are based on sci-entific work, but development of the other design parameters was based in strategic policy decisions. There is no explicit or clear precedent or practice

of what each weight, floor, or ceiling must be. Some of the challenges of developing such a com-plex framework for the first time would become apparent in implementation, and considerable work lay ahead to operationalize the decision.

Phase 2: Planning for implementation, August 2005–summer 2006The first discussions on actual RAF implementa-tion began in October 2005, with the initial meet-ing of the Inter-Agency RAF Task Force. This was the first time the GEF Agencies were invited offi-cially to consult on the framework.

Work of the RAF Task Force

Two challenges presented themselves: (1) opera-tional policies and procedures, and (2) disclosure of RAF data and allocations. On the latter issue, the GEF Secretariat requested agreement from the November 2005 Council meeting on some early disclosure of tentative allocations so Agen-cies and countries could prepare for the transi-tion to the RAF. Specific allocations were not yet determined, as the fourth replenishment negotia-tions were still in progress. However, for the first time, the Council presented tables that illustrated eligible countries in bands (ranges) of allocations, with likely countries in the group and individual allocations, and those on the cusp that might fall either way. The final allocation would prove to be relatively similar to this draft categorization.

The RAF Task Force addressed a number of issues that had not been considered thus far in the pro-cess, including meeting GEF-4 programming tar-gets developed in the replenishment, managing aggregate focal area resources and short-term imbalances in aggregate resources under the RAF, definition of global and regional projects and the lack of incentives to engage in such projects, and the need for criteria to determine eligibility for funding. The GEF focal area task forces also

Page 117: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 43

helped develop criteria to determine eligibility of concepts. Nevertheless, the discussions were ham-pered by a lack of clarity on the possible effects of the RAF. Hoping to help with interim disclo-sure and planning of country allocations, the task force’s main output was a set of guidelines to the GEF focal points in April 2006, after which it was disbanded.

Rollout

The year of the RAF’s launch and implementation, 2006, was marked by a flurry of letters, consulta-tions, changes, and decisions. Some decisions taken to manage the transition in this period were later overturned. In retrospect, some termed it “the lost year,” in that stakeholders lost the oppor-tunity to secure a strong transition to GEF-4 and the start of the RAF.

The CEO letter of March 7, 2006—the first of six letters during 2006—was the first announce-ment of the RAF to the majority of operational focal points. The CEO recommended that the focal points initiate a process of consultations to determine national funding priorities for the GEF. The May 4, 2006, guidelines provided preliminary amounts based on GEF-3 figures and lists of proj-ect concepts under preparation in the individual country. Countries were also encouraged to con-sider additional concepts in their consultation on priorities. By May 12, 2006, customized letters had been sent to the OFPs, requesting an initial list of endorsed project concepts by mid-September.

The main vehicle for support to the recipient gov-ernments on the RAF was a series of seven sub-regional workshops for focal points held between the end of April to August 2006 (three of these were held after the RAF’s official July 1 launch). At the workshops, the focal points expressed numer-ous concerns and questions, as well as frustration at being presented with a fait accompli, without

prior consultation. Most concerns were common across regions and mirror the implementation issues (see Technical Paper #4, “Implementation of the RAF”).

The global conventions had not been officially involved with the RAF during its development. But once it had been approved, they were formally briefed, with presentations made at the UNFCCC COP11 in November 2005 and the CBD COP in March 2006. Meanwhile, the GEF legal counsel and an independent study (Wiser 2006) provided a generally positive assessment of the conformity of the RAF with the GEF Instrument and guidance.

The first progress report on RAF implementation was presented at the June 2006 Council meeting. The Council asked the GEF Secretariat to ensure that countries would be informed about the pos-sibility of using their country allocations for the SGP, which had not been expressly covered in the guidelines to focal points. The Council was pre-sented with the largest work program in GEF his-tory, with 76 proposals amounting to $565 million for unused resources under GEF-3.

Phase 3: implementation to Midpoint Reallocation, July 1, 2006–July 1, 2008GEF-4 and RAF implementation officially began July 1, 2006, but in reality key parameters were not in place, as the third replenishment was only con-cluded at a special Council meeting at the end of August 2006, in conjunction with the third GEF Assembly in South Africa. The Assembly endorsed the replenishment policy recommendations but raised several concerns about the RAF’s impact.

In mid-September, the initial indicative allocations under the RAF were finalized and disclosed. The GEF Secretariat concurrently informed the Agen-cies that all concepts in the pipeline would have to be reviewed and “repipelined” in the context of the programming strategies.14

Page 118: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

44 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Pipeline Projects and Discussions

By the September 15, 2006, deadline for national priorities by OFPs, 55 countries had provided a prioritized list of projects for funding in GEF-4; these were not necessarily the same projects as were in the official pipeline. In August 2006, the new GEF CEO informed the focal points that the September deadline for endorsement of proj-ect concepts would apply only for proposals that might be considered for inclusion in a possible December 2006 work program (GEF CEO 2006d). Many OFPs had, however, prepared a full list as per the original instructions.

By October 2006, 75 countries had provided a detailed pipeline of project proposals with identi-fied GEF Agencies. The fourth CEO letter (GEF CEO 2006e) to focal points noted that “it is not clear how the proposals reflect national priorities, GEF strategies, and global environmental com-mitments,” as well as Agency comparative advan-tages, and that the GEF Secretariat would contact all countries for verification. Over the next six months, the GEF Secretariat therefore conducted teleconferences with 127 recipient countries, rep-resenting the first time the Secretariat had entered directly into pipeline discussions with countries. The Agencies were not part of the consultations, but were supposed to receive copies of the Secre-tariat letters summarizing the conclusions. These letters indicate Secretariat agreement/disagree-ment with the country proposals, suggestions to merge or reformulate, or no decision. The tele-conferences ultimately had a great effect on the pipeline.

New Activity Cycle and New Rules and Criteria

Another set of influential developments was the preparatory consultation on the evaluation of the GEF activity cycle and the evaluation of the expe-rience of the Executing Agencies, both of which were presented to the November 2006 Council.

Changes were introduced to make the playing field more level for the Agencies. Also, “the CEO clarified that there should be no formal agree-ments between the agencies and countries prior to CEO approval of a PIF. It was further requested by the CEO that the agencies not lobby countries or Council Members” (GEF 2006d).

At the December 2006 Council meeting, no work program was approved, as the GEF Trustee had not yet received sufficient contributions to make the fourth replenishment effective. The Council approved new rules and criteria for project selec-tion and cancellation, which were put into imme-diate effect, and, on the basis of which, the CEO rejected 115 proposals from the 2007 pipeline. These rejections and a list of the projects retained were documented in a letter from the CEO to the Agencies, which noted that “no agency should undertake formal discussion on a project proposal for GEF financing prior to approval of a PIF by the GEF” (GEF CEO 2006a). In the fifth letter to the focal points, the CEO provided detailed informa-tion on the project concepts that were omitted from the GEF pipeline, but stated that the “GEF is not permanently closed for those project concepts that have not been included” (GEF CEO 2006f).

Guidelines on the SGP were issued in Decem-ber 2006 from the CEO to focal points in new countries covering graduation strategy and limits of RAF use for the SGP. In their list of national pri-orities, several countries had indicated their desire to provide considerable funding to the SGP. The first SGP Steering Committee meeting had agreed on procedures for allocating resources, whereby the SGP core budget would be prioritized for group allocation countries and 23 new entrants to the SGP, while RAF individual country allocations would be capped at certain amounts.

In early February 2007, GEF-4 and the RAF finally became fully effective, and the extended GEF-3

Page 119: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 45

phase came to an end. The first full work program under the RAF was presented at the June 2007 Council meeting. By the next month, nine coun-tries had managed to fully use the first half of their allocations.15

summaryThe complex and protracted RAF development and transition process had a number of unin-tended effects, some of which have affected implementation. Primarily, the process had a neg-ative fallout in terms of reduced trust and dissat-isfaction among stakeholders. Participation and involvement in RAF design was uneven. The pro-cess did not fully include standard GEF partners: none of the GEF Agencies were actively involved before the approval of the RAF, either regarding its design or its implementation; the focal points, the STAP, and the convention parties were simi-larly excluded. Excepting the representatives in the Council, the majority of focal points were not informed or consulted. It is of course possible that more extended consultations would have made the process even more complex, with little impact on the final outcome. Nonetheless, the lack of such consults did not secure the necessary buy-in from the very persons who would have to implement the RAF—the countries and the Agencies.

3.4 Allocation Process Once the RAF was approved, a number of issues had to be resolved before implementation could begin; these issues and their resolution are described in this section.

Replenishment The timing, size, and level of replenishment are important for the predictability of RAF funds. The GEF-4 replenishment was completed by the end of August 2006. On October 19, 2006, the World Bank executive directors adopted the

GEF-4 resolution, thereby authorizing the GEF Trustee to manage the resources made available under GEF-4. The advance contribution scheme under GEF-4 became effective November 30, 2006.16

GEF-4, with the largest replenishment in GEF his-tory of $3.13 billion, became effective on February 8, 2007, when the Trustee received instruments of commitment or qualified instruments of com-mitment from donors amounting to at least SDR 929 million (typically 60 percent of total contribu-tions).17 Replenishment participants decide on the share of resources among focal areas. In GEF-4, biodiversity and climate change received $1 bil-lion, corresponding to 33 percent of the total of all focal area funds, as has been historical practice.

The payment schedule for replenishment con-tributions contained four equal installments of about $783 million each, payable at the end of November 2006, 2007, 2008, and 2009. By this schedule, the GEF should have received 50 per-cent of the GEF-4 replenishment amount by the end of November 2007, seven months before the midpoint. By April 2008, only two donors were in arrears of their second installment (arrears total-ing $18.35 million), and another three had not submitted instruments of commitment.18 Seven donors had exercised their right to an extension of payment for the second quarter (until June 30, 2008, the exact midpoint of GEF-4), amounting to $103.5 million.

The replenishment amounts have increased in nominal terms since the GEF pilot phase, from $2 billion in GEF-1, $1.2759 billion (GEF-2), and $3 billion in GEF-3 to $3.13 billion in the current phase. These amounts do not reflect deprecia-tion, inflation, exchange rate differences, or other changes in value over time; nor do the amounts provided to countries (in U.S. dollar terms) take account of purchasing power parity, whereby

Page 120: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

46 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

exchange rates equalize the purchasing power of different currencies in different countries for a given basket of goods. Some of the “gain” in the GEF-4 replenishment was caused by the deprecia-tion of the U.S. dollar compared to other curren-cies. Estimates indicate that the GEF-4 figure of $3.13 billion may amount to less than $2 billion in 1994 dollars.

In summary, the timing and size of the replen-ishment influenced access of funds by coun-tries under the RAF. Timely fulfillment of pay-ment schedules plays a role in future access; the Trust Fund currently provides sufficient but not extensive liquidity for approvals, as considerable amounts are tied up in commitments for projects and concepts. With 20 donors having paid their full amounts, the net funds available for approval in April 2008 amounted to $666.1 million equiv-alent (with $3.05 billion set aside for projects already approved by the CEO or GEF Council but not yet disbursed). Thus, the flow of funds is not linked to the 50 percent limitation in access per country until the midpoint of GEF-4.

eligibilityAccording to the GEF Instrument, countries are eligible for GEF funding in a focal area if (1) they meet eligibility criteria established by the relevant COP for the focal area, or (2) they are members of the conventions and are countries eligible to bor-row from the World Bank or eligible for technical assistance from UNDP.

The RAF has changed the processes for estab-lishing which countries may receive GEF support because a system allocating resources up front must be based on a clear list of which countries are eligible. Until the RAF, country eligibility was decided on a case-by-case basis when a project was submitted, and the system regulated itself automatically.

Generating a List of Eligible Countries

Establishing eligibility up front was not an easy process for the GEF Secretariat, as “there are not always clear criteria provided by the conventions to determine eligibility. Indeed, no clear list exists of eligible parties under the convention for which the GEF is the financial mechanism” (GEF 2007j). For instance, while the CBD considers developing country parties eligible for GEF funding, it does not provide a list of developing countries. Under the UNFCCC guidelines, non-Annex I parties to the convention are eligible for funding regardless of their income level. The GEF Secretariat there-fore established interim criteria and has continued to expend efforts in trying to resolve the issue on a more permanent basis for the reallocation, as well as for other focal areas.

In its meeting of November 2005, the Council requested that the GEF Secretariat consult with the UNFCCC and CBD Secretariats to finalize the lists of eligible countries by April 2006. At the first meeting of the RAF Task Force at the end of November 2005, the first item on the agenda was confirmation of the eligibility list by the UNFCCC, the CBD, and the World Bank/UNDP, since indic-ative allocations could not be finalized without this information.19

The Council is authorized to determine additional eligibility criteria as per the GEF Instrument. In November 2004, the GEF Secretariat asked the Council to clarify the appropriate treatment of countries that were in line for European Union accession. Subsequently, Estonia, Hungary, Lat-via, and Lithuania became members of the Euro-pean Union and graduated from World Bank and UNDP assistance;20 their GEF allocations reverted to the Trust Fund and were redistributed at the midterm reallocation. This was also the case for Poland, which although eligible, voluntarily declined its allocation ($38.1 million for climate

Page 121: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 47

change) so less developed countries could benefit from the GEF resources.

Because the convention criteria are broader, the criteria relating to World Bank or UNDP sup-port do not play a large role in determining the country list. For example, Turkey and Ukraine—two indicative allocation countries—are eligible as parties and recipients of World Bank and UNDP assistance, but are not non-Annex I signatories. The World Bank does not have operations in 25 GEF-eligible countries.21 UNDP provides assis-tance to most of the countries, except for the East European countries that have graduated from both UNDP and World Bank support.22 UNDP also provides support to so-called net contributor countries; these are countries with relatively high income that benefit from UNDP support while providing more in donor contributions to UNDP. This was an issue that required clarification in the development process.

Coverage of New Countries

Some eligible countries had never requested GEF funds previously. These new entrants to the GEF system are typically found in the climate change focal area, where the convention provides for GEF funding to all non-Annex I signatories. The new entrants consist of either high-income countries or low-income countries, such as small crisis or post-conflict countries. In the climate change focal area, 18 eligible countries have not had any allocation in the past; in biodiversity, four eligible countries have not benefited from past GEF assis-tance. Four countries are not party to the conven-tions and are therefore not eligible.23

The RAF also provides funds to countries that are eligible for loans and lending but that are not oth-erwise eligible for large sums of grant money, such as China. RAF allocations are provided as well to 27 countries that are not traditional recipients of

ODA as defined by OECD and to 27 countries that do not benefit from either IBRD loans or concessional funding from IDA. Because the RAF performance index is based on the CPIA assess-ment of IDA grant recipients and IBRD loan cli-ents, performance data for such countries are not available. Eight countries do not have a GEF focal point; it is uncertain how they would access a RAF allocation.

The RAF design mitigates some potentially skewed effects of its broad eligibility criteria. The RAF document specifies that “if an eligible country: (i) is not a Participant in the GEF; or (ii) has not pre-viously received GEF resources in the focal area; or (iii) does not have any GPI data, then it will … have access to the group resources” (GEF 2005t). Given that many countries that need resources receive small allocations, it would be politically difficult to give large allocations to countries that are not even part of the GEF.

The GEF Instrument specifies that any state mem-ber of the United Nations or of any of its special-ized agencies may become a participant in the GEF “by depositing with the Secretariat an instrument of participation.”24 There are currently 10 eligible countries that are not GEF participants: Angola and Oman (biodiversity) and Angola, Bahrain, Cyprus, Kuwait, Oman, Qatar, San Marino, Saudi Arabia, Singapore, and the United Arab Emirates (climate change). Of these, Angola (biodiversity) is most affected; with a high GBI and past alloca-tion, the country would have had an indicative allocation of $6.53 million had the government signed and deposited the Instrument annex with the Secretariat.

Issues

The broad eligibility criteria add complexity to the RAF system and are not helpful in ensuring that GEF funds are provided in a focused manner.

Page 122: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

48 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Issues related to the current eligibility structure include the following:

Small allocations. z Support and guidance from the COPs have not been helpful or timely in determining eligibility. The broad eligibility criteria from the conventions mean that the GEF has more recipient countries than any other donor. The bilateral donors work with fewer countries, ranging from Portugal (20) to the European Commission (144).25 The inter-national financial institutions with a regional focus each work with fewer than 50 partners. The large number of recipients, coupled with limited resources, spreads GEF resources rela-tively thin.

IFAD is the Agency closest to the GEF in terms of its coverage of countries, including a large number of small countries that traditionally accessed funds only infrequently. IFAD also resembles the GEF in being a special-purpose entity with a focused mandate rather than a gen-eral development agency. IFAD has coped with this challenge by making quick iterative reallo-cations to countries with effective demand. (See section 4.3, under “Tools for Ensuring Flexibil-ity,” for a discussion of effective demand.)

Unused funds. z To the extent that countries new to the GEF will not make use of their potential allocations, this ties up funds that could have been made available to other recipients for global environmental benefits. Questions arise as to whether higher income countries need the GEF funding, and how the incremental cost principle would relate to GEF support in countries without much ODA. These countries are mainly in the group allocation and are thus not assigned any specific amount. However, it would be easier to manage the group alloca-tion with clearer information on how many and which of the 115 and 93 countries, respectively,

would realistically want to access biodiversity and climate change funds.

Managerial and information issues. z The Sec-retariat, with information from the World Bank and UNDP, manages and discloses the eligibil-ity list. However, apart from the RAF docu-ments posted on the GEF Web site, eligibility is not explicitly announced to recipients. It is not clear that capacity exists to ensure individual notification to countries of eligibility, changes in eligibility, or reasons therefore.

Barriers to access. z Countries find it increas-ingly difficult to understand the eligibility of the various funds, focal areas, and funding win-dows supported by the GEF. Eligibility is likely to become more complex with an expansion of the RAF, with 119 countries potentially eli-gible in POPs, 148 in land degradation and in ozone, 112 in biosafety, and 150 in international waters.

Data limitations. z Broad eligibility poses chal-lenges in obtaining index data for all coun-tries. Where standard data are not available, other sources are used. Countries that have not worked with the World Bank or had past allo-cations mostly lack performance data for the GPI; therefore, their allocation cannot be fully computed.

Data Coverage and Gaps The GBIs must be calculated for 161 countries in climate change and 150 in biodiversity, respec-tively. To determine which countries obtain what amounts from the GEF Trust Fund under the RAF, the Secretariat requests and obtains under-lying data for the indicators, with support from the World Bank Development Economics depart-ment; puts the indicator data into the RAF for-mula to calculate the country scores; and applies other RAF design rules to arrive at each country allocation.

Page 123: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 49

Benefits Data

Country coverage of data for the GBIs is good. Vir-tually all countries have data for the indicators. In the biodiversity focal area, no missing value is found for the GBIBIO indicators for 150 eligible countries. In the climate change area, 157 (of 161) countries have the full set of climate change indicator data; the remaining four countries (all small states—Marshall Islands, Federated States of Micronesia, San Marino, and Tuvalu) have no GHG emissions or energy intensity ratio data and are included in the climate change group allocation. Four coun-tries, again all small states (Cook Islands, Maldives, Nauru, and Niue), have their GBICC computed from GHG data only; an additional 13 countries, including several post-conflict countries (Afghan-istan, Bosnia and Herzegovina, Libya, and Serbia and Montenegro), do not have their GBICC calcu-lated because they have never participated in the GEF or received GEF resources previously.26 When data on improvement in energy intensity cannot be established, the energy intensity ratio is set at neu-tral (factor set to one), which has more of an effect on countries with high GHG levels.

Performance Data

Country coverage for data in the GPI is more mixed. The majority of countries (115, or 70 per-cent of the 161 countries) have data for all four performance indicators—the CEPIA, the broad framework indicator (BFI), the implementation completion report (ICR) indicator, and the proj-ect implementation review (PIR) indicator (the last two of which comprise the PPI)—as envisaged in the RAF allocation formula. If data for one indi-cator are missing, the RAF document provides for use of the other GPI indicators or substitute indicators. (See the use of different indicators for countries in Technical Paper #1, “Methodology and Context,” table 2.2.)

IFAD develops an indicator annually from its sec-toral policy and institutional assessment of the rural development sector for each of its client countries; this is used in the GPI as a substitute indicator for the CPIA. While it may be unusual to use different sources in the same index, the num-ber of countries lacking the CPIA (10) was consid-ered too large and too important for the GEF not to cover them.

The fact that missing data are mostly noted in performance may be considered unfortunate for a PBA system. However, the main cause of data gaps is not specific weaknesses in coverage of the respective data sources, but the fact that GEF eli-gibility is broader than is common in development assistance. A total of 46 countries (30 percent of 161) have some data gaps in performance. Several are crisis or post-conflict countries, small coun-tries, or SIDS. Others are high-income countries or countries without ODA.

impact of Missing DataIn most cases of a country lacking full index data, the allocation would have remained the same had the needed data been available for the country. Countries that have never had any GEF projects do not have the PPI. Many countries without a GEF portfolio are also not traditional World Bank recipients and therefore do not have the CEPIA or BFI either. The RAF design ensures that countries without complete performance data will be part of the group allocation. Seven countries in the biodi-versity allocation (4.6 percent of 150) do not have a GPI computed. In the climate change focal area, the number of countries without a GPI increases to 17 ( 10.5 percent of 161).

Formula Calculation of scoresOnce eligibility and data availability are ascer-tained, the data for the indexes are compiled. This is a relatively time-consuming process that can

Page 124: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

50 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

take four to six months, depending on data gaps, eligibility changes, and assessment of available resources. Many more steps are involved when data are missing, whereby scores for many coun-tries are calculated separately.

The midterm review found four countries (the Democratic Republic of Congo, Grenada, the Solomon Islands, and Tongo) to have erroneous data values in the calculation, whereby ICR rat-ings values had changed from blank (missing) in the spreadsheet to zero (below the possible range of 1 to 5). These were group allocation countries, and the miscalculation only affected one country with an individual allocation, which should have had $0.76 million more (the Democratic Repub-lic of Congo).27 In working with such large num-bers and complex data sets, such problems are not uncommon. It does pose risks for the future, how-ever, as only one person in the GEF Secretariat has had access to the data and the ability to calculate and apply the formula.28 There has been no system of staff back-up or verification for the application and maintenance of a system on which the GEF is now dependent.

The continuity and audit trail in underlying data are insufficient. On the performance side, the internal original performance data were not sys-tematically recorded for the initial allocation—namely, ICRs and PIRs. This meant that for the reallocation, a new assessment of relevant ICR ratings was made for the last 10 years, rather than updating the initial assessment on a rolling basis. As there is some judgment in determining which of the many ICRs for a country are relevant to the environment, a consistent set of ICRs for each country would be preferable.

The GEF is also dependent on the availability of the raw data, and the World Bank Development Economics department’s support, for the GBI analysis; this in turn is dependent on a single per-

son, and there are striking challenges in continu-ity.29 Apart from the interoffice agreement with Development Economics, no formal working arrangements have been established with sources for cooperation on data. From the perspective of the relevant organizations, their data are global public goods (except for the World Bank CEPIA and BFI), for which they would like to see active application and do not typically charge at pres-ent. They are, however, interested in due credit for their work and in formalizing the arrangement with the GEF. Some would appreciate support in the data provision; other sources, whose informa-tion was downloaded, were not aware of its use for the GEF indexes.

3.5 Council Decisions and implementation Based on the Council decisions and the process described above, this section addresses the ques-tion of whether the RAF has been implemented in accordance with Council decisions. The decisions made are compiled in Technical Paper #1, “Meth-odology and Context,” table 2.3.

In general, the RAF has been implemented in full accordance with Council decisions on the intended actions to launch and operate the RAF. The GEF Secretariat and Agencies have implemented the RAF as instructed, including consultation with countries, involvement of the Executing Agencies, outreach and communica-tion with the global conventions, and monitoring the implementation of the RAF. The RAF docu-ment has been fully implemented, with applica-tion of the formula and additional design rules and the reallocation. Minor exceptions were made to the 50 percent restriction on country resource use before the GEF-4 midpoint.

The GEF legal counsel concluded in 2004 that “there is no provision requiring or prohibiting a

Page 125: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 51

performance-based allocation system” in the GEF Instrument, and that convention guidance has not implied any decisions having the effect of mandat-ing or prohibiting a PBA (Freestone 2004). This was also a conclusion of a review to assess whether the RAF is consistent or compatible with the con-ventions (Wiser 2007), although that review noted some areas where attention to future impacts of the RAF are merited.

All decisions were not equally realistic or suffi-cient. The initial timeline set for the development of the RAF (six months) was not realistic. Even if the magnitude of political considerations had not been taken into account, experience with other PBA systems with more straightforward needs than the GEF’s should have indicated that such a system would not be operational within two years. Other organizations that have adopted a PBA seem to have been able to do so more quickly, but they all use a similar off-the-shelf needs compo-nent of population and GNI per capita.

The initial objectives of the RAF were also overly ambitious, specifically that the system should aim at “maximizing the impact of these resources on global environmental improvements and promot-ing sound environmental policies and practices worldwide” (GEF 2003a). It is difficult to see how such a system for GEF recipients would affect a worldwide scale. The goal of maximizing impact on the environment is likely somewhat more realistic.

While the global conventions have not provided specific guidance on the RAF, several reports have observed that “the guidance from some con-ventions has been very vague and without any prioritization” (Wiser 2007). In the third CBD review (2008) of the effectiveness of the financial mechanism, the independent evaluator recom-mended “The CBD COP providing clear, priori-tized guidance including on funding requirements

for the GEF in its role to support global benefits” (UNCBD 2008c).

The key principles established for the RAF are open to interpretation. The extent to which the RAF has been implemented in accordance with these principles is therefore debatable. A firm assessment of implementation is especially dif-ficult for the principles assigned to the RAF—simplicity, transparency, pragmatism, cost-effec-tiveness, comprehensiveness, country drivenness, and equal opportunity for all recipient countries. The actions taken in accordance with Council decisions do not necessarily lead to achievement of the objectives assigned to the RAF. For exam-ple, the GEF Council asked for the system to be based on transparent assessments and to ensure that all member countries can be informed as to how allocation decisions are made. The RAF design, underlying indicators, and process remain unclear to virtually all stakeholders.

Discussion of RAF conformity and compliance with guidance has focused on the indexes and other design elements. Yet it is not realistic to expect that all aspects relevant to the GEF can be reflected in indicators, as some issues are best addressed in implementation. The RAF does not require a link between the indexes and how funds are spent. Countries are not obliged to prioritize areas for which they have received an allocation, nor are they constrained from funding areas not included in the indexes. Limitations on how funds can be spent are established by the GEF focal area strategies, which are generally derived from con-vention guidance. This influences how issues such as land use, land use change, and forestry; adap-tation; and carbon capture and storage can be addressed in the RAF.

Since the conventions have not provided explicit guidance on most of the issues possibly touched by RAF implementation, it cannot be said that

Page 126: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

52 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

the RAF is against such guidance. In principle, it provides enough minimal funding to ensure the enabling activities and reports required by the COPs. The group allocation rules do not guar-antee a minimum amount for any country. Any allocation is subject to GEF project criteria, and projects might not be approved. If the conven-tions were to issue guidance on required enabling activities, the GEF Secretariat and Council would have to amend those rules or obtain the funding in another manner.

Countries may have a RAF allocation at their dis-posal and yet choose to spend it on activities other than obligations to the conventions. It is not feasi-ble for the GEF Secretariat or Agencies to pressure countries to prioritize projects in areas to which a country has signed as a party to a convention. A larger issue is whether the funding is sufficient for all the different priorities.

notesThe concerns cited (except those regarding con-4. vention commitments) are taken from Council member statements made at the Third GEF Assem-bly, the August–September 2005 special meeting of the GEF Council, the June 2005 and May 2004 GEF Council meetings, and the 2002 Meeting on the Third Replenishment of the GEF Trust Fund; these can be found in GEF (2006a, 2005l, 2005m, 2004d, and 2002e). Concerns from the conventions are taken from Namibia (2008).

Examples include IFAD’s Results and Impact Man-5. agement System, UNDP’s Results-Based Manage-ment System, and the ADB Project Performance Management System (GEF EO 2006c).

UN RBM initiatives include efforts by UNDP, the 6. United Nations Population Fund, and the World Food Programme; UNICEF is implementing results-based program planning and management; and the UN Secretariat is introducing results-based budgeting (UNJIU 2007).

The UN Evaluation Group is currently concluding 7. an evaluability assessment of eight “delivering-as-

one” pilots as part of its Evaluation of the Pilot Ini-tiative for Delivering as One.

Other programs participating in this group include 8. the Cities Alliance, the Consultative Group on International Agricultural Research, the Fast Track Initiative for Education for All, the GAVI Alliance, and the Global Fund to Fight AIDS, Malaria and Tuberculosis; this last is the group convener.

The Climate Investment Funds include the Clean 9. Technology Fund, which will finance the deploy-ment and transfer of low-carbon technologies in the power and transportation sectors and energy efficiency in buildings, industry, and agriculture; and the Strategic Climate Fund, which will provide financing to pilot new development approaches or to scale up activities aimed at a specific climate change challenge through targeted programs.

This is illustrated by the “Declaration of Integrat-10. ing Climate Change Adaptation into Development Co-operation” (OECD 2006) adopted in 2006 by OECD member country ministers of development and environment.

The first “Annual Monitoring Review Report” 11. (GEF 2008a) was presented at the April 2008 Council meeting.

A number of written comments had been submit-12. ted before the seminar from Colombia, Denmark, France, Germany, India, the Netherlands, and Pakistan Council members. Before the Paris meet-ing, members from Canada and the Group of 77 provided comments.

These comments were from Belgium, Bolivia, Can-13. ada, Colombia, India, Mexico, Spain, Switzerland, the United Kingdom, and the United States as well as from the UNFCCC and the NGO Network.

These notes, and their respective URLs, are listed 14. in the bibliography of this report.

GEF (2005l), annex. These constituencies com-15. prised Azerbaijan, Kazakhstan, Kyrgyz Repub-lic, Switzerland, Tajikistan, Turkmenistan, and Uzbekistan, supported by Austria, Belgium, the Czech Republic, Hungary, Luxembourg, the Slo-vak Republic, Slovenia, and Turkey. The Council also noted a statement by the NGO Network.

Page 127: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

3. Context of the RAF 53

GEF (2005t). Amendments were subsequently 16. introduced for the GEF Council meeting in Novem-ber 2005 (GEF 2005c). This document describes the GEF RAF as adopted by the Council.

At that point, there were 180 concepts (including 17. the Critical Ecosystem Partnership Fund, which as of this writing is still awaiting formal approval by the Council into the work program), totaling about $1.7 billion, in the GEF pipeline; 119 of these had PDF-Bs approved for project preparation.

These countries were Brazil, Costa Rica, Guate-18. mala, Nicaragua, Paraguay, and South Africa (bio-diversity) and Brazil, Indonesia, and South Africa (climate change). Many of these had to defer some projects in the pipeline because of the 50 percent rule.

This scheme aims to avoid an interruption in the 19. GEF’s financing commitment and is triggered when one-quarter of the amount of instruments of commitment received becomes available.

GEF replenishments are cited in terms of SDR 20. (special drawing rights), which is used as a “base currency” and figured as a basket made up of fixed proportions of donor currencies. The GEF-4 replenishment is equivalent to SDR 2.14 billion.

In arrears: Belgium and the United States; not 21. deposited: Italy, Nigeria, and Pakistan.

By the second meeting in January 2006, the 22. UNFCCC Secretariat had certified the eligibility list; shortly thereafter, the Executive Secretary of the CBD agreed on the list of eligible countries under the CBD as those countries that are eligible under paragraph 9(b) of the GEF Instrument minus the list of developed countries of the CBD.

Hungary and the Czech Republic were initially eli-23. gible for GEF financing in the climate change focal area.

The Bahamas, Bahrain, Barbados, Cook Islands, 24. Cuba, Cyprus, the Czech Republic, Estonia, Hun-gary, Democratic People’s Republic of Korea, Kuwait, Latvia, Lithuania, Malta, Nauru, Niue, Oman, Poland, Qatar, San Marino, Saudi Arabia. Singapore, Slovenia, Tuvalu, and the United Arab Emirates.

The Czech Republic, Estonia, Hungary, Latvia, 25. Lithuania, Poland, and San Marino.

Climate change: Angola, Bosnia and Herzegovina, 26. Cook Islands, Cyprus, Equatorial Guinea, Estonia, Israel, Republic of Korea, Kuwait, the Marshall Islands, the Federated States of Micronesia, Myan-mar, Nauru, Qatar, San Marino, Serbia and Mon-tenegro, Singapore, and the United Arab Emirates; biodiversity: East Timor, Libya, Myanmar, and Ser-bia and Montenegro; not party to the conventions: Iraq, Jordan, Palestine, and Somalia.

In the case of a state contributing to the GEF 27. Trust Fund, an instrument of commitment shall be deemed to serve as an instrument of participation.

OECD DCD-DAC (2008c). Other donors with 28. numerous partners include Japan (135) and the United States (128); Canada, France, Germany, the Global Fund to Fight AIDS, Tuberculosis and Malaria, UNICEF, UNDP, and the United Nations Population Fund each work with over 100 part-ners; Greece, Luxembourg, New Zealand, the Asian Development Fund, the African Develop-ment Fund, and IDB each work with fewer than 50 partners.

Of the 17 countries, only Cambodia, Cuba, and the 29. Democratic People’s Republic of Korea have their GBI used in formula; they receive individual cli-mate change allocations. The other countries are included in the group allocation, and their carbon intensity ratio and baseline emissions are not used for allocation. Maldives has a low GBI and is allo-cated in the group.

The GEF Evaluation Office informed the GEF 30. CEO of this discrepancy by email in June 2008, and the data and allocation have accordingly been amended.

This staff member has in fact since left, and the 31. vacancy was announced in July 2008.

The Development Economics staff member con-32. ducting the complex geographic information sys-tem mapping of ecosystems and species regretfully suffered a fatal motor accident, and it took some time for a replacement to assume the duties.

Page 128: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

54

4. Design of the RAF

This chapter presents the structure and ele-ments of the RAF design. The analysis draws on the Delphi peer expert study, statistical analysis, comparative review with other PBA systems, and expert interviews. Further details on data sources are available in Technical Paper #2, “Design of the RAF,” and Technical Paper #5, “Delphi Study of the RAF Benefits and Performance Indexes.” All Delphi scores mentioned in this report range from 1 (low) to 10 (high).

As in other PBA arrangements, the GEF RAF is a rules-based system that uses a set of formulas to allocate funds. The formula contains two main components: needs and potential benefits, which are measured, using the GBI, according to a country’s potential to generate global environ-mental benefits; and performance, which is mea-sured using the GPI. The RAF is unique among PBA systems in the direct attention it gives to environmental benefits in assessing needs and potential benefits.

A GEF allocation is not an entitlement. A country may receive grants up to a maximum of its allo-cation during the four years of the replenishment period, provided it submits project proposals through a GEF Agency that satisfy GEF require-ments. Many factors influence the level of the GEF allocation to a particular country. These fac-tors include the number of eligible countries, the total amount of money available for grants in each

focal area, and—of course—the country’s GBI and GPI scores. In the allocation process, specific rules aim to ensure that extreme allocation results are avoided through ceilings, pooling, and floors.

For each of the indexes included in the RAF design, this chapter addresses

the relevance and reliability of indicator data, z

the related topic of substantive coverage and z

scope of the indicators,

balance and weights among elements as each z

indicator/index is applied,

data gaps and opportunities for using new data z

sources.

4.1 The GeF Benefits indexThe GBI measures the scope for producing global environmental benefits in a particular focal area in a given country.1 It is not designed to measure country intention, capacity, or performance.

The GeF Benefits index for Biodiversity

The purpose of the GBIBIO is “to measure the potential global benefits that can be realized from biodiversity related activities in a country” (GEF 2005c). The index is made up of two parts:

Terrestrial score. z This score counts for 80 per-cent of the index and is constructed through a four-part process that takes into account rep-

Page 129: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 55

resentation and threat levels across the coun-try’s terrestrial ecoregions for six taxonomic groups—mammals, birds, amphibians, reptiles, vascular plants, and freshwater fish.

Marine score. z This score, which counts for 20 percent of the GBIBIO, is the sum of the cred-its from all the marine fish species located in the country’s territorial waters.

Relevance and Reliability

The quality and comprehensiveness of GBIBIO data are generally satisfactory. Participants in the Del-phi expert study expressed strong support for the view that the GBIBIO data are the most comprehen-sive and reliable available for the items covered. The index uses data sources from international organizations specializing in various aspects of biodiversity issues. The sources are considered authoritative in their respective fields within the scientific community, and these international organizations mainly derive their raw data from the national level.

The RAF biodiversity index mainly focuses on the first of the three objectives of the CBD, conserva-tion. Delphi experts felt that the emphasis on con-servation was appropriate but indicated that its emphasis was insufficient regarding the two other objectives, sustainable use of biological resources and transfer of genetic resources across borders.

The GBIBIO contains information on both eco-regions and species, with particular emphasis on the latter. The RAF index will inevitably reflect weaknesses or gaps in underlying data, such as for arid ecosystems and for marine and freshwater species and habitats, area size and habitat com-plexity, incomplete mapping of species in some countries, and species migration across borders and ecoregions. Areas not covered include habi-tats, ecosystem services, the cultural significance of biodiversity, and sustainable livelihoods and

use. While these are among many factors leading to the threatened or protected status of species and ecosystems, they are also intrinsically difficult to measure.

Statistical analysis found a strong relationship between the individual indicators and both the final index score and the country allocations. No indicator dominates the index more than others, as the statistical correlation among each indicator, the GBIBIO score, and the allocation is relatively high.

Coverage and Scope

Delphi participants support the view that the data used in the GBIBIO should be expanded to incorpo-rate a broader range of taxonomic groups. There is strong expert agreement (an average of 8.5 on the Delphi score of 1–10) on the desirability of including marine invertebrates such as sponges, jellyfish, corals, mollusks, crabs, shrimp, and lob-sters, and moderate support (an average of 6.0) for expansion to terrestrial invertebrates.

There was no agreement among the Delphi par-ticipants to amend the index to give greater weight to biosafety. Experts pointed out that it was diffi-cult to envision how this issue could be measured, particularly as national data are not yet broadly available.2

There was also a disinclination to amend the GBIBIO to give greater weight to agrobiodiversity. The sci-entific community has not yet reached consensus on this issue; 32 percent indicated strong disagree-ment. UNCBD (2008a, Decision IX/1) invited

Parties and other Governments and relevant organiza-tions to finance and undertake research as appropriate to further develop and apply methods and techniques for assessing and monitoring the status and trends of agricultural biodiversity…

The GBIBIO does not cover carbon sequestration and other ecosystem values (Watson and others

Page 130: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

56 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

2000) or carbon sinks. Carbon pools can be for-est biomass, wood products, and soils. The GEF mandate covers desertification, biodiversity loss, and climate change, for which issues and policies are strongly interlinked, rendering measurement difficult. If sinks were included, a country with a high forest sequestration would score higher in biodiversity, while its net GHG emissions under the RAF’s current GBICC would decrease, leading to a lower score in climate change.

Balance and Weights

The main concern regarding weights relates to the fact that the RAF gives a country’s terrestrial bio-diversity score a weight of 0.8 and its marine bio-diversity score a weight of 0.2. The initial design decision on these weights was mainly political (see chapter 3), and was partly based on the uncertain-ties related to marine data. There is no scientific model that indicates the right balance, as data for the two ecosystems are not comparable.

Delphi experts indicated moderate support for the view that marine biodiversity should be given more weight. Half of the 22 participants respond-ing to this question gave numerical responses of 7 or more, indicating that the weight of terrestrial biodiversity was too high.

Decisions on marine/terrestrial weights mostly affect SIDS, countries with a large exclusive eco-nomic zone; on the other side of the spectrum, landlocked countries would be scored on their terrestrial component only. The midterm review simulated the effects of changes in the marine weight. Of the 37 SIDS with biodiversity alloca-tions, 9 have individual allocations. The simula-tion demonstrated that a 50/50 weight with the current data would bring five SIDS up to individ-ual allocations, while seven countries (including one small island developing state and four land-locked countries) would move from individual to

group allocations. For SIDS currently receiving individual allocations, amounts would increase for five and decrease for two countries. Other special categories (LDCs, landlocked countries, fragile states) would lose funds. Because countries that currently have high individual allocations also have large marine resources, their GBIBIO increases when the weights are modified. The individual allocation countries currently have 85 percent of the accumulated marine score (and 89 percent of the accumulated terrestrial score).

There was strong agreement that the threatened/endangered status of species and ecosystems should be treated the same way for marine bio-diversity as for terrestrial biodiversity. There was less agreement about the feasibility of doing so. Delphi biodiversity experts were uncertain about the availability of data for assessing the threat-ened/endangered status of marine species (4.8 on a scale of 1–10), though some suggested explor-ing data on the areal extent of coral reefs, man-grove areas, and seagrass beds. A study on the RAF marine biodiversity indicators (Fedder 2007) identified potential new data sources on marine biodiversity that could be relevant to the RAF and warrant monitoring for inclusion in the future.

Channeling Resources for Biodiversity to Global Environmental Benefits

The RAF channels resources to countries with high global biodiversity environmental ben-efits, although not in exact proportion to GBI scores. The 57 indicative countries (that is, those with individual allocations) account for the bulk (88 percent) of GBIBIO scores of the 150 eligible countries. These countries accumulate 75.3 per-cent of the total resources of $1 billion in the focal area. (See table 4.1.)

There was general agreement among Delphi bio-diversity experts that the list of countries qualify-

Page 131: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 57

ing for individual funding was somewhat biased toward conservation. There was no consensus as to whether the GBIBIO should be amended to give greater weight to megadiversity countries or countries with biodiversity hotspots (median of 3 on a 1–10 scale).3 The 17 countries rich in biologi-cal diversity and associated traditional knowledge called like-minded megadiverse countries accu-mulate a share of the biodiversity index of 59 per-cent and 46 percent of the total focal area funds. A recent report to the CBD noted that this amount is an increase of 76 percent from GEF-3 (UNCBD 2008c).

The picture is more mixed for the biodiversity hotspots. Some hotspots fall within or across countries with individual allocations (Brazil, Chile, the Philippines, South Africa); some fall squarely within group allocation countries. Others—such as the Atlantic Forest in Brazil (individual allo-cation) and Uruguay (group), and the Guinean Forests of West Africa, which covers Nigeria and Côte d’Ivoire (individual allocation) as well as Ghana, Guinea, and Liberia (group)—cross bor-ders between countries with individual and group allocations, often with the group allocation coun-try being smaller in size. Of course, allocation to a country with biodiversity hotspots does not imply that GEF funds will be used for the hotspots as such.

GeF Benefits index for Climate Change The purpose of the GBICC is “to measure the potential global benefits that can be realized from

climate change mitigation activities in a country” (GEF 2005c). It consists of two major parts:

The index measures the country’s z baseline GHG emissions in tons of carbon equivalent in the year 2000 from fossil fuel combustion and cement and the emission of other GHGs.

The z carbon intensity adjustment factor is computed as the ratio of carbon intensity in 1990 to that in 2000. A country’s carbon intensity measures the tons of carbon equivalent emitted by the country per unit of economic activity as measured by GNI.

Relevance and Reliability

Annual GHG emissions were included as the main component of the GBICC because of assumed lower abatement costs and greater demonstration effects in high-emitting countries. Delphi climate change experts found annual GHG emissions moderately useful as a broad indicator of a coun-try’s mitigation potential.

However, some concerns were raised in the Del-phi study. A country’s mitigation potential is not only based on its GHG emissions but also on its capacity to implement mitigation measures. Annual GHG emissions do not take into account those countries that have low emissions and high forest cover, or indicate if countries have season-ally high emissions. Emissions are subject to vola-tility of external shocks not related to mitigation. For certain major emitters, emissions profiles are changing fairly rapidly, but the index does not

Table 4.1

RAF Allocations and GBi scores by Type of Allocation: Biodiversity

Allocation type

number of countries

share of allocation (%)

Allocation (million $) GBi score share of scores (%)

Max. Min. Max. Min. GBi Marine Terrestrial

Individual 57 75 63.2 3.5256 663.7 19.9 88 85 89

Group 93 15 3.5255 1 70.5 0.1 12 15 11

Page 132: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

58 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

measure growth in emissions. As alternatives, emissions per capita may give a better view of mitigation potential, or marginal abatement cost curves directly, if these can be estimated for the different countries.

In the GBICC, countries’ change in energy inten-sity is used to complement GHG emissions. Cli-mate change experts in the Delphi study found energy intensity useful as an indicator of a coun-try’s mitigation potential (average of 6.3).

The energy intensity adjustment factor takes account of a country’s economic growth. The index is constructed with per capita GNI in such a way that a country can increase its GHG emis-sions at the same pace as GNI growth without changing its GBICC score. Delphi climate change experts found the per capita GNI useful (average of 5.8). However, the adjustment factor plays a small role in the index: GHG emissions dominate the scores, and energy intensity will only adjust the emissions in the index up or down, since the GBICC multiplies the GHG emissions with inten-sity change (rather than adding the two indicators with relative weights). A total of 75 percent of cli-mate change allocations go to the top 20 percent emitters; the carbon intensity adjustment factor is more evenly distributed, with the top 20 percent of countries having improved their carbon intensity.

The GBICC uses a baseline year and a yearly range for both GHG emissions and carbon inten-sity; the year 2000 was used as the baseline for the initial allocation, and the UNFCCC indicated 1990 as the base year. Delphi experts found the choice of baseline years, the 10-year lag, and the use of a single base year to be arbitrary. Experts disagree on the best year for measuring GHG emissions for the index. The midterm review simulation shows no significant allocation changes across GBI quin-tiles with different baseline years in 1990, 1995, or 2000.4

Coverage and Scope

In the GBICC, GHGs from land use change and from industrial non–carbon dioxide emissions are not included. For many LDCs, non-energy GHG emissions dominate, so the exclusion of land use, land use change, and forestry emissions may distort the index. Distortion is a particular con-cern for forest-rich countries such as Brazil and Indonesia.

Experts found the representation of sources of GHGs (for example, fossil fuel use and cement production) adequate to some degree (average of 5.2). Given that the index is supposed to be cor-related with mitigation opportunities, the Delphi panel suggested that the GBICC consider the fol-lowing alternative sources of GHGs in decreasing order of importance: (1) agriculture and land use, (2) deforestation and forest degradation, (3) gas flaring, and (4) industrial non–carbon dioxide, to the extent that recent and robust data would become available.

About half of the Delphi participants found that the representation of gases in the GBICC is adequate (average of 6.0). Participants were of the view that all types of GHGs from all sources should be accounted for. On the other hand, most (60 percent) of the Delphi participants found Clean Development Mechanism and carbon trading initiatives not very relevant for a climate change index.

Balance and Weights

There is a high level of agreement among experts and stakeholders that more should be done to balance funding between adaptation and mitiga-tion in developing countries. A majority of Del-phi experts agreed that more should be done to balance funding (average of 8.5). Experts agree, as do many stakeholders, on channeling the major-ity of funding for adaptation to the most vulner-

Page 133: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 59

able countries, paralleling the fact that most of the funds under the GBICC go to mitigation in coun-tries with more emissions.

There were mixed views on how best to address this, either by using vulnerability broadly as a principle to guide funding under the RAF, con-structing a vulnerability index, or both, if possible. There were also mixed views as to the right group-ing or definition of categories of vulnerable coun-tries. Under the UNFCCC, there is no distinction among developing countries as far as support for adaptation costs from developed countries under article 4.4 is concerned.

Ultimately, if no scientific evidence exists to deter-mine the right balance, the balance is determined by strategic or political concerns. Historically, GEF funding for climate change has focused on the big-ger GHG emitters, based—among other things—on the assumption that projects could catalyze market change and broader impact in such coun-tries. The RAF formula accepts this focus. GEF Trust Fund resources have not been used for dedi-cated adaptation projects until recently, through the Strategic Pilot on Adaptation.

Most developing countries are still in the process of preparing their GHG inventories based on the 1997 guidelines from the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change. Coverage of GHG emissions in national communications to the UNFCCC is still too limited to include all of the countries eli-gible for GEF support in a consistent manner; this

is partially because some countries lack the capac-ity to fully report their GHG emissions, especially from land use, land use change, and forestry. Stakeholders and experts indicated a variety of areas where improvements are needed to capture the full range of issues related to climate change mitigation and adaptation, but it is less certain if data would be available for inclusion in an index. Forty-seven percent of the Delphi respondents did not know of any measures relating to human vulnerability or social impacts that should be reflected in the climate change index or in another index or form of measurement. Future data may emerge from the UNFCCC Nairobi work pro-gram on impacts, vulnerability, and adaptation to climate change.

Channeling Resources for Climate Change to Global Environmental Benefits

The RAF channels resources to countries with high global environmental benefits, though not in exact proportion to GBICC scores. As can be seen in table 4.2, the GBI share increase outpaces the resource allocation share increase. The 46 indica-tive countries receive 75 percent of total focal area resources, but cover 89 percent of the GBI envi-ronmental scores of the 161 eligible countries. Forty percent of the Delphi respondents indicated that the GBICC makes moderately good sense by giving larger funds to larger emitters and reward-ing countries that reduce carbon intensity.

Table 4.2

RAF Allocations and GBi scores by Type of Allocation: Climate Change

Allocation type

no. of countries

share of allocation (%)

Alloc. (mil. $) GBi score share of scores (%)

emissions (%)

Max. Min. Max. Min. Baseline Co2 non-Co2

Individual 46 75 150 3.09 2413020.9 8402.8 89 86 87 85

Group 115 15 2.97 1 145958.4 1.0 11 14 13 15

notes: CO2 = carbon dioxide. Only carbon emissions from fossil fuel combustion and cement and the emission of other GHGs are included in baseline GHG emissions.

Page 134: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

60 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

A few (15 percent) of the Delphi respondents found the GBICC to make no sense, since the larger countries and those that have already reduced their carbon emissions significantly have enough experience and capacity regarding GHG mitiga-tion and have generated sufficient momentum to continue even with less GEF support.

Countries with high emissions intensity and low growth, such as countries in transition, are likely to have a higher mitigation potential. Some stake-holders have suggested that the GBICC should concentrate resources in countries in the middle range of GHG emissions, not the highest emit-ters, since the latter most likely can afford proj-ects and pay from their own resources for national consultations.

It was stated in the Delphi study that neither a country’s overall size of emissions nor its eco-nomic growth are reliable proxies in getting the most emission reductions for the money spent. Drawbacks of the formula include the focus on energy and industry.

About two-thirds of the experts on the Delphi panel thought that there was too great a concen-tration of funding for climate allocated to too few countries (average of 7.1, with 10 being “far too much”). But it is not obvious which countries should receive more or less.5 Some of the pan-elists believed that a more balanced distribution of GEF climate change funding would result in substantially greater GHG emissions mitigation (average of 6.5, with 5 being “about the same” and 10 being “substantially more”). Smaller countries may have less capacity to invest their own human and financial resources, and the small amounts allocated may be below a threshold to carry out meaningful projects. Delphi experts felt that a more balanced distribution would encour-age action on mitigation in a larger number of countries.

Emerging New Data and Data Gaps

The data for the GBICC is provided by the World Resources Institute’s Climate Analysis Indicators Tool. Delphi experts agreed with the use of this tool to a limited extent (average 4.6) for the inven-tories from national communications. Experts also thought that the correlation between World Resources Institute and national communications data was not strong, but no consensus emerged as to which data to use. Future data should espe-cially be sought on expanding country coverage for other gases; linkages between climate change mitigation and sustainable development; land use, land use change, and forestry; and agriculture, for-estry, and other land uses.

4.2 The GeF Performance indexThe likelihood of success of GEF projects and programs depends on, among other things, the capacity of countries’ institutions to produce global environmental benefits. The purpose of the GPI is to “measure each country’s capacity to suc-cessfully implement GEF programs and projects” (GEF 2005c). The GPI is a quantitative measure of this capacity, combining data on

government performance in relevant policy z

areas, measured by the CEPIA;

quality of management in selected areas of the z

public sector, measured by the BFI;

quality of completed and ongoing environmen- z

tal projects in the country, measured by the PPI.

The GPI was a central part of the RAF from the beginning and was perhaps its most controversial aspect (see Technical Paper #1, “Methodology and Context”). Several factors contributed to the inter-est in including country performance as a criterion for GEF allocations, including a concern on the part of the Council that the GEF focus resources

Page 135: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 61

toward “high-performing” countries, the presence of an established practice of multilateral develop-ment banks, and broad awareness of recent stud-ies emphasizing the importance of country policy environments in the effectiveness of development assistance. By the time GEF Council discussions of the RAF began, a broad consensus had emerged that country policies and institutions do indeed pertain to development results.

In the RAF formula, the GPI is a major element (with a weight of 1.0 as compared to the GBI weight of 0.8). At the same time, for technical reasons associated with measurement arrange-ments supporting the GPI, it is not a driving force in determining individual country ranks for allocations. In the biodiversity focal area, the first quintile (30 countries) with the highest GPI ratings features 13 with indicative allocations; in climate change, 16 of 30 countries have indicative allocations.6

The CePiA and the BFi These two indicators are derived from the same assessment and data source, namely, from the annual World Bank structured and internally reviewed assessments of country performance (now called the IDA Resource Allocation Index); they are analyzed here together.

Relevance and Reliability

Delphi experts support the overall structure and weight accorded to country policy and institu-tional performance, with an average response of 7.55 (on a 1–10 scale) regarding the extent to which the CEPIA and the BFI make use of best practices in performance measurement. A corre-lation analysis of strength of association between the GPI and its components reinforces this, show-ing that the CEPIA correlates with the GPI at 0.99, while the correlations for the BFI and the PPI are 0.83 and 0.43, respectively.

While the possible ratings for the CEPIA and the BFI for a given country range from 1.0 to 6.0, the actual range of scores is more limited. There is a long-standing tendency for ratings to hover con-siderably around the median, with most ratings in the 3.0 to 4.0 range. In the 2007 assessment, CEPIA scores for 75 IDA countries ranged from 2.0 to 4.5. This relatively narrow range of actual ratings has the effect of reducing the influence of these indicators on resulting allocations, dimin-ishing the diagnostic power of the indicator and suggesting that methodology improvement may not make a notable difference to scores. In fact, as seen in figure 4.1, the performance indicators tend to cluster around a few ratings in the midrange of the scale, contrasting with the skewed distribution of GBI scores.

The CEPIA aims to assess “the extent to which environmental policies foster the protection and sustainable use of natural resources and the man-agement of pollution” (IDA 2007a). CEPIA data are obtained from an IDA indicator for policies and institutions for environmental sustainability in six policy areas—air pollution, water pollu-tion, solid and hazardous waste, ecosystem con-servation and biodiversity protection, marine and coastal resources, and freshwater resources and commercial natural resources.7 The relevance of the indicator’s substantive coverage to biodiver-sity is high, but fighting against pollution is not the primary GEF mandate. The indicator does not explicitly relate to the GEF mandate within cli-mate change.

Many dimensions of environmental policy are bundled together in the narrative criteria used to guide scoring. The description covers much substantive ground, but the diagnostic value of a summary rating of this kind may be limited, since specificity regarding the applicable environmental subsectors is lacking.

Page 136: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

62 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

The quality of public sector management is gauged through the BFI, which carries a weight of 20 per-cent in the GPI. The BFI is based on the average value for five indicators included under the public sector management and institutions cluster in the

IDA CPIA: property rights and rule-based gover-nance; quality of budgetary and financial manage-ment; efficiency of revenue mobilization; qual-ity of public administration; and transparency, accountability, and corruption in the public sector.

Figure 4.1

Distribution of indicators in the GBi and the GPi

a. BFI distribution

05

10

15

20

25

30

35

40

1.13 1.50 1.87 2.24 2.61 2.98 3.35 3.72 4.09 4.46 4.83 5.20 5.57 5.94

b. CEPIA distribution

05

1015202530354045

1.05 1.50 1.95 2.40 2.86 3.31 3.76 4.21 4.67 5.12 5.57 6.00

Frequency Frequency

e. GBI biodiversity distribution

0

20

40

60

80

100

120

0 41 81 122 162 203 243 284 324 365 405 446 486 527 567 608 649 689 730

Rating

f. GBI climate change distribution

0

20

40

6080

100

120

140

160

70708 141416 212123 282831 4.E+05 707078 2474774

Rating

Frequency Frequency

c. PIR distribution

2.042.17

2.302.43

2.562.69

2.822.95

3.083.21

3.343.47

3.603.73

3.863.99

4.124.26

4.39

d. ICR distribution

0

10

20

30

40

50

0.00 0.54 1.08 1.61 2.15 2.69 3.23 3.76 4.30 4.84 5.38 5.92 6.00RatingRating

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70Frequency Frequency

RatingRating

Page 137: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 63

The BFI rating is a simple average of scores for the five indicators. A recent internal assessment by the World Bank found it to be “a sound index” for measuring governance to support IDA’s resource allocation system (World Bank 2006).

If CEPIA and BFI data are not available for a country, a summary score from the rural sector assessment indicators developed by IFAD is used instead. This group of indicators, which was used for six climate change and seven biodiversity coun-tries in the RAF allocation, covers five thematic clusters: strengthening the capacity of the rural poor and their organizations, improving equitable access to productive natural resources and tech-nology, increasing access to financial services and markets, gender issues, and public resource man-agement and accountability. While these themes are especially relevant to assessing the health of the rural sector in developing countries, they have limited or unclear relevance to the quality of envi-ronmental policies.

Coverage and Scope

Substantive coverage in the CEPIA indicator appears good. Policies in the areas of air pollu-tion, water pollution, solid and hazardous waste, ecosystem conservation and biodiversity protec-tion, marine and coastal resources, freshwater resources, and commercial natural resources are given separate subscores as this criterion’s rating is developed. Ultimately, policy status is rated jointly for both pollution and resource issues.

Delphi performance experts did not come to a consensus on whether there are other avail-able indicators that should be considered for use within the CEPIA or the BFI (average of 4.0). Sev-eral remaining indicators from IDA’s CPIA are not included in the overall GPI, including three indi-cators from the economic management cluster, three from the structural policies cluster, and four

from the policies for social inclusion/equity clus-ter. Environmental issues are concentrated in the CEPIA indicator; these others did not appear to have much relevance to the GEF mandate.

Balance and Weights

The CEPIA is given a weight of 70 percent in the overall GPI; this means that the numerical value of data for this indicator is multiplied by 0.7 to pro-duce its resulting value for the GPI. The CEPIA thus counts the most in determining the overall value of the GPI.

Within the GPI, 90 percent of the formula weight is accorded to country policy and institutional per-formance. This weighting arises from the view that the quality of policies and institutions is crucial to the success of GEF objectives. Delphi participants found that the CEPIA and the BFI make use of best practices in performance measurement (7.6 average response). Experts were somewhat less convinced about the exact weight of 90 percent accorded to country policy and institutional per-formance within the GPI (6.1 average response).

The PPiThe third component of the GPI is the PPI, which measures the quality of both ongoing and closed projects. Data for the PPI are derived in an equally weighted split between an indicator summariz-ing ratings contained in PIRs of GEF projects and an indicator summarizing ratings by the World Bank’s Independent Evaluation Group of ICRs for the Bank’s environment-related projects in the country. The PPI counts for 10 percent of GPI calculation.

Relevance and Reliability

In principle, an indicator that captures project performance would be highly relevant in assess-ing the capacity to produce global environmental benefits through GEF projects. Both ICRs and

Page 138: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

64 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

PIRs are based on self-assessments by project management with internal verification processes established to ensure consistency of ratings.

There was a high level of support among the Del-phi performance experts for the proposition that PIR and ICR scores are likely to be a useful partial measure of a country’s ability to implement GEF projects successfully (average of 7.1 for the PIR and 6.2 for the ICR). PIRs are highly relevant in that they rate GEF projects only and are imple-mented by all Agencies for all GEF projects in all focal areas and extend back over the last 10 years. However, this long time horizon means that the performance assessed is relatively dated.

The ICR rating covers environmental projects implemented by the World Bank, whether funded by the GEF or not. The classification of “environ-mental” is quite broad, and the decision as to which projects to include is based on the judgment of the GEF Secretariat. On the other hand, experts inter-viewed have argued that, for portfolio and project management, the broader the coverage the better, as a country’s ability to manage projects is rela-tively consistent regardless of sector.

The GBI does not cover terminal evaluations from Agencies other than the World Bank. The num-ber of completed GEF projects with verified out-come ratings has increased since 2006; potentially, evaluations from other GEF Agencies could be included in the next version of the RAF.

A major concern regarding portfolio indicators for PBA systems is small portfolios. Many coun-tries do not have enough environmental projects ongoing to allow for statistical stability in mea-suring their quality. Some PBA systems use vari-ous methods to “smooth” data (10-year moving averages of ratings, for example) to address this problem. The PPI summarizes data for all projects implemented in a country over 10 years, which

helps somewhat but does not fully address the challenge faced by countries with small portfolios. For the PIRs, 28 countries have a single project rated; only 8 countries have more than 10 differ-ent projects rated. Coverage is better for the ICRs, for which 59 countries have ratings for more than 10 projects.

As noted, to overcome the bias of smaller portfo-lios and to provide stability, the PPI covers ratings over the last 10 years. Delphi experts did not reach consensus as to whether to shorten this period (average 4.5). PIR scores cover yearly ratings for the same projects, although it is relatively rare that there are major fluctuations in ratings for one project over time. On average, PIRs yield ratings 0.83 points higher than those given by the GEF Evaluation Office.

Another approach to counter bias is the inclu-sion of several ratings. For the PIR, both devel-opment objective and implementation progress are rated. The ICRs may contain several ratings (including ratings on risks, sustainability, impact, quality at entry, Bank supervision, overall Bank performance, borrower preparation, borrower implementation, borrower compliance, overall borrower performance, and ICR quality), but only one—that for overall outcomes—is used in the index. Terminal evaluations can be made available some time after project completion, causing the resulting indicator to be a measure of past perfor-mance. On average, there is a delay in submission of final evaluations to the GEF Evaluation Office of 7.9 months (GEF EO 2008c).

Coverage and Scope

The PIRs and ICRs assess, among other things, the quality of the implementing organization in reaching planned project accomplishments. In the case of GEF projects, this organization is a GEF Agency. Historically, governments have executed

Page 139: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 65

70 percent of GEF FSPs and 36 percent of MSPs; and, in most cases, the government also plays a role in projects executed by NGOs and private sector partners. For projects managed by founda-tions or multilateral or bilateral entities (histori-cally, 28 percent of FSPs, although many of these are global projects), government’s influence on the ability of a project to meet its objectives suc-cessfully or to make implementation progress may be indirect. To the extent that data are available for both Agency and country performance in the ICR, the midterm review did not find that these ratings differed notably or favored Agency perfor-mance over the borrower’s.

Balance and Weights

Delphi participants indicated general support for the inclusion of portfolio performance in the GPI, although that support is not as strong as for the CEPIA and the BFI. There was neutral sup-port for the current weighting of portfolio perfor-mance within the GPI (10 percent), with an aver-age response of 5.3; some experts would support a higher weight for the PPI of up to 30 percent. Statistical simulations were undertaken to change the PPI weight to 30 percent while keeping con-stant other GPI ratios. The results in both focal areas show that the pattern of allocations is not significantly sensitive to increased PPI weight.

Channeling Resources to High-Performing Countries

The 57 countries with individual allocations in bio-diversity accumulate 41 percent of the GPI scores and 75 percent of the funds, while the group allo-cation countries obtain 59 percent of the total GPI scores (see table 4.3). In climate change, the shares are more widely spread: 35 percent versus 65 per-cent of GPI from individual and group allocation countries, respectively. Within the GPI for the first 20 highest ranked countries, 8 out of 20 are indicative countries allocated with $169.27 mil-lion; the other 12 have a higher GPI but a lower GBI and are group allocation countries. The high GPI indicative countries account for 16.9 percent of the total resources.

In general, the countries with the highest GPI are found in the group allocation, and the group allocation countries have more GPI scores col-lectively. The individual allocation countries are spread across the quintiles described in table 4.3.

The GPI has a small range (1–5), and its values are spread more evenly across recipient countries. The six countries with the highest GPI scores are all group allocation countries and are mainly located in Europe.8 Some of the highest GPI-scor-ing countries are fixed at $1 million; some with low performance scores receive high allocations; the rest is spread unevenly.

Table 4.3

Distribution of GPi and GBi scores across GPi Quintiles

Quintile

GPi Allocation GBi

score share (%) Maximum Minimum Million $ share (%) score share (%)

1 113.83 26.7 4.43 3.37 296.99 33.00 2366.42 30.99

2 95.04 22.3 3.36 3.05 246.54 27.39 2011.54 26.34

3 87.58 20.6 3.05 2.74 152.95 16.99 1180.36 15.46

4 79.84 18.7 2.73 2.49 94.55 10.51 694.76 9.10

5 49.72 11.7 2.49 1.27 108.98 12.11 1384.14 18.12

Total 426.01 100.0 4.43 1.27 900.00 100.00 7637.20 100.00

Page 140: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

66 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

It is fair to say that the RAF channels resources to high GBI countries, adjusted to their performance. However, the formula could provide encourage-ment for countries on the margin, such as a group allocation country with a relatively high GBI that can increase its performance rating to be lifted out of the group, or an indicative country that can increase its country share of resource allocations. Countries with a high GBI are less sensitive to changes in performance. For example, China has considerable room to lower its performance effort and keep the ceiling allocation while still retaining $150 million in funding for climate change.

4.3 other Design elements This section details various index-related RAF design elements, specifically weights; flexibil-ity and volatility; and exclusions to the formula, together with floors and ceilings. Further infor-mation is provided in Technical Paper #8, “Com-parison of the GEF RAF with Other Performance-Based Allocation Systems,” section 4.

Weights in the RAF FormulaThis discussion addresses key midterm review questions on the weights of performance within the indexes and the possible impact on allocations of differing weights in the allocation equation.

Definition and Importance of Weights

To apply a weight in an allocation formula, a numer-ical multiplier (or other coefficient) is used in the calculation to control the importance or influence of a particular component. Elements given a rela-tively high weight contribute more to the calcula-tion result than do elements given a lower weight.9

There are two ways in which organizations have chosen to apply weights to factors in their PBA systems. One way is to assign weights to dif-ferent indicators and then add them up. The GEF’s calculation of the GPI is an example of this

approach. The GPI is the sum of three different country scores (for the PPI, CEPIA, and BFI), each with its own weight in the formula (10 percent, 70 percent, and 20 percent, respectively):

GPI = 0.1 PPI + 0.7 CEPIA + 0.2 BFI

This is a relatively simple approach. IDB uses it throughout its PBA. Other organizations (AfDB, CDB, IDA, and IFAD) do not use it throughout the PBA, but they do tend to use it in calculating the performance component.

Another way to assign weights is by using expo-nents in a multiplication formula. Exponential weights encourage volatility in allocations. The overall GEF RAF formula is an example:

Country score = GBI0.8 × GPI1.0

The GBI and GPI exponential weights are 0.8 and 1.0, respectively. The weight of 1.0 indicates no changes to any GPI values when applying the formula.

Virtually all organizations that use PBA systems—with the single exception of IDB—apply this form of allocation formula. There are apparently two reasons why this rather complex mode of assign-ing weights is popular. First, it was the format of the pioneering allocation formula of the World Bank in the 1990s; second, it is commonly held that using exponents in a multiplication formula gives greater weight to performance. In general, it is true that a larger exponent means a higher weight to that variable. However, this link is not straight-forward, because of its exponential nature.

Simulation of Weights

In a multiplication formula, there are many things that affect the resulting pattern of country scores, and the relationships between allocations and variables in such a formula are complex. In fact, the very complexity of this type of formula, and

Page 141: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 67

common misunderstandings about how it works, can be serious arguments against it. With expo-nential weights, relatively minor changes in a country’s score on a given variable can radically affect its dollar allocation, particularly if there is a large exponent on the variable. Exponential weights and changes in performance scores thus can be a rather explosive combination.

The effect of changing weights differs greatly depending on which weight is increased or decreased. The midterm review tested three sce-narios using various modifications to the RAF formula:

Scenario A: Increasing GPI weight from 0.5 z

to 4.0 (by small steps), while keeping the GBI weight constant at 0.8. In both focal areas, increasing the weight of performance would reduce the number of countries with indica-tive allocations, while increasing the maximum allocation to the group countries as well as to the indicative countries. The rankings among top-scoring countries would change in both focal areas.

Scenario B: Keeping the GPI weight equal to z

1.0, while decreasing the GBI weight from 1.0 (by steps) to 0.1. This scenario would have a much larger effect on the current pattern of allocations. As the GBI is applied below its cur-rent exponent, the number of countries chang-ing from indicative to group allocation, or in the other direction, would range from a few to more than a dozen, depending on the particular weight.

Scenario C: Weight both the GBI and GPI z

at 1.0 (neutral weight). This scenario would reduce the number of countries with individual allocations from 57 to 44 in biodiversity and from 46 to 35 in climate change. For example, the top-ranked country in biodiversity would receive $22.6 million more than currently.

These scenarios clearly show that while changes in the relative weights of the GBI and GPI can poten-tially produce significant shifts in country alloca-tions, under the current RAF weights it is the GBI and not the GPI that is the driving force behind the distribution of allocations in both focal areas. The Delphi panel of experts indicated a positive (although not overwhelmingly so, with an average score of 6.3 on a scale of 1–10) assessment on the appropriateness of the relative weights of the GBI and the GPI. The panel participants recognized weighting as a “judgment call.”

Flexibility and Volatility in AllocationsThis discussion covers key questions as to the flexibility of the RAF formula, how scores and allocations fluctuate (volatility), and how the for-mula takes into account changes in the underlying indicators.

Tools for Ensuring Flexibility

In a lending or granting program, formula-based resource allocations must be balanced with effec-tive demand from eligible member countries. Effective demand is partly a matter of a member government’s interests and priorities and partly a matter of absorptive capacity. Since these vary, and since a program’s impact will be significantly affected by the timely utilization of its resources, most organizations have found it important to build flexibility, or readiness to adapt to chang-ing circumstances, into their resource allocation frameworks. There are several ways in which this can be done.

Reserves. z Organizations traditionally main-tain a significant portion of their concession-ary funds in an unallocated reserve. The use of reserve funds is subject to board approval of specific projects. IDB, for example, has a reserve of $100 million.

Page 142: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

68 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Set-asides. z Most organizations have set-asides of funds (taken out of the overall pot of avail-able funds before the country-wise allocation is made) for special purposes. Such purposes include, for example, regional projects, emer-gency/disaster response, post-conflict or frag-ile states, or high-priority public goods such as the control of AIDS. Set-aside funds are nor-mally unrestricted geographically. The portion of funds set aside varies from about 5 percent (for example, the IDA allocation for regional projects) to as much as 25 percent of the total concessionary funds being allocated (for exam-ple, CDB set-asides for regional projects and special purposes). The GEF RAF has a 10 per-cent exclusion of climate change and biodiver-sity funds (including 5 percent for global and regional activities and 5 percent for cross-cut-ting issues, the SGP, and capacity building).10

Reallocations. z If reallocations are sufficiently frequent, they can make a major contribution to flexibility in two ways. First, formal alloca-tions can be made more frequently. IDA allo-cations are done annually, for example, rather than every two years. Second, a single alloca-tion can have several iterations; that is, repooled funds of excess allocations can be reallocated using the same performance-based formula as in the original allocation. This is approximately how IFAD conducted its 2006 allocation exer-cise. IDA, in the third year of its replenishment period, provides for a limited amount of addi-tional ad hoc funds reallocation from specific low-demand countries to specific high-demand countries, as long as funds flow only from lower performing countries to higher.

Special pools of funds. z The GEF has a special pool of 15 percent of the total funds that it has available for biodiversity and climate change grants (the group allocation). The maximum grant for any country in the pool is fixed by

the highest allocation any country in the pool would receive if each received formula-based individual allocations. On the other hand, the pool has a rigid ceiling that cannot be changed, so not all countries can access the maximum. ADB also operates a pool of funds for its Pacific region, which comprises SIDS, at 4.5 percent of total funds. However, there is no obvious gain in flexibility, since the allocation within the pool uses the standard ADB allocation formula resulting in individual allocations.

Front-loading within a replenishment period. z

In most PBA systems, a country may seek access to funds that normally would be available only at a later time in the period, although most orga-nizations do impose limits on such front-load-ing. The rationale for limiting carry-forwards and carry-backs is to discourage governments from using a whole allocation and returning for more, or neglecting to use an allocation until the last minute. However, it is debatable whether this rationale outweighs the practi-cal difficulties created by constraints on how quickly an allocation can be drawn down, espe-cially for small countries trying to put together a viably sized project in face of an already small allocation.

An example of provisions for front-loading is given by IDA, which, in the first year of its roll-ing three-year allocation period, can increase an individual country’s allocation by up to 30 per-cent. The first year share of a country’s AfDB allocation can be increased by up to 50 per-cent, and the ADB first year allocation can be increased by different amounts depending on country size up to 75 percent for the smallest countries. The midterm review Delphi panel on performance indicated moderate to strong agreement with enabling access to 100 percent of country allocations to fund viable projects (average of 7.3 on a 10-point scale).

Page 143: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 69

Back-loading within a replenishment period. z

In general, organizations do not limit back-loading (waiting until late in the replenishment period) until the final year, when allocations that have not been taken up tend to be subject to reallocation.

Waivers, exceptions, and ad hoc adjust- z

ments. Information on waivers, exceptions, and ad hoc adjustments to allocations is diffi-cult to obtain, but they seem to contribute sub-stantially to the flexibility of resource allocation systems in some organizations. For example, actual amounts approved by CDB for some countries during Special Development Fund 5 were, in some instances, twice the formal allo-cation or greater.

Final year adjustments. z Most organizations allow more flexible adjustments to allocations than usual in the final year of the replenishment period. IDA, for example, allows shifting of allocated monies from one country to another in the final year of the allocation period on a paired case-by-case basis. Such case-by-case reallocations must be from a country with a lower performance score to one with a higher performance score. The RAF includes no pro-vision for final year adjustments.

Flexibility in Response to Socioeconomic Changes and Crises

Another aspect of flexibility is a PBA system’s capacity to respond to special country circum-stances that may be relevant to need or perfor-mance, such as significant economic downturns, natural disasters, or extensive civil conflict. The allocation systems of various donor institutions vary in their approaches to such situations. In some, such as the RAF, there is no provision for such circumstances in the PBA system itself. His-torically, countries in conflict situations did not tend to access funding for GEF projects.

In other PBA systems, particular approaches are applied, especially since other organizations nor-mally have crisis and emergency support as part of their mandate. Fragile states receiving AfDB assistance, for example, may receive a “top up” (increase) to their country allocations as fragile states have their own special window for support. In ADB, set-asides for conflict and post-conflict situations account for 10 to 15 percent of the Asian Development Fund. CBD uses its PBA sys-tem flexibly so as to respond to disasters; it also has a vulnerability index which takes into account both economic shocks and natural disasters. The World Bank has a separate assessment for post-conflict countries to replace CPIA scores. This assessment, which is not used by the GEF, includes other indicators such as demobilization of militia. Then, as circumstances allow, a transition period begins using a mixture of the post-conflict assess-ment and the CPIA.

Some have suggested that the GEF should develop a rapid response mechanism for addressing immediate effects of environmental disasters such as extended drought and flooding.11 It is recog-nized that lower income countries tend not to have adequate systems of national response to environmental crises. The RAF does not feature a rapid response mechanism, but crises in various countries have nevertheless drawn project assis-tance from the GEF, sometimes via RAF funding. The GEF was able to quickly approve support in response to the 2008 China earthquake, for example.12

Volatility

Currently, updates to the RAF are conducted every two years. The RAF appears to be more stable than volatile as currently designed; this is also influenced by the lack of new data for some biodiversity indicators. Simulations reveal that a simple one-year updating of performance data

Page 144: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

70 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

results in only minor changes in the overall pat-tern of allocation, but for a relatively small num-ber of countries such an update can be significant. Changes observed are (1) the number of indi-vidual allocation countries and group allocation countries (varying by a couple going up or down), (2) small shifts in group ceilings, and (3) decrease or increase in allocation of more than 10 percent (two countries only).

Group Allocation, supplements, Floors, and Ceilings The following discussion considers the key ques-tion of the impact on allocations of the various exclusions to the allocation formula based on indexes, as well as the impact of the floors in allo-cations. (The 10 percent exclusion for the SGP and global and regional projects is discussed in Technical Paper #4, “Implementation of the RAF,” section 4.2; and Technical Paper #6, “Effects of the RAF on the Small Grants Programme.”)

The Group Allocation and Targeted Supplement

In an unusual move among international financial institutions, the RAF created two categories of countries that are treated differently with regard to allocations.13 The RAF document specifies that the countries with the highest score accumulating up to 75 percent of all focal area funds will receive individual allocations. The remaining countries can access collective funds, amounting to total funds minus the exclusion (or set-aside) of 10 per-cent and minus the funds given to individual allo-cation countries. Before the adjustment of 75 per-cent is made, each group allocation country has a preliminary allocation that corresponds to its score from the RAF formula. This results in two categories of countries:

Category 1: Indicative countries. z This cate-gory is defined by the smallest number of coun-tries whose allocations sum to 75 percent of the

funds available for the focal area. Each country in category 1 received an individual allocation in GEF-4.14

Category 2: Group allocation countries (all z

countries not in category 1).15 A country in this category can access a maximum amount16 equal to the highest individual allocation any country in this group would have received if there had been no grouping. That is, all coun-tries in category 2 have the same maximum amount they can access (subject to a cash con-straint for the whole group).

Each country whose preliminary allocation is less than $1 million is automatically given a minimum adjusted allocation of $1 million, which becomes the floor. The additional amount needed to bring these countries up to $1 million is called a tar-geted supplement—in effect, a kind of subsidy to these countries. The total for such supplements amounts to $41.3 million, or 2 percent of the resources for the two focal areas.

Preliminary country allocations for the 93 countries in the biodiversity group allocation were as fol-lows before they were pooled in the group funds:

Fifty-three countries received allocations in a z

range between $1.02 million and $3.53 million.

Ten countries were set to the minimum allocation z

of $1 million because they had no historical allo-cations, were not previously GEF participants, or lacked basic data for the RAF indicators.

Thirty countries were increased to the mini- z

mum allocation of $1 million because their pre-liminary allocations were below $1 million. The amount needed for the targeted supplement for the biodiversity group was $15.4 million.

Preliminary country allocations for the 115 coun-tries in the climate change group allocation before pooling were as follows:

Page 145: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 71

Forty-one countries received allocations in a z

range between $1.03 million and $2.97 million.

Thirty-three countries were set to the mini- z

mum allocation of $1 million because they lacked historical allocations, were not previ-ously GEF participants, or lacked basic data for the RAF indicators.

Forty-one countries were increased to the mini- z

mum allocation of $1 million because their pre-liminary allocations were below $1 million. The amount needed for the targeted supplement for the climate change group was $25.9 million.

One reason for the group allocation is to give each smaller country access to the possibility of a larger amount than it would have had otherwise. This is not an entitlement, but the possibility of the larger grant could provide category 2 countries with greater flexibility and a greater incentive—the possibility of a grant from each focal area large enough for a substantial viable project. The group countries share about 15 percent of all focal funds.

The RAF document is ambiguous in some impor-tant respects in its explanation of how the group country allocations are to be calculated.17 Each country in the group allocation is limited in the funds for which it can apply in two ways. First, it cannot apply for more than its standard maxi-mum allocation. Second, there is a limit on the total funds available to the group. This situation seems unnecessarily complex. It is clear that the RAF needs simplification with regard to the group allocation for smaller countries.

The midterm review Delphi panel on performance exhibited mixed viewpoints on these issues. Par-ticipant responses did not indicate a consensus on the advisability of exclusions, the group allocation, and targeted supplements. In response to the ques-tion, “To what extent does the exclusion of some

resources impair the achievement of GEF objec-tives?,” the average rating was 4.5 out of a possible 10, with 10 representing “a great extent.” On the other hand, a number of participants expressed the view that the GEF has multiple objectives for these programs and that not all of those objectives are intended to be met by the RAF.

Ceilings

This discussion considers whether a limit (ceil-ing) should be placed on the maximum allocation a country can receive in a single period. Ceilings are limits on country allocations to ensure a more equal distribution of funds. The capped amounts are smaller than what would have been provided to the countries if they received their full alloca-tion as per the formula. In GEF-4, the GEF limited its individual member countries to a maximum allocation of 10 percent of the total funds available in the biodiversity focal area and 15 percent of the funds available in climate change.

Other organizations impose ceilings as well. These ceilings are formulated in various ways. For exam-ple, IFAD has a ceiling of 5 percent of its total funds that can be allocated to any one country during a single replenishment period. IDA limits the allo-cation of any individual country to a maximum of SDR 19.8 per capita. ADB operates what it calls a “soft cap,” whereby blend countries (those coun-tries with access both to ADB’s ordinary capital resources and to Asian Development Fund assis-tance) whose individual allocation is greater than 14 percent of the total funds available receive only half of the allocation above that threshold. AfDB has a maximum allocation of 10 percent of total AfDB funds, and IDB limits individual allocations to a maximum of $54 million per year. CDB has a fixed allocation for Haiti.

Since ceilings are often used as a means of pre-venting especially large-population or low-income

Page 146: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

72 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

countries from being granted major proportions of total available funding, some may argue that they represent a shift away from maximizing potential benefits and performance.18 On the other hand, there may be several reasons for establishing ceil-ings, including answering to political equity and mandate concerns to protect the interests of small countries, practical concerns about absorptive capacity in countries that may be given the largest allocations, and concerns about marginal return to scale of investment.

Without a ceiling, a large country might receive such a large allocation as to crowd out access to resources by some smaller countries entirely, or at least reduce their allocations below the threshold size for a single viable project.19 The choice of a ceiling depends on the degree to which allocations would be skewed toward large countries if the ceiling did not exist. In the GEF biodiversity focal area, for example, no country had received grants historically that exceeded about 4 percent of total funds available. Although there was no pressing need for a ceiling, one was set at 10 percent, with no effect on allocations.

In contrast, in the GEF climate change area, a single country (China) had historically received as much as 17 percent of total funds. A ceiling of 15 percent of total funds was established for this focal area. In this case, the shift for the largest allo-cation country was substantial: without the ceil-ing, China would have received $224 million; with the ceiling, it received $150 million, a reduction of 33 percent. Note that the GEF ceiling is applied to total focal area funds including the exclusion ($1 billion), not as a ceiling on country funds ($900 million) after the exclusion. If the latter were the case, China would have received $135 million in climate change.

Depending on their placement in the overall ranking and the proportion of total funding they

account for, different countries’ sensitivity to ceil-ings varies. For example, if the biodiversity ceiling had been set at 5 percent in GEF-4, the allocations of two countries (Brazil and Mexico) would have been reduced by 21 percent and 8 percent, respec-tively. Since the increment would have been only 2.4 percent of the total monies available in the bio-diversity resource envelope, the impact of the ceil-ing would have been small on countries other than the two directly affected.

In contrast, because a higher proportion of total funding in climate change goes to a few large allo-cation countries, a ceiling of 5 percent in the cli-mate change area would have resulted in a redis-tribution of about 28 percent of total resources in this area. China’s allocation would have fallen by 67 percent, India’s by 33 percent, and Russia’s by 31 percent. As a secondary effect, five countries would have had individual allocations rather than being in the general pool of small countries. If the climate change ceiling for any individual coun-try had been 10 percent of total funds, approxi-mately 7.4 percent of total funds in this focal area would have been redistributed to other coun-tries with modest but discernible effects on their allocations.

Establishing the right ceiling is ultimately a stra-tegic decision, but can have a notable effect on the distribution of funds. In simulations of alter-native levels of country caps, it was found that lower ceilings mainly benefit individual allo-cation countries. An argument for lowering ceil-ings in the climate change area is that, at present, the countries with the largest GHG emissions are receiving large amounts of GEF funds. In addition, the current formula addresses only the potential costs of climate change mitigation and not adapta-tion to the effects of climate change. This suggests the possible utility of lower ceilings, perhaps com-bined with reforms in the nature of the allocation formula, in this focal area.

Page 147: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 73

Floors

Floors aim to secure countries a minimum amount and avoid allocations of tiny amounts that are not practicable for programming purposes. The RAF’s targeted supplement, whereby countries with a preliminary allocation of less than $1 million are provided with a minimum adjusted allocation of $1 million, is in effect a “floor” in allocations. In practical application, this “supplement” becomes part of the group allocation pool, to be shared with other group countries under or above the $1 million floor. There is no guaranteed minimum amount. In biodiversity, 30 countries are subject to the floor; in climate change, 41 countries.

There are three different scenarios with regard to floors.

Scenario A: Floor set lower than $1 million. z

In this scenario, the number of indicative coun-tries falls, but the number in the group alloca-tion grows, the group ceiling becomes higher, and the overall allocation to the indicative countries increases.

Scenario B: No floor. z In this extreme case, allocations are equivalent to a country’s pre-liminary allocation (not made public), however small. No supplement is needed to raise the group countries to $1 million, and the 75 per-cent cutoff point moves up. The number of indicative countries decreases from 57 to 51 in biodiversity and from 46 to 31 in climate change.

Scenario C: Floor set to more than $1 mil- z

lion. In this scenario, the number of indica-tive countries increases, the group shrinks, the group ceiling falls, and the overall allocation to the indicative countries decreases. For example, with a floor at $2 million, the number of indica-tive countries would rise to 75 in biodiversity and to 86 in climate change.

These changes may perhaps seem counterintui-tive, in that if the floor were higher, the supplemen-tary funding needed would normally increase, and there would be less money for individual country allocations. The pattern above is mainly because of the rule that 75 percent of resources go to indic-ative allocations for the top-scored countries. The more funds that are available, the more funds that go to the top 75 percent. The floors help distribute resources across countries to a larger extent than would be the case without floors.

4.4 Recognition of Country Achievements Resource allocation systems such as the RAF have several objectives. One is to address needs and potential benefits; another is to recognize good performance. By “performance,” the GEF means both project performance and policy/institutional performance.20 Both types are important, but the longer term effects of the latter are potentially more significant, because the whole country would be affected by improved policies and insti-tutions. Recognition of this is partly intended to place grants or loans where they are likely to be effective and partly to provide an incentive for improved performance. This means favoring governments that have both the opportunity to produce global benefits and the capability of doing so. These governments have demonstrated that they can use funding well (as measured by their portfolio performance, PPI), and that they have policies and institutions in place that ensure country-wide effectiveness (as measured by their policy and institutional performance, CEPIA and BFI).

In the longer term, the aim is to recognize that member countries have enhanced their practices so that their RAF scores improve, which in turn increases their access to grants. The question is

Page 148: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

74 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

how much a country’s RAF score (and therefore its allocation) changes when its practices upgrade. The incentive depends on how much recogni-tion a country would realistically get when it has improved its practices, and also on government understanding of the links between its perfor-mance, its scores, and the grants it receives.

Incentives are partly a matter of how much money is at stake. There is a wide range of RAF alloca-tions. It is reasonable to assume that larger allo-cations receive more attention from their recipi-ent governments and that larger GEF budgets would exert greater influence. A resource alloca-tion framework can aim to reward performance at many levels, and with different time frames, by recognizing improvements in national policies and institutions (the CPIA and the BFI), of ongo-ing projects (the PPI), and in producing global environmental benefits. The increases in the GBI will naturally be more long term, so the shorter term window for improving scores is through the GPI.

The Relative Weight of Performance in Various Allocation FormulasThe effects of incentive weights are often not easy to understand because of the complexity of the allocation formulas used by multilateral devel-opment banks and funds. Most organizations, including the GEF, use a complex formula that contains several variables, each raised to a par-ticular exponent.21 The weighted scores on the variables are multiplied together to give a coun-try score; resources are then generally allocated in proportion to country scores. Nevertheless, the effective weight of performance is difficult to calculate. It depends on the number of variables, the exponent on each, and the nature and variabil-ity of the underlying data. In general, however, a larger exponent indicates a greater weight to that variable.

The Reasons for Different Weights in Allocation FormulasIDA was the first of the international financial institutions and funds to adopt a formal PBA system with a rules-based allocation formula. Its use dates back to 1977, although during its first decades, it was confidential with access restricted to management. Toward the end of the 1990s, the IDA Board became increasingly interested in two things: (1) the importance of the recipi-ent country’s policy and institutional context in determining whether aid would be effective, and (2) the importance of providing positive incen-tives when providing aid. From 1999 to 2007, all of the international financial institutions and funds adopted the concept of a PBA system for conces-sionary funds, generally during replenishment negotiations. The designers of the new systems had several objectives in mind, including provid-ing a strong incentive for improved performance, avoiding radical shifts in traditional levels of allocations, harmonizing approaches with other international financial institutions and funds, and expressing the special values and priorities of the particular organization.

Of course, not all of these objectives can be maxi-mized at the same time; the result was variations among the allocation formulas alongside some basic similarities. All the formulas contain at least one “needs/potential” variable—in many cases, population or per capita GNI are used as surro-gates for needs and potential.22 The exponents on population vary from about 0.6 to 1.0; smaller exponents on population are more advantageous to smaller countries. The GEF’s choice of 0.8 for its needs and potential variable (GBI) puts it squarely in the middle of this customary range.

The Weight Given to PerformanceAs noted above, it is not easy to tell from a for-mula how much weight is given to performance

Page 149: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 75

because it requires complex calculations of elas-ticities. Some organizations, including IDA, IFAD, and the regional banks, have generally sought to have about 60 percent of the variance in country allocations determined by performance variables in their formula.23 The exponents on variables in the GEF RAF formula are approximately in bal-ance with this idea. Performance is more heavily weighted than needs and potential, but not by much.

With simulations of different weights of the GPI, the RAF formula produces very different incentive effects in the two focal areas. In biodiversity, there are modest but clear incentives; in climate change, there are not (see tables in Statistical Annex #1, “Simulations”).

Biodiversity

In biodiversity, the incentives are positive.

Scenario A: Increasing the weight of the GBI. z Biodiversity allocations are heavily concen-trated in the top quintile and only modestly responsive to increases in the weight of the GBI in the allocation formula. It makes little differ-ence to the bottom three quintiles, essentially because many countries in the bottom quintiles have fixed allocations at a minimum indicative $1 million.

Scenario B: Increasing the weight of the GPI. z In the biodiversity focal area, allocations are considerably less concentrated in the upper quintiles of performance than is the case with climate change. In biodiversity, the resource concentration ratios are in the range of 2.7 to 10.7; in climate change, they are in the range of about 10.6 to 18.1. Modest changes in the weight of the GPI make only a small difference to allocations. Larger changes to the weight of performance do accumulate to substantial dif-ferences.

Climate Change

GEF climate change allocations are not highly responsive to changes in country performance. Part of the reason for this is that China’s allocation does not change, since it is already at the ceiling. Delphi climate change experts agreed that the RAF did not provide adequate incentives for countries to improve their mitigation performance (average of 4.4 on a scale of 1–10).

Scenario A: Increasing the weight of the GBI. z

In climate change, the RAF formula results in a high concentration of allocated monies in the top quintile of member countries (the top quintile by GBI has 76 percent of total climate change funds). The bottom quintile was allo-cated only 3 percent. The resource concentra-tion coefficient is 23.5 to 1.0.24 When increas-ing the GBI weight, nothing much happens. Climate change resources are already highly concentrated in the top fifth of countries.

Scenario B: Increasing the weight of the GPI. z

The resource allocations for climate change are not very sensitive to changes in country perfor-mance unless the weight of the GPI in the allo-cation formula is greatly increased. The pat-tern of allocations is not particularly affected if the weight of the GPI is increased modestly by 10 percent seven times; the top quintile of countries by performance increases its share from 44 percent to 48 percent, and the resource concentration ratio rises from 11.2 to 13.2.

In summary, incentives in the climate change area need improvement. Although the format of the allocation formula for the GBI and the GPI is the same for climate change and biodiversity, the incentives provided to countries in each focal area differ in some respects. In climate change—where the greatest scope for incentives might have been expected because there is much room for policy interventions to lessen emissions—the incen-

Page 150: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

76 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

tive effects of the allocation formula are weak or negative. In essence, the largest emitters receive the largest grants, without a balancing reward for improvement.

The importance of Portfolio PerformanceAll organizations that use a PBA system have a formula that includes a measure of portfolio per-formance. However, this measure has tended to be a controversial variable. Its weight varies greatly from one formula to another (for example, for IDA, it is 8 percent, and for IFAD 35 percent). The weight the GEF gives to project performance is at the lower end of the range (10 percent).

There are arguments for and against a high weight for the PPI. Some believe that the PPI is worth considerable weight because it is a good indicator of likely performance under a new grant, is rela-tively objective, and provides an incentive for per-forming well on GEF projects. Others believe it is unwise to give much weight to the PPI because project performance is a result of many factors including donor behavior. Average project per-formance can also be somewhat open to manipu-lation. For example, consider a country that has only two projects, one performing well and one performing poorly. If the country closes its poorly performing project early, its portfolio now con-tains only the well-performing project and its PPI score could double. Scores thus can be unstable.

On the other hand, another problem with the PPI is that scores can be too stable. When taking a very long-term view (as the GEF does with its 10-year perspective on portfolio performance), the PPI can be out of date and slow to change. If it is, there might be little incentive for a country to try to improve its PPI.

Since the PPI is the only part of the performance factor based directly on GEF judgments (the remaining performance data in the GPI are taken

from other organizations that calculate their own scores for policy and performance assessments), this is perhaps an additional argument for giving it more weight. However, there is inevitably some trade-off between stability (by being averaged over a long period of time) and responsiveness and predictive accuracy (by emphasizing recent performance).

The GBi VariableThe formulas used by PBA systems have two com-ponents. The first measures needs and potential; this shows the scale of the problem to address. Countries that have a large population of very poor people, or high carbon emissions, or a great deal of biodiversity that is under threat receive a higher allocation. The scale of the problem deter-mines the scale of funding.

The scale variable often includes measures of pop-ulation and income (for example, gross national product [GNP] per capita). It can include other variables as well. For example, CDB uses a mea-sure of vulnerability to natural disasters and exter-nal economic shocks; and the European Com-mission uses five variables to indicate the scale of needs and potential, including population, per capita GNP, vulnerability, indebtedness, and rat-ing on the UNDP Human Development Index.

In its biodiversity focal area, the GEF measures needs and potential benefits with a combination of terrestrial data (represented and threatened species) and marine data (represented species). In its climate change area, the GEF measures needs and potential benefits using data on GHG emis-sions.25 The variables in the allocation formula are measured on different scales. Some (the GPI) are on a scale of 1 to 6; others are on much broader scales—the GBICC ranges from 1 to millions. This has no effect on allocation outcomes as long as scoring is true to scale, because it is relative scores

Page 151: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 77

rather than absolute scores that determine alloca-tions among countries.

It is sometimes argued that the scale variable also indicates the most cost-effective opportunities for intervention, but this argument confuses two ideas. First, there are often diminishing returns in any given set of potential investments. A govern-ment faces a set of opportunities for carbon emis-sion abatement, for example, and is well advised to pursue those opportunities first that produce the greatest value for the money. The second idea is that larger countries, having larger problems, will have better investment opportunities. This is not necessarily correct, as it is not possible to generalize by country size where the best marginal returns to investment in carbon emission abate-ment, for instance, will be.

Ideally, the scale variable should have a single weight. Best practice in this regard is the simple arithmetic weights used by IDB.26 The GEF comes close to best practice by having a single scale factor (GBI) and a single performance factor (GPI). Each has a weight, and the two weights total 100 per-cent. In the biodiversity focal area, this works well. In the climate change focal area, the scale factor (GHG emissions) is multiplied by a performance factor (change in the carbon intensity of the econ-omy) before a weight is applied, making it difficult to grasp just how much weight overall is being applied to the scale factor and how much to the performance factor.

summary of Findings on Performance WeightsDelphi experts on performance were not confi-dent about the impact of the CEPIA and the BFI in providing an incentive to countries to improve their performance in the future (average 4.6 for the CEPIA and 4.0 for the BFI, with 10 being “to a large extent”). In their comments, participants

cited the relatively modest level of GEF funding as one reason why the performance impact may not be great. They also mentioned the need for a clear difference in funding between well- and less-well-performing countries and the need to publi-cize performance results and use them in policy dialogues.

As with the CEPIA and the BFI, Delphi partici-pants do not believe that either the PIR or ICR project evaluation performance scores provide a strong incentive to improve performance in the future (average response of 4.9 for PIRs and 4.2 for ICRs, on a scale of 1–10). GEF OFPs noted that ratings for regional projects would not be taken into account, which is of concern to those coun-tries that have mainly benefited from regional GEF funds.

4.5 synergies and interrelationshipsThis section addresses the key question of how the RAF provides opportunities for synergies between climate change and biodiversity work, or with other focal areas. Synergies occur when two or more discrete influences or agents acting together create an effect greater than the separate effects of the individual agents. Synergies were assessed both in terms of the RAF’s index design and RAF implementation.

There is no positive assessment of synergies before the RAF. To date, the GEF has pursued synergies primarily through Operational Program 12: Integrated Ecosystem Management, which is intended to be multifocal and synergistic, mean-ing that achievement of benefits in one focal area would lead to increased benefits in another.27 A review of this operational program by the GEF Evaluation Office (2005), concluded that “very few projects convincingly presented potential synergies among focal areas.” More than 52 per-cent of projects reviewed scored moderately

Page 152: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

78 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

unsatisfactory or less for synergy, while only a little over 25 percent scored satisfactory or bet-ter, and only 5 percent scored highly satisfactory. A STAP review concurs, noting that “GEF project documents do not reveal evidence of a systematic approach to incorporating these [linkages] explic-itly in project design” (GEF STAP 2004b).

Synergies can be particularly important for smaller states. The STAP

recognizes that the GEF has been active in SIDS through all of its focal areas. However … the range of GEF-assisted activities may be more effective if they are better linked in concept and in project interven-tions, and through activities on the ground in any such State (GEF STAP 2007b).

There was no clear goal or assumption that the RAF would lead to synergies. By itself, RAF design does not ensure synergies. The RAF was not assigned goals to promote synergies, and, by its firm distinction between climate change and biodiversity focal area funding, does not ease work between the two fields. Areas important for syn-ergies, such as adaptation, carbon sequestration, Clean Development Mechanism initiatives, and biomass are not covered in the RAF design. How-ever, it is not apparent how these aspects might be reflected in the indexes. For example, a coun-try that loses carbon stocks through burning for-est vegetation would, through the rationale of the RAF index, merit more funding in climate change (higher emissions) but less in biodiversity (threat to ecosystems, reduced forest cover).

Projects funded under the RAF must correspond to GEF-4 focal area strategies, which do not explicitly aim for links or synergies. In the GEF-4 climate change focal area strategy, the only men-tion of links is Strategic Program 6: Management of Land Use, Land-Use Change and Forestry as a Means to Protect Carbon Stocks and Reduce GHG Emissions.28 The GEF-4 biodiversity focal

area strategy does not mention links and syner-gies per se, but these may occur in new strategic programs of sustainable forest management or a strategy for land use, land use change, and forestry and for biomass.

In implementation, synergies under GEF-4 are not linked directly to the RAF. Synergies are more likely to emerge from implementation. Under GEF-4, there has been a growth in programmatic approaches as well as in multifocal approaches (see Technical Paper #4, “Implementation of the RAF,” section 4.2). In part, multifocal projects are now established to overcome rigid walls between limited focal area funding under the RAF. There are some examples of countries obliged to change the pipeline, whereby projects are “merged” to fit allocations without synergy as a primary objec-tive. At the Ninth Meeting of the CBD COP, the Africa representative pointed out that “multi-focal area funding … may constitute a risk for biodiver-sity in that such activities may be diluted.” A STAP review of PIFs in the November 2007 work pro-gram came across only 1 project (of 50), in inter-national waters, that would develop novel forms of intervention and linkages to deliver global envi-ronmental benefits (GEF STAP 2007a).

The GEF emphasizes synergies with other activi-ties at the country level by financing incremental costs of global environmental benefits. The prin-ciple of incremental cost was originally envisaged to ensure that GEF funds do not substitute for existing development finance. The RAF design does not take the actions of governments and other donors on global environmental ben-efits into account. Obviously, improvement in the RAF indexes would stem from support and actions taken by a number of stakeholders, but this is not possible to capture in an index.

The improved predictability of RAF funding may in principle facilitate joint programming, but the

Page 153: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 79

fixed amounts for smaller countries may also make this more challenging. The RAF de facto fixes lim-its on the increment for the country to baseline that government and other donors finance. Delphi biodiversity experts supported the view that the costs of biodiversity conservation and/or sustain-able use should be taken into account to encourage greater conservation of biodiversity and/or sustain-able use of biological resources. However, this does not indicate if more funds should be given to coun-tries managing biodiversity efficiently or to coun-tries with high biodiversity but also high costs.

Few examples were found of key environmen-tal donors being involved in RAF pipeline pri-ority setting at the country level. The GEF does not have specific mechanisms, such as country programs, for donor or stakeholder consultation at the national level. At the project level, there is some indication that the RAF puts more time pressure on project proponents and may make it more difficult to work with cofinancing and other development actions in a synergistic manner.

Conceptually, it might be possible to promote synergies between RAF index design and proj-ect design. There is now no clear relationship between the information used to construct the GBI and the expected benefits of specific pro-posed projects in the focal area. Various stake-holders when interviewed during the midterm review noted that allocations do not seem to translate into projects for which the money was originally allocated. This situation is not helped by the fact that the underlying indicator data have not been disclosed. Other PBA systems use their assessments for dialogue with select countries on relative weaknesses for attention in policy and programming. The lack of policy dialogue and of knowledge of GEF indicator data together repre-sent a lost opportunity for better targeting and effectiveness.

In biodiversity, most indicators provide a score on both representation and threat for ecosystems, mammals, birds, and amphibians. The underlying data have not been disclosed, so it is not possi-ble for countries and Agencies to develop proj-ects consistent with the threat or representation for which the country obtained its allocation. (See Technical Paper #2, “Design of the RAF,” annex A, on relative ranking of the top 25 coun-tries per biodiversity RAF indicator.) Simply put, a country may derive much of its allocation from amphibians and their threat, yet spend its alloca-tion on another species or on other GEF priori-ties not directly related to this aspect. In climate change, the link is less obvious, but most Delphi climate change experts (62 percent) thought that the RAF should provide more opportuni-ties for interactions between climate change and biodiversity work within a context of sustainable development.

Delphi biodiversity participants were neutral regarding whether the information contained in a country’s GBIBIO is relevant for guiding the selection of biodiversity projects (average of 4.7 on a scale of 1–10). Experts did not agree on the extent to which using indicative allocations influ-ences the coherence of GEF biodiversity funding portfolios.

Obviously, there are different incentive structures in the RAF for indicative allocation and group allocation countries. Delphi participants were not convinced that using indicative allocations to guide funding decisions would affect the quality of project proposals. Indicative allocations may allow countries to plan better and may give them more leverage to negotiate, but if allocations are seen as entitlements, proponents may take less care in selecting and preparing proposals. The effect of crowding out NGO and civil society proposals due to caps on funding is also a concern.

Page 154: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

80 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

notesFor the exact language describing the index as 1. approved, see GEF (2005c). For ease of understand-ing, this chapter attempts to describe the index in simple, nontechnical terms.

See UNCBD (2006), Decision BS-III/14.2.

Megadiverse countries harbor the majority of 3. the Earth’s species and are therefore considered extremely biodiverse. The World Conservation Monitoring Centre, a UNEP agency, has identi-fied 17 megadiverse countries, most of which are located in the tropics. A biodiversity hotspot must contain at least 1,500 species of vascular plants as endemics, and it has to have lost at least 70 percent of its original habitat. Around the world, at least 25 areas qualify under this definition; 9 others are possible candidates.

Other scenarios were also simulated: keeping year 4. 2000 for noncarbon but considering two years after and before 2000 for carbon dioxide.

The Delphi panel had an average response of 6.6 5. for “group countries that should qualify for indi-vidual funding” and of 5.1 for “individual countries that should qualify for group allocation.”

Some of these countries have since graduated from 6. GEF support, and three in the climate change area are restricted to the group allocation for historical and other reasons.

The indicator source is from the policies for social 7. inclusion/equity cluster in the IDA CPIA.

Several of these countries have since graduated 8. from GEF assistance.

Vogt (1993). In statistics, for example, weights 9. are commonly applied to various subgroups of a sample to ensure that the resulting analysis reflects the relative proportions of these subgroups in the population at large.

In addition, the GEF manages other resources 10. such as the GEF Trust Fund for the four other focal areas, the adaptation funds, and the funds for climate change (LDC Fund, Special Climate Change Fund). These existed before the RAF was developed and are not set-asides, even though they function as such because they have to be accessed and managed separately.

This was mentioned, for example, in GEF subre-11. gional workshops.

Approval was given at that time to the FSP Rapid 12. Assessment of Chemical Contamination of the Wenchuan Earthquake in Sichuan Province (GEF ID 3702) and the MSP China Biodiversity Partner-ship Framework: Emergency Biodiversity Con-servation Measures for the Recovery and Recon-struction of Wenchuan Earthquake Hit Regions in Sichuan Province (GEF ID 3706).

Some other international financial institutions 13. use pools of funds by country groups but to a much smaller extent. For example, ADB operates a pool of funds for its Pacific region, which, with the exception of Papua New Guinea, comprises very small island states. ADB puts aside $50 mil-lion into a pool that is allocated exclusively among the approximately 15 Pacific member states. Each obtains an individual allocation that is larger than would be the case if these states were to compete for allocations on an equal footing with all mem-ber states.

Each category 1 country was guaranteed an indi-14. vidual allocation (although no fixed amount) through the whole period—that is, its indicative allocation might change after midpoint realloca-tions but would remain an individual allocation. Any country designated as category 1 for the first half of GEF-4 remains in that group for the whole of GEF-4.

In GEF-4, about two-thirds of all countries were in 15. category 2: 62 percent of the countries in the bio-diversity focal area, and 71 percent of the countries in climate change.

Only the highest individual allocation of any coun-16. try in category 2 is made public. The initial indi-vidual allocations that are the basis for the division into categories 1 and 2 are not made public.

Specifically, it requires two incompatible calcula-17. tions (GEF 2005c). First, in paragraphs 9 to 15, it says that exclusions (essentially the 10 percent for global and regional and small grants) are made as the first step in calculating category 2 alloca-tions—that is, all countries bear the cost of these exclusions. The remaining 90 percent of funds (the adjusted allocation) is then split 75/25, mean-ing that category 2 receives 25 percent of 90 per-

Page 155: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

4. Design of the RAF 81

cent, or 22.5 percent of total funds in each focal area. However, paragraph 16 says that the group adjusted allocation (22.5 percent as noted above), exclusions (10 percent), and targeted supplements (the difference between the total unadjusted allocation for all countries under $1 million and the total adjusted allocation for these coun-tries—$1 million each, or $41.3 million in GEF-4) cannot together exceed 25 percent of total funds in the given focal area. Clearly, something must give. If category 2 countries bear the full weight of exclusions as well as of targeted supplements, their share drops from 22.5 percent to around 15 percent. In fact, the 75 percent is applied to the full focal area amount, not to the 90 percent going to countries.

The RAF Delphi panel was not asked a separate 18. question as to the appropriateness of ceilings on the maximum size of a single country allocation.

Ceilings normally redistribute monies proportion-19. ally among all countries too small to reach the ceil-ing. One result is an increase in the median size of allocations, with a positive effect in terms of providing budget coverage for projects of at least minimum size.

See GEF (2003a) for the GEF Council’s definition 20. of performance.

One exception is IDB, which has a relatively sim-21. ple allocation formula. It allocates 60 percent of its concessionary funds (Fund for Special Opera-tions) solely according to member countries’ rela-tive scores on a performance index. Nothing other than country performance is taken into account in allocating this pot of funds. Other pots of conces-sionary funds are allocated separately, each accord-ing to its own relevant variables.

It is interesting to note the use of log population by 22. two organizations (IFAD and the European Com-mission). The effect is to make a nonlinear (expo-nential) distribution of country sizes closer to lin-ear—useful when an organization has many small country members including one or two relatively very large members. By moderating the influence of country size, the log transformation of the scale variable may help avoid explicit and arbitrary caps on the allocations of the largest countries. It would

be possible to use log GBI in the same way and for the same purpose.

The amount of weight given to the performance 23. variable changes frequently even within a single organization. For example, the traditional IDA allocation formula had an exponent of 2.0 for the performance variable, which is the most common exponent for this variable. Recently, however, IDA added a separate governance variable—thus dou-ble counting part of the CPIA—which it shortly thereafter dropped, in favor of splitting the CPIA performance variable in two and raising the expo-nent on the performance variable to 5.0. These changes reportedly did not have a significant effect on allocations as the weights were selected to keep allocations in line with what they would have been under the old formula. Regardless, the sensitivity of IDA allocations to changes in performance in the future has been substantially increased. The GEF RAF, with an exponent of 1.0 for its performance variable, is presumably less sensitive to changes in performance than the IDA system.

The resource concentration coefficient is defined 24. as the ratio of monies allocated to the top quintile relative to the bottom quintile.

The GEF confuses the issue somewhat by includ-25. ing a performance variable—change in carbon intensity of the economy—in its benefits index rather than its performance index.

Even in the IDB case, there are complexities, how-26. ever. There are in fact two scale variables in the IDB formula for allocating the IDB Fund for Special Operations: 22.0 percent of the fund is allocated by share of population alone, and 13.3 percent is allocated by relative levels of per capita GNP alone. These percentage weights are arbitrary, as all judg-mental weights ultimately are; in addition, they lack a visible link to priorities and reasonableness.

Integration and synergies have also been attempted 27. at the institutional level with the creation of the GEF Natural Resources Management Team, which focuses on biodiversity, international waters, and land degradation.

The land use, land use change, and forestry strate-28. gic program is not yet reflected in the indexes.

Page 156: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

82

5. Allocations and Utilization

This chapter presents an overview of RAF alloca-tions and analyzes to which countries funds were allocated and reallocated at midpoint, and how these allocations compare to historical GEF sup-port. It also addresses how resources are utilized and how the GEF portfolio is evolving. For more information, see Technical Paper #3, “RAF Allo-cations and Utilization,” and Statistical Annex #2, “Portfolio Analysis and Historical Allocations.”

5.1 Country AllocationsIn biodiversity, the initial allocation provided 57 countries with individual allocations totaling 75.3 percent of focal area funds ($753.2 million).1 This was part of the RAF negotiation; the highest ranked countries whose cumulative allocations equal 75 percent of the focal area resources receive country-specific indicative allocations. The coun-try with the highest ranking and allocation is Bra-zil, with $63.2 million; Afghanistan has the lowest

individual allocation, with $3.5 million. Of the 150 eligible countries, the 93 without indicative alloca-tions receive a group allocation of $146.8 million.

In climate change, 115 of the 161 eligible coun-tries share $148.6 million in the group allocation. Of the 46 remaining indicative countries, China is the top allocated, receiving the ceiling of 15 per-cent of climate change resources ($150 million); Uganda receives the lowest individual allocation of $3.09 million. Table 5.1 shows the number of coun-tries and allocations, without global and regional resources, as well as past resource utilization for the two categories (individual and group allocation).

Distribution of RAF Allocations As a mathematical model, the RAF formula reflects some degree of consistency with GEF his-torical resource allocations, with most consistency for biodiversity individual allocation countries. As shown in figure 5.1, plotting individual country

Table 5.1

Comparison of historical and RAF Allocations

Allocation type

Allocations for biodiversity Allocations for climate change

RAF Pilot phase to GeF-3 RAF Pilot phase to GeF-3

number of countries

Million $ (% of total)

number of countries

Million $ (% of total)

number of countries

Million $ (% of total)

number of countries

Million $ (% of total)

Individual 57 753 (84%) 57 1,347 (74%) 46 751 (83%) 45 1,557 (82%)

Group 93 147 (16%) 90 481 (26%) 115 149 (17%) 98 331 (18%)

Total 150 900 147 1,828 161 900 143 1,888note: Assumes adjusted allocations.

Page 157: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

5. Allocations and Utilization 83

allocations in a logarithm yields close to paral-lel trend lines between RAF, GEF-3, and histori-

cal allocations. (Since the group allocation does not provide funds in proportion to each country score, trend patterns cannot be analyzed by coun-try in the same way.)

Allocations by Region and Constituency

While the overall trend pattern matches histori-cal utilizations, it conceals differences for specific countries and regions, as it would be impossible for a formula to yield a perfect match. The larg-est allocations by RAF type and region have been assigned to individual climate change allocations in Europe and Central Asia and to individual bio-diversity allocations in Latin America, as shown in figure 5.2. Europe and Central Asia has gained in relative share of climate change funds (from 12 to 28 percent), while Latin America and the Carib-

Figure 5.1

logarithm Match with historical Allocation

-1.0

-0.5

0.0

0.5

1.0

1.5

2.0

2.5

1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0Log GBI

Log allocation in biodiversity

Pilot to GEF-3RAF allocationGEF-3

Figure 5.2

Regional shares of Resources: historical and RAF Adjusted Allocations

note: Dollars are in millions. Biodiversity allocations apply to 150 eligible countries, climate change to 161eligible countries.

$63.117%

$197.0022%

$360.8740%

$28.613%

$53.146%

$197.2622%

Europe and Central Asia

East Asia and the Paci�c

Latin America and the Caribbean

Middle East and North Africa

South Asia

Sub-Saharan Africa$224.1012%

$558.8029%

$428.8623%

$186.9810%

$243.0413%

$246.0013% $244.38

28%

$237.6326%

$147.5916%

$62.337%

$102.1111%

$105.9612%

c. Climate change: historical allocation

b. Biodiversity: RAF adjusted allocation

d. Climate change: RAF adjusted allocation

a. Biodiversity: historical allocation

$97.765%

$152.258%

$193.6411%

$289.8916%

$633.6135%

$460.7425%

Page 158: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

84 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Table 5.2

Comparison of historical, Adjusted, and Unadjusted Group Allocations under the RAFmillion $

Constituency/region

Group allocation for biodiversity (93 countries)

Group allocation for climate change (115 countries)

GeF-4 utilizationa

historicalRAF

adjusted$1 million/

country historicalRAF

adjusted$1 million/

countryBD

(93)CC

(115)

Europe and CIS 108.51 26.21 23.00 48.06 21.61 15.00 14.20 0.99

Asia 65.75 16.83 8.00 43.98 12.94 10.00 2.04 0.00

West and Central Africa 132.73 35.27 21.00 76.25 31.48 25.00 4.60 0.00

East and Southern Africa 41.80 11.32 8.00 55.52 20.42 15.00 1.54 1.01

Caribbean 38.89 21.30 12.00 12.56 17.31 15.00 5.47 0.10

Pacific SIDS 6.26 20.63 12.00 6.12 14.00 14.00 6.26 1.08

Latin America 38.27 6.52 3.00 43.58 14.83 9.00 2.41 1.84

Middle East & North Africa 48.89 8.71 6.00 44.92 16.02 12.00 2.71 1.10

Total 481.10 146.80 93.00 331.00 148.62 115.00 39.21 6.11notes: BD = biodiversity; CC = climate change; CIS = Commonwealth of Independent States. Historical allocations include aggregate resources from 1990 to 2006 (16 years). RAF allocations include assumed funds for 2006–10 (4 years).

a. Actual utilization as of July 3, 2008.

bean has decreased its share in climate change (from 23 to 16 percent) but gained in biodiversity (from 35 to 40 percent).

Individual allocation countries. z There is some match between the share of resources histori-cally and the RAF regionally and by GEF con-stituency. Among the countries with individual allocations, the increase in climate change in Europe is offset by a decrease in shares for Latin America and the Caribbean, Asia, and the Middle East and North Africa. In biodiversity, the percentage changes are smaller for the indi-vidual countries, and most receive exactly or approximately the same shares of resources as in the past (see Technical Paper #3, “RAF Allo-cations and Utilization,” table 2).

Group allocation countries. z Although the group allocation countries are pooled together, they each had a score and allocation that reflect their potential environmental benefits and performance. Once the countries are put in

the group, it is less certain what a country can access. Table 5.2 shows two RAF scenarios: the first is the RAF adjusted allocation (what these countries accumulate before they are placed in the group); in the second, each receives $1 mil-lion each, a lower total amount. The likely uti-lization will of course differ from these scenar-ios; actual utilization in terms of approvals until GEF-4 midpoint (last two columns) is currently too low to provide a useful estimate.

Distribution by RAF Allocation Category

The type of RAF allocation, namely the distinc-tion between individual or group allocation, is now more important than the traditional regional dis-tribution in shaping the pattern of GEF resources. New country “groups” are emerging with the intro-duction of the RAF, with a diverse mix of catego-ries. This mix influences regional cooperation and means that regions require diversified support. The different RAF allocation types are as follows.

Page 159: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

5. Allocations and Utilization 85

Group allocation countries in both focal z

areas. This is the largest category by far (78 countries or 48 percent of all eligible coun-tries). Of these, 30 (39 percent) are from Sub-Saharan Africa, and 30 countries (with 4 over-lapping with Africa) are SIDS. Another 12 are from Eastern Europe. Three countries in Latin America (El Salvador, Paraguay, and Uruguay), four in Asia (Bhutan, Myanmar, Nepal, the Republic of Korea), and five from the Middle East and North Africa (Jordan, Lebanon, Libya, Tunisia, and the Republic of Yemen) are part of the group allocation. Historically, they accessed $326.2 million in climate change (share of 17 percent) and $485.9 million (share of 27 per-cent) in biodiversity.

Countries with only climate change group z

allocation. This group, which receives no bio-diversity allocation at all, consists of 11 coun-tries; most of which are new to the GEF, and several of which are Arab states: Bahrain, Cyprus, Israel, Kuwait, Malta, Oman, Qatar, San Marino, Saudi Arabia, Singapore, and the United Arab Emirates.

Allocations for Special Categories of Countries

The regional distribution conceals specific needs and country circumstances. The majority of countries in special circumstances—LDCs, crisis or post-conflict countries, small states—forms part of the group allocation.2 In climate change, 97 percent of the 35 SIDS receive the group allocation; 88 percent of 48 LDCs are group allocation countries. The other coun-try categories—87 percent of fragile states, 88 percent of heavily indebted poor countries, and 75 percent of landlocked countries—fall into the group allocation in both focal areas (see table 1.3 in chapter 1 and Technical Paper #3, “RAF Allocations and Utilization,” section 1.3).

Countries with individual allocations in z

both focal areas. These are “the big recipients” (31 countries, or 19 percent of 161) and the most diverse group regionally. These countries are found in Africa (22 percent), Latin America and the Caribbean (29 percent), Asia (26 per-cent), and the Middle East and North Africa and Europe (26 percent for the two regions combined). However, their level of resources varies considerably, with 14 biodiversity coun-tries and 16 climate change countries with allocations between $3 and 10 million, and 5 countries with more than $50 million. These countries account for $549.7 million in biodiver-sity (61 percent of the $900 million allocated to individual countries) and $608.9 million (68 per-cent of $900 million) in climate change. Their historical shares are 54 percent of biodiversity and 73 percent of climate change resources.

Biodiversity countries. z These have individual allocations in biodiversity and a group alloca-tion in climate change (26 countries, or 16 per-cent of 161). They are just about evenly distrib-uted between Africa (11) and Latin America (10). This category of countries also has the proportionately highest representation of SIDS (7 of 26). Together, these countries account for $195.6 million (22 percent of the $900 million allocated to countries) of GEF-4 biodiversity country funds, compared to 20 percent of bio-diversity (and 6 percent of climate change) his-torical resources.

Climate change countries. z These have indi-vidual allocations in climate change and a group allocation in biodiversity (15 countries, 9 per-cent). This group is dominated by countries in Europe and the Commonwealth of Indepen-dent States (10). These countries account for $142.5 million (16 percent of $900 million) in climate change, compared to 9 percent over past replenishment phases.

Page 160: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

86 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

In biodiversity, more countries in special circum-stances receive individual allocations, but the majority of countries are still part of the group allocation (74 percent of SIDS; 60 percent of LDCs, heavily indebted poor countries, and land-locked countries; and 73 percent of fragile states). Supporting data and definitions are available in Statistical Annex #4, “Country Classification and RAF Allocations.”

The majority of RAF funding goes to countries categorized as either low income or lower mid-dle income.3 Of 161 countries, 32 percent (51) are low income and 33 percent (53) are lower middle income, assuming that the 75 group allocation countries (of 107) in these two categories obtain $1 million (see table 5.3). High-income countries have a per capita GNI of $11,456 or more, with Singapore at the top of GEF-eligible countries with $29,320 (as of 2006). However, all of the 17 high-income countries receive group allocations only.4 The relatively largest share of funds goes to upper middle-income countries: in biodiversity, 38 percent of funds go to upper middle-income countries, which is 23 percent of all countries; in climate change, 34 percent of funds go to 25 per-cent of countries. Low-income countries receive

23 percent of biodiversity funds and 25 percent of climate change funds to countries (LDCs receive 17 percent and 9 percent), assuming they access the equivalent of their adjusted allocation.

historical Use of GeF ResourcesThere are three ways of comparing historical with current allocations: (1) relative rankings, (2) shares of total allocations, and (3) actual amounts.5

Comparative Ranking

The RAF approximates the relative ranking of countries of GEF historical allocations; this is par-ticularly true for biodiversity and for the top- and lower ranked countries. When comparing histori-cal utilization to current RAF allocations, several patterns emerge.

There is a relatively good match in the rank-ings from the RAF allocation and historical utilization. The top four recipients of biodiver-sity RAF allocations are the same as for historical allocations, and the top two for climate change are the same. All but 3 of the top 20 in the RAF bio-diversity allocation ranking were also in the top 20 historically, and 12 of 20 countries in climate change are the same. (See table 5.4.)

Table 5.3

Allocations under the RAF by Country income Category

income category

Biodiversity Climate change

number of countries

Allocation (million $)

number of countries

Allocation (million $)Total

individual allocation

Group allocation Total

individual allocation

Group allocation

Upper middle income 36 14 22 304.78 37 17 20 339.24

Lower middle income 53 23 30 359.85 53 16 37 335.91

Low income 51 20 31 221.65 51 13 38 203.77

High income: OECD 1 0 1 2.89 1 0 1 1.00

High income: non-OECD 5 0 5 6.82 15 0 15 16.07

Not classified 4 0 4 4.00 4 0 4 4.00

Total 150 57 93 900.0 161 46 115 900.00note: Assumes RAF adjusted allocation for group allocation countries.

Page 161: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

5. Allocations and Utilization 87

In climate change, 5 of the top 10 recipients are new. In biodiversity, only 2 of the top 10 countries are new. There is also a general match between the group allocation countries and countries with historically low allocations. For countries whose ranking is in between—a medium-level individual allocation—there is general correspondence in relative ranking, but also movement up or down for several countries.

Comparative Shares

Because the value of nominal U.S. dollar amounts has decreased over time, comparison by share of resources in a period yields a more accurate measure. The top 3 countries of 150 biodiversity countries account for almost 16 percent of the total past allocation; they now account for 18 per-cent of $900 million in biodiversity. In biodiver-sity, the shares per country reflect past shares of focal area utilization relatively well. Brazil, with 7.0 percent of RAF biodiversity funds, had a 6.8 percent share in the past; and Mexico, with 6.0 percent, had 5.1 percent historically. It is dif-

ficult to discern a pattern of decrease or increase in share, and differences are in small percentage increments. No country is close to the ceiling of 10 percent of focal area funds.

In climate change, some individual differences from past share are greater than for biodiversity, but overall shares are also similar and without a clear pattern. China now accounts for 16.7 per-cent of the RAF adjusted allocation compared to 17.9 percent in the past; and India, with 8.3 per-cent, had a 9.9 percent share historically. Russia has increased from 1.0 percent to 8.1 percent under the RAF, while Mexico has decreased from 7.0 to 3.1 percent.

Figure 5.3 shows the share of resource use for individual and group allocation countries by replenishment period. The overall pattern is rela-tively consistent in share, ranging between 70 and 85 percent for the individual allocation countries. In GEF-3, more countries accessed resources than in the past, so the difference seems more marked when compared to GEF-4.

Table 5.4

Top 10 Recipients of GeF Assistance under the RAF and historically

Rank

Biodiversity Climate change

RAF historical RAF historical

Ranking Allocation (million $) Ranking

Allocation (million $) Ranking

Allocation (million $) Ranking

Allocation (million $)

1 Brazil 63.2 Brazil 121.69 China 150.0 China 336.58

2 Mexico 54.6 Mexico 91.68 India 74.9 India 185.52

3 China 44.3 China 83.22 Russia 72.5 Brazil 134.38

4 Indonesia 41.4 Indonesia 59.12 Brazil 38.1 Mexico 132.22

5 Colombia 36.6 Russia 56.51 Poland 38.1 Egypt, Arab Rep. of 69.08

6 India 29.6 Colombia 54.75 Mexico 28.3 Philippines 68.28

7 Russia 25.3 India 52.96 South Africa 23.9 Morocco 57.53

8 Peru 25.3 Philippines 43.66 Ukraine 18.9 Poland 54.39

9 Madagascar 24.2 South Africa 43.20 Turkey 17.5 Indonesia 48.91

10 Ecuador 23.2 Peru 42.76 Iran, Islam Rep. of 16.5 Vietnam 35.39

note: Historical allocations include aggregate resources from 1990 to 2006 (16 years). RAF allocations include assumed funds for 2006–10 (4 years).

Page 162: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

88 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Comparative Amounts

In terms of actual allocation compared to past amounts, there is an uneven mix of increase and decrease in country allocations in both focal areas. For stakeholders, the perception of actual amounts seems more important than rank-ing. The match between the historical experi-ence with GEF programming and RAF alloca-tions influences how countries have been able to address the transition to the RAF. Historical allocations are available in Statistical Annex #2, “Portfolio Analysis and Historical Allocations.” Key trends in biodiversity and climate change follow.

Most countries have gained in resources z

available under the RAF, especially in cli-mate change, compared to their historical average four-year replenishment allocation. In biodiversity, 39 percent of countries have seen some gain, and in climate change 81 per-cent, including countries with no historical allocation. A few countries have doubled their past allocation or increased it by more than 1,000 percent (about 36 climate change recipi-ents and 25 countries in biodiversity).

The main large recipients historically con- z

tinue to benefit from high RAF individual allocations, and many have experienced increases. Among the countries that have gained compared to their past allocations are some of the largest recipients under the RAF. In climate change, the $150 million amount for China for four years is larger than its $21 mil-lion annual average historical allocation. In biodiversity, Brazil’s average yearly allocation is $15.8 million under the RAF compared to $7.6 million annually over 16 years. Several countries have gained comparatively in both focal areas, including Malaysia, Russia, Thai-land, and República Bolivariana de Venezuela.

Countries that received little in the past z

may gain under the RAF, even if they now only receive group allocations. The bot-tom 25 percent of countries in biodiversity accessed an average of $0.98 million over 16 years. In GEF-3, 51 countries (30 percent of 166) did not access any GEF-3 resources for country projects in either focal area.6 Some countries that may now benefit from group allocations never accessed any GEF resources over 16 years (3 countries in biodiversity and 19 in climate change).

Some midrank countries have seen a drop in z

RAF resources in their focal area compared to historical support. This is true for about 32 countries in biodiversity and 30 countries in cli-mate change. Most of these have become group allocation countries. For example, Ghana had more than $6 million in biodiversity and $4 mil-lion in climate change each replenishment period, and is now part of the group allocation in each focal area. Among individual allocation countries, three in biodiversity and nine in cli-mate change have seen a relative reduction in support (such as the Arab Republic of Egypt).

Figure 5.3

shares of Resource Utilization by individual and Group Allocation Countries by Replenishment Period

% of total phase replenishment

0

20

40

60

80

100

Biodiversityindividual

Climatechange

individual

Biodiversitygroup

Climatechangegroup

Pilot phase GEF-1 GEF-2 GEF-3 GEF-4

Page 163: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

5. Allocations and Utilization 89

Some countries have experienced a switch in z

resource availability between the two focal areas. Cambodia, for example, with an average of $1.7 million in each past replenishment period, gained an individual allocation of $3.3 million in climate change, but dropped from a $2.7 mil-lion average to a group allocation in biodiversity. Bangladesh, Pakistan, the Slovak Republic, and Ukraine saw similar increases in climate change and drops in biodiversity; Cuba, Kenya, Mex-ico, Morocco, Peru, the Philippines, and South Africa received more funds in biodiversity and saw drops in their climate change funding.

Country allocations mean that the recipient coun-tries receive less resources from global and regional GEF funding, which is a significant shift for those countries that have in the past depended more on such resources than on funding for country-spe-cific projects. The above trends underestimate the RAF changes in such countries. (See chapter 6 and Technical Paper #4, “Implementation of the RAF,” section 4.2.)

Reallocation As agreed when the RAF was approved, a recalcu-lation of indexes was undertaken at the midpoint of GEF-4, and a reallocation of funds published in August 2008 (GEF 2008f). The reallocation reflected changes in eligibility with new coun-tries in both focal areas (Serbia and Montenegro, Timor-Leste). Six countries became ineligible in climate change and biodiversity (Estonia, Hun-gary, Latvia, Lithuania, Poland, and Slovenia).7

One country in biodiversity—Suriname—was lifted to indicative allocations from the group allo-cation, as were four countries in climate change: Croatia, Serbia, Tunisia, and Turkmenistan. The overall increase in programmable resources also led to an increase in amounts for both individual and group allocation countries. Eighty-four coun-

tries each in biodiversity and climate change saw an increase in their allocation from the initial RAF amount, while 32 countries in biodiversity and 66 in climate change experienced no change in fund-ing. Relative decreases in funding were experi-enced by 28 biodiversity countries and 5 climate change countries (see Technical Paper #3, “RAF Allocations and Utilization”).

5.2 Portfolio overview This section addresses how the resources allocated have been used so far, with patterns of changes in GEF programming for the portfolio and pipeline under GEF-4.

Resource Utilization The RAF has caused substantial changes in implementation. RAF allocations may not be significantly different overall, but in implementa-tion changes are obvious at several levels: resource utilization, Agency composition and involvement, and project modalities and the nature of projects.

By midpoint in the GEF-4 replenishment period, the GEF had allocated a total of $1.3 billion, of which $295 million has gone to biodiversity and $280 million to climate change.8 This corresponds to an overall resource utilization rate of 31 percent at midpoint. For non-RAF focal areas, resource utilization is considerably higher in shares and actual amounts: 81 percent for land degradation, 59 percent for international waters, and 48 per-cent for POPs. At midpoint in GEF-3, 42 percent of all resources had been committed for projects, compared to the RAF overall resource utiliza-tion rate of 23 percent in biodiversity and 21 per-cent in climate change. This masks considerable differences among countries.

Few projects have started. Under the new proj-ect cycle, utilization is defined as PIF approval of project concepts. If utilization is defined as project

Page 164: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

90 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

document endorsement, it is at 6 percent of total GEF-4 country RAF funding. Fifteen FSPs in cli-mate change and biodiversity totaling $103.2 mil-lion have been endorsed by the GEF CEO;9 and were expected to begin implementation on aver-age within four months of endorsement. Fifty MSPs totaling $43.9 million have been approved by the CEO. PIFs for another 74 FSPs have been approved; many of these were included in the April 2008 work program. Assuming a 22-month proj-ect cycle, their endorsement would be expected in February 2010, four months before the end of GEF-4. One FSP under the RAF is recorded in the Secretariat database as having started implemen-tation by November 2008.

Resource use is uneven. On average, the individ-ual allocation countries in biodiversity have used 34 percent of their full initial allocation, while those in climate change have used 33 percent of their funds. More negatively affected are climate change group allocation countries, which have only utilized 5 percent of their allocation, and the biodiversity group allocation with 18 percent.

Allocation of GEF resources under the RAF has become relatively more dispersed—and, conse-quently, less equal, as measured by the Gini coeffi-cient of inequality (see Statistical Annex #1, “Sim-ulations”).10 For both focal areas, the utilization at midpoint is more unequal than both the histori-cal utilization and the RAF allocation, meaning that the difference in which succeeds in accessing resources has increased. Utilization to midpoint of biodiversity resources indicates that the spread, or “concentration of resources,” has increased the Gini coefficient to 0.60 (from 0.45) for individual allocation countries. Utilization of climate change resources to midpoint indicates that the Gini coef-ficient is 0.76 for individual allocation countries. This makes the RAF, as of its utilization at mid-point, more unequal in its distribution of resources

than any country in the world as measured by the Gini coefficient.

Several factors, including various GEF reforms, play a role in access to resources. Approvals in the first half of replenishment periods are generally slower than in the second half. However, utiliza-tion in the RAF focal areas is slower at midpoint than in the past. At GEF-3 midterm, 37 percent of total biodiversity resources, and 44 percent of climate change resources, had been approved. By October 2008, the GEF Secretariat reported that the overall ratio of utilization in GEF-4 was 37 percent in biodiversity and 36 percent in cli-mate change (GEF 2008l).

At GEF-4 midpoint, there has been a significant increase in utilization in non-RAF focal areas (43 percent of midterm GEF-4 resources) relative to both biodiversity and climate change. Resource utilization in the two RAF focal areas is lagging compared to both historical practice and to other focal areas under GEF-4, which have been sub-ject to the same reforms. As shown in figure 5.4, countries and Agencies seem to have shifted their attention to non-RAF areas.

Figure 5.4

shares of historical and GeF-4 Resource Utilization by Focal Area

Pilotphase

0

10

20

30

40

50

GEF-1 GEF-2 GEF-3 GEF-4

% of total phase replenishment

Biodiversity

Climatechange

Multifocal

Non-RAF

43 43

23

2

21

13138

4

1719 19

25

403838

36 35 31

Page 165: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

5. Allocations and Utilization 91

The main problems in access to funds are found in Sub-Saharan African countries. A total of 130 countries (of 161) have a group allocation of some kind. At midpoint, average utilization across the biodiversity group allocation countries was $317,000, and the average climate change group allocation utilization was $62,000. When tak-ing into account other concurrent factors, it was confirmed that being assigned to the group cat-egory is associated with the largest difference in resource utilization. Key drivers in resource utili-zation are (1) being a country in Africa, (2) being an IDA or IBRD grant recipient country, and (3) being an LDC.11 Controlling for all contextual fac-tors, the following associations are noted, in order of magnitude:

The utilization in biodiversity by IBRD coun- z

tries is 50 percent as compared with 18 percent for non-IBRD countries. The utilization by LDCs is just 8 percent as compared with non-LDCs at 40 percent. By region, countries outside Africa (98) have on average utilized 39 percent of their biodiversity allocation, as compared with 52 African countries which have on aver-age utilized 14 percent (statistically significant at 1 percent).

For climate change, assignment to the group z

allocation category makes the largest (negative, 24 percent less) difference to resource utiliza-tion. When controlling for all factors, World Bank blend countries, which have access to both IBRD loans and IDA grants, show a posi-tive correlation with resource use (35 percent more access than nonblend countries), while IBRD countries show a positive effect (20 per-cent more than non-IBRD).12 Differences across regions are not significant.

To some extent, this pattern matches the histori-cal patterns of resource utilization, in that few countries have managed to access resources in all

four phases from the pilot phase to GEF-3. Only 16 percent and 9 percent of the currently eligi-ble countries in biodiversity and climate change, respectively, have accessed GEF funds since the pilot phase until now (see table 5.5). Only 15 coun-tries in biodiversity and 14 in climate change experienced a fluctuation in access every other replenishment, of which most are group alloca-tion countries. However, while many countries have accessed funds historically, the amounts have often been limited. Almost half of the countries have received less than $500,000 in total histori-cally, equivalent to an enabling activity.

Table 5.5

number and Percentage of Countries with Resource Access across the GeF Phases

Access

Biodiversity Climate change

number % number %

1 phase only 24 16 18 11

2 phases 54 36 68 42

3 phases 44 29 41 46

Pilot to GEF-3 24 16 14 9

Total 150 161

The number of countries that did not access funds in GEF-3 is 61 in biodiversity and 52 in climate change. Only 21 countries did not access GEF-3 funds in either focal area; 7 of these are SIDS. The number of countries involved with the GEF has grown over time. In GEF-3, more than 100 coun-tries received funds in each focal area, up from 49 countries in biodiversity and 24 in climate change in the pilot phase. Thus, most countries would expect to access funds during a replenishment period. (See Technical Paper #3, “RAF Allocations and Utilization,” tables 10 and 11.)

Agency DistributionThe portfolio distribution among GEF Agen-cies has shifted significantly under the RAF.

Page 166: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

92 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

The World Bank, historically the largest Agency in terms of GEF resources under implementation, has dropped from more than half of GEF utiliza-tion in biodiversity and climate change in past periods to 32 percent of RAF resource utilization. UNDP now accounts for 43 percent of resource utilization, up from 32 percent in GEF-3. The role of the seven Executing Agencies has increased; these currently account for 17 percent of RAF uti-lization, compared to about 8 percent in GEF-3 including indirect access, or 2 percent of all his-torical resources. UNEP’s share remains more or less the same (7 percent) for the RAF focal areas. Joint projects seem to have disappeared.13 (See fig-ure 1.2 in chapter 1 and Technical Paper #3, “RAF Allocations and Utilization.”)

There are slight differences in modalities across Agencies. UNDP accounts for $201 million for 49 FSPs (average size: $4 million). UNDP also has the most MSPs (40), and implements 8 of the 10 enabling activities approved. The World Bank has 23 FSPs ($175 million, average of $7.6 million each), mainly in climate change. With $99 million in approvals, the Executing Agencies have sur-passed UNEP ($42.1 million).

The non-RAF focal areas have higher resource utilization. The World Bank leads in the non-RAF focal areas ($181 million), closely followed by UNDP ($178 million). The Executing Agency share in the non-RAF focal areas is very competitive. In particular, the United Nations Industrial Develop-ment Organization is active in POPs (13 projects), and IFAD in land degradation (13 projects). In the multifocal area, UNDP has accessed $114 million, as compared to $56 million by World Bank/IFC for the Earth Fund.

Project Modalities Three interlinked trends are notable regarding modalities, namely changes in the mix of modali-

ties, new types of projects, and changes in the average size of projects.

The main focus under the RAF is on FSPs, with a decrease in enabling activities and project preparation grants. The relative number of MSPs is growing, but the evolution is uncer-tain. Of total RAF resources, 91.0 percent has been allocated to FSPs, 7.0 percent to MSPs, 1.0 percent to preparation grants, and 0.5 percent to enabling activities. According to the Joint Evaluation of the GEF Activity Cycle and Modalities database, the percentage of FSPs in the past portfolio is the same, has increased slightly for MSPs (historically 3 percent), and has decreased for enabling activi-ties (historically 4 percent) and preparation grants (previously termed PDFs14). With assumed likeli-hood of $1 million per country, MSPs are more likely for group allocation countries. Given the low resource utilization for the group allocation, the number of likely MSPs may be underestimated.

In GEF-4, the average size of FSPs has declined somewhat, dropping from $7.7 million over past replenishment periods to $5.3 million. The average size of FSPs in biodiversity for individual countries has been $8 million. In climate change, the average size of an FSP has been $10 million for individual countries. Historically, the average FSP for group allocation countries has been $4.5 mil-lion in biodiversity and $3.7 million in climate change, which is lower than the maximum per country in the group allocation.

Because MSPs have a standard cap of $1 mil-lion, there is little difference in MSP size between group and individual allocation countries and with the past.15 There is a slight increase from $0.8 million to $1 million on aver-age. A contributing factor is the policy under the RAF to finance Agency fees on top of $1 million for group countries, rather than inclusive of fees as for indicative RAF allocations.

Page 167: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

5. Allocations and Utilization 93

Multifocal projects (27) have historically averaged $6 million. In GEF-4, a total of $169 million (33 percent) for FSPs are for so-called projects with a “financial break-up” project classifica-tion. These are projects defined by the GEF Secre-tariat database with the same identification num-ber, spread over numerous countries, Agencies, and/or focal areas. The trend of break-up projects is related, in part, to the increase under the RAF to make a viable project by combining resources from different sources or funding windows in and outside of the RAF.16

notesThis amount was the equivalent of 83.7 percent of 1. $900 million, which excludes the set-side.

Small states include SIDS as well as other nations 2. of small geographical size and population such as Bhutan, Djibouti, Equatorial Guinea, Gabon, The Gambia, and Swaziland.

All World Bank member economies, and all other 3. economies with populations of more than 30,000, have been categorized by the Bank into income groups according to their 2007 per capita GNI; this has been calculated using the World Bank Atlas method. The income groups are: low income, $935 or less; lower middle income, $936–$3,705; upper middle income, $3,706–$11,455; and LDC, $745. One RAF country recipient (the Republic of Korea) is designated as an OECD high-income country. Information is not available for four Pacific states receiving funding under the RAF.

These 17 high-income countries are Antigua 4. and Barbuda, The Bahamas, Bahrain, Barba-dos, Cyprus, Estonia, Israel, Republic of Korea, Kuwait, Malta, Qatar, San Marino, Saudi Arabia, Singapore, Slovenia, Trinidad and Tobago, and the United Arab Emirates.

Comparison of actual amounts is not exact, as it 5. must take into account varying replenishment sizes and durations, depreciation and inflation over time, and country resource use over differ-ent replenishment periods. The midterm review compiled the total amount provided per country for 1990–2006 (16 years) and divided this over

four replenishment periods of four years each. This addresses historical support consistently for all countries but may conceal uneven activity in each replenishment period for a given country. To compare average amounts per year would entail incorporation of some amounts that would be too small to be useful.

The median GEF country utilized $0.7 million over 6. four years for single country projects.

These were largely group allocation countries, 7. except for Hungary, Latvia, Lithuania, and Poland, which were indicative countries in climate change.

All RAF amounts cited here include Agency fees; 8. RAF data are as of July 3, 2008.

Under this reckoning, SGP contributions are 9. counted as one project, program documents under programmatic approaches are not counted, and individual PIFs approved with different identifica-tion numbers are counted.

The Gini coefficient is the most commonly used 10. measure of inequality. The coefficient varies between 0, which reflects complete equality, and 1, which indicates complete inequality (one country has all the income or consumption, and all others have none).

Other variables, such as geographical region or 11. being a small island developing state or a land-locked country, were not found to be statistically significant.

Blend countries are those “that are eligible for IDA 12. resources on the basis of per capita income but also have limited creditworthiness to borrow from IBRD” (IDA 2001b).

This may also be due in part to the manner of 13. recording resources under GEF-4, by which funds are split in the GEF database by Agency and RAF funding source.

These numbers are not strictly comparable, since 14. PDFs for approved past projects are included in full project budgets. Past PDFs amount to $138 million for 420 FSPs and 164 MSPs.

Average funding for a biodiversity MSP in the past 15. was $0.84 million for individual countries and $0.78 million for group allocation countries. Com-

Page 168: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

94 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

parable figures for climate change were $0.85 mil-lion and $0.81 million, respectively.

This also means that comparative analysis is 16. exceedingly difficult. Projects downloaded from the GEF Project Management Information Sys-tem no longer have a unique identifier (ID) as in the past; instead, many have the same number. Any of these project IDs may be a single project

with different funding sources (say from the RAF and another focal area), a single project with one funding source but different Implementing Agen-cies, several projects under a single programmatic approach, not a real project at all (such as a coun-try allocation contribution to the SGP), or a mix of the above. For meaningful analysis, the midterm review had to identify and aggregate these into a single project (where identifiable).

Page 169: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

95

6. implementation of the RAF

This chapter explores the implementation of the RAF, including roles and responsibilities, support and guidance, barriers and promoting factors to access of funds, emerging effects, and issues of cost-effectiveness.

6.1 institutional Roles and RelationshipsThe GEF is a networked organization, made up of a diverse group of partners playing a variety of roles. Responsibility for accomplishment of GEF goals is shared among the multiple entities. Flows of authority and accountability are complex. Rela-tionships, particularly on an informal basis, shift and evolve as circumstances change within and among the respective organizations.

The RAF has not caused any major formal changes in roles, but ways of doing business, organizational arrangements, and relationships among partner organizations have shifted—in some cases, signifi-cantly. The most important developments are ones that have taken place outside the realm of formal adjustments to traditional roles, typically in response to constraints and opportunities presented by RAF implementation. These include the following.

The bilateral relationship between z country focal points and the GEF Secretariat has grown in importance. Management of country project pipelines—an issue of less compelling

concern before the RAF’s implementation—is now critically important to all GEF entities. GEF OFPs now play a more central role in pipe-line planning and prioritization.

The z GEF Secretariat appears to have become relatively more influential than before the RAF, partially because the outcomes of project pro-posal reviews by the Secretariat affect country pipelines. In addition, the Secretariat directly consults with OFPs regarding prioritization of projects within pipelines. Some stakeholders feel that the Secretariat’s role in GEF policy for-mulation has expanded as well.

The pattern of changes among z Implementing and Executing Agencies is mixed. Some Agen-cies have expanded their levels of GEF activity in the RAF context; others have slowed down.

In the implementation phase of projects, z

NGOs and the private sector appear to be less engaged than they were before the RAF, perhaps in large part because of the more pre-dominant role played by national governments in portfolio planning.

The roles of z other GEF entities, such as the GEF Council, the STAP, the GEF Trustee, and the GEF Evaluation Office, have not changed significantly.

Other (non-RAF) changes in GEF policies and procedures have accentuated these shifts in roles.

Page 170: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

96 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

During the first half of GEF-4, certain develop-ments and reforms were put into place roughly at the same time that the RAF came into full imple-mentation. These developments include stop-page of the GEF pipeline (late 2006), revision of the GEF project cycle (June 2007), approval of the Agency comparative advantage paper (June 2007), approval of focal area strategies for GEF-4 (July 2007), and revisions of project approval templates (September 2006 and April 2008). These reforms reinforced the increasingly enhanced role of the GEF Secretariat, with a commensurate shift in Agency positioning.

Taken together, these changes have generally added complexity to the work of GEF entities and country partners. Some, such as the timing of approval of focal area strategies, likely would not have been hindrances to normal forward progress in the GEF had they not taken place along with early implementation of the RAF. While the RAF design does not call for any of these changes, the shifts in roles and relationships observed are a summative result of the procedural developments themselves and RAF implementation.

GeF Focal PointsIn some ways, the RAF has empowered coun-try focal points; in other ways, it has diminished their influence. Most stakeholders find that the RAF can potentially strengthen the role of coun-try participants. In the survey conducted by the midterm review, 63 percent of GEF stakeholders believed that the RAF may strengthen country roles in portfolio planning, while 25 percent held this to be mostly or completely untrue. GEF coun-try focal points and government staff were most likely to agree, with 77 percent finding the state-ment mostly or completely true.

The RAF seems to have boosted the focal point role in individual allocation countries. The

administrative and political resources available to OFPs in these countries tend to be better than in many group allocation countries, although not without constraints. It is the focal points in indi-vidual allocation countries who tend to be regu-larly contacted by the GEF Agencies. In these countries, focal points report that the RAF allo-cation has provided them with a platform for coordination and attention to GEF matters, both among other ministries and at the political level. The certainty attached to the individual country allocation helps attract stakeholders, including GEF Agencies, and often promotes a more delib-erate approach to portfolio planning. For example, in Bulgaria, the RAF increased political awareness of the GEF, and GEF priority setting is now under-taken at the ministerial level.

Group allocation countries are often lower income countries with relatively limited institu-tional capacity for managing a GEF portfolio. The scope of consultations on national pipeline priori-ties tends to be similar regardless of whether the country has a large or small allocation, which puts a relatively greater strain on smaller countries.

GeF secretariatThe role of the GEF Secretariat has changed, but its institutional capacity is challenged. The influ-ence of the GEF Secretariat has expanded, but not without strains. As noted above, the influence of the Secretariat within the RAF context has evolved on an informal basis. In RAF implementation, the Secretariat has a facilitating function, but also sees its role as one of quality control and steer-ing the project development and approval pro-cess. Performance of its other functions, such as those regarding focal areas, policies, project rejec-tion, the project cycle, and financial requirements, are seen by the Secretariat staff—and particularly the CEO—as concerns separate from RAF imple-mentation, even though some of these decisions

Page 171: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 97

have implications for RAF implementation and relationships.

The organizational rearrangements in the Sec-retariat may also influence RAF implementation. Relationships and delineation of responsibility are not as smooth as some would wish, with the exter-nal relations team interacting with focal points on general concerns on their pipeline, the focal area teams interacting with Agency task managers and sometimes countries on project proposals, and the operations team interacting with the other teams and Agency coordinators to facilitate overall RAF implementation. The Secretariat faces several hin-drances to its effectiveness as a key institutional participant in the GEF under the RAF, including the following:

There was considerable z turnover of more than half of its staff during the first half of GEF-4. The staff turnover may also contribute to less frequent personal interaction between the Agencies and Secretariat staff.

The Secretariat is responsible for z multiple functions and has new internal organizational arrangements to address them.

Cross-team communication z within the Sec-retariat is challenged by the multiplicity of demands placed on the teams and the increas-ing need to coordinate effectively across teams. GEF Secretariat staff morale appears to be low, as captured by the 2007 staff satisfaction survey of the World Bank Group.

Field visits and z country contacts by the Secre-tariat staff are minimal, impeding adequacy of communication.

Majorities among the GEF stakeholders observe that implementation of the RAF may have been accompanied by enhancement of the influence of the GEF Secretariat in project and portfolio plan-

ning. Sixty percent of all stakeholders responding indicated that RAF implementation “may shift project decision-making power in favor of the GEF Secretariat.”1

Its only formal change in roles or responsibilities has been for the GEF Secretariat to manage the RAF. In essence, this is a program support function that provides the Secretariat with access to infor-mation on RAF design and implementation. The pipeline consultation teleconferences between the Secretariat and OFPs in early 2007, in particular, is an example of new bilateral relations between countries and the GEF enabled by the introduc-tion of the RAF. While the idea of the teleconfer-ences was welcomed by most, there has been no capacity for systematic follow-up, a constraint clearly felt by many Secretariat staff members.

GeF AgenciesThe RAF has significantly affected the GEF Agen-cies, with mixed but mainly negative results. The RAF has influenced Agency composition, role, and engagement in several ways:

It has strengthened the government role in pipe- z

line development, which has changed demand for certain types of projects and affected those Agencies traditionally working with the private sector or NGOs (such as IFC).

It has reduced the availability of global and z

regional funds, and its direct steerage by the Secretariat has curtailed UNEP involvement in particular.

The small level of allocation for group countries z

has affected all Agencies, in that most focus on larger countries that provide opportunities for synergies, reasonable transaction costs, and mainstreaming.

Some countries did not have regular GEF activ- z

ity in each replenishment period. Some Agen-

Page 172: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

98 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

cies now find it difficult to develop small proj-ects for the range of eligible countries in the short time frame involved. This puts pressure on Agency representation in such countries, which might not be as used to dealing with GEF requirements.

The shift from historical allocations to the RAF z

focus and the concentration of funding in coun-tries have disturbed Agencies’ traditional pat-tern of engagement. Countries are often quite specific as to which Agencies they want to work with, based on involvement with the Agencies on their regular portfolios.

The RAF necessity of country dialogue and z

planning encourages focal points to rely on Agencies’ in-country presence. The Agency with the most extensive country office presence is UNDP, with 142 offices in developing coun-tries; the World Bank has about 111 offices.

The walls between focal areas and the lim- z

ited funds for some countries have enabled the push for programmatic approaches and multifocal projects to gain momentum. Both the Secretariat and the Agencies have taken on new functions, with new design and imple-mentation challenges under the programmatic approaches.

The policy on comparative advantage (GEF 2006g) outlines the relative areas of technical and mana-gerial strength for each of the GEF Agencies and encourages them to focus their GEF work in the areas identified. An outgrowth of this refinement has been an increase in the tendency of OFPs to “comparison shop” among Agencies for a pre-ferred project partner, shifting decision-making power in the countries’ favor and placing Agen-cies in a more directly competitive context than earlier. Some OFPs use the RAF allocation to share smaller projects among several Agencies; this tends to crowd out an Agency needing larger

interventions. In some cases, the GEF Secretar-iat has decided to shift Agency responsibility to another Agency; this has been done, for example, for at least four Pacific countries and in the Dem-ocratic Republic of Congo. This practice creates disincentives for Agencies to put effort into proj-ect proposals.

Other factors are also involved in the changed position of the GEF Agencies:

Added complexity. z This complexity takes various forms, and entails frequent changes in format and procedures. It can prove difficult to match the resources available in a country’s RAF allocation to the project features an Agency is capable of delivering and to the capacity of an Agency’s local office. Many Agency task man-agers have become discouraged and may back away from dealing with the added GEF com-plexities, making it more challenging to find a “champion” within an Agency to overcome challenges in pursuing GEF funding.

Changes in financial context. z Reductions in the corporate budget for the Implementing Agencies and the flexibility to negotiate fees, the lack of availability of fees for programmatic approaches, and reduction in the value of the U.S. dollar all contribute to increased financial strains in doing GEF Agency business.

Additional functional demands. z GEF Agen-cies have had to take on additional responsibili-ties, such as including monitoring and evalu-ation plans with projects, expanded fiduciary responsibilities, and the need to be prepared for audits and other forms of administrative scrutiny.

RAF support. z An added function for the Agen-cies has been to provide training and informa-tion on the GEF changes and the RAF, as well as sometimes serving as the bearer of “bad news.”

Page 173: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 99

The instructions from the GEF CEO to the Agen-cies not to consult with countries and the cancel-lation of their pipeline projects have further dis-couraged Agency commitment to the GEF. Some Agencies have other options for funding and may feel they no longer have to endure discordant treatment from the GEF in programming.

nGos, the Private sector, and Civil societyThe RAF has, in general, negatively affected the roles of the private sector, civil society, and the NGO community.

NGOs

There are a few excellent examples of government-NGO cooperation on GEF programming, such as in Honduras, Madagascar, and Uganda. However, in the majority of countries, the involvement of the NGO community has declined or at least not improved. There was no involvement of or consul-tation with the NGO Network or accredited NGO partners on RAF design and operational policies for implementation, which might have mitigated some negative effects.

The RAF has affected NGOs in several ways:

NGOs have had low or uncertain involvement z

in national priority setting. Where national committees for GEF matters have been estab-lished, the review found no systematic evidence of NGO membership. In interviews, the focal points often did not indicate that they had consulted with NGOs. However, in countries where priority setting was undertaken through stakeholder workshops, NGOs did participate.

Previously, much NGO consultation happened z

at the project design level. As priority setting has moved up to the portfolio level, the engage-ment of NGOs has diminished. The reduction of the extensive project preparation facility also tends to curtail preproject outreach.

There has been a reduction in NGO z project execution. NGOs used to execute 1.9 percent of FSPs and 28.6 percent of MSPs, accord-ing to the Joint Evaluation of the GEF Activity Cycle and Modalities database. Under the RAF, 20 projects (all but 1 in biodiversity) are classi-fied as having an NGO as the executing agency, including 3 enabling activities, 7 MSPs, and 10 FSPs.2 With a total budget of $63.2 million, this is 11 percent of all funds for FSPs, MSPs, grants, and enabling activities.3 Of 14 country MSPs and FSPs, 11 are in individual allocation countries.

Funding for the z SGP, which is a key vehicle for access to GEF funding by community-based organizations, has changed.

Private Sector and Civil Society

Historically, the private sector executed 1.2 per-cent of FSPs and 4.0 percent of MSPs, again according to the Joint Evaluation database. There are now no projects under the RAF executed by the private sector, and the midterm review con-sultations on the emerging pipeline did not reveal a high likelihood of future projects. The private sector’s lack of engagement will likely affect the recent policy on nongrant instruments (April 2008). Factors in the lack of involvement of the private sector include the central role of country governments through the OFPs, as well as the lack of certainty in accessing funding easily. Also, much private sector cooperation in the past has taken place through IFC. IFC is now working with three endorsed GEF-3 projects and has no proposals in the pipeline.

The main vehicle for GEF collaboration with the private sector is the GEF Earth Fund, previously the IFC-implemented GEF Public Private Part-nership Initiative (GEF ID 3357). The Earth Fund was approved in June 2007 to establish innovative partnerships with the private sector to generate

Page 174: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

100 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

global environmental benefits in a sustainable and cost-effective manner. The budget for this multi-focal project, which has a GEF contribution of $50 million, draws on resources from the Trustee’s project data reconciliation and savings in the cor-porate budget. The Earth Fund is designed around five initial “platforms” and will rely on project pro-posals to disburse funds. Because the partnership is not yet operational as of this writing, it is too soon to say how it will affect the private sector and GEF cooperation.

There was no clear consensus among participants in the Delphi peer study as to whether the RAF should be amended to take into account private sector involvement. Sentiment ran in favor of incorporating some measure of private sector involvement and that the private sector should be viewed broadly and include individual households as well as businesses.

6.2 Guidance, support, and Transparency Within the GEF network, the provision of support, information, policies, and guidance is part of the function of the GEF Secretariat as well as of the GEF Agencies. This section addresses the issues of how guidelines and GEF support facilitate timely and efficient implementation of the RAF.

support and Guidance The GEF has used a number of channels to dis-seminate RAF-related information and provide support to its stakeholders, including some six CEO letters and guidelines; the GEF Web site, which was updated in 2006 and 2008; the country portal with access to portfolio information; RAF documents; subregional workshops for sharing information among countries; teleconferences with 127 countries; the Country Support Pro-gramme; bilateral support and interaction; sup-

port of national consultations; and support for programmatic approaches.

When asked by the midterm review survey about the utility of such information and assistance, a slight majority of stakeholders (51 percent) found these to be helpful, 31 percent found them to be a hindrance, and 21 percent found them to be both helpful and hindering. Overall, GEF stakeholders appear to be disappointed in the level of trans-parency regarding GEF design and the allocation process, but they are receptive to outreach and information-sharing activities.

The extensive guidelines and support offered have not succeeded in making the RAF trans-parent and accessible. Guidance, especially on implementation issues, has not been sufficient or fully consistent for countries and Agencies. The GEF partnership moved quickly to provide information once the RAF had been approved. The workshops under the Country Support Pro-gramme and the GEF country profile Web pages were helpful in providing basic information to focal points.

The effectiveness of guidance on implementation and support provided seems to have been coun-teracted by changes in guidance and decisions, or indications of follow-up that did not material-ize, so many countries did not know quite how to proceed. This includes periodic summary of the resources allocated, a schedule of periodic reviews for pipeline entry of concepts, and the pipeline for the GRE. On different occasions, countries were advised of different approaches to pipeline priori-ties and SGP funding. The April 2006 RAF guide-lines (GEF 2006b) consist mainly of instructions on how to establish a pipeline for the RAF allo-cation but fall short of providing comprehensive guidance on how to understand, introduce, and manage the RAF, as had originally been requested by the Council. The GEF Operations Manual was

Page 175: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 101

released in April 2008, but it is not accessible to country stakeholders and does not add informa-tion on the RAF beyond the guidelines.

Tools also were not provided to help OFPs inform other stakeholders. Some countries hired per-sonnel to help with the translation of the RAF guidelines, such as Sri Lanka, which translated the RAF documents into Sinhala. Countries have expressed concern that the direct support facility, established before the RAF at $8,000, is insuffi-cient given the expanded role of focal points and national consultations, and especially where sev-eral rounds of consultations are needed (as was the case in Togo).

Historically, countries frequently relied on the Agencies for instructions regarding GEF proce-dures. In many cases, however, Agency country offices were also uncertain about the changing rules on the RAF and the new project cycle, as they were not party to additional information beyond what was available to the focal points. Exclusion from pipeline discussions and changing imple-mentation arrangements have hampered Agency offices’ ability to provide clarification and support to countries.

Once the initial RAF launch was complete, coun-try concerns moved to support for developing projects to access funds within the RAF period. In this changing context, neither the GEF Secretariat nor the Agencies have been able to provide timely and clear feedback to countries on a systematic basis. Countries are no longer sure of where to turn for resolution, and miscommunication frequently occurs. The country Web pages do not provide up-to-date status of PIFs before they are approved by the Secretariat, so countries do not know the status of their project ideas. This does not imply that the Agencies and the Secretariat are not working on the issue, but that the channels of communication for feedback do not seem to function effectively.

The trend of bilateral discussions among partners in a multiparty network appears to have caused a number of misunderstandings as well.

At the GEF Council’s request, the Secretariat has prepared progress reports on the implementation of the RAF. As these reports are not well known to country stakeholders or task managers, this chan-nel of information does not reach them. Stake-holders who are familiar with these reports do not find their format helpful in obtaining an accurate, realistic picture of RAF status.

Overall, the GEF channels of information dis-semination have relied on traditional support mechanisms of letters, guidelines, and workshops. These may not suffice for the kind of training and continuous support needed for a multicom-ponent, multidimensional system with so many different actors and country categories. Enhanc-ing communication with the GEF constituencies is ranked as one of the major issues of interest to stakeholders.

Transparency and Public Disclosure The need for public involvement and informa-tion dissemination is set forth explicitly both in the GEF Instrument and in the GEF definition of the RAF. A 2005 GEF technical paper notes, “Throughout its deliberations, the Council has consistently agreed on the need for public disclo-sure of the GEF Resource Allocation Framework to increase the transparency of the system” (GEF 2005h). In response to these concerns, in 2007, the GEF Council approved a new communication and outreach strategy which aims to improve the GEF’s accessibility.4

The GBI and RAF allocations for countries were made public on September 15, 2006, after the replenishment negotiations were concluded and GEF-4 was slated to begin. This disclosure docu-ment (GEF 2006c) contains indicative allocations

Page 176: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

102 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

for the individual allocations, the GBI for both focal areas, and each country’s percentage share of the GBI.5 Because of the RAF, a list of GEF-eligible countries has been made public for the first time.

At its November 2005 meeting, the Council agreed that individual country allocations and the GBI for all countries would be publicly disclosed and that CPIA data used in the GPI would be provided via a link from the GEF Web site to that of the World Bank. Council discussions on disclosure had focused on the confidentiality of the World Bank CPIA indicators and how to address this. The lack of participation in the design and development of the RAF did not give stakeholders an opportunity to understand the approach, which in turn, has created some discomfort with the final results and data.

The GEF Secretariat had proposed that the GEF would publicly disclose all RAF data and indica-tors; this would include both the methodology and indicators for the GBI, GPI, BFI, and PPI. The approved RAF paper states that “The public disclosure of data and indicators used in the RAF depends on the rules and conditions placed on the use of such information by the source of the infor-mation [emphasis added]” (GEF 2005c). Except for the conditions placed on the World Bank CPIA data used in the GEF GPI, the midterm review has not found any overview of rules and conditions with the GEF Secretariat limiting disclosure of the “raw” data from sources of information. All of the original data underpinning the GBI indicators are in the public domain, although not always in the same form as used by the GEF.

It was also proposed that the indicators used for the BFI and the CEPIA would be disclosed only to respective countries, which is how the World Bank handles its CPIA scores. Other organiza-tions would be able to use the scores for policy dialogue with the countries in discussing how to

focus their efforts. There is no evidence that this has been done for the GEF GPI scores. And, while the World Bank CPIA scores may be shared with the countries, the midterm review found that this does not include the GEF focal points.

The actual disclosure of information is thus less ambitious than was originally proposed and what is legally possible. The GEF has not publicly disclosed all of the information needed for countries to understand why they receive a par-ticular allocation amount, including the indexes, their formula, and the indicators that they consist of; the original data underpinning the indicators; the methodology to develop the indexes from these data; and the allocations resulting from the application of the formula and indexes. A major-ity (59 percent) of respondents to the midterm review’s stakeholder survey indicated that they found it mostly or completely true that “The pro-cess of awarding country allocations may not be sufficiently transparent.” Given the complexity of the RAF index scores and calculations, it is pos-sible that further disclosure may not help provide such clarity.

6.3 RAF effectiveness and efficiency This section looks at the barriers and promoting factors for access to funds by countries, and the underlying reasons for these. It builds on changes in the GEF portfolio and pipeline, contextual issues, and feedback from interviews and surveys. Factors promoting or hindering access to GEF funds are summarized in table 6.1.

Access to funds has so far not been fully satisfac-tory. Group allocation countries have accessed relatively less than indicative countries with uti-lization in biodiversity, 27 percent; and climate change, 5 percent (GEF 2008f). Resource access is uneven within each category of countries. With

Page 177: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 103

individual allocations, 12 biodiversity countries and 6 climate change countries have not accessed any funds; in the group allocations, 47 countries for biodiversity and 104 for climate change have not yet accessed any GEF funds.

Factors Promoting Access to RAF ResourcesMany countries have succeeded in gaining access to RAF funds via approved projects. Some coun-tries have hastened to obtain project approvals under their allocations (nine countries reached their maximum 50 percent of total GEF-4 alloca-tions in June 2007, over a year before midpoint).6 At least four aspects of the RAF setting have been beneficial to improved access.

Improved z predictability is especially benefi-cial for countries with individual allocations. These countries tend to view their allocations as promoting a more systematic approach to GEF portfolio planning, especially for coun-tries with a high allocation, which have “revi-talized” their GEF programming (such as India and Russia). For example, in climate change, the 11 countries with high resource utiliza-tion all have high country allocations. Of the 15 upper middle-income biodiversity coun-tries, virtually all have high resource utilization. However, predictability contains a limitation, in that knowing the allocation is small may inhibit

national stakeholders from action. For both focal areas, low resource utilization is generally linked to having smaller individual allocations or to being an LDC (even one with a relatively high allocation).

A z history of engagement with the GEF, cou-pled with an existing pipeline, has helped some countries use the predictability of funding to push projects. They have either been able to progress with projects already under develop-ment during GEF-3 or to generate new project ideas quickly. This facility obviously requires in-country technical expertise and familiarity with GEF requirements and processes. Virtu-ally all the countries with high allocations and high resource utilization had a considerable pipeline already under development and were able to continue almost as usual.

An improved sense of z country ownership is found in many countries, most commonly among individual allocation countries. The increased significance of the role of the GEF OFP is both a manifestation of and a contrib-uting factor toward increased ownership. With a known allocation, national stakeholders and Agencies alike are given the incentive to con-tribute to proposal development. Expanded participation and engagement of expertise can be a key resource, although in itself it is no guar-antee that all choices will be the right ones.

Strengthened z support from GEF entities is widely appreciated among the focal points and can enable countries to work more efficiently and effectively with GEF Agencies toward suc-cessful project proposals. This support may come from the Country Support Programme or through funds available to the GEF focal points. In addition, the development of a country pro-file page on the GEF Web site allows countries access to portfolio and related information.

Table 6.1

Key Factors influencing Access to Funds

Promoting factors Barriers to access

Enhanced predictability in yGEF fundingHistorical engagement ywith the GEFCountry ownership ySupport from the GEF and yAgencies

Small allocations yCorporate reforms and yrelated developmentsGaps in knowledge yCapacity limitations y50 percent rule yCofinancing y

Page 178: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

104 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Some focal points have also reported posi-tive, constructive working relationships with the GEF Secretariat on PIF or project prepa-ration grant reviews. Additionally, the select CEO exceptions to the 50 percent rule bring up the overall rate of resource utilization. The Secretariat, along with the GEF Agencies, has increased its efforts to develop programmatic approaches to help boost the access of funds by group allocation countries, especially in the Pacific, the Caribbean, and West and Central Africa.

Many Agencies have mobilized support to help raise awareness and understanding of the RAF at the country level, facilitate national priority setting, and develop project proposals. Coun-tries that have a tradition of working with the Agencies and coordinating efforts with them may have been more successful in securing support.

Despite these measures, there is still high frus-tration with the overall lack of support in many countries. The shift in Agency composition has placed stress on other Agencies to fill the gap, with some resulting bottlenecks. Expec-tations that all countries should access funds in the four years, which was never historically the case, have placed additional demands on Agency capacity. There have been delays in the development of PIFs and project documents, and, most of all, insufficient feedback to coun-tries on the status of their proposals.

Barriers to Access to RAF ResourcesWhile predictability and strengthened support are helpful, they cannot overcome the generally more powerful limitations observed at the GEF-wide level. Aside from increasing the size of allo-cations, which would require an adjustment to the RAF’s design (or an unusually large future replen-ishment), the other limitations described below

are matters of procedural simplification and of improvements to the administrative capacity of the various GEF entities.

Small Allocations

Countries identified the limited RAF allocation itself as a barrier to access. This is especially true for the group allocation countries, although some countries with individual allocations also see this as a constraint.

For many countries, and especially group allo-cation countries that historically may have used little or no GEF resources, the RAF presents a dilemma. GEF resources are “newly available” in the sense that countries are given a tentative allo-cation, but access to these funds requires develop-ing successful proposals that fit within the alloca-tion as well as with GEF priorities. In addition, a change in a country’s historical funding levels can result in challenges. The funding limits and time constraints associated with the RAF have led to changes in patterns of accessing GEF funds.

A substantial 71 percent of stakeholders indicated in the midterm review survey that country allo-cations may be so small they discourage develop-ment of project proposals. This view varied across different categories of stakeholders, with 59 per-cent of focal points and government staff, 73 per-cent of NGO staff, and 88 percent of Agency staff finding this to be mostly or completely true. The restricted level of funds inhibits access to resources in different ways:

Countries that have seen a z drop in RAF resources in the focal area compared to his-torical support seem to have low resource uti-lization, although past experience has demon-strated their ability to access GEF funds (such as Burkina Faso, Egypt, Ghana, and Uganda). This appears to be linked to a decline in moti-vation to program small fund amounts, when

Page 179: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 105

stakeholders have historically expected larger amounts of funds that better reflected their needs.

Countries that have experienced a z switch in resource availability between the two focal areas can attempt to manage this dual focus. Substantial allocation reductions across replen-ishments can lead to low utilization.

Small overall allocations often mean z smaller projects, either by reducing projects to fit the allocation or by countries dividing the portfo-lio into smaller projects per national priority or Agency share.

Limited funds can make it impossible for coun- z

tries to address either national or GEF priori-ties. From African focal points, the midterm review heard that “The national priorities are so vast that they cannot be satisfied with one small project.” Other proposals cannot satisfy the relatively ambitious scope of the GEF-4 strategic priorities, especially in climate change where projects are historically larger so as to address market transformation effectively.

GEF Corporate Reforms and Related Developments

During the first half of GEF-4, certain develop-ments and reforms were put into place roughly concurrent with the RAF’s full implementation. These changes together added complication to RAF implementation and resource utilization; they include the following.

Stoppage of the GEF pipeline. z To allow for more efficient processing of project propos-als, the CEO canceled the existing pipeline. The late replenishment also led to a stoppage of work programs in December 2006. A major-ity of respondents to the midterm review’s stakeholder survey (70 percent) recognized the closeout and restart of the GEF pipeline as a hindrance to accessing GEF funds; only 11 per-

cent of the respondents reported that they found these changes to be helpful.7

Revision of the project cycle. z In response to a grossly overloaded GEF pipeline and to a GEF Evaluation Office analysis of the problem (GEF EO 2007d), the GEF Council modified the activity cycle in June 2007. As GEF entities have thus far worked with the new cycle, the occa-sional procedural error has been made, taking time and effort to resolve.8 Forty-six percent of all stakeholders recognized changes in the proj-ect cycle as a hindrance, while only 24 percent viewed them as a helpful factor.

Revision of project approval templates. z The initial templates for submitting project iden-tification information were made available in September 2006, but experience subsequently showed that revisions were necessary. Interim drafts were circulated to Agencies, changes were incorporated, and revised templates were made available in April 2008. For those sub-mitting projects for approval, this sequence resulted in two separate waves of revision to the forms and guidance. In many cases the “origi-nal” GEF-4 submissions were revised versions of proposals left over from GEF-3. Because existing submissions were not “grandfathered,” requests for approval were, on occasion, sub-mitted two or even three times, according to Agency and focal point sources.

Scope and timing of PIF reviews. z Many inter-viewees expressed dissatisfaction with the con-tent and timeliness of PIF reviews. According to reports from Agencies and OFPs, there is a tendency on the GEF Secretariat’s side to call for further details to explain or expand upon the content of originally submitted PIFs. The result has been “bounce backs,” widespread frustration, and discouragement regarding subsequent proposals. RAF complexities exac-erbate this barrier.

Page 180: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

106 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Approval of focal area strategies for GEF-4. z In content, the strategies, which were approved in July 2007, are not seen as constraining pipe-line prioritization, but delays in their approval resulted in pipeline development and priori-tization consultations in their absence, thus leaving room for interpretation. Moreover, the strategies are often too ambitious for countries’ project proposals, especially group allocation countries with limited funds.

Bilateral teleconferences on the pipeline. z

The teleconferences between the GEF Secre-tariat and focal points (2006–07) were advisory consultations, but the follow-up letters identi-fied feedback on proposals. The rate of project clearance was low. Actionable items were not fully clear to countries, and the parties that were supposed to take action (the Agencies) were not part of the discussions. Consequently, the tele-conferences have given rise to a number of mis-understandings. The in-depth country reviews in 2008 revealed that the “experience of the RAF negotiations for developing project pro-posals and endorsement of PIFs has increased the perception that country ownership of GEF projects has diminished” (GEF EO 2008a). Cou-pled with the instructions that Agencies should not negotiate PIFs before country-Secretariat agreement, the teleconferences led to a freeze on planning in some countries and regions.

Gaps in Knowledge

For the GEF to work effectively under the RAF, all parties directly involved in implementation need to be kept adequately informed of the new set of RAF-related rules and procedures. Countries and GEF Agencies have together struggled to share their understanding of the RAF. Unfortunately, the RAF’s history is characterized by limited disclo-sure on technical design points, incomplete trans-parency of decision making, unclear guidance,

mixed messages or operational policy changes, and indications of further guidance and action that did not materialize. These limitations have translated into weak institutional responsiveness and have implications for project delivery.

Most countries are now aware of the basics of what the RAF is and how it works. There remain some exceptions, however, especially in group alloca-tion countries. Individual allocation countries are clear regarding the amounts of money they have available, but not regarding how they are to obtain it (including the 50 percent rule and other process concerns). Recipient countries that are represented on the Council were generally able to understand the RAF at an earlier point, but this understanding is not shared by their constituencies.

The high rate of turnover among GEF focal points undermines efforts at sustained clarity of com-munication to countries regarding GEF proce-dures and policies. Most stakeholders agree that there is a need to better inform countries on RAF implementation and to improve GEF information systems.

Capacity Limits

Whether a country’s RAF allocation is large or small, it calls for a bundle of basic resources, such as technical expertise, human time and energy, administrative capacity, networking and consul-tation skills, and political influence to manage its country portfolio effectively. When the critical mass of such resources is not present, the modest level of resources made available through a group allocation is insufficient for a government to invest seriously in improving the situation.

The certainty attached to the individual country allocation helps attract political attention and other stakeholders, and often promotes a more deliberate approach to portfolio planning. Admin-istrative capacity can be strained for individual

Page 181: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 107

allocation country OFPs, however, particularly in view of the fact that these individuals may be faced with the challenge of juggling the interests and concerns of many GEF partners. It may prove difficult to draw the attention of top leadership to GEF activities in the more complex institutional context of a larger or somewhat wealthier country.

The largest RAF recipient category by far (78 countries, or 48 percent of all countries) con-sists of those countries with group allocations in both focal areas.9 Of these, 39 percent are from Sub-Saharan Africa, and 39 percent are SIDS. The large majority of countries in special circum-stances (LDCs, crisis and post-conflict countries, SIDS, and so on) is part of the group allocation. As noted earlier, resource utilization by LDCs is just 8 percent, compared with non-LDC country utilization of 40 percent. Focal points in group allocation countries typically face daunting chal-lenges. For one thing, their countries’ communi-cations infrastructure may inhibit their ability to stay informed about GEF procedural changes or guidance on pipeline management. Also, some GEF Agencies may elect to “triage” their country partnerships, focusing on larger allocation coun-tries. More powerful ministries in government may overshadow the policy interests of a relatively weak ministry of environment. Most of these countries are ill equipped to deal with the added complexities and rules of the group allocation.

The GEF Secretariat has taken on additional tasks and exhibits some capacity limitations in support-ing implementation. The Secretariat was not set up well to implement the RAF; for example, new personnel were brought in at the middle of the process, many of whom had a steep learning curve in understanding the RAF and/or the GEF. Many stakeholders feel that the GEF Secretariat also was developing systems and rules or directives as it went along, in that its traditional role has not been

to support implementation issues. The complexi-ties, including the logistics, of holding teleconfer-ences with the various countries demonstrate the challenges in dialoguing with the large number of recipient countries.

The GEF Agencies also exhibit capacity limits in dealing with GEF projects and the RAF transition. Agencies may be willing and able to provide sup-port, but face barriers of their own. For the Agen-cies, the RAF often means additional challenges in terms of added complexity in operations, changes in the financial context, and occasionally mixed messages from the Secretariat and the GEF CEO regarding when and under what circumstances to communicate with country governments or other GEF Agencies. Moreover, it is often diffi-cult to match the resources available in a country’s RAF allocation to the project features an Agency is capable of delivering. The priorities and capac-ity of an Agency’s country or regional office may need to be addressed. Programmatic approaches and multifocal projects present new design and implementation challenges. Changes in the finan-cial context for Agencies and cofinancing ele-ments and blended projects add to the financial and managerial complexity of GEF activities. The policy on Agency comparative advantage can also be a barrier to access, even though not intended as such. In some cases, Agencies have reduced their involvement in GEF matters.

From a country standpoint, it can be very diffi-cult to identify the origin of barriers that are expe-rienced within the complex network of GEF enti-ties. For example, focal points may see the Agency as the cause of delay in obtaining project approval. In some cases, this may be true; in other cases, the logjam appears to be the Secretariat review. The midterm review team heard numerous com-plaints that Agencies “tend to disappear once they get the country’s endorsement.” Countries are

Page 182: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

108 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

frustrated as a result of not knowing the status of their proposals.

The 50 Percent Rule

The 50 percent rule is a barrier, although not to all countries. It is too early to verify if countries have been waiting for the 50 percent point in GEF-4 to pass before submitting new PIFs. A slim majority (51 percent) of midterm review survey respondents found the overall effect of the 50 percent rule to be somewhat or very negative. This view may be influ-enced by the delays in the launch of the RAF, so that few countries experienced the 50 percent rule in this replenishment period. Due to the delay in the start of GEF-4, utilization arguably would be expected to be less than half of full GEF-4 levels. Exceptions to the 50 percent rule have been made by the CEO for operational reasons for some countries.10

Cofunding Requirements

Countries are called upon to identify cofinanc-ing of GEF projects. The timing constraint of the RAF, combined with the prioritization and approval challenges, results in a more complex environment for planning this aspect of projects. At times—for example, when an OFP is located in a ministry of finance—the cofinancing issue may be dealt with fairly readily, but this is the case in a minority of countries. Countries with smaller allocations, and smaller projects, may find it more difficult to attract cofinancing.

6.4 emerging effects This section first looks at key questions on the emerging effects of the RAF related to country ownership and processes. It then addresses how priorities for the project pipeline and the nature of projects have changed from two perspectives: (1) whether the introduction of the RAF had unin-tended, negative effects on the GEF portfolio and projects; and (2) whether the RAF encouraged

improvements in the portfolio. In this regard, it looks at the effects of the RAF on special groups or modalities, such as global and regional pro-gramming, enabling activities, and the SGP. Key trends are summarized in box 6.1.

Box 6.1

Key Trends in GeF-4Merged projects z

Selection among projects z

New projects z

Smaller projects z

Less NGO and private sector involvement z

Shift in operational programs z

Multifocal area projects z

Programmatic approaches z

More MSPs z

Fewer project preparation grants z

Fewer global and regional projects z

Fewer enabling activities z

SGP growth in RAF focal areas z

Country ownershipCountry ownership, or country drivenness, is one of the GEF’s 10 operational principles, linked to country capacity and the effectiveness of GEF processes and projects. The concept of coun-try ownership contains some intrinsic tensions. For example, country environmental priorities may be at odds with those of other GEF entities, and country ownership may or may not involve engagement and consultation with a broadly rep-resentative group of stakeholders at the national and local levels.

Enhancements to Country Ownership Linked to the RAF

GEF OFPs, especially in countries with individual allocations and thus predictable funding, report an

Page 183: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 109

expansion in their role, from project endorsement to engaging more actively in actual programming and prioritization. Another possible strength of individual allocations is that the associated cer-tainty and levels of funding may empower coun-tries in negotiating with GEF Agencies. Fifty-three percent of all stakeholders surveyed found the statement that application of the RAF “may strengthen country roles in portfolio planning” to be completely or mostly true.

Survey data confirm that there is broad agree-ment that the country role has expanded. Sixty-three percent of all survey respondents found that the RAF may strengthen country roles in portfo-lio planning, while only 25 percent felt this to be completely or mostly untrue. In the group alloca-tion countries, this new sense of empowerment is present on occasion, but it is much less common. Focal points and other stakeholders have noted that small country allocations tend to offer a less compelling platform for engaging Agencies and other project partners.

The processes and structures accompanying GEF project conception and prioritization in countries have in many cases been strength-ened, in part because of the enhanced role of the focal point. Some countries have found that they can plan the use of resources in a more struc-tured and methodical way than was possible under the “first come, first served” approach applied before the RAF. India and Russia may be examples of countries that have brought more coherence to portfolio planning in response to the RAF. In India’s case, the RAF has enabled and strength-ened national priority setting and coordination as well as monitoring and evaluation of the portfolio. The quality of participation in national consulta-tions to establish priorities in country pipelines appears, in some cases, to have become broader and more systematic than previously.

As found by other studies, formal national coordi-nation mechanisms for the GEF are limited to a few countries, such as Bolivia, China, Colombia, Poland, South Africa, and Uganda (GEF NDI 2005). These countries all have individual allocations under the RAF. National consultations appear to have moved up from a focus at the project level to greater atten-tion to portfolios. Similarly, with the CEO request in spring 2006 for identification of national priori-ties, the level of consultation appears to have moved up as well in most countries. Specifically, with the need to discuss a portfolio, consultations seem to have shifted away from the project-by-project dis-cussions of the past. The following techniques have been observed:11

GEF committees. z Some countries reported that they have established national coordina-tion committees of varying levels of formality. In some cases, the RAF was the primary factor in encouraging governments to intensify and/or formalize national consultation processes (for example, the Republic of Congo).

Consultation meetings. z Some countries have established such meetings either of committees or of a larger group. Bhutan, for example, held a consultative meeting with all stakeholders.

National consultative workshops and pro- z

cesses. Some countries, including Indonesia and Sri Lanka, have set up a process to consult on proposals, with a series of meetings, brain-storming sessions, or workshops entailed.

Other innovative mechanisms to establish z

priorities. Such mechanisms include contract-ing with a private company to help develop a country strategy (as in Ecuador) or utilizing a national roundtable (as in Vietnam).

Thus far, no consultations or discussions of pri-orities have taken place regarding focal point decisions.

Page 184: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

110 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Limitations to Country Ownership Linked to the RAF

While country government engagement in port-folio planning has been strengthened, the picture regarding nongovernmental participation leaves room for concern. In its strictest interpretation, country ownership is government engagement in decision making and not broad participation in planning. As one survey respondent noted, this is not necessarily a guarantee of a project’s envi-ronmental relevance or quality. There are some potentially significant limitations to the quality of country ownership under the RAF once owner-ship is viewed as including broad engagement of a spectrum of country stakeholders both within and beyond government.

The GEF NGO community appears to hold a mixed view regarding the RAF’s effect on country portfolio planning processes. Fifty per-cent of the NGO respondents to the survey noted that the RAF has been successful or very success-ful in promoting transparency of country portfolio planning. Forty percent of NGO and private sec-tor respondents reported that their involvement in country portfolio priority setting had increased moderately or a great deal under the RAF. On the other hand, a substantial number of concerns were expressed to the midterm review team regarding a perceived decline in effective NGO and civil society participation. These concerns included perceptions that governments manage projects according to the interests and priorities of the cur-rent focal points; that the involvement of line min-istries is lacking as is that of NGOs which used to have better opportunities to develop MSPs with a community-based focus; that the RAF has low visibility at the local NGO level, partly due to a lack of information from the government; and that there are few if any materials on the RAF available in local languages. Some believe that there is disparity among types of NGOs in terms of access to GEF resources. Specifically, they feel

that large international environmental NGOs may have benefited from the RAF, while smaller international and regional NGOs have been more negatively affected by it.

Despite expanded opportunities for strength-ened country ownership, limitations to country capacity can leave country focal points “lost in a sea of change.” Capacity can place limits upon a country’s ability to actuate the opportunities that may be presented by the relative certainty of RAF funding. Constraints of particular relevance to country ownership include the following:

Changeover in the staffing of focal points, due z

to shifts in country political leadership, retire-ment, and other career changes among civil service staff, makes for challenges. The need to climb the steep learning curve of GEF processes is critical, making sustained focus at the coun-try government level both more important and more challenging.

The opportunity posed by more institutional- z

ized and systematic consultation on country pipelines can be mitigated by the time and staffing constraints faced by a focal point. Some focal points remarked on what is to them a trade-off between effective consultation and efficiency in managing the portfolio. The fact that only 55 of 161 countries were successful in submitting pipelines to the Secretariat before the September 2006 deadline suggests the extent of this challenge.

The various barriers to funding access iden- z

tified earlier tend to weigh against effective country ownership as well.

PredictabilityOne of the main advantages expected from the RAF was to promote increased predictability in the financing available from the GEF, which could help countries in their programming and in secur-

Page 185: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 111

ing cofinancing. In fact, the RAF has increased predictability for individual allocation countries by specifying at the beginning of each four-year replenishment period the resources each eligi-ble country can expect from the GEF during the period. Some regions that did not access large funds in the past, such as Europe and the Com-monwealth of Independent States, expressed positive feedback on the greater predictability of funding, which also helps the focal points in inter-acting with national stakeholders.

However, the level of predictability has not been even, and has been negatively affected by the fol-lowing RAF design and operational factors:

Group allocation. z Countries in the group allo-cation do not know the exact amount of their specific allocation. They know they can in prin-ciple access up to $3.5 million or $3.1 million for biodiversity or climate change, respectively, but that does not provide the same level of pre-dictability to help with long-term planning as for countries with individual allocations. For some, predictability was higher before, when they could work for years on a project and still be likely to have it approved at some point.

GEF eligibility and the project cycle. z For all countries, confusion over the GEF project cycle and insufficient guidance and communication with country focal points weaken the predict-ability of the RAF.

Fifty percent rule. z Many countries, and most of the GEF Agencies, maintain that the 50 percent rule has reduced the predictability of four-year planning and makes the process more complex and inefficient. Because the GEF information system did not address up-to-date pipeline sta-tus, Agencies submitted projects and were then told that the 50 percent rule was in effect for a given country.

While the midterm reallocation could have changed allocations and predictability, there was relatively low volatility in the exercise. For the GEF system as a whole, there is a trade-off between high predictability and the possibility of increas-ing allocations for countries based on perfor-mance and need.

operational ProgramsWithin each focal area, the operational programs describe how and under which themes the GEF implements its Operational Strategy (1996). His-torically, projects in biodiversity operational pro-grams account for 17.1 percent of GEF funding compared to almost 7.9 percent now; the four cli-mate change operational programs have decreased their share from 26.7 percent to 12.7 percent (see table 6.2), reflecting the low resource utilization of the RAF focal areas.

The trends within biodiversity point to relatively more projects in agrobiodiversity and arid eco-systems. In climate change, sustainable transport and energy efficiency have grown. These changes reflect the new GEF-4 focal area strategies. The shares of multifocal, integrated ecosystem man-agement, and mixed operational programs appear similar to past GEF-3 shares, but figures may be skewed since the GEF database has less data on operational programs in GEF-4 (29.1 percent not specified).

efficiency and elapsed TimeOne of the key aims of the new GEF project cycle is to reduce elapsed time for proposals in the cycle. Too few projects have completed the cycle prepa-ration phase to make any definitive conclusions about whether GEF targets have been achieved.

Given that GEF-4 started in February 2007, only PIF approvals since then are counted. Conse-quently, the projects that have moved from PIF

Page 186: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

112 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

approval to CEO endorsement by mid-2008 have taken less than a year. The relatively short elapsed time from PIF approval to endorsement reflects the fact that these projects are from previous replenishment periods and had been under prepa-ration prior to the start of the revised project cycle and “repipelining” as PIFs.

For 28 FSPs approved since GEF-4 effectively started, the actual average elapsed time from pipe-line entry (concept approval) to CEO endorsement is 40.4 months.12 The 18 endorsed projects in the RAF focal areas have averaged 36.9 months.

The GEF Council originally established a time frame of 22 months from concept (now PIF) approval to start of project implementation; this has since been amended to 22 months from PIF approval to CEO endorsement (which, in GEF-3, was 4 months before project implementation on

average). The standard timeline would therefore now be around 26 months on average, and the approximate 4 months would be added to the 40.2 months to an estimated 44-45 months from con-cept approval to start. One FSP under the RAF is recorded in the Secretariat database as having started implementation.13 For MSPs, the Secretar-iat reported that the average elapsed time is close to 22 months from the original date of receipt to CEO approval.

For the new project cycle, service standards were established for Secretariat response time to Agency submission of proposals within 10 work-ing days.14 Feedback from the Agencies to the mid-term review team indicates that the 10-day turn-around rule from submission to decision is not consistent. Approval review can be delayed, the submission date may not be correctly recorded,

Table 6.2

shares of Resource Utilization by GeF operational Program historically and under the RAFpercentages

operational program Pilot to GeF-3 GeF-4

Biodiversity: Arid and Semi-Arid Zone Ecosystems (OP1) 3.6 2.9

Biodiversity: Coastal, Marine, and Freshwater Ecosystems (OP2) 5.8 1.3

Biodiversity: Forest Ecosystems (OP3) 5.4 1.4

Biodiversity: Mountain Ecosystems (OP4) 1.5 0.8

Biodiversity: Conservation and Sustainable Use of Biological Diversity Important to Agriculture (OP13) 0.9 1.5

Climate Change: Removal of Barriers to Energy Efficiency and Energy Conservation (OP5) 8.9 6.0

Climate Change: Promoting the Adoption of Renewable Energy by Removing Barriers and Reducing Implementation Costs (OP6)

11.9 1.8

Climate Change: Reducing the Long-Term Costs of Low GHG-Emitting Energy Technologies (OP7) 4.0 0.3

Climate Change: Promoting Environmentally Sustainable Transport (OP11) 1.9 4.6

International Waters (OP8, OP9, OP10) 11.6 6.4

Integrated Ecosystem Management (OP12) 1.8 0.4

Land Degradation (OP15), POPs (OP14), ozone depletion 4.6 18.3

Short-term response measures, enabling activities, Strategic Pilot on Adaptation 11.6 1.9

Mixed 24.3 23.3

Not specified 2.4 29.1

Total 100.0 100.0note: OP = operational program.

Page 187: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 113

and counting can begin from when the Secretariat staff is back from travel or vacation. More difficult to assess is the time spent back-and-forth before formal submission.

Changes in Pipeline and Portfolio For those countries with historically large resource use, continuous pipeline development, and a large RAF allocation, such as China, changes from GEF-3 are limited. However, in most cases at the country level, there are changes to the pipeline and portfolio influenced by the RAF allocation and RAF priority setting. The change in pipeline depends on past historical involvement with the GEF and thus the likelihood of having a proposal in the pipeline already, and the RAF allocation, as follows: (1) need to develop proposals, for coun-tries with limited or no pipeline in either focal area (there are 37 countries with no pipeline, including about 9 with no historical allocation) and coun-tries with an existing pipeline but a larger alloca-tion than historically; or (2) need to cut or reduce proposals, for countries with an existing pipeline but a smaller allocation than historically.

The evolution of the portfolio and transition from GEF-3 to GEF-4 can be tracked according to the following timeline.

Baseline at the end of GEF-3. z At this time, 646 proposals were in the pipeline (including 200 prepipeline ideas) (GEF EO 2007d).

Spring 2006. z The Secretariat disclosed the existing pipeline to countries and at subregional workshops, including FSPs that had entered the pipeline and MSPs and enabling activities under preparation. This included 198 coun-try projects under preparation, and 39 global and regional projects in the two focal areas. A total of 88 countries had a pipeline; around 37 countries did not have a pipeline in either focal area.

September 2006. z The Secretariat informed the Agencies that all concepts currently in the pipeline would have to be repipelined. This involved concepts totaling about $1.7 billion, of which 119 had PDF-Bs. Of 177 concepts in the pipeline, 96 were resubmitted by the Agencies.

October 2006. z Seventy-five countries sent a list of their priorities to the Secretariat. Of these, 31 percent were countries with individ-ual allocations in both focal areas, 20 percent were biodiversity individual allocation coun-tries, 9 percent were climate change individual allocation countries, and the rest were group allocation countries in both focal areas (31 per-cent, relatively low).

October 2006–April 2007. z The Secretariat initiated teleconferences with countries, dis-cussing a total of 513 proposals as summa-rized in follow-up letters from the Secretariat to the OFPs, including 465 country projects and 48 global and regional projects. In all, 127 countries were called; 26 countries had neither a pipeline nor a teleconference.

December 2006. z One hundred and fifteen proj-ects in the pipeline were canceled; this included 30 global and regional projects because the 5 percent RAF GRE had been frozen.

July 2008. z Twenty-eight country, regional, and global FSPs had been endorsed under the RAF, and 65 MSPs approved.

When comparing the pipeline lists along the time-line, no clear pattern or consistency emerges, and considerable changes have been made. Many of the old GEF-3 proposals have been discontinued or were not picked up in the country prioritiza-tion or in current approvals. The countries seem to have taken seriously the GEF CEO’s request to consult widely; consequently, broader priorities have emerged. Some of these proposals had been

Page 188: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

114 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

long in preparation, with focal point and govern-ment attention meanwhile shifting to other issues. Regardless of whether these changes result in an improved pipeline, they have required consider-able cost and effort to develop.

A total of 586 different ideas and proposals were presented both in the initial pipeline and the tele-conferences. Changes to the pipeline can result from the RAF introduction; from the teleconfer-ences with the GEF Secretariat; and other modifi-cations during development related to the national, GEF, or Agency situation. Several changes have been identified that primarily stem from the RAF consultations and the size and kind of RAF alloca-tion, including the following.

Merging project proposals. z Countries devel-oped lists of project priorities, which drew in part on existing GEF-3 concepts and in part on new ones. Overlaps with proposed or past initiatives may have occurred, but merging was also proposed when funds would not suffice for several projects. Most proposals have sub-sequently not yet reached PIF submission, as redesign may take time.

Choosing among several projects. z This case appears common when funds are insufficient for several projects, for group allocation coun-tries, or because of the 50 percent rule. It is also noted for those countries that had past experi-ence with GEF projects and had a pipeline, but that are now part of the group allocation. Due to the 50 percent rule or smaller allocations, some countries had to select one project in the first half of the RAF, then wait for a second project—although in some cases, the proposal was ready for submission. Some countries informed the midterm review team that they would select the proposal most likely to pass GEF approval.

Revising project proposals. z This is common in GEF project development. Requests for

changes were made by the Secretariat based on new focal area strategies before and after these strategies were approved. The RAF contributed to such changes by shifting allocations com-pared to existing pipelines.

Dropping projects under development. z Proj-ects were dropped for several reasons. A total of 45 percent of 96 projects were discouraged in the teleconferences for lack of strategic fit. At least 55 pipeline projects from GEF-3 were not reconfirmed by the focal points.15 The major-ity of these projects were in climate change (56 percent, 31), which may have contributed to resource utilization issues.

Developing new projects. z A large number (388, or 76 percent) of the 513 proposals dis-cussed during the teleconferences were new, in the sense that they were not in the pipeline at the start of GEF-4. For only 24 percent of these (92 of 388), the proposal was cleared by the Secre-tariat; the majority of these were in biodiversity (57, versus 35 in climate change). The propos-als have not yet materialized into PIFs. Although the proposals were new compared to the exist-ing pipeline, this does not imply that they were new or innovative types of ideas or of a different operational program focus. In any case, propos-als must comply with the focal area strategies.

Some projects moved on to approval or devel-opment even when they were not highlighted as priorities during the teleconferences. Of the 121 existing pipeline proposals not discussed, some were since approved (80), and some not (55). More proposals have been approved in bio-diversity (55 of 80); including 5 enabling activities, 12 MSPs, and 4 CEO-endorsed FSPs.

ModalitiesThe share of MSPs has increased under the RAF. At the GEF-3 midpoint, this share was 5.5

Page 189: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 115

percent; at the GEF-4 midpoint, it is 9.0 percent. For small allocations, Agencies are encouraged to view projects as part of entire portfolios; in this way, some FSPs subsidize the cost of administer-ing smaller projects. This approach has been dif-ficult for the Agencies for several reasons, notably because of the increased unpredictability of fund-ing under the RAF, because of group allocations, the application of eligibility and the compara-tive advantages policy, and the stoppage of the pipeline.

There has been a reduction in project prepara-tion grants. This decrease is mainly linked to the new policy to limit preparation grants within the new project cycle. The RAF may create additional disincentives especially with regard to project preparation funds because they take away from project funds, in particular for countries with low allocations. Such countries often express the need for more support for project formulation. Up until the end of GEF-3, there had been a steady annual increase of PDF-Bs for FSPs and PDF-As for MSPs. A total of 71 percent of all FSPs and MSPs approved during GEF-3 had some PDF compo-nent, up from 60 percent in GEF-2 and 46 percent in GEF-1. In GEF-4, 61 project preparation grants have been approved for the RAF focal areas, but the amounts are naturally smaller than previously (1 percent of approved resources).

Project QualityIt is too early to assess project design quality. Given all the changes to the GEF pipeline, it is not pos-sible to determine if the portfolio has improved or not. In most cases, proposals are not yet final-ized. In the midterm review survey, 60 percent of respondents found that RAF implementation may place stress on the design quality of GEF projects.

In a 2007 review of proposals, the STAP found that, in general, the problem definition was sci-

entifically valid in a number of PIFs, with a signifi-cant minority that did not provide a logical prob-lem definition. No comparative assessment of the past portfolio is available, and the findings may be influenced by the PIF format. There appears to be no discernible pattern by RAF focal area.

There is a risk that the RAF may reduce the chance for innovative projects involving more than one country, or innovative approaches in general and those not generated by governments. This concern seems to be linked to a number of factors, includ-ing limited country funding, reduction in global and regional resources, tighter focal area strategic priorities, and an inclination for countries to try to fit “safe” projects to ensure that the GEF will find them eligible. The Secretariat may find itself con-strained in launching new initiatives as well.

Programmatic Approaches A GEF programmatic approach represents a part-nership among the GEF, the countries, the Agen-cies, and other interested stakeholders such as the private sector and donors. At its April 2008 meeting, the Council endorsed the objectives and basic principles for programmatic approaches (GEF 2008d), namely to secure larger scale and sustained impact on the global environment through integrating global environmental objec-tives into national or regional strategies and plans using partnerships. The first three program-matic approaches under GEF-4 were approved in November 2007, prior to the finalization of these principles. So far, 12 programmatic approaches have been approved in GEF-4. Financial com-mitment is handled through individual PIFs that may be presented at the same time as the pro-gram framework document or within a year. As most programmatic approaches were approved in April 2008, it is too soon to say if this will material-ize. There is as yet no compelling evidence that it expedites projects and access to funds.

Page 190: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

116 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Programmatic approaches can cause delays in project delivery when Agencies and countries are asked to wait for a program to be developed although PIFs are already in progress. This has affected the UNEP biosafety projects. As a spe-cific example, preparation of the GEF Pacific Alli-ance for Sustainability program framework docu-ment took more than a year. The current manner of applying programmatic approaches adds layers of bureaucracy to a process already perceived as complex and nontransparent. Combined with the 50 percent rule and the four-year allocation, this makes it more difficult to recognize the longer term perspective that a programmatic approach entails.

The programmatic approaches were origi-nally envisaged because of likely coherence and impact, and in the hope that they would help overcome barriers in the project cycle. During the RAF, however, the programmatic approach is increasingly considered a potential solu-tion to RAF resource utilization problems, especially for group allocation countries in specific regions. Among stakeholders, 35 percent indicated that the use of programmatic approaches are help-ful in promoting access to GEF funding under the RAF; 23 percent found them a hindering factor, and 29 percent found them helpful as well as hindering.

Key Principles

As the first principle, the Council established that programmatic approaches should be country owned and build on national priorities. Large countries with individual allocations seem to have been able to achieve this for their national pro-grammatic approaches, such as the India Sustain-able Land and Ecosystem Management program, the China Biodiversity Partnership Framework, and similar programs in Russia and Vietnam.

In spite of the new policy, the approaches remain unclear to stakeholders. Some countries feel they

need support in this shift to more programmatic approaches, including help to produce proposals that will qualify and in obtaining more and reli-able statistical data. The lack of understanding on how to engage in a programmatic approach and of roles, responsibilities, and consequences causes hesitancy. According to feedback at the subregional workshops as well as in bilateral inter-views, countries support the concept in principle, but raise a number of concerns, as do Agencies. Regional or global programmatic approaches do not arise from country demand but are mainly encouraged by the GEF Secretariat.

Programmatic approaches should emphasize the GEF’s catalytic role and leverage of additional financing from other sources. For the regional multifocal programmatic approaches, much of the resource planning has centered on negotia-tions regarding how to use different GEF sources and how to package the program, from which focal areas and country RAF resources, how much should be taken from the group allocation or from the GRE, and so on.

A third principle is the open and transparent process of multistakeholder representation. Country stakeholders are still not sure about the roles and responsibilities of the entities involved and how the RAF allocation is used in this regard. The new role of the Secretariat in the design of programs and the inception of projects has caused some confusion among stakeholders. Participants in the subregional workshops in Africa asked questions about who is ultimately going to be accountable for ensuring access of funds by coun-tries. Considerably more clarity is needed in terms of rules of engagement and how the GEF plans to implement the programs. Countries observed that guidelines for the new initiatives have been slow to arrive, which in turn has slowed the process of RAF implementation. NGOs have noted that it is

Page 191: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 117

more difficult for civil society to engage with pro-grammatic approaches than with projects.

A fourth principle is the cost-effectiveness of pro-grammatic approaches. There is funding support available for thematic programmatic approaches such as for sustainable forest management, bio-safety, and TerrAfrica. However, transaction costs are higher with a programmatic approach, and the efforts required to launch such an approach can be considerable. The GEF Pacific Alliance for Sustainability, the Congo Basin initiative, and the West Africa programs are all based on a number of ministerial meetings, workshops, and consulta-tions. The coordination work and program frame-work document preparation are not recognized through support; Agency fees are available only for project PIFs. At times, programmatic approaches may decrease competition by forcing coordina-tion. Some stakeholders noted that programmatic approaches are sometimes more difficult to link to the global conventions and that cofinancing is especially difficult for global and regional projects. A programmatic approach that is purely regional may not achieve the same level of cost-effective-ness; the added impact compared to individual country projects is not yet demonstrated.

Issues

The main issue with programmatic approaches is the lack of transparency and lack of consistent involvement of all three key parties—the Secre-tariat, countries, and Agencies. Some program-matic approaches were not sufficiently discussed with the Agencies from the outset. The notion of programmatic approaches tends to be discussed at constituency or bilateral meetings. In the Pacific, Agencies were invited to the Palau meet-ing in March 2008 to finalize the GEF Pacific Alli-ance for Sustainability, for which the World Bank serves as lead Agency. For the African program-matic approaches, most initial discussions and

planning were bilateral. Directives have also been given to change the Implementing Agency both in the Democratic Republic of Congo and for several projects under the GEF Pacific Alliance for Sus-tainability, although another Agency had already undertaken initial work in accordance with the government’s wishes. This sort of inconsistency leads to delays in preparation and frustrations among Agencies and countries.

The bilateral relations between the Secretariat on the one side and the focal points and ministers on the other are appreciated, especially as they help to clarify eligibility and funding. The problems arise when turning to the Agencies that are expected to do most of the work in preparing the PIFs and the program and in obtaining the funds needed, and this partner is not on board or informed of the purpose and steps. The criteria for selecting an Agency are not clear, and in some cases the Sec-retariat plays this role. There are requests that the process should be open and cooperative from the start, with an open marketplace for the Agencies.

Financial arrangements are especially complex. There are no specific rules, and deals can be made. Countries wonder how much they will be asked to contribute to a regional program and how much they will get back. The regional programmatic approaches have engaged countries by promising the group allocation countries about $2 million in a focal area. This is less than the maximum that they can obtain ($3.5 million for biodiversity and $3.1 million for climate change) but considerably more than $1 million, and is of particular inter-est if they have not accessed—or are not likely to access—any funds. If countries accept the $2 mil-lion, they cannot expect to get any more funds from the group allocation. The individual alloca-tion countries, fewer in number, are also encour-aged to join regional programs; and all countries may access additional funds from the GRE, as well

Page 192: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

118 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

as from the other non-RAF focal areas. In turn, a mix of individual PIFs and regional projects will be provided. To meet the overall financial target of the program, considerable negotiations can ensue.

Global and Regional ProgrammingThis section addresses the key question of how the allocation to global and regional projects has been implemented, and what its relationship has been with individual and group allocations. Under the RAF, global and regional projects can be funded both from the GRE (the 5 percent exclusion from the formula) and from individual countries using country allocations for regional or global projects.16

The historical allocation to global and regional projects was considerably higher than the 5 per-cent of funds set aside from the RAF formula in each focal area. The RAF provides $50 million per RAF focal area for global and regional proj-ects. During the pilot to GEF-3 phases, a total of $389 million was allocated across 165 countries in biodiversity and $271 million in climate change. Historically, across all replenishment periods, resources for global and regional projects amount to 23 percent of biodiversity funds and 20 percent of climate change focal area funds. As the use of global and regional resources has grown over the last replenishment periods, with GEF-3 shares at 29 percent in biodiversity and 37 percent in climate change, the GRE represents a dramatic drop.

The reduction in global and regional projects has particularly affected countries in Africa. African countries historically received the largest share of biodiversity global and regional resources (46 percent), as well as the largest share of cli-mate change resources (37 percent). In biodiver-sity, Africa is followed by Latin America and the Caribbean (33 percent) and Asia (13 percent). In

climate change, the Eastern European countries (23 percent) received the second most resources, followed by Asia and Latin America and the Carib-bean (20 percent for each region).

Within these regions, the countries now receiv-ing individual allocations have historically used larger amounts of biodiversity (61 percent) and climate change (56 percent) global and regional resources. However, many smaller countries have been affected more by the reduction in access to these funds, because they were more dependent on regional support compared to their limited country projects (such as Burkina Faso, El Salva-dor, Honduras, Kenya, and Lesotho).

By Agency, UNDP accounts for the largest share (44 percent, $166 million) of historical regional resources in the biodiversity focal area. In climate change, the World Bank historically accounts for the largest share (46 percent) of regional resources. In the biodiversity focal area, UNEP accounts for 59 percent ($106 million) of the resources in global projects from the pilot phase to GEF-3, followed by the World Bank (30 percent). For cli-mate change, the World Bank accounts for the largest share (40 percent, $99 million), followed by UNDP-UNEP joint projects (29 percent) and UNEP alone (17 percent). The latter’s share has now dropped to 28 percent and 32 percent in cli-mate change and biodiversity, respectively.

The utilization of global and regional resources in the RAF focal areas exclusion appears mar-ginal at the midpoint of GEF-4, with $8 million for biodiversity and $27 million for climate change (see table 6.3). For biodiversity and climate change, respectively, this is 1 percent and 2 percent of all global and regional resources, as compared with historical shares of 25 percent and 21 percent. Outside of the RAF, there has been a growth in regional projects, from 34 percent to 64 percent of global and regional resources in a replenishment

Page 193: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 119

period. So far, 15 global and regional projects have been approved under the RAF.

Guidance and transparency on global and regional programming have not been ade-quate. In 2006, the RAF Task Force agreed that “a flexible approach, encompassed by a set of com-mon understandings, was the pragmatic way to approach the issue of programming global and regional projects” (GEF RAF Implementation Team 2006d). Later, guidance was not made avail-able, as had been expected for global and regional project criteria and guidelines, criteria for com-mitting funds to global and regional projects, information on how such projects are managed, and a clear set of policies for use in light of revised focal area strategies. Participants at the Africa subregional workshop in June 2008 commented on the lack of funding guidelines.

Some resources were committed elsewhere from the outset, in a move one interviewee called “taxa-tion of the focal areas.” For example, in the climate change focal area, the GEF Council approved a Strategic Pilot on Adaptation in 2004, but had not managed to spend the global commitment of $50 million in GEF-3. It was decided in the GRE guidelines that the estimated remaining $23 mil-lion would be funded out of the GRE, although adaptation projects are in general single country

projects. It remains difficult to discern in GEF mon-itoring reports and work programs which funds are being used for what and from what source. Deci-sion making and prioritization for the GRE by the Secretariat is not transparent to stakeholders. Most funds appear to have been committed; and Agen-cies, countries, and convention secretariats have been told that there is no money left. Some funds are being held for programmatic approaches.

The current application of the GRE is changing the nature of global and regional programming under the RAF. Global projects are of worldwide scope and would not be funded otherwise by indi-vidual countries; such projects generate global knowledge and/or transform global markets. Multicountry projects are funded through contri-butions from countries and country group pools with benefits that go beyond each country and are justified on the basis of cost-effectiveness.

At the start of GEF-4, several global projects were approved that had been in preparation for some time. The regional projects funded from the GRE so far mainly concern the GEF Pacific Alliance for Sustainability. With the growth of regional programmatic approaches, there appears to be a movement away from projects that address prob-lems that are transboundary or common to sev-eral countries, or that complement or enhance country activities.

The introduction of the RAF changed the nature of many regional and global projects under devel-opment, disrupting the preparation of some. In the cancellation of the 2007 pipeline, 30 projects were global or regional. When the pipeline plan-ning exercises came to an end, no criteria were established for selection. For example, the 2006 Biosafety Strategy, which responds to the Carta-gena Protocol, emphasizes the importance of regional approaches and has become difficult to implement under the RAF due to limitations on

Table 6.3

shares of Global/Regional Resource Utilization by Focal Area historically and under the RAFpercentages

Focal areaPilot to GeF-3 GeF-3

GeF-4 midpoint

Biodiversity 24 9 1

Climate change 20 8 2

Multifocal 66 8 13

Non-RAF 56 13 27

Total global/regional (million $)

2,243 1,112 560

Page 194: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

120 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

global and regional programs. Another issue is the concern about invasive species, for which cross-border funding is essential.

The reduction in corporate funds for global and regional projects means that there is some pressure on countries to contribute with their RAF coun-try resources to such initiatives. The global and regional resources that have been approved from the set-aside are complemented by RAF resources from the biodiversity and climate change focal areas. In the pipeline at the start of GEF-4, there were a number of global and regional projects, and 47 such projects were discussed in the tele-conferences between the focal points and the GEF Secretariat in 2006–07. For the majority of these projects, the countries were told that endorsement from other countries would be needed. Depend-ing on the source of funds (GRE or country RAF), it was not clear to many countries who would han-dle the negotiation of such endorsements.

The RAF constitutes a disincentive for regional and global projects. Given the reduction in funds available corporately, it was assumed during the RAF design that countries would voluntarily pro-vide funds from their country allocation, especially for group allocation countries.17 This assumption is not holding up, and it has become more difficult to organize regional projects for a number of rea-sons provided to the midterm review.

A disinclination by countries to give up their z

country allocation, however small. Even though the GEF emphasizes that the alloca-tions are not entitlements, they tend to be seen as such at the country level. In a few cases, sin-gle country projects were approved along with resources for a global or regional component.18 The pooling of country resources has so far been done with considerable encouragement from the Secretariat and in part from the Agen-cies, but has not been voluntary.

Regional cultural barriers to cooperation. z

In some regions, as in Southeast Asia, regional cooperation has a long history. This is not the case in all subregions, however; thus, these relationships can be uneasy and forced.

Uneven RAF distribution of funds. z For exam-ple, South Africa has an individual allocation but is surrounded by countries that are in the group allocation, making it difficult to partner collaboratively with neighboring countries that have access to only limited GEF funding.

Past negative experience with global and z

regional projects. Global and regional proj-ects may receive less attention because they are more difficult to implement.

Ultimately, there are very different views of the “right” level of global and regional program-ming—and the rationale for same. As a facility on global environmental issues, the GEF might be expected to emphasize activities of a cross-border nature. However, at the time of RAF design, the main discussion centered on the RAF as a perfor-mance-based system for individual countries. The level of funding to global and regional projects may not have been quite clear during the RAF design process. In the design discussion, it had been pro-posed to create separate line items for global and regional projects, as with the SGP and support to cross-cutting capacity building. The Secretariat had originally proposed 12 percent for the GRE in each focal area; there does not seem to have been any specific rationale or discussion behind the 5 percent set-aside. Global and regional proj-ects do not appear to have had strong proponents in the design process and were perceived as being more complex.

One issue of concern for a PBA system may be the perception of performance of global and regional projects compared to individual country projects. Based on the terminal evaluation reviews under-

Page 195: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 121

taken by the GEF Evaluation Office, the global and regional projects have lower outcome ratings (70 percent were rated marginally satisfactory and above versus 85 percent for single country proj-ects), but are less affected by risks to sustainability (the sustainability of 63 percent of these projects was rated as marginally likely and above versus 48 percent for single country projects).19

The Delphi expert panel supported increased fund-ing for capacity building (average response 6.7 on a scale of 1–10) and for regional projects (average 7.2). Stakeholder comments supported the need to level the playing field and address multicountry prob-lems. International NGOs also suggested increased funding to deal with transboundary issues.

A reduced GRE level would benefit the top-ranked individual countries but push more countries into the group allocation. A mixed pic-ture emerges from simulations of GRE levels other than 5 percent for the initial RAF allocation:

No GRE. z If all focal area funds were provided to countries (with zero GRE), in biodiversity, the number of individual allocation countries would decrease from 47 to 39, and these would see their allocation increase by 4.08 percent as compared to their initial RAF allocation. Eight more countries would fall into the group allo-cation but would share a larger pot. In climate change, the pattern would be more extreme. It would push 17 countries into the group alloca-tion, increase the individual country allocation by 5.65 percent, and fix the maximum group allocation at $4.9 million.

GRE allocation at historical levels. z If the GRE allocation were increased to approximate historical levels, all the top-ranked and lower ranked countries would receive less. With a set-aside of 18 percent in each focal area, 28 countries would move up from the group allo-

cation to an individual allocation in biodiver-sity (although the individual allocation coun-tries would receive somewhat less20), and the remaining group allocation countries could only access a maximum of $1.6 million. In cli-mate change, 43 countries would move up to individual allocations, and the rest would have $1 million each. China would still remain at the ceiling with $150 million, and other countries would get somewhat less in dollar amounts.

enabling Activities Enabling activities provide financing for the prep-aration of a plan, strategy, or program to fulfill commitments under a global environmental con-vention, or for the preparation of a national com-munication or report to a convention.

For many, if not most, countries, GEF support thus far has primarily comprised enabling activities. From the pilot phase to GEF-3, 817 enabling activi-ties were undertaken, representing a GEF alloca-tion of $268 million; 34 percent of this funding was for biodiversity and 31 percent for climate change (GEF EO 2007d). During GEF-4 until midpoint, 21 enabling activities were approved, of which 10 are in biodiversity, 5 are for POPs, and 6 are for National Capacity Self-Assessments for Global Environment Management (multifocal area).

No country used its RAF allocation to support the preparation of national communications under the expedited enabling activity procedures. This is because under the umbrella project jointly man-aged by UNDP and UNEP, the GEF provided grant financing totaling $67,889,302 to cover the preparation of national communications in 134 countries, corresponding Implementing Agency fees, and support for the implementation of the National Communication Support Program. This money was essentially a carryover from GEF-3 and preceded the RAF under GEF-4.

Page 196: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

122 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

The utilization of resources for enabling activ-ities is linked to the ongoing umbrella pro-gram and to the cyclical nature of convention requirements. Expedited GEF procedures involve decentralized project approval of enabling activities under an umbrella program for about 130 coun-tries, approved in April 2004 (National Communi-cation Project for Climate Change, UNDP-UNEP). The climate change guidelines establish a period of three to five years between the initial disbursements of financial resources for the first national commu-nication before applying for subsequent financing. Many countries are thus still developing national communications with this funding window which was made available prior to GEF-4, and have not needed to use RAF funds for this purpose.

Approval of enabling activities fluctuates based on periodic reporting to the conventions. Before the RAF, the latest convention guidance on GEF enabling activities in climate change dated Novem-ber 2003 from COP8, and from October 2000 for biodiversity. Decision 7 of the 13th session of the UNFCCC COP asks the GEF to

… refine, as appropriate, operational procedures to ensure the timely disbursement of funds to meet the agreed full costs incurred by those non-Annex I Par-ties that are in the process of preparing their third, and where appropriate, fourth national communications … (UNFCCC 2008b).

In principle, the RAF provides sufficient funds for each country to undertake enabling activi-ties in each focal area. Because countries are cur-rently accessing such funds through the umbrella program, it is too soon to say how the enabling activities will be affected in practice.

The GEF-4 biodiversity enabling activities have an average budget of $0.28 million. The average enabling activity has ranged from $0.16 million to $0.33 million in biodiversity and climate change, respectively. The latest cap on funding in GEF

guidelines on enabling activities was $350,000 for an expedited enabling activity in biodiversity and $405,000 for climate change (GEF 2000, 2003d), which is within the $1 million potentially available for RAF group allocation countries. Countries with larger financial needs for national communica-tions, such as China and India, have been able to approve enabling activities as nonexpedited efforts for larger amounts. These countries now have indi-vidual RAF allocations. The responsibility lies with the countries to establish RAF pipeline priorities in line with their national priorities and obliga-tions under the conventions. Historically, there has been a high demand from countries for enabling activities, as well as an appreciation for their utility (GEF EO 2007d). However, to this point, enabling activities have not been in competition with project funding for country MSPs or FSPs.

Access to funds for convention obligations will be more challenging for group allocation coun-tries. The revised rules indicate that projects sub-mitted after December 31, 2008, “may be endorsed, at the discretion of the CEO and where funding allows” (GEF 2008o). If a country has already used its allocation for other projects, or if the overall group allocation is short of funds, resources for enabling activates will be in jeopardy if new COP guidance requires additional funds. For example, if a group allocation country uses $350,000 for an enabling activity, there would be little left to access for another project of meaningful scope. Group allocation countries have been relatively more dependent on enabling activities. If a country’s allocation is not sufficient, it may also affect the quality of the report to the convention.

At the launch of the RAF, there was a lack of clar-ity as to whether (and which) enabling activities would fall under the RAF. The existence of other funding windows (National Adaptation Programs of Action under the LDC Fund and the UNDP-

Page 197: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 123

UNEP umbrella program) contributed to the confusion. Recognizing the risk of competition in funding, it has been suggested to provide enabling activity funds as an exclusion to the RAF. Both the biodiversity and climate change convention secretariats have raised suggestions to this effect. However, a set-aside fund would require a country to know its funding requirement at the start of a replenishment phase.

The predictability of funding needs is an issue beyond the predictability of funding availabil-ity. The UNFCCC Secretariat indicated to the midterm review team that feedback is needed from the GEF Secretariat about the availability of RAF resources so that the COP can generate guidelines for the third national report. For its part, however, the GEF bases the amount of resources provided for national communications on climate change on the convention requirement and the guidelines approved by the COP. In climate change, financial support would likely have to be provided to the more than 50 countries that are expected to begin preparation of their third national communica-tions before June 2010 after completion of their second national communication reports.

The main concern regarding convention obli-gations under the RAF is for biosafety. The Cartagena Protocol on Biosafety is the only pro-tocol fully supported by the GEF as the financial mechanism; it is covered by the RAF biodiversity allocation. The COP recently urged the GEF

to provide additional support from sources other than the RAF for capacity-building activities in the devel-oping countries, in particular the least developed and small island developing States among them, and coun-tries with economies in transition (UNCBD 2008c)

in order to establish and operate the required bio-safety clearing-house mechanism; it also urged the GEF to “make financial resources available with a view to enable eligible Parties to prepare their

national report” (UNCBD 2008b, Decision IV/5). Measures that facilitate consideration of regional and subregional projects to be developed by coun-tries in a given region were suggested. Past sup-port was efficiently provided through a UNEP umbrella program. Capacity was built during the implementation of this global project, but now there seems to be limited funds for the imple-mentation of plans and project proposals. Thus, the RAF appears to have slowed the momentum created by the previous global biosafety project. The average cost of country implementation plans is about $600,000, which is not possible to fund within the RAF allocations for most countries. So far, 10 biosafety projects have been approved under GEF-4, most (7) as part of the Regional Project for Implementing National Biosafety Frameworks in the Caribbean Subregion under the GEF Biosafety Program.

The discussion on priorities within the RAF highlights an underlying tension between a focus on obligations and on results. Ultimately, there may be different expectations from donors and convention parties as to what constitutes GEF effectiveness. The key indicator of GEF success for the UNFCCC is the preparation and approval of national communications, whereas the main thrust of GEF focal area strategies is positive impact on the global environment. The GEF Cli-mate Change Program Study of 2004 found that “Apart from their use for reporting to the Conven-tion, the National Communications do not seem to have been valuable in guiding programming” (GEF EO 2004b). With limited funds, countries are faced with a difficult choice between potential achievements from GEF assistance on environ-mental impact or of national reports.

The small Grants ProgrammeDuring the third phase of its operation (that is, until the end of calendar year 2007), the SGP received

Page 198: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

124 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

almost all of its GEF support through core funds. During its fourth operating phase, the SGP needs to access a substantial proportion of potential GEF support through RAF country allocations. Rules framed by the SGP Steering Committee estab-lished in 2006 regulate the manner in which GEF resources can be accessed through core funds and RAF country allocations; these have affected SGP operations as described below. For more informa-tion, see Technical Paper #6, “Effects of the RAF on the Small Grants Programme.”

So far, the SGP has accessed $18 million from RAF allocations. The rules regulating access and use of RAF resources have constrained the SGP from accessing GEF resources through RAF country allo-cations, and it is likely that, during GEF-4, the SGP will be able to access only about $62 to $68 million from RAF country allocations. This is lower than the $90 million expected as per GEF (2006j).

The SGP portfolio is shifting because RAF funds can only be used in the focal area provid-ing the funds—that is, biodiversity or climate change. Overall, the proportional investment in projects pertaining to the climate change focal area has increased significantly; there has been a concur-rent moderate increase in investments in the biodi-versity focal area. SGP investments in other focal

areas, however, have declined. The project portfo-lios of RAF funds only country programs have been most affected. Project portfolios of RAF-core funds country programs were moderately affected, and those of core funds only country programs have remained unaffected. (See table 6.4.)

At the overall global program level, the predict-ability of funding has improved for the SGP, espe-cially for management activities. At the country program level, however, a significant proportion of the coordinators from RAF/core funds country programs report that after implementation of the RAF, the predictability of funding allocations for their programs has declined. On the positive side, a majority of these coordinators maintained that, after RAF implementation, transparency in fund-ing allocations has improved.

The country program expenditure caps intro-duced by the SGP Steering Committee for GEF-4 have affected at least 11 country programs. Com-pared to the third operating phase of the SGP, the annual expenditure by these programs on project grants has declined. Due to lower levels of opera-tion, program management costs increased from 13.5 percent during the third operating phase to 14.8 percent during the first year of the fourth phase.

Table 6.4

GeF investment in the sGP Project Portfolio by Focal Areapercentages

Country program type

BiodiversityClimate change

international waters

land degradation Multifocal PoPs

oP4 oP3 oP4 oP3 oP4 oP3 oP4 oP3 oP4 oP3 oP4 oP3

RAF funds only programs (17) 75 57 23 9 0 1 0 11 2 18 0 5

RAF and core funds programs (47) 46 44 31 18 1 7 15 17 7 11 1 3

Core funds only programs (44 LDCs/SIDS + 16 others)

41 43 14 13 10 6 21 22 10 12 4 3

All country programs 51 46 24 15 4 6 13 18 7 13 2 3

notes: OP4 = fourth SGP operational phase beginning July 1, 2008; OP3 = third SGP operational phase (fiscal years 2003–07) . Figures for OP4 are based on 984 projects for which data were available; figures for OP3 are based on data for 1,933 projects.

Page 199: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 125

The need to access resources from RAF country allocations has encouraged the SGP to seek greater involvement and engagement with the GEF OFPs and with relevant government departments of the participating countries in RAF funds only and RAF-core funds country programs. On the one hand, this has provided the SGP with opportunities to mainstream and scale up its experience through government agencies; on the other, it has made the SGP vulnerable to government influences.

Implementation of the RAF has increased the workload of the SGP staff both at the country pro-gram and global program levels. Some of this work-load is due to additional reporting requirements and the need to interact more intensively with gov-ernment agencies and is thus likely to persist.

6.5 Cost-effectiveness This section describes the costs of the RAF and some aspects of likely cost-effectiveness. Obser-vations are preliminary because the RAF is new. The section covers the costs of transition to the RAF and likely ongoing costs.

Costs of the RAFCosts vary from minor (staff time and consulta-tion costs) to potentially major (opportunity costs of delays in the granting program).

Design, Transition, and Administrative Costs

Transition costs from the old system to the RAF were expected to be larger than costs in an ordi-nary year. However, RAF design and development costs are difficult to separate from ordinary oper-ating costs. Much of the work in developing the RAF is not visible in the accounts; this includes the costs of the Technical Working Group, the Inter-Agency RAF Task Force, and the midterm evalua-tion review team. The RAF was an important item in five Council meetings, two Paris consultations, and several subregional workshops.

Typically, organizations that operate a PBA sys-tem incur administrative costs ranging from about $1 million per year to about $1.5 million.21 The GEF’s experience in the first year of RAF implementation has been similar. Direct costs amounted to approximately $1.3 million (from the Council’s approved budget for special initia-tives) over several years for Secretariat staff costs (35 percent), World Bank Development Econom-ics work (31 percent), and travel costs for Council meetings (22 percent). As of July 2008, there is a balance of $383,000 of the approved special initia-tives budget of $1.716 million.

Ongoing maintenance of the RAF as a PBA sys-tem by the GEF Secretariat will be less costly than the transition has been.22 Nevertheless, experi-ence in other organizations has shown that a PBA system evolves continually because it is so central to the organization’s strategy and priorities. For example, the RAF will probably be an important topic in replenishment consultations for the fore-seeable future. Consequently, development costs will likely continue for some time.

Focal Point Consultation Costs

Consultations enable the RAF to exert influence and provide incentives to member governments. Therefore, the costs of the focal point system may increase. The funds that GEF OFPs have for awareness activities and consultation ($8,000) may be insufficient given the RAF’s demands. These costs are not necessarily in proportion to the size of a country’s portfolio or allocation; rather, a minimum level of discussion on RAF priorities is needed in all cases.

Agency Costs and Pipeline Costs

In the short term, costs have increased for the Agencies as they have taken on additional tasks in terms of explaining RAF arrangements and work-ing within RAF constraints. There have been costs

Page 200: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

126 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

of revision and re-endorsement of projects in the pipeline to respond to the RAF. Some of these re-endorsements are likely one-time costs related to the establishment of the new system.

Agency fees were reduced to a flat percentage of the project budget in GEF-3, with no possibility for negotiation as was the case previously. At the same time, the corporate budget was abolished for the three Implementing Agencies. This bud-get was used for portfolio monitoring, support to GEF policy development, coordination, and cross-support to projects. These changes, while perhaps justified on their merits, leave the Agencies with little financial flexibility to adapt to new systems such as the RAF. However, additional Agency costs are not all attributable to the RAF’s institu-tion, and many are the consequence of frequent changes in rules during the same period.

Additional costs, not closely related to the RAF as such, may have affected Agencies’ incentives to undertake GEF work. For example, the new pro-grammatic approaches encouraged by the GEF Sec-retariat are not fully covered by fees. Some of the cost pressure during the transition to the RAF, including some shifts in country concentration of resources, may have contributed to utilization problems.

Potential Funding inefficienciesThe RAF has established a “firewall” between the GEF’s two largest focal areas, which adds to the complexity of multifocal projects. Access to all these different funding windows depends on vari-ous criteria of eligibility, country classification, historical participation in the GEF, being a signa-tory of conventions, and so on.

The GEF manages a number of separate funding windows—the Special Climate Change Fund, the LDC Fund, the Adaptation Fund, and the Strate-gic Pilot on Adaptation on the same subject (taken from RAF funds). Adaptation activities can be

financed through the pilot, the LDC Fund, the Spe-cial Climate Change Fund, and, in the near future, the Clean Development Mechanism, as well as through enabling activities or regular projects, but not through the climate change RAF. Some funds are accessed directly for country projects; for others, countries have to go through corporate programs, which may be regional or global, with separate procedures. The support fund for focal points is accessed through UNDP.

Some of these special funds are underutilized. Their relationship to the RAF, if any, is unclear. All involve different procedures and modalities. It is therefore not difficult to understand why some stakeholders find the whole funding situation nontransparent and inaccessible.

opportunity Costs of Delay GEF projects generally have high economic rates of return. When grants are delayed, the hidden costs (opportunity costs) can be large. In fact, this may be the greatest, although invisible, cost of the transition to the new RAF. The slow utilization of resources, which may have been partially a result of the RAF’s institution, has serious implications for effectiveness. Delays may be a temporary phe-nomenon during transition, but they may also be partly a result of insufficient flexibility in the design of the RAF itself.

impact and Cost-effectivenessThe cost-effectiveness of the RAF will depend mainly on whether it improves the GEF’s impact. It is too early to tell whether impact will in fact be better under the RAF. In the short term, the RAF has yielded benefits in terms of better planning and ownership in some countries. It has improved the predictability of funding for individual alloca-tion countries. Additionally, some countries with large allocations have been able to bring more coherence to their portfolio.

Page 201: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

6. implementation of the RAF 127

As few projects have been approved, and even fewer started, it is impossible to say if they will be better implemented or generate more global environmental benefits. Some trends are positive, although not quantifiable in financial terms. These include a broader composition of Agencies in the portfolio, new projects based on national priority setting, and broad coverage of countries.

These positive trends are offset by some unfa-vorable ones. The RAF may have encouraged a broader spread of resources, smaller projects, and an entitlement mentality among some member governments. These factors could inhibit the effi-ciency of GEF resource allocation. Also, the RAF has not benefited from significant involvement by NGOs, civil society, and the private sector, with a consequent loss in opportunities to broaden the effectiveness and range of GEF resources.

The cost-benefit of the RAF has not yet been fully demonstrated compared with the previous system or with other PBA systems in terms of value for the money. In future implementation, cost-effectiveness can be enhanced by increasing overall funds and country allocations (same effort but more benefit), decreasing efforts to access existing funds (same benefit but less effort), or, preferably, both of these.

Simulations of different replenishment amounts (from $900 million to the formula currently in place, to $1.0 billion, $1.5 billion, $1.8 billion, and $2.0 billion) show that if there is more money in the system, the RAF formula would push countries into the group allocation because of the 75 per-cent rule. Without this rule, but with more funds, many more countries could potentially receive a reasonable individual allocation. For example, with a group cutoff at $4 million, with the high-est replenishment scenario, the GEF could pro-vide sizable individual allocations to 87 countries in biodiversity and 70 countries in climate change (see Statistical Annex #1, “Simulations”).

notesThe breakdown for individual stakeholder groups 1. agreeing with the statement included 53 percent among GEF focal points and government staff, 56 percent among NGO and private sector orga-nization staff, and 77 percent among GEF Agency staff.

The enabling activities are in Guyana, Jamaica, 2. and Malawi; the MSPs are in Bulgaria, Indonesia, Kenya, Liberia, Mexico, and Uganda; and the FSPs are in Brazil, Chile, Costa Rica, Mexico, Paraguay, Peru, South Africa, Tajikistan, and Tanzania. There are no reliable data on the involvement of NGOs as contractors or partners for project components nor on services within projects, either before or under the RAF. Smaller allocations and smaller projects would not favor such NGO components.

This represents 13 percent of MSP funds and 3. 11 percent of FSP funds. However, these figures are overestimated, as not all of these projects will be under NGO management (since some have more than one executing agency); also, some of the classifications in the database erroneously cite NGOs rather than government entities.

The communication strategy sets out five principal 4. objectives: “To create a clear GEF corporate iden-tity; for GEF partners, to speak with a unified GEF voice; for the public, to position GEF as a leader on the global environment; for expanded interest groups, to communicate effectively with GEF; and to embed GEF messages at country and regional levels. Accessibility: on four fronts: strengthening the Secretariat’s capacity for direct dialogue with countries, improving the effectiveness of corporate programs, strengthening the GEF’s capacity to tap into and share its knowledge base, and strengthen-ing the GEF’s corporate image and public commu-nications” (GEF 2007b).

This document was sent by email to the opera-5. tional and political focal points on September 20, 2006, from the GEF Secretariat, copying the Coun-cil members, convention secretariats, and GEF Agencies.

In biodiversity, 61 percent of individual countries 6. have a medium to high resource utilization rate, and 61 percent in climate change have zero or low resource utilization.

Page 202: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

128 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

By stakeholder group, those finding the pipeline 7. changes to be a hindering factor were 35 percent of focal points and government staff, 43 percent of NGO staff, 68 percent of GEF Agency staff, and 78 percent of Council members and alternates. Because the number of responses from Council members and alternates is low, the data for this group are not statistically comparable with those from the other groups listed.

For example, one country endorsed three PIFs for 8. the same project. Each PIF named a different GEF Agency as its executing organization. Through subsequent negotiation, a resolution was arrived at among the Agencies.

This excludes the 11 countries, mainly located in 9. the Middle East and new to the GEF, that are only included in the climate change group allocation.

Countries for which the 50 percent rule has been 10. lifted are China, Guatemala, Indonesia, Malay-sia, the Marshall Islands, Mauritius, the Feder-ated States of Micronesia, Mongolia, Palau, South Africa, Thailand, Turkey, Ukraine, and Vietnam.

It is uncertain if the consultation structures for the 11. portfolio are also used for PIF or project prepara-tion and reviews, or for consultation on propos-als in other GEF focal areas. It is also too early to establish if such coordination mechanisms are permanent and sustainable or whether these are in place mainly for RAF priorities.

The Secretariat reports 33.8 months for 13 FSPs. 12.

Mainstreaming Prevention and Control Mea-13. sures for Invasive Alien Species into Trade, Trans-port and Travel across the Production Landscape (GEF ID 3254), implemented by UNDP in the Seychelles.

As there is no institutionalized system for moni-14. toring and recording response time, the midterm review was not able to verify the times reported by the Secretariat.

This was the case for Albania, Armenia, Djibouti, 15. India, Indonesia, the Islamic Republic of Iran, Jordan, Mongolia, Myanmar, Namibia, Palau, the Philippines, Russia, Senegal, Tanzania, Ukraine, Uruguay, Uzbekistan, Vietnam, the Republic of Yemen, and Zambia.

When funded in the latter manner, these projects 16. are recorded in the GEF database as country proj-ects. Under GEF-4, the GEF Project Management Information System often records these under a financial break-up project classification according to the source of funds (GRE, country individual allocation, focal area, and so on), making statistical historical comparisons challenging.

For example, the point was made at subregional 17. workshops in 2006 that “this fund pool [the GRE] is dedicated to projects that go beyond the country level and it is hoped that countries will contribute to regional projects.”

Examples include the GEF Pacific Alliance for Sus-18. tainability, the Carbon Benefits Project, and the Global Market Transformation for Efficient Light-ing initiative.

Of 259 terminal evaluation reviews available and 19. 190 reviewed, 132 are for single country projects and 58 for global and regional projects (GEF EO 2008c). Monitoring and evaluation during imple-mentation is naturally more challenging for multi-country projects (58 percent were rated as mar-ginally satisfactory and above on this parameter, versus 75 percent of single country projects).

For example, funding for the top-ranked coun-20. try, Brazil, would decrease from $63.0 million to $57.5 million.

Both IDA and ADB have estimated at different 21. times that their PBA systems cost about $1.5 mil-lion per year. Small international financial institu-tions and funds—for example, CDB—spend less on their systems, which tend to be smaller and simpler.

Costs for RAF maintenance have, since 2007, been 22. mainstreamed under the GEF Secretariat corpo-rate budget—for example, the cost of the staff post covering RAF environment economics. Other costs related to RAF maintenance include out-reach to countries. Training and awareness raising have mainly been handled through the Country Support Programme for focal points, including participation from the GEF Secretariat. This rep-resents a considerable indirect cost, given that the agenda for the subregional workshops has been dominated by RAF matters since 2006.

Page 203: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

129

Annex: Management Response

This annex presents the management response to the executive summary of this report, which was presented to the GEF Council in November 2008 as GEF/ME/C.34/2. Minor editorial corrections have been made.

This is the management response to docu-ment GEF/ME/C.34/2, “Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework,” undertaken by the GEF Evaluation Office. The overall objec-tive of the midterm review was to “evaluate the degree to which resources have been allocated to countries in a cost-effective manner based on global environmental benefits and country per-formance,” with the following three subobjectives: (1) to evaluate the extent to which the design of the RAF is able to facilitate maximization of the impact of scarce GEF resources to enhance global environmental benefits, (2) to assess the extent to which the early implementation of the RAF is providing countries with predictability and trans-parency as well as country-driven approaches to improve the potential for delivery of global envi-ronmental benefits, and (3) to compare the design and implementation of the RAF with the resource allocation systems of other multilateral agencies.

The review focuses on three major phases of the RAF experience: (1) design and approval from August 2002 to August 2005, (2) planning for implementation from August 2005 to June 2006,

and (3) implementation to midpoint allocation from July 2006 to July 2008.

The management response has been prepared by the GEF Secretariat, with comments received from the GEF Agencies.1 The GEF plays a unique role among global multilateral institutions with a particular mandate to assist developing countries generate global environmental benefits. It is the financial mechanism of four multilateral envi-ronmental conventions. It is a networked part-nership, depending upon 10 Agencies to work with eligible countries to develop and implement GEF-financed activities. The design and imple-mentation of the RAF has been a major challenge facing the GEF over the last six years. The RAF represents a fundamental change in GEF business practices in the focal areas of climate change and biodiversity. Instituting this fundamental change through a complex network partnership is bound to have been a learning experience with positives and negatives. The midterm review of the RAF provides us with a good opportunity to take stock of this experience, benefit from its conclusions and recommendations, and move forward to fur-ther refine the programming framework of the GEF to meet the goals of all its partners.

We are in general agreement with the four recom-mendations emerging from the review, and con-sider them to provide a sound basis for further development of the RAF. Some of the conclusions

Page 204: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

130 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

of the review, however, need to be placed and interpreted within their proper contexts.

A.1 Findings and ConclusionsWe are pleased with the review’s overall conclu-sion that the “RAF has, overall, been implemented in accordance with Council decisions.” As the review underscores, the shift to a new mode of allocating and programming resources has been challenging for the GEF and its Agencies. It is our view that, to a large extent, the rigid rules of the RAF design contributed significantly to difficul-ties in the operational phase.

Conclusion 1: The GeF is operating in circum-stances that intensify the need to allocate scarce resources purposefully.

We are in overall agreement with the above con-clusion. However, as the GEF looks forward, it is also important to note that we need to find ways to allocate resources that are responsive to the GEF mandate to deal with global environmental commons in its different focal areas. In addition, we need to take into consideration the level of resources available and the large number of eli-gible countries to allocate resources not only pur-posefully, but also pragmatically. The future evo-lution of the allocation system has to reflect the networked structure of the GEF with 10 Agencies, its fundamental obligations to conventions, and the particular needs of least developed countries.

Conclusion 2: Data and indicators for assessing global environmental benefits used in the RAF reflect the best information available today, with some gaps that should be addressed over time.

We are pleased with the conclusion that the indexes for biodiversity and climate change in general reflect the best scientific data currently available. It is interesting to note that the Delphi experts experienced the same quandaries faced by

the RAF team with regard to the choice of indi-cators, weights, and methodologies. We intend to continue to improve the methodology and the indicators as better data become available, both in biodiversity and climate change—in biodiversity with regard to marine ecosystems, and in climate change with regard to land use, land use change and forestry, and adaptation—and will engage with experts in the Agencies, the STAP, NGOs, and research organizations in this endeavor.

Conclusion 3: The RAF does not provide effec-tive incentives to improve performance.

The above conclusion must be regarded in the general framework of how performance is usu-ally included in a resource allocation system. First, resource allocation systems are primarily designed to help direct scarce resources toward generating benefits in the scope of the institution’s mandate. The GEF’s mandate is to provide assistance to developing countries to generate global environ-mental benefits. Second, performance is usually included in the allocation framework to manage risk, that is, to influence the resource allocation at the margin toward countries where conditions for success are better. Third, allocation systems are based on relative ranking of both benefits and performance. At the extreme, for example, if all countries improve their performance, with no change in benefits, the allocations would remain the same. To make a resource allocation system primarily driven by performance is to risk mis-direction of resources with respect to the institu-tion’s overall mandate.

We note the review’s concern with regard to the lack of a clear understanding of what performance means in the minds of several stakeholders. The review also notes that the performance of the envi-ronmental portfolio has a relatively low weight in the performance indexes (5 percent for ongoing GEF projects) thereby implying that improving

Page 205: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Annex: Management Response 131

the performance of this portfolio will lead to a very limited increase of the allocation. Allocation systems are usually forward-looking with regard to performance, usually providing a higher weight for existing institutional and policy frameworks that reflect the potential for future performance, and therefore a lower weight for past performance, usually reflected through portfolio performance. The GEF RAF very much reflects the approach with regard to inclusion of performance in other allocation systems, though the weight of portfolio performance is at the lower range when compared to other systems.

In closing, we do think that, in the RAF, perfor-mance does matter on the margin with regard to influencing allocations. The more relevant ques-tion to ask is whether the overall level of resources available under the GEF really provides strong incentives to countries to improve performance with regard to their respective environmental institutions and policies.

Conclusion 4: Unclear guidelines have limited the access of the group allocation countries to GeF funds in the first period of the RAF.

The group allocation system was conceived to provide flexibility to the RAF system. Histori-cally, not all eligible countries have requested GEF funding during a replenishment period. A group allocation system, it was thought, would provide the flexibility to program several countries to the ceiling of the group, while some others may not request GEF funding. However, programming the group has been a challenge, particularly to ensure that countries that request funding do get the mini-mum guaranteed of $1 million in each focal area.

The Secretariat has taken a pragmatic, as well as a proactive, approach to this challenge. In order to ensure that first-comers do not garner all resources, the Secretariat has adopted a phased

tactic to ensure that group countries utilize their allocations. Countries can submit proposals requesting up to $1 million for each country until the end of December 2008. These proposals will be reviewed for their strategic fit and technical merits prior to any approval. After that, the resources in the group allocation will be programmed through a batch review of requests for proposals up to the ceiling of the group for each country. While the evolution of such an approach may have created confusion among several stakeholders, we think that it is an equitable and pragmatic way to pro-gram countries in the group.

Conclusion 5: The complexity of the RAF’s implementation rules does not encourage flex-ible and dynamic use of resources given the relatively small GeF-4 funding.

We are in agreement with this finding that some of the rules of the RAF have reduced the flexibil-ity in implementation. For the small level of fund-ing available in the GEF, the rules are particularly onerous. Indeed, as the review points out, the 50 percent rule does not serve as a strong incen-tive for performance improvement at midpoint, nor does it serve to improve liquidity.

We also agree with the finding that the RAF needs to have rules for reallocating unutilized alloca-tions in the crucial last year of GEF-4 in order to reduce the amount of unprogrammed resources carried over to GEF-5. We will review the reallo-cation practices in other institutions and propose an approach to the Council in spring 2009.

Conclusion 6: The RAF design and rules are too complex for a network partnership such as the GeF, and the guidelines and support provided have not succeeded in making the RAF trans-parent and accessible.

We are in agreement with the finding that the design of the RAF is too complex to be commu-

Page 206: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

132 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

nicated easily. We are, however, not in agreement that implementation practices and the corporate reforms and requirements have resulted in slow utilization of funds.

The RAF implementation team was very aware that the introduction of a complex instrument such as the RAF would need a smooth transition to GEF-4. Steps were taken to inform countries of the arrangements to operate under the RAF with the issuance of guidelines in May 2006 when countries were also requested to provide an ini-tial list of project concepts by September 15, 2006. This was, of course, in parallel with the series of regional workshops to roll out the RAF.

In practice, why was the transition not as smooth as expected? When the project endorsement let-ters began arriving at the Secretariat during Sep-tember 2006, the Secretariat was concerned that many projects were no longer in line with country priorities, or no longer provided the best fit with the emerging GEF-4 strategic priorities. In order to ascertain the evolving priorities of countries and to ensure that concepts under development would fit within the GEF-4 priorities, the Secre-tariat had teleconference discussions with over 120 countries during October 2006 to April 2007. This process was followed by a close monitoring by the Secretariat of the RAF programming rates through direct engagement with the countries. As the review notes, this exercise strained the resources of the Secretariat.

In parallel with the above effort to reach out to countries, the Secretariat also engaged in an exer-cise to deal with an oversized project pipeline of 177 concepts amounting to about $1.5 billion, or nearly half of the GEF-4 replenishment. Given the historical nature of the pipeline, many of the concepts were outdated and did not fit with the evolving focal area strategies and/or were not in consonance with the country allocations under

the RAF. The re-pipelining effort was necessary in order to reduce the pipeline overhang to nearly half its original size so that innovative new pro-posals that reflect both the GEF priorities and the country allocations could be approved for further preparation. Needless to say, the process was a lit-tle tumultuous, but was necessary in order to “cut the coat according to the cloth.”

The midterm review also points to the GEF-4 reform agenda as a significant cause of slow uti-lization of funds in the focal areas under the RAF. First, the utilization of funds has to be carefully interpreted. The simple fact is that the GEF can-not program ahead of availability of funds, mean-ing that the Council just cannot approve work pro-grams if there are no funds in the GEF Trust Fund. Though the GEF-4 phase began on July 1, 2006, it became effective only in February 2007. Until June 3, 2008, over a period of 17 months, nearly a third of the resources have been utilized in each of the climate change and biodiversity focal areas. The Secretariat and the Agencies are now on tar-get to program about half the resources in both the focal areas by November 2008, that is, over 21 months since funds became available. Therefore, closer analysis reveals that the programming rate is close, or even marginally faster than, what can be expected vis-à-vis the availability of funds.

The steps taken under the reform process were practical responses, approved by Council, to issues identified in a series of reports from the GEF Eval-uation Office. The evaluation of the GEF project activity cycle, in particular, led to the revamping of the project cycle that was approved by the Coun-cil in June 2007. The fundamental changes in poli-cies and operational procedures, combined with the transition to programming under the RAF for two focal areas, while posing some early dif-ficulties, were necessary in order to improve the effectiveness of the GEF. In fact, the new project

Page 207: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Annex: Management Response 133

cycle, where resources are marked as utilized at the point where PIFs are approved by the Council, provides an early guarantee to a recipient coun-try regarding the feasibility of the concept and the availability of resources. Similarly, other reforms have established a better and transparent operat-ing environment for different GEF stakeholders. It was inevitable that the early period of dealing with this transition would pose difficulties. However, it is our judgment that the system is now settling down as the different players have become famil-iar and comfortable with the revised policies and procedures.

Conclusion 7: The RAF has increased country ownership in countries with an individual allo-cation and has had a neutral or detrimental effect on country ownership in countries with a group allocation.

We are pleased with the review’s finding that the RAF has increased country ownership of GEF-financed activities, particularly in those countries with individual allocations. We are not surprised that country ownership is relatively weak in coun-tries in the group that expect to get very little resources from the GEF. We hope to work with the Council in refining the RAF such that coun-try ownership becomes a strong feature of GEF-financed activities across all recipient countries.

We share the concern raised by the review that in the majority of countries, the involvement of NGOs and the private sector is limited, or even nonexistent, in government-led consultations on GEF programming. The Secretariat and the Agencies will continue to work through our cor-porate programs such as the regional consulta-tions and National Dialogue Initiative to continue to encourage broader stakeholder involvement in GEF-financed activities. Again, it is impracti-cal to expect wide-ranging consultative processes

in countries that expect to receive very little resources from the GEF.

We remain concerned that the RAF has restricted the potential for the private sector to access GEF funding, considering the need to engage the pri-vate sector in maximizing positive impact on the global environment. We believe that the continu-ation of the Earth Fund mechanism to enable the private sector to participate in the GEF is vital to achieving far greater leverage of and returns to GEF resources.

We agree with the midterm review’s view that the concept of country ownership contains some intrinsic tensions. Country programming cannot be solely driven by national priorities; it also has to respond to global priorities established by the GEF Council, reflecting the mandate of the GEF. The challenge for the GEF is to identify, in consul-tation with eligible countries, those activities that meet national priorities while delivering global environmental benefits.

Conclusion 8: The exclusions did not work well and may have diminished the effectiveness of the GeF in the delivery of global and regional environmental benefits.

We do not share the definite conclusion as stated above. It is true that the exclusions of 5 percent for global and regional projects do not fully reflect the historical shares in either of the focal areas. However, there has been a long-standing concern, expressed by several recipient countries, that multicountry projects may not fully reflect the priorities of the participating countries. In order to address this issue during the design of the RAF, the Council agreed to limit the exclusions under the RAF to 5 percent for global and regional proj-ects in each of the focal areas, with the under-standing that a significant share of resources for participating in multicountry projects would be

Page 208: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

134 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

generated from the allocations of the participat-ing countries. A share of the exclusion would be directed toward global projects, while multicoun-try regional projects would be programmed from a combination of country allocations and resources from exclusions.

The Secretariat, together with the Agencies, has been implementing the above-mentioned approach in order to ensure that multicountry projects are really country driven. While such an approach may have affected the implementa-tion of projects through particular GEF Agencies, the participating countries have often expressed a stronger ownership for the projects that they are involved in. In the final analysis, multicountry projects with country ownership not only reflect priorities of the countries, but are also better positioned to deliver project benefits. However, overall, it remains true that given the low base level of resources available for the focal areas, the resources available through the 5 percent exclu-sions are too small for any meaningful interven-tions through global and regional projects.

Regarding the “taxation” of focal areas for fund-ing corporate and global activities, it reflects the approach suggested by the donors during the fourth replenishment negotiations. We hope to work with the donors during future replenish-ments to fund such activities without taxing the focal areas.

Similarly, for the Small Grants Programme, under the RAF it was agreed by the Council that fund-ing would be from a combination of core funds (largely directed toward LDCs and SIDS) and contributions from focal area allocations of par-ticipating countries, particularly those with indi-vidual allocations. It was also agreed by the SGP Steering Committee that there was a need to limit the contributions from those countries contribut-ing from their country allocations to their respec-

tive SGP activities, so that a significant share of the resources would continue to be programmed for focal area activities. Hence the need for man-aging the country contributions to the SGP. The SGP Steering Committee will revisit the necessity of country strategies for country allocations to the RAF if the country already has an SGP strategy.

A.2 RecommendationsWe are in overall agreement with the four recom-mendations emerging from the review, and look forward to guidance from the Council in following up on the recommendations. As part of the man-agement response, we would like to suggest some approaches toward follow-up.

Recommendation 1: Reallocation of unused funds should be allowed in the last year of GeF-4.

We agree with the review’s finding that the GEF and its Agencies should ensure that very limited unused resources be carried forward into GEF-5. While we do not foresee any overall underuti-lization issues, we have to be prepared for cases where several countries may not be able to utilize their respective allocations by the end of GEF-4 (June 30, 2010). We will take stock of the program-ming situation by December 31, 2008, and make a proposal to the Council at its spring 2009 meeting for a reallocation of funds for programming during the last year of GEF-4 (July 1, 2009–June 30, 2010).

Recommendation 2: The last phase of GeF-4, including reallocation of funds, should be imple-mented with full public disclosure, transpar-ency, participation, and clear responsibilities.

We could not agree more with the above recom-mendation. We will establish an inter-Agency process to develop proposals for reallocation and reprogramming for the consideration of the CEO. In addition to electronic communications, con-

Page 209: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Annex: Management Response 135

stituency meetings, and so on, we will also employ the inter-Agency process as a means to dissemi-nate information rapidly through participating Agencies and countries.

Recommendation 3: implementation rules need to be simplified.

We agree with the need for simplification of pro-cessing. We have already established a moratorium on additional requirements for project identifica-tion and formulation for the remainder of GEF-4. We will also take a proposal to the Council in spring 2009 to further simplify the requirements for medium-size projects.2

As the report recommends, it is important for the countries to reflect national priorities, but we have also got to identify where pursuit of those national priorities can deliver global benefits in accordance with GEF priorities. Such an approach is essential if the GEF is to maintain its mandate among dif-ferent funding sources.

Several issues have been raised with regard to the SGP and programming under the RAF. The SGP Steering Committee will revisit those issues in the context of the midterm review, and will inform the Council in spring 2009 regarding the steps taken.

Recommendation 4: steps to improve RAF design and indexes for GeF-5 should be taken now.

The midterm review has provided several forward-looking suggestions for improving the RAF design before implementation of GEF-5. These include (1) improvement of the global benefits indexes and their weights, (2) increase of the weight of environ-mental portfolio performance, (3) improvement of predictability and cost benefits for the group allo-cation, (4) reconsideration of ceilings and floors, (5) recognition of transboundary global environ-mental problems, and (6) expanding the RAF to

one integrated allocation for all focal areas. The review provides detailed suggestions for each of the above areas.

The introduction of the RAF was a fundamental change in the GEF’s way of doing business. Rela-tive to other institutions with allocation systems, the GEF is straitjacketed in many ways. It has a lower level of resources, dispersed across six differ-ent focal areas and programmed across more than 160 countries. The GEF is a financial institution of four multilateral environmental conventions with the obligation to support eligible countries with the fundamental requirements of each one of those conventions. Eligible countries prepare and implement GEF projects through 10 Agen-cies. Therefore, it is not surprising that both the design and the implementation of the RAF were difficult experiences for the GEF and its different stakeholders. If a GEF-wide RAF is implemented, the Secretariat agrees with the midterm review’s finding that there is a clear need to strengthen the Secretariat to be able to play a stronger coordinat-ing role in programming among GEF Agencies and recipient countries, in line with findings men-tioned in the review regarding staff resources of comparable multilaterals with resource allocation systems such as IFAD and the Global Fund.

notesThe preparation of this management response has 1. been under a very tight deadline. The GEF Evalua-tion Office distributed to the Agencies and the Sec-retariat a working document on the RAF midterm review on September 30, 2008. The Office distrib-uted a revised version of the review on October 14, 2008. The Secretariat prepared a draft manage-ment response and distributed it to the Agencies on October 14, 2008, with request for comments by October 15, 2008, in order to meet the deadline for Web posting of documents.

Currently, the requirements for medium-size 2. projects are little different from that of full-size projects.

Page 210: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework
Page 211: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

137

Bibliography

The GEF Council documents cited here (indicated with the designation “GEF/C.xx”) are available on the GEF Web site, www.thegef.org, under Council/Coun-cil Meetings and Documents. GEF Evaluation Office documents can be found on the GEF Evaluation Office Web site, www.gefeo.org, under Publications.

Accra High Level Forum. 2007. “Summary of Partner Country Consultation on the Preparation of the Accra High Level Forum on Aid Effectiveness.” www.afd.fr/jahia/Jahia/cache/offonce/lang/en/home/Efficacite_1/pid/1686;jsessionid=93824B8A76C693BE3E7DF065AA58DB46. Accessed March 18, 2009.

ADB (Asian Development Bank). 2000. “Performance-Based Allocation of ADF Resources.” Board Work-ing Paper 9-00.

—. 2001. “Policy on Performance-Based Alloca-tion for Asian Development Fund Resources.”

—. 2003. “ADF VIII Midterm Review: Chairper-son’s Summary of Discussions.”

—. 2004a. “Increasing the Weight of Governance in the Revised PBA System.” Prepared for Asian Development Fund IX Donors’ Meeting, May 11–12, 2004.

—. 2004b. “Review of the Asian Development Bank’s Policy on the Performance-Based Alloca-tion of Asian Development Fund Resources.”

—. 2006a. “2005 Annual Report on ADB’s Country Performance Assessment Exercise.”

—. 2006b. “Implementation of the Performance-Based Allocation Policy—A Review.” Prepared for Asian Development Fund IX Midterm Review Meeting, December 4–6, 2006.

—. 2007. “Refining Performance-Based Alloca-tion.” Prepared for Asian Development Fund X Donors’ Meeting, September 13–14, 2007.

—. 2008. Strategy 2020: The Long-Term Strategic Framework of the Asian Development Bank 2008–2020. Mandaluyong City, Philippines.

—. n.d. “Asian Development Fund: Fact Sheet on ADB’s Performance-Based Allocation Policy.” www.adb.org/ADF/PBA/fact-sheet.asp. Accessed March 10, 2009.

ADB (Asian Development Bank), Operations Evaluation Department. 2006. Annual Evaluation Report: 2006 Annual Evaluation Review. RPE: OTH 2006-11.

—. 2007a. “ADB’s Japan Funds: Japan Fund for Poverty Reduction, Japan Special Fund, and Japan Scholarship Summary Report.” JFS: OTH 2007-20.

—. 2007b. “ADB’s Japan Funds: Japan Scholarship Program.” SES: REG 2007-11.

—. 2007c. “ADB’s Japan Funds: Japan Special Fund.” Evaluation Study. SES: REG 2007-12.

—. 2007d. “Asian Development Fund VIII and IX Operations.” SST: REG 2008-01.

—. 2007e. “Corrigendum to Document IN.98-07 Country Assistance Program Evaluation for Pakistan.”

—. 2007f. “India.” Country Assistance Program Evaluation. CAP: IND 2007-23.

—. 2007g. “Learning Curves: ADB and the Paris Declaration on Aid Effectiveness.” December.

—. 2007h. “Learning Curves: ADB’s Environmen-tal Safeguards.” January.

—. 2007i. “Learning Curves: Performance and Pro-cess Evaluations of ADB-GEF Projects.” August.

Page 212: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

138 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

—. 2007j. “Pakistan.” Country Assistance Program Evaluation.

—. 2007k. “Special Evaluation Study on Long-Term Strategic Framework: Lesson from Implementa-tion (2001–2006).” SST: REG 2007-38.

—. 2007l. “Sri Lanka Inclusive Development and Conflict Resolution: Major Challenges in the Future.” Country Assistance Program Evaluation.

—. 2008a. “Learning Curves: ADB’s Long-Term Stra-tegic Framework: Lessons, 2001–2006.” January.

—. 2008b. “Learning Curves: Asian Development Fund VIII and IX Operations—Targeting Poverty and Governance.” January.

—. 2008c. “Learning Curves: Managing for Devel-opment Results in ADB.” January.

AfDB (African Development Bank). 20007. ADF–11 Deputies Report. London.

AfDB (African Development Bank), Operations Evalu-ation Department. 2004. Stepping up to the Future: An Independent Evaluation of African Develop-ment Fund VII, VIII and IX.

Atkins, M., and A. Easter. 2000. A Commonwealth Vulnerability Index for Developing Countries: The Position of Small States. London: Commonwealth Secretariat.

Berridge, R. J., P. Ramani, and B. E. Young, eds. 2008. Threatened Amphibians of the World. Barcelona: Lynx Edicions, in association with IUCN, Conser-vation International and NatureServe.

Boisson de Chazournes, L. 2003. The Global Environment Facility as a Pioneering Institution: Lessons Learned and Looking Ahead. GEF Working Paper 19. www.gefweb.org/Outreach/outreach-PUblications/2003-11WP19.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

Caribbean Conservation Association. 2004. “Report on Interventions Made at GEF Seminar on Resource Allocation Framework.”

Castle, S., and K. Bradsher. 2008. “China’s Shift on Food Was Key to Trade Impasse.” New York Times, July 31.

CDB (Caribbean Development Bank). 1998. “Natural Disaster Strategy and Operational Guidelines.”

—. 2000. “Index of Inherent Economic Vulnerabil-ity for Developing Countries.” CDB Staff Working Paper No. 4/00.

—. 2007. “Review of the Special Development Fund (Unified) Resource Allocation System and the Management Response Thereto.” SDF 6/3 SM-2.

Chanson, J., S. Stuart, N. Cox, B. Young, and M. Hoffmann. In press. “The Global Amphibian Assessment (GAA): History, Objectives and Methodology.”

Clemencon, R. 2006. “What Future for the Global Environment Facility?” Journal of Environment & Development 15: 50.

DFID (UK Department for International Develop-ment). 1999. “Aligning Aid Strategies to Perfor-mance in Low Income Countries: Roundtable Dis-cussion.” London, March 3–4, 1999.

Easterly, W. R. 2001. The Elusive Quest for Growth: Economists’ Adventures and Misadventures in the Tropics. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.

Eccles, S., and C. Gwin. 1999. Supporting Effective Aid: A Framework for Future Concessional Funding of Multilateral Development Banks. Overseas Devel-opment Council Policy Essay No. 23. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press.

Eifert, B., and A. Gelb. 2005. “Coping with Aid Volatil-ity.” Finance and Development Magazine 42(3).

Eurodad (European Network on Debt and Develop-ment). 2006. “Role of Donors in Aid Volatility and How to Reduce It.”

European Environment Agency. 2007. “Climate Change: The Cost of Inaction and the Cost of Adaptation.” EEA Technical Report No 13. Copenhagen.

Evaluation Cooperation Group of the International Financial Institutions. 2007. The Nexus Between Infrastructure and Environment. http://siteresources.worldbank.org/EXTOED/Resources/nexus_infrastructure_environment_quicknote.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

Executive Board of the UNDP (United Nations Devel-opment Programme) and of the UNPF (United Nations Population Fund). 1999. “Report on the First Regular Session 1999.” www.undp.org/execbrd/html/dp99-8.html. Accessed March 18, 2009.

—. 2005. “Midterm Review of the Program-ming Arrangements for the Period 2004–2007.” www.undp.org/execbrd/word/dp05-18.doc. Accessed March 18, 2009.

Page 213: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Bibliography 139

—. 2008. “Information on TRAC-2 Allocation and Methodology and Criteria for Establishing Fixed Lines in the Programming Arrangements.” www.undp.org/execbrd/word/dp08-14.doc. Accessed March 18, 2009.

Fedder, G. D. B. 2007. “Assessment of Global Marine Biodiversity Indicators for the Global Environ-ment Facility Resource Allocation Framework (GEF RAF).” M.Sc. thesis. Bremen: University of Bremen, Faculty for Biology & Chemistry.

Freestone, D. 2004. Legal opinion from the GEF Act-ing Deputy General Counsel to the GEF CEO as to whether a GEF performance-based framework be consistent with the GEF Instrument, April 20, 2004.

GEF (Global Environment Facility). 1994. Instrument for the Establishment of the Restructured Global Envi-ronment Facility. Reprinted 2008. www.gefweb.org/uploadedFiles/GEF_Instrument_March08.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 1996. “Public Involvement in GEF-Financed Projects.” www.gefweb.org/Operational_Policies/Public_Involvement/public_involvement.html. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2000. “Revised Guidelines for Additional Fund-ing of Biodiversity Enabling Activities (Expe-dited Procedures).” www.gefweb.org/documents/enabling_activity_projects/documents/Revised_biodi_EA_guidlelines.pdf. Accessed March 24, 2009.

—. 2001. “The GEF Programmatic Approach: Cur-rent Understandings.” GEF/C.17.Inf.11.

—. 2002a. “Beijing Declaration of the Second GEF Assembly.” www.gefweb.org/Beijing_Declaration _-_English.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2002b. “Draft Policy Recommendations Agreed as Part of the Third Replenishment of the GEF Trust Fund.”

—. 2002c. “Joint Summary of the Chairs, GEF Coun-cil Meeting October 14–15, 2002.” GEF/C.20.

—. 2002d. “Suggested U.S. Language for Perfor-mance-Based Allocations.” gefweb.org/GEF-3-4Replenishment/Reple_Documents/R.3.CRP.3_language--gef.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2002e. “Summary of the Co-Chairs, Meeting on the Third Replenishment of the GEF Trust Fund.”

—. 2002f. “Summary of Negotiations on the Third Replenishment of the GEF Trust Fund.” GEF/C.20/4.

—. 2003a. “Issues Note: A Framework for Pro-gramming Resources for Enhanced Performance and Results at the Country Level.” GEF/C.21/8.

—. 2003b. “Joint Summary of the Chairs, GEF Council Meeting May 14–16, 2003.” GEF/C.21.

—. 2003c. “Joint Summary of the Chairs, GEF Coun-cil Meeting November 19–21, 2003. GEF/C.22.

—. 2003d. “Operational Procedures for the Expe-dited Financing of National Communications from Non-Annex I Parties.” GEF/C.22/Inf.16.

—. 2003e. “Performance Based Framework for Allocation of GEF Resources.” GEF/C.22/11.

—. 2004a. “Additional Issues for Operationalizing the GEF Resource Allocation Framework.” www. thegef.org/Whats_New/Issues_for_Operational-izing_the_GEF_RAF_Sept27.doc. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2004b. “Annotated Provisional Agenda, Seminar on Resource Allocation Framework.” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/RAF_Annotated_Provisional_Agenda.doc. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2004c. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework.” GEF/C.24/8.

—. 2004d. “Joint Summary of the Chairs, GEF Council Meeting May 19–21, 2004.” GEF/C.23.

—. 2004e. “Joint Summary of the Chairs, GEF Coun-cil Meeting November 17–19, 2004.” GEF/C.24.

—. 2004f. “Performance Based Allocation Frame-work for GEF Resources.” GEF/C.23/7.

—. 2005a. “Discussion Note on the Resource Allo-cation Framework.” Consultations on the Resource Allocation Framework, March 2005, Paris.

—. 2005b. GEF and Small Island Developing States: How the Global Environment Facility Is Working with SIDS for a Sustainable Future. www.gefweb.org/Outreach/outreach-PUblications/GEF_SIDS_ENG.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2005c. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework.” GEF/C.27/Inf.8/Rev.1.

—. 2005d. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework: Equations and Weights.” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/RAF_Technical_Note_Equations_and_Weights.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

Page 214: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

140 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

—. 2005e. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework: GEF Benefits Index for Biodiversity (GBIBIO).” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/RAF_Technical_Note_5-Benefits_Index_for_Bio.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2005f. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework: GEF Benefits Index for Climate Change (GBICC).” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/RAF_Technical_Note_4_-_Assessment_of_Climate_Change_Benefits__May_4__2005.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2005g. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework Operationalization.” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/RAF_Technical_Note_6_Operationalization_of_the_RAF.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2005h. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework: Public Disclosure of Indicators.” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/GEF_RAF_Techncial_Note_No_2_Public_Disclosure.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2005i. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework Technical Notes and Clarifications.” GEF/C.25/Inf.10.

—. 2005j. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework: Threshold for Individual Country Allocations.” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/RAF_Technical_Note_3_-_Threshold_Indiv_Ctry_Alloc.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2005k. “Implementing the GEF Resource Allo-cation Framework.” GEF/C.27/5/rev.1.

—. 2005l. “Joint Summary of the Chairs, GEF Council Meeting June 3–8, 2005.” GEF/C.25.

—. 2005m. “Joint Summary of the Chairs, Special Meeting of the GEF Council August 31–Septem-ber 1, 2005.” GEF/C.26.

—. 2005n. “Non-Paper towards a Draft Decision on RAF by Interested Parties.” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/RAF%20Non-paper%200303-05.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2005o. “Note on the GEF Council Consultations on the Resource Allocation Framework.” www.thegef.org/Whats_New/Note_on_Consultations_on_RAF.pdf. Accessed March 13, 2009.

—. 2005p. “Provisional Agenda: GEF Consulta-tions on the Resource Allocation Framework.”

—. 2005q. “Resource Allocation Framework.” GEF/C.25/8.

—. 2005r. “Resource Allocation Framework Addendum.” GEF/C.25/8/Add.1.Rev.1.

—. 2005s. “Secretariat Proposal on RAF.” GEF/C.25/CRP.5.

—. 2005t. “Technical Paper on the GEF Resource Allocation Framework.” GEF/C.26/2/Rev.1.

—. 2005u. “Working Draft of Council Decision on RAF Proposal by the Secretariat.” GEF/C.25/CRP.1.

—. 2006a. “Chair’s Summary of the Third GEF Assembly, Cape Town, South Africa, August 29–30, 2006.” www.gefweb.org/3rd_assembly/chair’s_summary.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2006b.“GEF Resource Allocation Framework: Guidelines for Country Operational Focal Points to Manage GEF Resources.” www.gefweb.org/Operational_Policies/raf/documents/RAFguidelinesforOperationalFocalPointsEnglish.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2006c. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework: Indicative Resource Allocations for GEF-4, for the Biodiversity and Climate Change Focal Areas.” www.gefweb.org/uploadedFiles/Policies/Resource_Allocation_Framework/GEF-4_Indicative_Allocations/RAF_Public_Disclosure_Document_English_15Sep2006.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2006d. “Minutes: Executive Coordinator Meet-ing, November 7, 2006.”

—. 2006e. “Progress Report on Implementing the RAF.” GEF/C.30/11.

—. 2006f. “Progress Report on Implementing the Resource Allocation Framework.” GEF/C.28/12.

—. 2006g. “Roles and Comparative Advantages of the GEF Agencies.” GEF/C.30/9.

—. 2006h. “Rules, Procedures and Objective Cri-teria for Project Selection, Pipeline Management, Approval of Sub-Projects, and Cancellation Pol-icy.” GEF/C.30/3.

—. 2006i. “Summary of Negotiations on the Fourth Replenishment of the GEF Trust Fund.” GEF/C.29/3.

—. 2006j. “Summary of Negotiations on the Fourth Replenishment Agreement of the GEF Trust Fund.” Revised. http://thegef.org/GEF-3-4Replenishment/Reple_Documents/SummaryofNegotiations_Revised_October2006.pdf. Accessed March 25, 2009.

Page 215: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Bibliography 141

—. 2007a. “Development of Country Strategies for GEF Programming.” GEF/C.32/Inf.5.

—. 2007b. “GEF Communications and Outreach Strategy.” GEF/C.32/8.

—. 2007c. “GEF Programming Report for the Period January 1–June 30, 2007.” GEF/C.34/Inf.7.

—. 2007d. “GEF Project Cycle Corrigendum.” GEF/C.31/7Corr.1.

—. 2007e. “Policies and Procedures for the GEF Project Cycle.” www.gefweb.org/uploadedfiles/GEF_Project_Cycle_Policy_Paper_Oct29_07.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2007f. “Progress Report on Implementing the RAF.” GEF/C.31/Inf.9.

—. 2007g. “Progress Report on the Implementa-tion of the RAF.” GEF/C.32 /Inf.6/Rev.1.

—. 2007h. “Relations with the Conventions and Other International Institutions.” GEF/C.32/4.

—. 2007i. Rules of Procedure for the GEF Council. www.gefweb.org/uploadedFiles/External_Affairs/Publications/Rules_of_Procedure2007.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2007j. “Terms of Reference for the Mid-Term Review of the Resource Allocation Framework.” Approved version. GEF/ME/C.32/6/Rev.1.

—. 2008a. “Annual Monitoring Review Report 2007.” GEF/C.33/4.

—. 2008b. “Elaborating a Strategic Program to Scale-Up the Level of Investment in the Trans-fer of Environmentally-Sound Technologies.” GEF/C.33/7.

—. 2008c. “Focal Area Strategies and Proposed Strategic Programs for GEF-5: Process Proposal.” GEF/C.33/Inf.7.

—. 2008d. “From Projects to Programs: Clarifying the Programmatic Approach in the GEF Portfolio.” GEF/C.33/6.

—. 2008e. “GEF Business Plan FY09–10 and FY09 Corporate Budget.” GEF/C.33/11.

—. 2008f. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework: GEF-4 Indicative Resource Allocations for the Biodiversity and Climate Change Focal Areas Based on the Midterm Reallocation (Revised Version October 3, 2008).” www.gefweb.org/

uploadedFiles/Policies/Resource_Allocation_Framework/RAF%20midterm%20reallocation_rev1.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2008g. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework: Mid-Term Reallocation of GEF-4 Resources: A Technical Note.” www.gefweb.org/uploadedFiles/Policies/Resource_Allocation_Framework/GE F-4_Indic at ive_Al lo c at ions/R A F%20midterm%20reallocation%20Technical%20Note%2007.31.08.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2008h. “Management of the GEF Project Cycle Operation: A Review.” GEF/C.34/Inf.4.

—. 2008i. “Manual for Calculating GHG Benefits of GEF Projects: Energy Efficiency and Renewable Energy Projects.” GEF/C.33/Inf.18.

—. 2008j. “Operational Policies and Guidance for the Use of Non-Grant Instruments.” GEF/C.33/12.

—. 2008k. “Progress Report on the Implementa-tion of the RAF.” GEF/C.33/Inf.4.

—. 2008l. “Progress Report on the Implementation of the RAF.” GEF/C.34/Inf.10.

—. 2008m. “Relations with the Conventions.” GEF/C.33/3/Rev.1.

—. 2008n. “Review of Administrative Expenses Allo-cated to GEF Implementing Agencies.” GEF/C.33/8.

—. 2008o. “Rules for Utilization of RAF Resources by Group Allocation Countries after July 1, 2008.” www.gefweb.org/uploadedFiles/Policies/Resource_Allocation_Framework/GEF-4_Indicative_Allocations/Rules%20for%20Group%20allocation%20countries%20from%2007.31.08.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2008p. “Second Progress Report on the Imple-mentation of the GEF Strategic Approach to Capacity Development.” GEF/C.33/Inf.5.

—. 2008q. “Sub-Regional Workshop for GEF Focal Points in East & Southern Africa, Workshop Summary Report.” www.gefweb.org/uploadedFiles/Windhoek%20Draft%20Workshop%20Summary_24%20July%2008_final_ENG.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

GEF CEO (Global Environment Facility Chief Executive Officer). 2005. Letter to GEF Council, April 8, 2005. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/Letter_to_Council_RAF_Technical_Notes.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

Page 216: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

142 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

—. 2006a. Communication to Implementing and Executing Agencies on PIFs. December 14, 2006.

—. 2006b. 1st letter to focal points, March 7, 2006.

—. 2006c. 2nd letter to focal points. May 4, 2006.

—. 2006d. 3rd letter to focal points, August 8, 2006.

—. 2006e. 4th letter to focal points, October 5, 2006.

—. 2006f. 5th letter to focal points, December 15, 2006.

—. 2006g. 6th letter to focal points, December 15, 2006.

GEF Council Member, Belgium. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/Belgium.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, Bolivia. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/Bolivia.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

—. n.d. Letter to Council.

GEF Council Member, Canada. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/Canada.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, Colombia. 2004a. Comments on the RAF (June 29). www.thegef.org/Whats_New/PBA_Comments_-_Colombia_0629-04.pdf.Accessed March 18, 2009.

—. 2004b. Comments on the RAF (June 30). www.thegef.org/Whats_New/PBA_Comments_-_Colombia_0630-04.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

—. 2004c. Comments on the RAF (November 3). www.thegef.org/Whats_New/Colombia.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, Germany. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/PBA_Comments_-_Germany.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, India. 2004a. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/PBA_Comments_-_India.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

—. 2004b. Comments on the RAF on behalf of the constituency comprising Bangladesh, Bhutan, India, Maldives, Nepal, and Sri Lanka. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/India.doc. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, Mexico. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/MEXICO_RAF_GEF.doc. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, the Netherlands. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/PBA_Comments_-_Netherlands.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, Pakistan. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/PBA_Comments_-_Pakistan.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, Spain. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/Spain.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, Switzerland. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/Switzerland.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, United Kingdom. 2004. Com-ments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/UK_1014-04.doc. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF Council Member, United States. 2004. Comments on the RAF. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/US.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

GEF EO (Global Environment Facility Evaluation Office). 2006a. Annual Performance Report 2004. Evaluation Report No. 29.

—. 2006b. The Role of Local Benefits in Global Envi-ronmental Programs. Evaluation Report No. 30.

—. 2006c. “Monitoring: Overview of Approaches in the GEF Family.”

—. 2007a. Evaluation of the Experience of Execut-ing Agencies under Expanded Opportunities in the GEF. Evaluation Report No. 35.

—. 2007b. GEF Country Portfolio Evaluation: Costa Rica (1992–2005). Evaluation Report No. 32.

—. 2007c. “Joint Evaluation of the Activity Cycle: Priorities and Indicators for Global Environment Benefits from Biodiversity: The Current Interna-tional Architecture.” Impact Evaluation Informa-tion Document No. 5.

—. 2007d. Joint Evaluation of the GEF Activity Cycle and Modalities. Evaluation Report No. 33.

—. 2008a. “Annual Country Portfolio Evaluation Report—2008.” GEF/ME/C.33/4.

—. 2008b. “Background and Elements for a GEF Monitoring and Evaluation Framework on Adaptation: Lessons from GEF Climate Change Adaptation Projects.” www.gefweb.

Page 217: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Bibliography 143

org/uploadedFiles/Documents/LDCFSCCF_Council_Documents/LDCFSCCF4_April_2008/LDCF.SCCF.4.Inf.4%20M%20and%20E%20of%20Adaptation%20Projects%2003.21.08.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2008c. GEF Annual Performance Report 2007. Evaluation Report No. 40.

—. 2008d. GEF Country Portfolio Evaluation: Benin (1994–2007). Evaluation Report No. 41.

—. 2008e. GEF Country Portfolio Evaluation: Mad-agascar (1994–2007). Evaluation Report No. 42.

—. 2008f. GEF Country Portfolio Evaluation: Samoa (1992–2007). Evaluation Report No. 37.

—. 2008g. GEF Country Portfolio Evaluation: South Africa (1994–2007). Evaluation Report No. 43.

—. 2008h. Joint Evaluation of the GEF Small Grants Programme. Evaluation Report No. 39.

GEF (Global Environment Facility) Implementing Agency Executive Coordinators. Summary of Sep-tember 21, 2006 Meeting.

GEF M&E Unit (Global Environment Facility Monitor-ing and Evaluation Unit). 2004. “Review of GEF Engagement with the Private Sector: Final Report.” GEF/C.23/Inf.4.

GEF NDI (Global Environment Facility National Dia-logue Initiative). 2005. GEF National Coordina-tion—Lessons Learned. www.gefcountrysupport.org/docs/4.pdf. Accessed April 1, 2009.

GEF RAF (Global Environment Facility Resource Allo-cation Framework) Implementation Team. 2006a. “Summary of the RAFT November 2005 Brain-storming Meeting.”

—. 2006b. “Summary of the Second Meeting of the RAFT January 24, 2006.”

—. 2006c. “Summary of the Third Meeting of the RAFT March 3, 2006.”

—. 2006d. “Summary of the Fourth Meeting of the RAFT, March 8, 2006.”

GEF (Global Environment Facility) Secretariat. 2005. “RAF Implications in the Biodiversity Focal Area Input from the GEF Biodiversity Task Force to the RAFT.”

—. 2006. “GEF Resource Allocation Framework Frequently Asked Questions: General.” http://

cfapp2.undp.org/gef_dialogue/guidance/raffaqs.pdf. Accessed April 7, 2009.

—. 2007a. “FY 2007 GEF Annual Monitoring Review (AMR) Guidelines.”

—. 2007b. “RAF at a Glance: GEF’s Framework for Allocating Resources.” www.gefweb.org/uploadedFiles/Policies/Resource_Allocation_Framework/RAF%20At%20A%20Glance%20Sept%2009%202007.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2008a. “Annual Monitoring Review Report 2007.” GEF/C.33/4.

—. 2008b. “Climate Change Mitigation Task Force Meeting September 18, 2008.”

—. 2008c. “Management Response to the Annual Country Portfolio Evaluation Report—2008.” GEF/ME/C.33/5.

—. 2008d. “Management Response to the GEF Annual Performance Report 2007.” GEF/ME/C.33/3.

—. 2008e. “RAF Reallocation Scenarios.” Power-Point presentation, January 29, 2008.

—. n.d. “Toolkit to Access Financial Resources under the Country Support Program for Focal Points.” www.gefweb.org/participants/focal_points/documents/COUNTRYSUPPORTPROGRAMTOOLKIT.April04.06-ENGLISH.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

GEF STAP (Global Environment Facility Scientific and Technical Advisory Panel). 2004a. “A Conceptual Design Tool for Exploiting Inter-linkages between the Focal Areas of the GEF.” GEF/C.24/Inf.10.

—. 2004b. “Statement of Julia Carabias, Chair of the Scientific and Technical Advisory Panel (STAP).” GEF/C.23/CRP.2.

—. 2007a. “STAP Summary Report: July 2007–October 2007.” GEF/C.32/Inf.7.

—. 2007b. “Workshop Report: STAP Workshop on Small Island Developing States (SIDS), Groundwa-ter and Interlinkages.” GEF/C.31/Inf.8.

—. 2008a. “Carbon Dioxide Capture and Storage: Conclusions and Recommendations from a STAP Brainstorming Meeting, October 17–18, 2007.” GEF/ME/C.33/Inf.14.

Page 218: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

144 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

—. 2008b. “STAP Summary Report.” GEF/C.33/Inf.11.

Gelb, A., B. Ngo, and X. Ye. 2004. “Implementing Per-formance-Based Aid in Africa: The Country Pol-icy and Institutional Assessment.” Africa Region Working Paper Series No. 77. Washington, DC.: World Bank.

IDA (International Development Association). 2000. “IDA Country Performance Rating Process: Annual Report 1999.”

—. 2001a. “Adapting IDA’s Performance-Based Allocations to Post-Conflict Countries.” http:// siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/Seminar%20PDFs/performanceANDallocations.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2001b. “IDA Allocations to Blend Coun-tries.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/Seminar%20PDFs/blend%20countires.pdf. Accessed March 31, 209.

—. 2002. “Additional IDA Resources: Thirteenth Replenishment.” IDA/SecM2002-0488.

—. 2003a. “Allocating IDA Funds Based on Performance: Fourth Annual Report on IDA’s Country Assessment and Allocation Process.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/PBAAR4.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2003b. “IDA’s Performance-Based Alloca-tion System: Current and Emerging Issues.” IDA/R2003-0203.

—. 2004a. “Debt Sustainability and Financing Terms in IDA14: Further Considerations on Issues and Options.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/DebtSustainabilityNov04.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2004b. “Disclosing IDA Country Performance Ratings.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/disclosingIDACPR.pdf. Accessed March 17.2009.

—. 2004c. “IDA’s Performance-Based Allocation System: IDA Rating Disclosure and Fine-tuning the Governance Factor.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/PBAFINAL.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2004d. “Supporting Small and Vulnerable States.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/SupportingSmallVulnerableStates.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2005. “Country Policy and Institutional Assess-ments (CPIA): 2005 Assessment Questionnaire.”

—. 2006a. “Country Policy and Institutional Assess-ments (CPIA): 2006 Assessment Questionnaire.”

—. 200b6. “IDA’s Performance-Based Allocation System: A Review of the Governance Factor.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/Seminar%20PDFs/73449-1164920192653/PBA.pdf. Accessed April 7, 2009.

—. 2007a. “Country Policy and Institutional Assess-ments: 2007 Assessment Questionnaire.” http://sit-eresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/CPIA-2007Questionnaire.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2007b. “The Demand for IDA15 Resources and the Strategy for their Effective Use.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/Seminar%20PDFs/73449-1172525976405/3492866-1172526109259/MZFinancingRequirements.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2007c. “Chairman’s Summary IDA15 Deputies Meeting.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/Seminar%20PDFs/73449-1172525976405/3492866-1175095887430/ChairmanSummaryDCMeeting.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2007d. “IDA’s Performance-Based Allocation System: Simplification of the Formula and Other Outstanding Issues.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/Seminar%20P D Fs / 7 3 4 4 9 - 1 1 7 2 5 2 5 9 7 6 4 0 5 / 3 4 9 2 8 6 6 -1175095887430/PBA_Sept.2007.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2007e. “IDA’s Thirteenth Replenishment: A Retrospective Review.”

—. 2007f. “Operations Policy and Country Services. Focus on Results: The IDA14 Results Measurement System and Directions for IDA15.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/Seminar%20PDFs/73449-1172525976405/3492866-1175095887430/IDA15Results.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2007. “Selectivity and Performance: IDA’s Country Assessment and Development Effectiveness.” www-wds.worldbank.org/external/default/WDSContentServer/WDSP/IB/2007/03/01/000310607_20070301092100/Rendered/PDF/38851core.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

Page 219: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Bibliography 145

—. n.d. “Country Policy and Institutional Assess-ment: Frequently Asked Questions.” http://go.worldbank.org/EEAIU81ZG0. Accessed March 17, 2009.

IFAD (International Fund for Agricultural Develop-ment). 2005. “Review of the Implementation of the Performance-Based Allocation System in IFAD.”

—. 2006. “Progress Report on Implementation of the Performance-Based Allocation System.” Rome.

IFAD and GEF (International Fund for Agricultural Development and Global Environment Facility). n.d. “IFAD/GEF Engagement Strategy for the Fourth Replenishment.”

IPCC (Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change). 2007. “Summary for Policymakers.” In M. L. Parry, O. F. Canziani, J. P. Palutikof, P. J. van der Linden, and C. E. Hanson, eds., Climate Change 2007: Impacts, Adaptation and Vulnerability. Contribu-tion of Working Group II to the Fourth Assessment Report of the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change, pp. 7–22. Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.

Kaufmann, D., A. Kraay, and M. Mastruzzi. 2003. “Governance Matters III: Governance Indicators for 1996–2002.” Policy Research Working Paper No. 3106. Washington, DC: World Bank.

—. 2007. “The Worldwide Governance Indicators Project: Answering the Critics.” Policy Research Working Paper No. 4149. Washington, DC: World Bank.

—. 2008. “Governance Matters VII: Aggregated and Individual Governance Indicators, 1996-2007.” Policy Research Paper No. 4654. Washington, DC: World Bank.

Kaufmann, D., A. Kraay, and P. Zoido-Lobatón. 2002. “Governance Matters II: Updated Indicators for 2000–2001.” Policy Research Working Paper No. 2772. Washington, DC: World Bank.

Learning Group of Global Programs on Aid Effectiveness. n.d. “Learning Group of Global Programs on Aid Effectiveness.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/ACCRAEXT/Resources/4700790-1210008992554/4968817-1218029841627/Learning-Group-Final.pdf. Accessed March 25, 2009.

Multilateral Development Banks. 2005. “Multilateral Development Bank Technical Meeting on Perfor-mance Based Allocation Methods.” Information note on meeting held January 24–25, 2005.

—. 2006. “The Second Multilateral Development Banks Technical Meeting on Performance-Based Allocation (PBA) Methods.” Chairman’s summary on meeting held March 8–9, 2006.

Naidoo, R., A. Balmford, P. J. Ferraro, S. Polasky, T. H. Ricketts, and M. Rouget. 2006. “Integrating Eco-nomic Costs into Conservation Planning.” Trends in Ecology & Evolution 21(12): 681–87.

Namibia. 2008. Statement on Behalf of the African Group on Agenda Item 4.16, Guidance to the Financial Mechanism of the Convention. Bonn: Conference of the Parties to the Convention on Biological Diversity.

OECD (Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development). 2003. Harmonising Donor Practices for Effective Aid Delivery. DAC Guidelines and Ref-erence Series. Paris.

—. 2006. “Declaration of Integrating Climate Change Adaptation into Development Co-oper-ation.” www.oecd.org/dataoecd/44/29/36426943.pdf. Accessed March 30, 2009.

OECD DCD-DAC (Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development Development Co-operation Directorate). 2008a. “DAC List of ODA Recipients Used for 2008, 2009 and 2010 Flows.” www.oecd.org/dac/stats/daclist. Accessed March 10, 2009.

—. 2008b. “Are We Ready for Accra …?” DACnews July. www.oecd.org/dataoecd/47/42/41018694.htm. Accessed March 10, 2009.

—. 2008c. Scaling Up: Aid Fragmentation, Aid Allocation and Aid Predictability: Report of 2008 Survey of Aid Allocation Policies and Indica-tive Forward Spending Plans. www.oecd.org/dataoecd/37/20/40636926.pdf. Accessed March 10, 2009.

—. n.d. “Paris Declaration: 12 Indicators of Prog-ress.” www.oecd.org/dataoecd/57/60/36080258.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

Parish, F., A. Sirin, D. Charman, H. Joosten, T. Minayeva, and M. Silvius, eds. 2007. “Assessment on Peat-lands, Biodiversity and Climate Change: Executive Summary.” Kuala Lumpur: Global Environment Centre and Wageningen, the Netherlands: Wet-lands International.

Poland Focal Point. 2007. Letter to GEF CEO, Janu-ary 4, 2007.

Page 220: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

146 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Reisen, H. 2008. “Chapter 2. Ownership in the Mul-tilateral Development-Finance Non-System.” In Financing Development 2008: Whose Ownership? Paris: Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development Development Centre.

Schuerch, W. E. (U.S. Treasury). 2003. Letter to GEF Council, October 16, 2003.

Udvardy, M. 1975. A Classification of Biogeographi-cally Provinces of the World. Occasional Paper No. 18. Morges, Switzerland: International Union for Conservation of Nature and Natural Resources.

UNCBD (United Nations Convention on Biological Diversity). 2006. “Report of the Third Meeting of the Conference of the Parties to the Convention on Biological Diversity Serving as the Meeting of the Parties to the Cartagena Protocol on Biosafety.” UNEP/CBD/BS/COP-MOP/3/15. www.cbd.int/doc/meetings/bs/mop-03/official/mop-03-15-en.pdf. Accessed March 30, 2009.

—. 2008a. “Decisions Adopted by the Confer-ence of the Parties to the Convention on Biologi-cal Diversity at Its Ninth Meeting.” www.cbd.int/doc/decisions/cop-09/full/cop-09-dec-en.pdf. Accessed March 30, 2009.

—. 2008b. “Report of the Fourth Meeting of the Conference of the Parties to the Convention on Biological Diversity Serving as the Meeting of the Parties to the Cartagena Protocol on Biosafety.” UNEP/CBD/BS/COP-MOP/4/18. www.cbd.int/doc/meetings/bs/mop-04/official/mop-04-18-en.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

—. 2008c. “Review of Implementation of Arti-cles 20 and 21—Review of the Effectiveness of the Financial Mechanism.” UNEP/CBD/COP/9/INF/20. www.cbd.int/doc/meetings/cop/cop-09/information/cop-09-inf-20-en.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

UNCBD (United Nations Convention on Biological Diversity) Executive Secretary. 2006. Letter to GEF CEO, December 22, 2006.

UNDP (United Nations Development Programme) Oslo Governance Centre and CMI (Chr. Michelsen Institute). 2007. Governance Assessments and the Paris Declaration: Opportunities for Inclusive Participation and National Ownership. www.undp.org/oslocentre/docs07/BergenSeminar.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

UNEP (United Nations Environment Programme). 2008. “Summary Report of the STAP Meeting 9–12 April, 2008.” GEF/C.33/Inf.13.

UNDG (United Nations Development Group). “Deliv-ering as One.” www.undg.org/?P=7. Accessed March 17, 2009.

UNEP (United Nations Environment Programme) Executive Director. 2007. “Proposal of the Execu-tive Director of UNEP on Enhancing the Impact of the Scientific and Technical Advisory Panel.” GEF/C.31/4.

—. 2008. “Proposal of the Executive Direc-tor of UNEP on the Reconstitution of STAP.” GEF/C.33/13/Rev. 1.

UNFCCC (United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change). 2008a. “Nairobi Work Programme on Impacts, Vulnerability and Adaptation to Climate Change.” http://unfccc.int/documentation/documents/advanced_search/items/3594.php?such=j&symbol=”FCCC/SBSTA/2008/L.13/Rev.1”#beg. Accessed March 18, 2009.

—. 2008b. “Report of the Conference of the Par-ties on Its Thirteenth Session,” Addendum Part Two. http://unfccc.int/resource/docs/2007/cop13/eng/06a01.pdf. Accessed March 18, 2009.

UNFCCC (United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change) Secretariat. 2004. Letter to GEF Acting Deputy CEO on RAF’s consistency with the conventions, eligibility, indicators for climate change, and availability of data. www.thegef.org/Whats_New/UNFCCC.doc. Accessed March 17, 2009.

United Nations General Assembly Economic and Social Council. 2008. “Summary by the President of the Economic and Social Council of the Special High-Level Meeting of the Council with the Bretton Woods Institutions, the World Trade Organiza-tion and the United Nations Conference on Trade and Development.” http://daccessdds.un.org/doc/UNDOC/GEN/N08/347/45/PDF/N0834745.pdf?OpenElement. Accessed March 18, 2009.

Universal Ecological Fund (FEU-US), World Wide Fund for Nature (WWF), Birdlife International, Conser-vation International, and the Nature Conservancy. 2008. “The Impact of the Global Environment Facility’s Resource Allocation Framework on Civil Society Organizations, Preliminary Report.”

Page 221: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Bibliography 147

UNJIU (United Nations System Joint Inspection Unit). 2007. “Results-Based Management in the United Nations in the Context of the Reform Process.” JIU/rep/2006/6. Geneva.

Vogt, W. P. 1993. Dictionary of Statistics and Methodol-ogy: A Nontechnical Guide for the Social Sciences. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.

Watson, R. T., I. R. Noble, B. Bolin, N. H. Ravindranath, D. J. Verardo, and D. J. Dokken, eds. 2000. Land Use, Land-Use Change, and Forestry: A Special Report of the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change. Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.

Wiser, G. M. 2007. “Legal Analysis of the GEF Resource Allocation Framework.” Washington, DC: Center for International Environmental Law.

Wood, B., D. Kabell, F. Sagasti, and N. Muwanga. 2008. “Synthesis Report on the First Phase of the Evalu-ation of the Implementation of the Paris Declara-tion.” Copenhagen.

World Bank. 1998. Assessing Aid: What Works, What Doesn’t, and Why. New York: Oxford University Press.

—. 1999. “Governance Matters.” Policy Research Working Paper 2196. Washington, DC.

—. 2004. “Country Policy and Institutional Assess-ments: An External Panel Review Panel Recom-mendations and Management Follow-up.” http://siteresources.worldbank.org/IDA/Resources/CPIAExpPanRepSecM2004-0304.pdf. Accessed March 17, 2009.

—. 2005. “Governance Matters IV: Governance Indicators for 1996–2004.” Policy Research Work-ing Paper 3630. Washington, DC.

—. 2006a. “Governance Matters V: Aggregate and Individual Governance Indicators for 1996–2005.” Policy Research Working Paper 4012. Washington, DC.

—. 2006b. “OP 3.10, Annex D: IBRD/IDA Coun-tries: Per Capita Incomes, Lending Eligibility, and Repayment Terms.” In The World Bank Opera-tional Manual: Operational Policies. http:// go.worldbank.org/0BM4HLLCB0. Accessed March 18, 2009.

—. 2007. “Governance Matters VI: Aggregate and Individual Governance Indicators for 1996–2006.”

Policy Research Working Paper 4280. Washington, DC.

—. n.d. “GMR 2008 Fact Sheet: Scaling Up Aid: Opportunities and Challenges in a Chang-ing Aid Architecture.” http://go.worldbank.org/F6Z5B2E6X0. Accessed March 17, 2009.

World Bank, Independent Evaluation Group (IEG) 2006. Engaging with Fragile States: An IEG Review of World Bank Support to Low-Income Countries under Stress. Washington, DC.

World Bank, Operations Evaluation Department (OED). 2001. “IDA Review. International Develop-ment Review of the Performance-Based Allocation System, IDA 10-12.”

World Bank and IMF (International Monetary Fund). 2006. Global Monitoring Report 2006: Strength-ening Mutual Accountability—Aid, Trade and Governance.

—. 2007. Global Monitoring Report 2007: Millen-nium Development Goals: Confronting the Chal-lenges of Gender Equality and Fragile States.

—. 2008. Global Monitoring Report 2008: MDGs and the Environment: Agenda for Inclusive and Sustainable Development.

Web sitesATLAS.ti. www.atlasti.de.

Environmental Vulnerability Index. www.vulnerabili-tyindex.net/.

FishBase. www.fishbase.org.

IUCN Red List. www.iucnredlist.org/.

Ocean Biogeographic Information System. www.iobis.org/.

KGSMapper. http://drysdale.kgs.ku.edu/website/Specimen_Mapper/.

Marine Mammals of the World. http://nlbif.eti.uva.nl/bis/marine_mammals.php?menuentry=atlas.

National Center for Ecological Analysis and Synthesis, A Global Map of Human Impacts to Marine Eco-systems. www.nceas.ucsb.edu/GlobalMarine.

Old Dominion University College of Sciences Global Marine Species Assessment. www.sci.odu.edu/gmsa/.

Page 222: Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

148 Midterm Review of the Resource Allocation Framework

Reefbase. www.reefbase.org/global_database/default.aspx?section=r5).

Sea Around Us Project. www.seaaroundus.org/distri-bution/search.aspx.

United Nations Environment Programme World Conser-vation Monitoring Centre. www.unep-wcmc.org/.

World Wildlife Fund, Marine Ecoregions of the World. www.worldwildlife.org/MEOW/.